]> git.ipfire.org Git - thirdparty/gcc.git/blame - gcc/doc/tm.texi
Remove LIBGCC2_HAS_?F_MODE target macros.
[thirdparty/gcc.git] / gcc / doc / tm.texi
CommitLineData
23a5b65a 1@c Copyright (C) 1988-2014 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
feca2ed3
JW
2@c This is part of the GCC manual.
3@c For copying conditions, see the file gcc.texi.
4
5@node Target Macros
672a6f42 6@chapter Target Description Macros and Functions
feca2ed3
JW
7@cindex machine description macros
8@cindex target description macros
9@cindex macros, target description
10@cindex @file{tm.h} macros
11
12In addition to the file @file{@var{machine}.md}, a machine description
13includes a C header file conventionally given the name
672a6f42
NB
14@file{@var{machine}.h} and a C source file named @file{@var{machine}.c}.
15The header file defines numerous macros that convey the information
16about the target machine that does not fit into the scheme of the
17@file{.md} file. The file @file{tm.h} should be a link to
18@file{@var{machine}.h}. The header file @file{config.h} includes
19@file{tm.h} and most compiler source files include @file{config.h}. The
648c546a 20source file defines a variable @code{targetm}, which is a structure
672a6f42
NB
21containing pointers to functions and data relating to the target
22machine. @file{@var{machine}.c} should also contain their definitions,
23if they are not defined elsewhere in GCC, and other functions called
24through the macros defined in the @file{.h} file.
feca2ed3
JW
25
26@menu
648c546a 27* Target Structure:: The @code{targetm} variable.
feca2ed3 28* Driver:: Controlling how the driver runs the compilation passes.
630d3d5a 29* Run-time Target:: Defining @samp{-m} options like @option{-m68000} and @option{-m68020}.
414c4dc4 30* Per-Function Data:: Defining data structures for per-function information.
feca2ed3
JW
31* Storage Layout:: Defining sizes and alignments of data.
32* Type Layout:: Defining sizes and properties of basic user data types.
33* Registers:: Naming and describing the hardware registers.
34* Register Classes:: Defining the classes of hardware registers.
35* Stack and Calling:: Defining which way the stack grows and by how much.
6ccde948 36* Varargs:: Defining the varargs macros.
feca2ed3
JW
37* Trampolines:: Code set up at run time to enter a nested function.
38* Library Calls:: Controlling how library routines are implicitly called.
39* Addressing Modes:: Defining addressing modes valid for memory operands.
aacd3885 40* Anchored Addresses:: Defining how @option{-fsection-anchors} should work.
feca2ed3
JW
41* Condition Code:: Defining how insns update the condition code.
42* Costs:: Defining relative costs of different operations.
c237e94a 43* Scheduling:: Adjusting the behavior of the instruction scheduler.
feca2ed3 44* Sections:: Dividing storage into text, data, and other sections.
6ccde948 45* PIC:: Macros for position independent code.
feca2ed3
JW
46* Assembler Format:: Defining how to write insns and pseudo-ops to output.
47* Debugging Info:: Defining the format of debugging output.
b216cd4a 48* Floating Point:: Handling floating point for cross-compilers.
9f09b1f2 49* Mode Switching:: Insertion of mode-switching instructions.
91d231cb 50* Target Attributes:: Defining target-specific uses of @code{__attribute__}.
feb60f03 51* Emulated TLS:: Emulated TLS support.
d604bca3 52* MIPS Coprocessors:: MIPS coprocessor support and how to customize it.
7bb1ad93 53* PCH Target:: Validity checking for precompiled headers.
4185ae53 54* C++ ABI:: Controlling C++ ABI changes.
09e881c9 55* Named Address Spaces:: Adding support for named address spaces
feca2ed3
JW
56* Misc:: Everything else.
57@end menu
58
672a6f42 59@node Target Structure
648c546a 60@section The Global @code{targetm} Variable
672a6f42
NB
61@cindex target hooks
62@cindex target functions
63
f6897b10
SS
64@deftypevar {struct gcc_target} targetm
65The target @file{.c} file must define the global @code{targetm} variable
672a6f42
NB
66which contains pointers to functions and data relating to the target
67machine. The variable is declared in @file{target.h};
68@file{target-def.h} defines the macro @code{TARGET_INITIALIZER} which is
69used to initialize the variable, and macros for the default initializers
70for elements of the structure. The @file{.c} file should override those
71macros for which the default definition is inappropriate. For example:
72@smallexample
73#include "target.h"
74#include "target-def.h"
75
76/* @r{Initialize the GCC target structure.} */
77
91d231cb
JM
78#undef TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES
79#define TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES @var{machine}_comp_type_attributes
672a6f42 80
f6897b10 81struct gcc_target targetm = TARGET_INITIALIZER;
672a6f42
NB
82@end smallexample
83@end deftypevar
84
85Where a macro should be defined in the @file{.c} file in this manner to
648c546a 86form part of the @code{targetm} structure, it is documented below as a
672a6f42
NB
87``Target Hook'' with a prototype. Many macros will change in future
88from being defined in the @file{.h} file to being part of the
648c546a 89@code{targetm} structure.
672a6f42 90
acce4e77
JM
91Similarly, there is a @code{targetcm} variable for hooks that are
92specific to front ends for C-family languages, documented as ``C
93Target Hook''. This is declared in @file{c-family/c-target.h}, the
dd5a833e 94initializer @code{TARGETCM_INITIALIZER} in
acce4e77
JM
95@file{c-family/c-target-def.h}. If targets initialize @code{targetcm}
96themselves, they should set @code{target_has_targetcm=yes} in
97@file{config.gcc}; otherwise a default definition is used.
98
c49a6962
JM
99Similarly, there is a @code{targetm_common} variable for hooks that
100are shared between the compiler driver and the compilers proper,
101documented as ``Common Target Hook''. This is declared in
102@file{common/common-target.h}, the initializer
103@code{TARGETM_COMMON_INITIALIZER} in
104@file{common/common-target-def.h}. If targets initialize
105@code{targetm_common} themselves, they should set
106@code{target_has_targetm_common=yes} in @file{config.gcc}; otherwise a
107default definition is used.
108
feca2ed3
JW
109@node Driver
110@section Controlling the Compilation Driver, @file{gcc}
111@cindex driver
112@cindex controlling the compilation driver
113
114@c prevent bad page break with this line
115You can control the compilation driver.
116
a2c4f8e0 117@defmac DRIVER_SELF_SPECS
db36994b
RS
118A list of specs for the driver itself. It should be a suitable
119initializer for an array of strings, with no surrounding braces.
120
3bd6d4c4
AO
121The driver applies these specs to its own command line between loading
122default @file{specs} files (but not command-line specified ones) and
123choosing the multilib directory or running any subcommands. It
124applies them in the order given, so each spec can depend on the
125options added by earlier ones. It is also possible to remove options
126using @samp{%<@var{option}} in the usual way.
db36994b
RS
127
128This macro can be useful when a port has several interdependent target
129options. It provides a way of standardizing the command line so
130that the other specs are easier to write.
131
132Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
a2c4f8e0 133@end defmac
db36994b 134
a2c4f8e0 135@defmac OPTION_DEFAULT_SPECS
7816bea0
DJ
136A list of specs used to support configure-time default options (i.e.@:
137@option{--with} options) in the driver. It should be a suitable initializer
138for an array of structures, each containing two strings, without the
139outermost pair of surrounding braces.
140
141The first item in the pair is the name of the default. This must match
142the code in @file{config.gcc} for the target. The second item is a spec
143to apply if a default with this name was specified. The string
144@samp{%(VALUE)} in the spec will be replaced by the value of the default
145everywhere it occurs.
146
147The driver will apply these specs to its own command line between loading
148default @file{specs} files and processing @code{DRIVER_SELF_SPECS}, using
149the same mechanism as @code{DRIVER_SELF_SPECS}.
150
151Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
a2c4f8e0 152@end defmac
7816bea0 153
a2c4f8e0 154@defmac CPP_SPEC
a3a15b4d 155A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
161d7b59
JM
156pass to CPP@. It can also specify how to translate options you
157give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the CPP@.
feca2ed3
JW
158
159Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
a2c4f8e0 160@end defmac
feca2ed3 161
a2c4f8e0 162@defmac CPLUSPLUS_CPP_SPEC
a9374841 163This macro is just like @code{CPP_SPEC}, but is used for C++, rather
161d7b59 164than C@. If you do not define this macro, then the value of
a9374841 165@code{CPP_SPEC} (if any) will be used instead.
a2c4f8e0 166@end defmac
a9374841 167
a2c4f8e0 168@defmac CC1_SPEC
a3a15b4d 169A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
66519c70
JL
170pass to @code{cc1}, @code{cc1plus}, @code{f771}, and the other language
171front ends.
a3a15b4d 172It can also specify how to translate options you give to GCC into options
630d3d5a 173for GCC to pass to front ends.
feca2ed3
JW
174
175Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
a2c4f8e0 176@end defmac
feca2ed3 177
a2c4f8e0 178@defmac CC1PLUS_SPEC
a3a15b4d 179A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
feca2ed3 180pass to @code{cc1plus}. It can also specify how to translate options you
a3a15b4d 181give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the @code{cc1plus}.
feca2ed3
JW
182
183Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
1d96e5b4
FF
184Note that everything defined in CC1_SPEC is already passed to
185@code{cc1plus} so there is no need to duplicate the contents of
161d7b59 186CC1_SPEC in CC1PLUS_SPEC@.
a2c4f8e0 187@end defmac
feca2ed3 188
a2c4f8e0 189@defmac ASM_SPEC
a3a15b4d 190A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
feca2ed3 191pass to the assembler. It can also specify how to translate options
a3a15b4d 192you give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the assembler.
feca2ed3
JW
193See the file @file{sun3.h} for an example of this.
194
195Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
a2c4f8e0 196@end defmac
feca2ed3 197
a2c4f8e0 198@defmac ASM_FINAL_SPEC
a3a15b4d 199A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program how to
feca2ed3
JW
200run any programs which cleanup after the normal assembler.
201Normally, this is not needed. See the file @file{mips.h} for
202an example of this.
203
204Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
a2c4f8e0 205@end defmac
feca2ed3 206
a2c4f8e0 207@defmac AS_NEEDS_DASH_FOR_PIPED_INPUT
4977bab6
ZW
208Define this macro, with no value, if the driver should give the assembler
209an argument consisting of a single dash, @option{-}, to instruct it to
210read from its standard input (which will be a pipe connected to the
211output of the compiler proper). This argument is given after any
212@option{-o} option specifying the name of the output file.
213
214If you do not define this macro, the assembler is assumed to read its
215standard input if given no non-option arguments. If your assembler
216cannot read standard input at all, use a @samp{%@{pipe:%e@}} construct;
217see @file{mips.h} for instance.
a2c4f8e0 218@end defmac
4977bab6 219
a2c4f8e0 220@defmac LINK_SPEC
a3a15b4d 221A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
feca2ed3 222pass to the linker. It can also specify how to translate options you
a3a15b4d 223give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the linker.
feca2ed3
JW
224
225Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
a2c4f8e0 226@end defmac
feca2ed3 227
a2c4f8e0 228@defmac LIB_SPEC
feca2ed3
JW
229Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}. The difference
230between the two is that @code{LIB_SPEC} is used at the end of the
231command given to the linker.
232
233If this macro is not defined, a default is provided that
234loads the standard C library from the usual place. See @file{gcc.c}.
a2c4f8e0 235@end defmac
feca2ed3 236
a2c4f8e0 237@defmac LIBGCC_SPEC
a3a15b4d 238Another C string constant that tells the GCC driver program
feca2ed3
JW
239how and when to place a reference to @file{libgcc.a} into the
240linker command line. This constant is placed both before and after
241the value of @code{LIB_SPEC}.
242
a3a15b4d 243If this macro is not defined, the GCC driver provides a default that
630d3d5a 244passes the string @option{-lgcc} to the linker.
a2c4f8e0 245@end defmac
feca2ed3 246
328163dc
MA
247@defmac REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC
248By default, if @code{ENABLE_SHARED_LIBGCC} is defined, the
249@code{LIBGCC_SPEC} is not directly used by the driver program but is
250instead modified to refer to different versions of @file{libgcc.a}
4ec7afd7
KH
251depending on the values of the command line flags @option{-static},
252@option{-shared}, @option{-static-libgcc}, and @option{-shared-libgcc}. On
328163dc
MA
253targets where these modifications are inappropriate, define
254@code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC} instead. @code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC} tells the
255driver how to place a reference to @file{libgcc} on the link command
256line, but, unlike @code{LIBGCC_SPEC}, it is used unmodified.
257@end defmac
258
743eeb5a
AM
259@defmac USE_LD_AS_NEEDED
260A macro that controls the modifications to @code{LIBGCC_SPEC}
261mentioned in @code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC}. If nonzero, a spec will be
e927b6ad
RO
262generated that uses @option{--as-needed} or equivalent options and the
263shared @file{libgcc} in place of the
743eeb5a
AM
264static exception handler library, when linking without any of
265@code{-static}, @code{-static-libgcc}, or @code{-shared-libgcc}.
266@end defmac
267
268@defmac LINK_EH_SPEC
269If defined, this C string constant is added to @code{LINK_SPEC}.
270When @code{USE_LD_AS_NEEDED} is zero or undefined, it also affects
271the modifications to @code{LIBGCC_SPEC} mentioned in
272@code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC}.
273@end defmac
274
a2c4f8e0 275@defmac STARTFILE_SPEC
feca2ed3
JW
276Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}. The
277difference between the two is that @code{STARTFILE_SPEC} is used at
278the very beginning of the command given to the linker.
279
280If this macro is not defined, a default is provided that loads the
281standard C startup file from the usual place. See @file{gcc.c}.
a2c4f8e0 282@end defmac
feca2ed3 283
a2c4f8e0 284@defmac ENDFILE_SPEC
feca2ed3
JW
285Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}. The
286difference between the two is that @code{ENDFILE_SPEC} is used at
287the very end of the command given to the linker.
288
289Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
a2c4f8e0 290@end defmac
feca2ed3 291
a2c4f8e0 292@defmac THREAD_MODEL_SPEC
008355a6
AO
293GCC @code{-v} will print the thread model GCC was configured to use.
294However, this doesn't work on platforms that are multilibbed on thread
295models, such as AIX 4.3. On such platforms, define
296@code{THREAD_MODEL_SPEC} such that it evaluates to a string without
297blanks that names one of the recognized thread models. @code{%*}, the
298default value of this macro, will expand to the value of
299@code{thread_file} set in @file{config.gcc}.
a2c4f8e0 300@end defmac
008355a6 301
a2c4f8e0 302@defmac SYSROOT_SUFFIX_SPEC
73774972
EC
303Define this macro to add a suffix to the target sysroot when GCC is
304configured with a sysroot. This will cause GCC to search for usr/lib,
305et al, within sysroot+suffix.
a2c4f8e0 306@end defmac
e7f13528 307
a2c4f8e0 308@defmac SYSROOT_HEADERS_SUFFIX_SPEC
73774972
EC
309Define this macro to add a headers_suffix to the target sysroot when
310GCC is configured with a sysroot. This will cause GCC to pass the
f4314bb6 311updated sysroot+headers_suffix to CPP, causing it to search for
e7f13528 312usr/include, et al, within sysroot+headers_suffix.
a2c4f8e0 313@end defmac
e7f13528 314
a2c4f8e0 315@defmac EXTRA_SPECS
feca2ed3
JW
316Define this macro to provide additional specifications to put in the
317@file{specs} file that can be used in various specifications like
318@code{CC1_SPEC}.
319
320The definition should be an initializer for an array of structures,
321containing a string constant, that defines the specification name, and a
322string constant that provides the specification.
323
324Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
325
326@code{EXTRA_SPECS} is useful when an architecture contains several
630d3d5a 327related targets, which have various @code{@dots{}_SPECS} which are similar
feca2ed3
JW
328to each other, and the maintainer would like one central place to keep
329these definitions.
330
331For example, the PowerPC System V.4 targets use @code{EXTRA_SPECS} to
332define either @code{_CALL_SYSV} when the System V calling sequence is
333used or @code{_CALL_AIX} when the older AIX-based calling sequence is
334used.
335
336The @file{config/rs6000/rs6000.h} target file defines:
337
3ab51846 338@smallexample
feca2ed3
JW
339#define EXTRA_SPECS \
340 @{ "cpp_sysv_default", CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT @},
341
342#define CPP_SYS_DEFAULT ""
3ab51846 343@end smallexample
feca2ed3
JW
344
345The @file{config/rs6000/sysv.h} target file defines:
346@smallexample
347#undef CPP_SPEC
348#define CPP_SPEC \
349"%@{posix: -D_POSIX_SOURCE @} \
50d440bc
NC
350%@{mcall-sysv: -D_CALL_SYSV @} \
351%@{!mcall-sysv: %(cpp_sysv_default) @} \
feca2ed3
JW
352%@{msoft-float: -D_SOFT_FLOAT@} %@{mcpu=403: -D_SOFT_FLOAT@}"
353
354#undef CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT
355#define CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT "-D_CALL_SYSV"
356@end smallexample
357
358while the @file{config/rs6000/eabiaix.h} target file defines
359@code{CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT} as:
360
361@smallexample
362#undef CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT
363#define CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT "-D_CALL_AIX"
364@end smallexample
a2c4f8e0 365@end defmac
feca2ed3 366
a2c4f8e0 367@defmac LINK_LIBGCC_SPECIAL_1
feca2ed3
JW
368Define this macro if the driver program should find the library
369@file{libgcc.a}. If you do not define this macro, the driver program will pass
630d3d5a 370the argument @option{-lgcc} to tell the linker to do the search.
a2c4f8e0 371@end defmac
feca2ed3 372
a2c4f8e0 373@defmac LINK_GCC_C_SEQUENCE_SPEC
bbd7687d
DM
374The sequence in which libgcc and libc are specified to the linker.
375By default this is @code{%G %L %G}.
a2c4f8e0 376@end defmac
bbd7687d 377
a2c4f8e0 378@defmac LINK_COMMAND_SPEC
9ec36da5
JL
379A C string constant giving the complete command line need to execute the
380linker. When you do this, you will need to update your port each time a
381change is made to the link command line within @file{gcc.c}. Therefore,
382define this macro only if you need to completely redefine the command
383line for invoking the linker and there is no other way to accomplish
bbd7687d
DM
384the effect you need. Overriding this macro may be avoidable by overriding
385@code{LINK_GCC_C_SEQUENCE_SPEC} instead.
a2c4f8e0 386@end defmac
9ec36da5 387
c49a6962
JM
388@deftypevr {Common Target Hook} bool TARGET_ALWAYS_STRIP_DOTDOT
389True if @file{..} components should always be removed from directory names computed relative to GCC's internal directories, false (default) if such components should be preserved and directory names containing them passed to other tools such as the linker.
390@end deftypevr
391
a2c4f8e0 392@defmac MULTILIB_DEFAULTS
feca2ed3
JW
393Define this macro as a C expression for the initializer of an array of
394string to tell the driver program which options are defaults for this
395target and thus do not need to be handled specially when using
396@code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS}.
397
398Do not define this macro if @code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS} is not defined in
399the target makefile fragment or if none of the options listed in
400@code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS} are set by default.
401@xref{Target Fragment}.
a2c4f8e0 402@end defmac
feca2ed3 403
a2c4f8e0 404@defmac RELATIVE_PREFIX_NOT_LINKDIR
05739753 405Define this macro to tell @command{gcc} that it should only translate
630d3d5a 406a @option{-B} prefix into a @option{-L} linker option if the prefix
feca2ed3 407indicates an absolute file name.
a2c4f8e0 408@end defmac
feca2ed3 409
a2c4f8e0 410@defmac MD_EXEC_PREFIX
feca2ed3
JW
411If defined, this macro is an additional prefix to try after
412@code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}. @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX} is not searched
1401cf37 413when the compiler is built as a cross
5505263f
JL
414compiler. If you define @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, then be sure to add it
415to the list of directories used to find the assembler in @file{configure.in}.
a2c4f8e0 416@end defmac
feca2ed3 417
a2c4f8e0 418@defmac STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX
feca2ed3 419Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
0d037580 420standard choice of @code{libdir} as the default prefix to
feca2ed3 421try when searching for startup files such as @file{crt0.o}.
0d037580
DJ
422@code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX} is not searched when the compiler
423is built as a cross compiler.
a2c4f8e0 424@end defmac
feca2ed3 425
656c7a3a
AL
426@defmac STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1
427Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
428standard choice of @code{/lib} as a prefix to try after the default prefix
429when searching for startup files such as @file{crt0.o}.
430@code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1} is not searched when the compiler
431is built as a cross compiler.
432@end defmac
433
434@defmac STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_2
435Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
436standard choice of @code{/lib} as yet another prefix to try after the
437default prefix when searching for startup files such as @file{crt0.o}.
438@code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_2} is not searched when the compiler
439is built as a cross compiler.
440@end defmac
441
a2c4f8e0 442@defmac MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX
feca2ed3
JW
443If defined, this macro supplies an additional prefix to try after the
444standard prefixes. @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX} is not searched when the
1401cf37 445compiler is built as a cross compiler.
a2c4f8e0 446@end defmac
feca2ed3 447
a2c4f8e0 448@defmac MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1
feca2ed3 449If defined, this macro supplies yet another prefix to try after the
1401cf37
MLI
450standard prefixes. It is not searched when the compiler is built as a
451cross compiler.
a2c4f8e0 452@end defmac
feca2ed3 453
a2c4f8e0 454@defmac INIT_ENVIRONMENT
e9a25f70 455Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to set environment
feca2ed3
JW
456variables for programs called by the driver, such as the assembler and
457loader. The driver passes the value of this macro to @code{putenv} to
458initialize the necessary environment variables.
a2c4f8e0 459@end defmac
feca2ed3 460
a2c4f8e0 461@defmac LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR
feca2ed3
JW
462Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
463standard choice of @file{/usr/local/include} as the default prefix to
464try when searching for local header files. @code{LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR}
08b2bad2
SB
465comes before @code{NATIVE_SYSTEM_HEADER_DIR} (set in
466@file{config.gcc}, normally @file{/usr/include}) in the search order.
feca2ed3 467
c237e94a
ZW
468Cross compilers do not search either @file{/usr/local/include} or its
469replacement.
a2c4f8e0 470@end defmac
feca2ed3 471
08b2bad2
SB
472@defmac NATIVE_SYSTEM_HEADER_COMPONENT
473The ``component'' corresponding to @code{NATIVE_SYSTEM_HEADER_DIR}.
e9a25f70
JL
474See @code{INCLUDE_DEFAULTS}, below, for the description of components.
475If you do not define this macro, no component is used.
a2c4f8e0 476@end defmac
e9a25f70 477
a2c4f8e0 478@defmac INCLUDE_DEFAULTS
feca2ed3 479Define this macro if you wish to override the entire default search path
e9a25f70
JL
480for include files. For a native compiler, the default search path
481usually consists of @code{GCC_INCLUDE_DIR}, @code{LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR},
08b2bad2
SB
482@code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR}, and
483@code{NATIVE_SYSTEM_HEADER_DIR}. In addition, @code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR}
feca2ed3 484and @code{GCC_INCLUDE_DIR} are defined automatically by @file{Makefile},
161d7b59 485and specify private search areas for GCC@. The directory
feca2ed3
JW
486@code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR} is used only for C++ programs.
487
488The definition should be an initializer for an array of structures.
e9a25f70 489Each array element should have four elements: the directory name (a
9f6dc500
HPN
490string constant), the component name (also a string constant), a flag
491for C++-only directories,
e9a25f70
JL
492and a flag showing that the includes in the directory don't need to be
493wrapped in @code{extern @samp{C}} when compiling C++. Mark the end of
494the array with a null element.
495
496The component name denotes what GNU package the include file is part of,
4bd0bee9 497if any, in all uppercase letters. For example, it might be @samp{GCC}
9f6dc500 498or @samp{BINUTILS}. If the package is part of a vendor-supplied
e9a25f70
JL
499operating system, code the component name as @samp{0}.
500
e9a25f70 501For example, here is the definition used for VAX/VMS:
feca2ed3 502
3ab51846 503@smallexample
feca2ed3
JW
504#define INCLUDE_DEFAULTS \
505@{ \
e9a25f70
JL
506 @{ "GNU_GXX_INCLUDE:", "G++", 1, 1@}, \
507 @{ "GNU_CC_INCLUDE:", "GCC", 0, 0@}, \
508 @{ "SYS$SYSROOT:[SYSLIB.]", 0, 0, 0@}, \
509 @{ ".", 0, 0, 0@}, \
510 @{ 0, 0, 0, 0@} \
feca2ed3 511@}
3ab51846 512@end smallexample
a2c4f8e0 513@end defmac
feca2ed3
JW
514
515Here is the order of prefixes tried for exec files:
516
517@enumerate
518@item
630d3d5a 519Any prefixes specified by the user with @option{-B}.
feca2ed3
JW
520
521@item
fe037b8a 522The environment variable @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} or, if @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX}
ff2ce160 523is not set and the compiler has not been installed in the configure-time
fe037b8a 524@var{prefix}, the location in which the compiler has actually been installed.
feca2ed3
JW
525
526@item
527The directories specified by the environment variable @code{COMPILER_PATH}.
528
529@item
fe037b8a 530The macro @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if the compiler has been installed
ff2ce160 531in the configured-time @var{prefix}.
feca2ed3
JW
532
533@item
ff2ce160 534The location @file{/usr/libexec/gcc/}, but only if this is a native compiler.
feca2ed3
JW
535
536@item
ff2ce160 537The location @file{/usr/lib/gcc/}, but only if this is a native compiler.
fe037b8a
CD
538
539@item
ff2ce160 540The macro @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if defined, but only if this is a native
fe037b8a 541compiler.
feca2ed3
JW
542@end enumerate
543
544Here is the order of prefixes tried for startfiles:
545
546@enumerate
547@item
630d3d5a 548Any prefixes specified by the user with @option{-B}.
feca2ed3
JW
549
550@item
fe037b8a
CD
551The environment variable @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} or its automatically determined
552value based on the installed toolchain location.
feca2ed3
JW
553
554@item
555The directories specified by the environment variable @code{LIBRARY_PATH}
512b62fb 556(or port-specific name; native only, cross compilers do not use this).
feca2ed3
JW
557
558@item
fe037b8a 559The macro @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}, but only if the toolchain is installed
ff2ce160 560in the configured @var{prefix} or this is a native compiler.
feca2ed3
JW
561
562@item
fe037b8a
CD
563The location @file{/usr/lib/gcc/}, but only if this is a native compiler.
564
565@item
ff2ce160 566The macro @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if defined, but only if this is a native
fe037b8a 567compiler.
feca2ed3
JW
568
569@item
ff2ce160 570The macro @code{MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX}, if defined, but only if this is a
fe037b8a 571native compiler, or we have a target system root.
feca2ed3
JW
572
573@item
ff2ce160 574The macro @code{MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1}, if defined, but only if this is a
fe037b8a 575native compiler, or we have a target system root.
feca2ed3
JW
576
577@item
fe037b8a
CD
578The macro @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX}, with any sysroot modifications.
579If this path is relative it will be prefixed by @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} and
580the machine suffix or @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX} and the machine suffix.
feca2ed3
JW
581
582@item
fe037b8a
CD
583The macro @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1}, but only if this is a native
584compiler, or we have a target system root. The default for this macro is
feca2ed3
JW
585@file{/lib/}.
586
587@item
fe037b8a
CD
588The macro @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_2}, but only if this is a native
589compiler, or we have a target system root. The default for this macro is
feca2ed3
JW
590@file{/usr/lib/}.
591@end enumerate
592
593@node Run-time Target
594@section Run-time Target Specification
595@cindex run-time target specification
596@cindex predefined macros
597@cindex target specifications
598
599@c prevent bad page break with this line
600Here are run-time target specifications.
601
a2c4f8e0 602@defmac TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS ()
12a41c22 603This function-like macro expands to a block of code that defines
44082375 604built-in preprocessor macros and assertions for the target CPU, using
1f95326c 605the functions @code{builtin_define}, @code{builtin_define_std} and
cb60f38d 606@code{builtin_assert}. When the front end
12a41c22
NB
607calls this macro it provides a trailing semicolon, and since it has
608finished command line option processing your code can use those
609results freely.
3df89291
NB
610
611@code{builtin_assert} takes a string in the form you pass to the
612command-line option @option{-A}, such as @code{cpu=mips}, and creates
d90a95fb 613the assertion. @code{builtin_define} takes a string in the form
3df89291
NB
614accepted by option @option{-D} and unconditionally defines the macro.
615
d90a95fb 616@code{builtin_define_std} takes a string representing the name of an
3df89291 617object-like macro. If it doesn't lie in the user's namespace,
d90a95fb 618@code{builtin_define_std} defines it unconditionally. Otherwise, it
3df89291
NB
619defines a version with two leading underscores, and another version
620with two leading and trailing underscores, and defines the original
621only if an ISO standard was not requested on the command line. For
622example, passing @code{unix} defines @code{__unix}, @code{__unix__}
623and possibly @code{unix}; passing @code{_mips} defines @code{__mips},
624@code{__mips__} and possibly @code{_mips}, and passing @code{_ABI64}
625defines only @code{_ABI64}.
626
e0322d5c
NB
627You can also test for the C dialect being compiled. The variable
628@code{c_language} is set to one of @code{clk_c}, @code{clk_cplusplus}
629or @code{clk_objective_c}. Note that if we are preprocessing
630assembler, this variable will be @code{clk_c} but the function-like
631macro @code{preprocessing_asm_p()} will return true, so you might want
ce3649d2 632to check for that first. If you need to check for strict ANSI, the
c219e1da
JDA
633variable @code{flag_iso} can be used. The function-like macro
634@code{preprocessing_trad_p()} can be used to check for traditional
635preprocessing.
a2c4f8e0 636@end defmac
e0322d5c 637
a2c4f8e0 638@defmac TARGET_OS_CPP_BUILTINS ()
12a41c22
NB
639Similarly to @code{TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS} but this macro is optional
640and is used for the target operating system instead.
a2c4f8e0 641@end defmac
12a41c22 642
a2c4f8e0 643@defmac TARGET_OBJFMT_CPP_BUILTINS ()
4e2e315f
NB
644Similarly to @code{TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS} but this macro is optional
645and is used for the target object format. @file{elfos.h} uses this
646macro to define @code{__ELF__}, so you probably do not need to define
647it yourself.
a2c4f8e0 648@end defmac
4e2e315f 649
a2c4f8e0 650@deftypevar {extern int} target_flags
75685792
RS
651This variable is declared in @file{options.h}, which is included before
652any target-specific headers.
a2c4f8e0 653@end deftypevar
feca2ed3 654
677f3fa8 655@deftypevr {Common Target Hook} int TARGET_DEFAULT_TARGET_FLAGS
75685792
RS
656This variable specifies the initial value of @code{target_flags}.
657Its default setting is 0.
9e3be889 658@end deftypevr
75685792 659
bacf5b96
RS
660@cindex optional hardware or system features
661@cindex features, optional, in system conventions
662
677f3fa8 663@deftypefn {Common Target Hook} bool TARGET_HANDLE_OPTION (struct gcc_options *@var{opts}, struct gcc_options *@var{opts_set}, const struct cl_decoded_option *@var{decoded}, location_t @var{loc})
75685792
RS
664This hook is called whenever the user specifies one of the
665target-specific options described by the @file{.opt} definition files
666(@pxref{Options}). It has the opportunity to do some option-specific
667processing and should return true if the option is valid. The default
668definition does nothing but return true.
669
96e45421
JM
670@var{decoded} specifies the option and its arguments. @var{opts} and
671@var{opts_set} are the @code{gcc_options} structures to be used for
672storing option state, and @var{loc} is the location at which the
673option was passed (@code{UNKNOWN_LOCATION} except for options passed
674via attributes).
75685792
RS
675@end deftypefn
676
acce4e77 677@deftypefn {C Target Hook} bool TARGET_HANDLE_C_OPTION (size_t @var{code}, const char *@var{arg}, int @var{value})
1f1d5130
MS
678This target hook is called whenever the user specifies one of the
679target-specific C language family options described by the @file{.opt}
680definition files(@pxref{Options}). It has the opportunity to do some
681option-specific processing and should return true if the option is
7a241624
JR
682valid. The arguments are like for @code{TARGET_HANDLE_OPTION}. The
683default definition does nothing but return false.
1f1d5130
MS
684
685In general, you should use @code{TARGET_HANDLE_OPTION} to handle
686options. However, if processing an option requires routines that are
687only available in the C (and related language) front ends, then you
688should use @code{TARGET_HANDLE_C_OPTION} instead.
689@end deftypefn
690
acce4e77 691@deftypefn {C Target Hook} tree TARGET_OBJC_CONSTRUCT_STRING_OBJECT (tree @var{string})
91ebb981
IS
692Targets may provide a string object type that can be used within and between C, C++ and their respective Objective-C dialects. A string object might, for example, embed encoding and length information. These objects are considered opaque to the compiler and handled as references. An ideal implementation makes the composition of the string object match that of the Objective-C @code{NSString} (@code{NXString} for GNUStep), allowing efficient interworking between C-only and Objective-C code. If a target implements string objects then this hook should return a reference to such an object constructed from the normal `C' string representation provided in @var{string}. At present, the hook is used by Objective-C only, to obtain a common-format string object when the target provides one.
693@end deftypefn
694
70f42967
SB
695@deftypefn {C Target Hook} void TARGET_OBJC_DECLARE_UNRESOLVED_CLASS_REFERENCE (const char *@var{classname})
696Declare that Objective C class @var{classname} is referenced by the current TU.
697@end deftypefn
698
699@deftypefn {C Target Hook} void TARGET_OBJC_DECLARE_CLASS_DEFINITION (const char *@var{classname})
700Declare that Objective C class @var{classname} is defined by the current TU.
701@end deftypefn
702
acce4e77 703@deftypefn {C Target Hook} bool TARGET_STRING_OBJECT_REF_TYPE_P (const_tree @var{stringref})
91ebb981
IS
704If a target implements string objects then this hook should return @code{true} if @var{stringref} is a valid reference to such an object.
705@end deftypefn
706
acce4e77 707@deftypefn {C Target Hook} void TARGET_CHECK_STRING_OBJECT_FORMAT_ARG (tree @var{format_arg}, tree @var{args_list})
91ebb981 708If a target implements string objects then this hook should should provide a facility to check the function arguments in @var{args_list} against the format specifiers in @var{format_arg} where the type of @var{format_arg} is one recognized as a valid string reference type.
26705988
IS
709@end deftypefn
710
2b7e2984 711@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS_AFTER_CHANGE (void)
74f7912a 712This target function is similar to the hook @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}
2b7e2984
SE
713but is called when the optimize level is changed via an attribute or
714pragma or when it is reset at the end of the code affected by the
715attribute or pragma. It is not called at the beginning of compilation
74f7912a
JR
716when @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} is called so if you want to perform these
717actions then, you should have @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} call
2b7e2984
SE
718@code{TARGET_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS_AFTER_CHANGE}.
719@end deftypefn
720
c7b5e395 721@defmac C_COMMON_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS
c5387660
JM
722This is similar to the @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} hook
723but is only used in the C
c7b5e395
GK
724language frontends (C, Objective-C, C++, Objective-C++) and so can be
725used to alter option flag variables which only exist in those
726frontends.
727@end defmac
728
677f3fa8 729@deftypevr {Common Target Hook} {const struct default_options *} TARGET_OPTION_OPTIMIZATION_TABLE
feca2ed3 730Some machines may desire to change what optimizations are performed for
3020190e
JM
731various optimization levels. This variable, if defined, describes
732options to enable at particular sets of optimization levels. These
733options are processed once
feca2ed3 734just after the optimization level is determined and before the remainder
3020190e 735of the command options have been parsed, so may be overridden by other
2b0d3573 736options passed explicitly.
feca2ed3 737
3020190e 738This processing is run once at program startup and when the optimization
a51fa0f4
MM
739options are changed via @code{#pragma GCC optimize} or by using the
740@code{optimize} attribute.
3020190e 741@end deftypevr
feca2ed3 742
677f3fa8 743@deftypefn {Common Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_INIT_STRUCT (struct gcc_options *@var{opts})
7e4aae92
JM
744Set target-dependent initial values of fields in @var{opts}.
745@end deftypefn
746
4c77620d 747@deftypefn {Common Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_DEFAULT_PARAMS (void)
128dc8e2
JM
748Set target-dependent default values for @option{--param} settings, using calls to @code{set_default_param_value}.
749@end deftypefn
750
3bd36029
RS
751@defmac SWITCHABLE_TARGET
752Some targets need to switch between substantially different subtargets
753during compilation. For example, the MIPS target has one subtarget for
754the traditional MIPS architecture and another for MIPS16. Source code
755can switch between these two subarchitectures using the @code{mips16}
756and @code{nomips16} attributes.
757
758Such subtargets can differ in things like the set of available
759registers, the set of available instructions, the costs of various
760operations, and so on. GCC caches a lot of this type of information
761in global variables, and recomputing them for each subtarget takes a
762significant amount of time. The compiler therefore provides a facility
763for maintaining several versions of the global variables and quickly
764switching between them; see @file{target-globals.h} for details.
765
766Define this macro to 1 if your target needs this facility. The default
767is 0.
768@end defmac
769
9193fb05
JM
770@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FLOAT_EXCEPTIONS_ROUNDING_SUPPORTED_P (void)
771Returns true if the target supports IEEE 754 floating-point exceptions and rounding modes, false otherwise. This is intended to relate to the @code{float} and @code{double} types, but not necessarily @code{long double}. By default, returns true if the @code{adddf3} instruction pattern is available and false otherwise, on the assumption that hardware floating point supports exceptions and rounding modes but software floating point does not.
772@end deftypefn
773
414c4dc4
NC
774@node Per-Function Data
775@section Defining data structures for per-function information.
776@cindex per-function data
777@cindex data structures
778
779If the target needs to store information on a per-function basis, GCC
780provides a macro and a couple of variables to allow this. Note, just
781using statics to store the information is a bad idea, since GCC supports
782nested functions, so you can be halfway through encoding one function
783when another one comes along.
784
785GCC defines a data structure called @code{struct function} which
786contains all of the data specific to an individual function. This
787structure contains a field called @code{machine} whose type is
788@code{struct machine_function *}, which can be used by targets to point
789to their own specific data.
790
791If a target needs per-function specific data it should define the type
e2500fed
GK
792@code{struct machine_function} and also the macro @code{INIT_EXPANDERS}.
793This macro should be used to initialize the function pointer
794@code{init_machine_status}. This pointer is explained below.
414c4dc4
NC
795
796One typical use of per-function, target specific data is to create an
797RTX to hold the register containing the function's return address. This
798RTX can then be used to implement the @code{__builtin_return_address}
799function, for level 0.
800
aee96fe9 801Note---earlier implementations of GCC used a single data area to hold
414c4dc4
NC
802all of the per-function information. Thus when processing of a nested
803function began the old per-function data had to be pushed onto a
804stack, and when the processing was finished, it had to be popped off the
805stack. GCC used to provide function pointers called
02f52e19 806@code{save_machine_status} and @code{restore_machine_status} to handle
414c4dc4
NC
807the saving and restoring of the target specific information. Since the
808single data area approach is no longer used, these pointers are no
809longer supported.
810
a2c4f8e0 811@defmac INIT_EXPANDERS
c21cd8b1 812Macro called to initialize any target specific information. This macro
414c4dc4 813is called once per function, before generation of any RTL has begun.
c21cd8b1 814The intention of this macro is to allow the initialization of the
a2c4f8e0
ZW
815function pointer @code{init_machine_status}.
816@end defmac
414c4dc4 817
a2c4f8e0
ZW
818@deftypevar {void (*)(struct function *)} init_machine_status
819If this function pointer is non-@code{NULL} it will be called once per
820function, before function compilation starts, in order to allow the
821target to perform any target specific initialization of the
822@code{struct function} structure. It is intended that this would be
823used to initialize the @code{machine} of that structure.
414c4dc4 824
8a36672b 825@code{struct machine_function} structures are expected to be freed by GC@.
e2500fed 826Generally, any memory that they reference must be allocated by using
a9429e29 827GC allocation, including the structure itself.
a2c4f8e0 828@end deftypevar
414c4dc4 829
feca2ed3
JW
830@node Storage Layout
831@section Storage Layout
832@cindex storage layout
833
834Note that the definitions of the macros in this table which are sizes or
835alignments measured in bits do not need to be constant. They can be C
836expressions that refer to static variables, such as the @code{target_flags}.
837@xref{Run-time Target}.
838
a2c4f8e0 839@defmac BITS_BIG_ENDIAN
feca2ed3
JW
840Define this macro to have the value 1 if the most significant bit in a
841byte has the lowest number; otherwise define it to have the value zero.
842This means that bit-field instructions count from the most significant
843bit. If the machine has no bit-field instructions, then this must still
844be defined, but it doesn't matter which value it is defined to. This
845macro need not be a constant.
846
847This macro does not affect the way structure fields are packed into
848bytes or words; that is controlled by @code{BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN}.
a2c4f8e0 849@end defmac
feca2ed3 850
a2c4f8e0 851@defmac BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
feca2ed3
JW
852Define this macro to have the value 1 if the most significant byte in a
853word has the lowest number. This macro need not be a constant.
a2c4f8e0 854@end defmac
feca2ed3 855
a2c4f8e0 856@defmac WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
feca2ed3
JW
857Define this macro to have the value 1 if, in a multiword object, the
858most significant word has the lowest number. This applies to both
c0a6a1ef
BS
859memory locations and registers; see @code{REG_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN} if the
860order of words in memory is not the same as the order in registers. This
feca2ed3 861macro need not be a constant.
a2c4f8e0 862@end defmac
feca2ed3 863
c0a6a1ef
BS
864@defmac REG_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
865On some machines, the order of words in a multiword object differs between
866registers in memory. In such a situation, define this macro to describe
867the order of words in a register. The macro @code{WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN} controls
868the order of words in memory.
869@end defmac
870
a2c4f8e0 871@defmac FLOAT_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
feca2ed3
JW
872Define this macro to have the value 1 if @code{DFmode}, @code{XFmode} or
873@code{TFmode} floating point numbers are stored in memory with the word
874containing the sign bit at the lowest address; otherwise define it to
875have the value 0. This macro need not be a constant.
876
877You need not define this macro if the ordering is the same as for
878multi-word integers.
a2c4f8e0 879@end defmac
feca2ed3 880
a2c4f8e0 881@defmac BITS_PER_WORD
e81dd381
KG
882Number of bits in a word. If you do not define this macro, the default
883is @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * UNITS_PER_WORD}.
a2c4f8e0 884@end defmac
feca2ed3 885
a2c4f8e0 886@defmac MAX_BITS_PER_WORD
feca2ed3
JW
887Maximum number of bits in a word. If this is undefined, the default is
888@code{BITS_PER_WORD}. Otherwise, it is the constant value that is the
889largest value that @code{BITS_PER_WORD} can have at run-time.
a2c4f8e0 890@end defmac
feca2ed3 891
a2c4f8e0 892@defmac UNITS_PER_WORD
c4336539
PB
893Number of storage units in a word; normally the size of a general-purpose
894register, a power of two from 1 or 8.
a2c4f8e0 895@end defmac
feca2ed3 896
a2c4f8e0 897@defmac MIN_UNITS_PER_WORD
feca2ed3
JW
898Minimum number of units in a word. If this is undefined, the default is
899@code{UNITS_PER_WORD}. Otherwise, it is the constant value that is the
900smallest value that @code{UNITS_PER_WORD} can have at run-time.
a2c4f8e0 901@end defmac
feca2ed3 902
a2c4f8e0 903@defmac POINTER_SIZE
feca2ed3
JW
904Width of a pointer, in bits. You must specify a value no wider than the
905width of @code{Pmode}. If it is not equal to the width of @code{Pmode},
2465bf76
KG
906you must define @code{POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED}. If you do not specify
907a value the default is @code{BITS_PER_WORD}.
a2c4f8e0 908@end defmac
feca2ed3 909
a2c4f8e0 910@defmac POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED
4923a230
RS
911A C expression that determines how pointers should be extended from
912@code{ptr_mode} to either @code{Pmode} or @code{word_mode}. It is
913greater than zero if pointers should be zero-extended, zero if they
914should be sign-extended, and negative if some other sort of conversion
915is needed. In the last case, the extension is done by the target's
916@code{ptr_extend} instruction.
917
918You need not define this macro if the @code{ptr_mode}, @code{Pmode}
919and @code{word_mode} are all the same width.
a2c4f8e0 920@end defmac
feca2ed3 921
a2c4f8e0 922@defmac PROMOTE_MODE (@var{m}, @var{unsignedp}, @var{type})
feca2ed3
JW
923A macro to update @var{m} and @var{unsignedp} when an object whose type
924is @var{type} and which has the specified mode and signedness is to be
925stored in a register. This macro is only called when @var{type} is a
926scalar type.
927
928On most RISC machines, which only have operations that operate on a full
929register, define this macro to set @var{m} to @code{word_mode} if
930@var{m} is an integer mode narrower than @code{BITS_PER_WORD}. In most
931cases, only integer modes should be widened because wider-precision
932floating-point operations are usually more expensive than their narrower
933counterparts.
934
935For most machines, the macro definition does not change @var{unsignedp}.
936However, some machines, have instructions that preferentially handle
937either signed or unsigned quantities of certain modes. For example, on
938the DEC Alpha, 32-bit loads from memory and 32-bit add instructions
939sign-extend the result to 64 bits. On such machines, set
940@var{unsignedp} according to which kind of extension is more efficient.
941
942Do not define this macro if it would never modify @var{m}.
a2c4f8e0 943@end defmac
feca2ed3 944
9ddb66ef 945@deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum machine_mode} TARGET_PROMOTE_FUNCTION_MODE (const_tree @var{type}, enum machine_mode @var{mode}, int *@var{punsignedp}, const_tree @var{funtype}, int @var{for_return})
cde0f3fd
PB
946Like @code{PROMOTE_MODE}, but it is applied to outgoing function arguments or
947function return values. The target hook should return the new mode
948and possibly change @code{*@var{punsignedp}} if the promotion should
949change signedness. This function is called only for scalar @emph{or
950pointer} types.
951
666e3ceb
PB
952@var{for_return} allows to distinguish the promotion of arguments and
953return values. If it is @code{1}, a return value is being promoted and
954@code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} must perform the same promotions done here.
955If it is @code{2}, the returned mode should be that of the register in
956which an incoming parameter is copied, or the outgoing result is computed;
957then the hook should return the same mode as @code{promote_mode}, though
958the signedness may be different.
959
5e617be8
AK
960@var{type} can be NULL when promoting function arguments of libcalls.
961
cde0f3fd
PB
962The default is to not promote arguments and return values. You can
963also define the hook to @code{default_promote_function_mode_always_promote}
964if you would like to apply the same rules given by @code{PROMOTE_MODE}.
61f71b34 965@end deftypefn
feca2ed3 966
a2c4f8e0 967@defmac PARM_BOUNDARY
feca2ed3
JW
968Normal alignment required for function parameters on the stack, in
969bits. All stack parameters receive at least this much alignment
970regardless of data type. On most machines, this is the same as the
971size of an integer.
a2c4f8e0 972@end defmac
feca2ed3 973
a2c4f8e0 974@defmac STACK_BOUNDARY
31cdd499
ZW
975Define this macro to the minimum alignment enforced by hardware for the
976stack pointer on this machine. The definition is a C expression for the
977desired alignment (measured in bits). This value is used as a default
978if @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY} is not defined. On most machines,
979this should be the same as @code{PARM_BOUNDARY}.
a2c4f8e0 980@end defmac
c795bca9 981
a2c4f8e0 982@defmac PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY
31cdd499
ZW
983Define this macro if you wish to preserve a certain alignment for the
984stack pointer, greater than what the hardware enforces. The definition
985is a C expression for the desired alignment (measured in bits). This
986macro must evaluate to a value equal to or larger than
987@code{STACK_BOUNDARY}.
a2c4f8e0 988@end defmac
feca2ed3 989
2e3f842f
L
990@defmac INCOMING_STACK_BOUNDARY
991Define this macro if the incoming stack boundary may be different
992from @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY}. This macro must evaluate
993to a value equal to or larger than @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}.
994@end defmac
995
a2c4f8e0 996@defmac FUNCTION_BOUNDARY
feca2ed3 997Alignment required for a function entry point, in bits.
a2c4f8e0 998@end defmac
feca2ed3 999
a2c4f8e0 1000@defmac BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT
c4f46fde
DD
1001Biggest alignment that any data type can require on this machine, in
1002bits. Note that this is not the biggest alignment that is supported,
1003just the biggest alignment that, when violated, may cause a fault.
a2c4f8e0 1004@end defmac
feca2ed3 1005
95331614
OH
1006@defmac MALLOC_ABI_ALIGNMENT
1007Alignment, in bits, a C conformant malloc implementation has to
1008provide. If not defined, the default value is @code{BITS_PER_WORD}.
1009@end defmac
1010
6e4f1168
L
1011@defmac ATTRIBUTE_ALIGNED_VALUE
1012Alignment used by the @code{__attribute__ ((aligned))} construct. If
1013not defined, the default value is @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}.
1014@end defmac
1015
a2c4f8e0 1016@defmac MINIMUM_ATOMIC_ALIGNMENT
861bb6c1
JL
1017If defined, the smallest alignment, in bits, that can be given to an
1018object that can be referenced in one operation, without disturbing any
1019nearby object. Normally, this is @code{BITS_PER_UNIT}, but may be larger
1020on machines that don't have byte or half-word store operations.
a2c4f8e0 1021@end defmac
861bb6c1 1022
a2c4f8e0 1023@defmac BIGGEST_FIELD_ALIGNMENT
11cf4d18
JJ
1024Biggest alignment that any structure or union field can require on this
1025machine, in bits. If defined, this overrides @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT} for
1026structure and union fields only, unless the field alignment has been set
1027by the @code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct.
a2c4f8e0 1028@end defmac
feca2ed3 1029
a2c4f8e0 1030@defmac ADJUST_FIELD_ALIGN (@var{field}, @var{computed})
feca2ed3 1031An expression for the alignment of a structure field @var{field} if the
ad9335eb
JJ
1032alignment computed in the usual way (including applying of
1033@code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT} and @code{BIGGEST_FIELD_ALIGNMENT} to the
1034alignment) is @var{computed}. It overrides alignment only if the
1035field alignment has not been set by the
1036@code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct.
a2c4f8e0 1037@end defmac
feca2ed3 1038
2e3f842f
L
1039@defmac MAX_STACK_ALIGNMENT
1040Biggest stack alignment guaranteed by the backend. Use this macro
1041to specify the maximum alignment of a variable on stack.
1042
1043If not defined, the default value is @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}.
1044
1045@c FIXME: The default should be @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY}.
1046@c But the fix for PR 32893 indicates that we can only guarantee
1047@c maximum stack alignment on stack up to @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}, not
1048@c @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY}, if stack alignment isn't supported.
1049@end defmac
1050
a2c4f8e0 1051@defmac MAX_OFILE_ALIGNMENT
feca2ed3
JW
1052Biggest alignment supported by the object file format of this machine.
1053Use this macro to limit the alignment which can be specified using the
1054@code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct. If not defined,
1055the default value is @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}.
11d90e2d
CD
1056
1057On systems that use ELF, the default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is
1058the largest supported 32-bit ELF section alignment representable on
a9243bfc 1059a 32-bit host e.g. @samp{(((uint64_t) 1 << 28) * 8)}.
11d90e2d
CD
1060On 32-bit ELF the largest supported section alignment in bits is
1061@samp{(0x80000000 * 8)}, but this is not representable on 32-bit hosts.
a2c4f8e0 1062@end defmac
feca2ed3 1063
a2c4f8e0 1064@defmac DATA_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{basic-align})
a8d1550a 1065If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a variable in
8a198bd2
JW
1066the static store. @var{type} is the data type, and @var{basic-align} is
1067the alignment that the object would ordinarily have. The value of this
feca2ed3
JW
1068macro is used instead of that alignment to align the object.
1069
1070If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1071
1072@findex strcpy
1073One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to
1074make it all fit in fewer cache lines. Another is to cause character
1075arrays to be word-aligned so that @code{strcpy} calls that copy
1076constants to character arrays can be done inline.
a2c4f8e0 1077@end defmac
feca2ed3 1078
df8a1d28
JJ
1079@defmac DATA_ABI_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{basic-align})
1080Similar to @code{DATA_ALIGNMENT}, but for the cases where the ABI mandates
1081some alignment increase, instead of optimization only purposes. E.g.@
1082AMD x86-64 psABI says that variables with array type larger than 15 bytes
1083must be aligned to 16 byte boundaries.
1084
1085If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1086@end defmac
1087
a2c4f8e0 1088@defmac CONSTANT_ALIGNMENT (@var{constant}, @var{basic-align})
feca2ed3
JW
1089If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment given to a constant
1090that is being placed in memory. @var{constant} is the constant and
1091@var{basic-align} is the alignment that the object would ordinarily
1092have. The value of this macro is used instead of that alignment to
1093align the object.
1094
1095If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1096
1097The typical use of this macro is to increase alignment for string
1098constants to be word aligned so that @code{strcpy} calls that copy
1099constants can be done inline.
a2c4f8e0 1100@end defmac
feca2ed3 1101
a2c4f8e0 1102@defmac LOCAL_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{basic-align})
a8d1550a 1103If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a variable in
d16790f2
JW
1104the local store. @var{type} is the data type, and @var{basic-align} is
1105the alignment that the object would ordinarily have. The value of this
1106macro is used instead of that alignment to align the object.
1107
1108If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1109
1110One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to
1111make it all fit in fewer cache lines.
4a6336ad 1112
64ad7c99 1113If the value of this macro has a type, it should be an unsigned type.
a2c4f8e0 1114@end defmac
d16790f2 1115
5aea1e76
UW
1116@deftypefn {Target Hook} HOST_WIDE_INT TARGET_VECTOR_ALIGNMENT (const_tree @var{type})
1117This hook can be used to define the alignment for a vector of type
1118@var{type}, in order to comply with a platform ABI. The default is to
1119require natural alignment for vector types. The alignment returned by
1120this hook must be a power-of-two multiple of the default alignment of
1121the vector element type.
1122@end deftypefn
1123
76fe54f0
L
1124@defmac STACK_SLOT_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{mode}, @var{basic-align})
1125If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for stack slot.
1126@var{type} is the data type, @var{mode} is the widest mode available,
1127and @var{basic-align} is the alignment that the slot would ordinarily
1128have. The value of this macro is used instead of that alignment to
1129align the slot.
1130
1131If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used when
1132@var{type} is @code{NULL}. Otherwise, @code{LOCAL_ALIGNMENT} will
1133be used.
1134
1135This macro is to set alignment of stack slot to the maximum alignment
1136of all possible modes which the slot may have.
4a6336ad 1137
64ad7c99 1138If the value of this macro has a type, it should be an unsigned type.
76fe54f0
L
1139@end defmac
1140
9bfaf89d
JJ
1141@defmac LOCAL_DECL_ALIGNMENT (@var{decl})
1142If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a local
1143variable @var{decl}.
1144
1145If this macro is not defined, then
1146@code{LOCAL_ALIGNMENT (TREE_TYPE (@var{decl}), DECL_ALIGN (@var{decl}))}
1147is used.
1148
1149One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to
1150make it all fit in fewer cache lines.
4a6336ad 1151
64ad7c99 1152If the value of this macro has a type, it should be an unsigned type.
9bfaf89d
JJ
1153@end defmac
1154
ae58e548
JJ
1155@defmac MINIMUM_ALIGNMENT (@var{exp}, @var{mode}, @var{align})
1156If defined, a C expression to compute the minimum required alignment
1157for dynamic stack realignment purposes for @var{exp} (a type or decl),
1158@var{mode}, assuming normal alignment @var{align}.
1159
1160If this macro is not defined, then @var{align} will be used.
1161@end defmac
1162
a2c4f8e0 1163@defmac EMPTY_FIELD_BOUNDARY
c771326b 1164Alignment in bits to be given to a structure bit-field that follows an
feca2ed3
JW
1165empty field such as @code{int : 0;}.
1166
78d55cc8 1167If @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} is true, it overrides this macro.
a2c4f8e0 1168@end defmac
feca2ed3 1169
a2c4f8e0 1170@defmac STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY
feca2ed3
JW
1171Number of bits which any structure or union's size must be a multiple of.
1172Each structure or union's size is rounded up to a multiple of this.
1173
1174If you do not define this macro, the default is the same as
1175@code{BITS_PER_UNIT}.
a2c4f8e0 1176@end defmac
feca2ed3 1177
a2c4f8e0 1178@defmac STRICT_ALIGNMENT
feca2ed3
JW
1179Define this macro to be the value 1 if instructions will fail to work
1180if given data not on the nominal alignment. If instructions will merely
1181go slower in that case, define this macro as 0.
a2c4f8e0 1182@end defmac
feca2ed3 1183
a2c4f8e0 1184@defmac PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS
feca2ed3 1185Define this if you wish to imitate the way many other C compilers handle
c771326b 1186alignment of bit-fields and the structures that contain them.
feca2ed3 1187
8dc65b6e
MM
1188The behavior is that the type written for a named bit-field (@code{int},
1189@code{short}, or other integer type) imposes an alignment for the entire
1190structure, as if the structure really did contain an ordinary field of
1191that type. In addition, the bit-field is placed within the structure so
1192that it would fit within such a field, not crossing a boundary for it.
1193
1194Thus, on most machines, a named bit-field whose type is written as
1195@code{int} would not cross a four-byte boundary, and would force
1196four-byte alignment for the whole structure. (The alignment used may
1197not be four bytes; it is controlled by the other alignment parameters.)
1198
1199An unnamed bit-field will not affect the alignment of the containing
1200structure.
feca2ed3
JW
1201
1202If the macro is defined, its definition should be a C expression;
1203a nonzero value for the expression enables this behavior.
1204
1205Note that if this macro is not defined, or its value is zero, some
c771326b 1206bit-fields may cross more than one alignment boundary. The compiler can
feca2ed3
JW
1207support such references if there are @samp{insv}, @samp{extv}, and
1208@samp{extzv} insns that can directly reference memory.
1209
c771326b 1210The other known way of making bit-fields work is to define
feca2ed3
JW
1211@code{STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY} as large as @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}.
1212Then every structure can be accessed with fullwords.
1213
c771326b 1214Unless the machine has bit-field instructions or you define
feca2ed3
JW
1215@code{STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY} that way, you must define
1216@code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} to have a nonzero value.
1217
a3a15b4d 1218If your aim is to make GCC use the same conventions for laying out
c771326b 1219bit-fields as are used by another compiler, here is how to investigate
feca2ed3
JW
1220what the other compiler does. Compile and run this program:
1221
3ab51846 1222@smallexample
feca2ed3
JW
1223struct foo1
1224@{
1225 char x;
1226 char :0;
1227 char y;
1228@};
1229
1230struct foo2
1231@{
1232 char x;
1233 int :0;
1234 char y;
1235@};
1236
1237main ()
1238@{
1239 printf ("Size of foo1 is %d\n",
1240 sizeof (struct foo1));
1241 printf ("Size of foo2 is %d\n",
1242 sizeof (struct foo2));
1243 exit (0);
1244@}
3ab51846 1245@end smallexample
feca2ed3
JW
1246
1247If this prints 2 and 5, then the compiler's behavior is what you would
1248get from @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS}.
a2c4f8e0 1249@end defmac
feca2ed3 1250
a2c4f8e0 1251@defmac BITFIELD_NBYTES_LIMITED
f913c102
AO
1252Like @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} except that its effect is limited
1253to aligning a bit-field within the structure.
a2c4f8e0 1254@end defmac
feca2ed3 1255
b5bde9ff 1256@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ALIGN_ANON_BITFIELD (void)
13c1cd82
PB
1257When @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} is true this hook will determine
1258whether unnamed bitfields affect the alignment of the containing
1259structure. The hook should return true if the structure should inherit
1260the alignment requirements of an unnamed bitfield's type.
1261@end deftypefn
1262
b5bde9ff 1263@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_NARROW_VOLATILE_BITFIELD (void)
c2a64439
PB
1264This target hook should return @code{true} if accesses to volatile bitfields
1265should use the narrowest mode possible. It should return @code{false} if
1266these accesses should use the bitfield container type.
1267
7d0b9a9c 1268The default is @code{false}.
c2a64439
PB
1269@end deftypefn
1270
d9886a9e
L
1271@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_MEMBER_TYPE_FORCES_BLK (const_tree @var{field}, enum machine_mode @var{mode})
1272Return true if a structure, union or array containing @var{field} should
1273be accessed using @code{BLKMODE}.
9f6dc500 1274
182e515e
AH
1275If @var{field} is the only field in the structure, @var{mode} is its
1276mode, otherwise @var{mode} is VOIDmode. @var{mode} is provided in the
1277case where structures of one field would require the structure's mode to
1278retain the field's mode.
1279
8d8da227 1280Normally, this is not needed.
d9886a9e 1281@end deftypefn
9f6dc500 1282
a2c4f8e0 1283@defmac ROUND_TYPE_ALIGN (@var{type}, @var{computed}, @var{specified})
0003feb2
VM
1284Define this macro as an expression for the alignment of a type (given
1285by @var{type} as a tree node) if the alignment computed in the usual
1286way is @var{computed} and the alignment explicitly specified was
feca2ed3
JW
1287@var{specified}.
1288
1289The default is to use @var{specified} if it is larger; otherwise, use
1290the smaller of @var{computed} and @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}
a2c4f8e0 1291@end defmac
feca2ed3 1292
a2c4f8e0 1293@defmac MAX_FIXED_MODE_SIZE
feca2ed3
JW
1294An integer expression for the size in bits of the largest integer
1295machine mode that should actually be used. All integer machine modes of
1296this size or smaller can be used for structures and unions with the
1297appropriate sizes. If this macro is undefined, @code{GET_MODE_BITSIZE
1298(DImode)} is assumed.
a2c4f8e0 1299@end defmac
feca2ed3 1300
a2c4f8e0 1301@defmac STACK_SAVEAREA_MODE (@var{save_level})
73c8090f 1302If defined, an expression of type @code{enum machine_mode} that
39403d82
DE
1303specifies the mode of the save area operand of a
1304@code{save_stack_@var{level}} named pattern (@pxref{Standard Names}).
1305@var{save_level} is one of @code{SAVE_BLOCK}, @code{SAVE_FUNCTION}, or
1306@code{SAVE_NONLOCAL} and selects which of the three named patterns is
1307having its mode specified.
73c8090f
DE
1308
1309You need not define this macro if it always returns @code{Pmode}. You
1310would most commonly define this macro if the
1311@code{save_stack_@var{level}} patterns need to support both a 32- and a
131264-bit mode.
a2c4f8e0 1313@end defmac
73c8090f 1314
a2c4f8e0 1315@defmac STACK_SIZE_MODE
39403d82
DE
1316If defined, an expression of type @code{enum machine_mode} that
1317specifies the mode of the size increment operand of an
1318@code{allocate_stack} named pattern (@pxref{Standard Names}).
1319
1320You need not define this macro if it always returns @code{word_mode}.
1321You would most commonly define this macro if the @code{allocate_stack}
1322pattern needs to support both a 32- and a 64-bit mode.
a2c4f8e0 1323@end defmac
39403d82 1324
9ddb66ef 1325@deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum machine_mode} TARGET_LIBGCC_CMP_RETURN_MODE (void)
c7ff6e7a
AK
1326This target hook should return the mode to be used for the return value
1327of compare instructions expanded to libgcc calls. If not defined
1328@code{word_mode} is returned which is the right choice for a majority of
1329targets.
1330@end deftypefn
1331
9ddb66ef 1332@deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum machine_mode} TARGET_LIBGCC_SHIFT_COUNT_MODE (void)
c7ff6e7a
AK
1333This target hook should return the mode to be used for the shift count operand
1334of shift instructions expanded to libgcc calls. If not defined
1335@code{word_mode} is returned which is the right choice for a majority of
1336targets.
1337@end deftypefn
1338
8a9a2486
JR
1339@deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum machine_mode} TARGET_UNWIND_WORD_MODE (void)
1340Return machine mode to be used for @code{_Unwind_Word} type.
1341The default is to use @code{word_mode}.
1342@end deftypefn
1343
9ddb66ef 1344@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_MS_BITFIELD_LAYOUT_P (const_tree @var{record_type})
f913c102
AO
1345This target hook returns @code{true} if bit-fields in the given
1346@var{record_type} are to be laid out following the rules of Microsoft
1347Visual C/C++, namely: (i) a bit-field won't share the same storage
1348unit with the previous bit-field if their underlying types have
1349different sizes, and the bit-field will be aligned to the highest
1350alignment of the underlying types of itself and of the previous
1351bit-field; (ii) a zero-sized bit-field will affect the alignment of
1352the whole enclosing structure, even if it is unnamed; except that
1353(iii) a zero-sized bit-field will be disregarded unless it follows
6335b0aa 1354another bit-field of nonzero size. If this hook returns @code{true},
f913c102 1355other macros that control bit-field layout are ignored.
e4850f36
DR
1356
1357When a bit-field is inserted into a packed record, the whole size
1358of the underlying type is used by one or more same-size adjacent
1359bit-fields (that is, if its long:3, 32 bits is used in the record,
1360and any additional adjacent long bit-fields are packed into the same
8a36672b
JM
1361chunk of 32 bits. However, if the size changes, a new field of that
1362size is allocated). In an unpacked record, this is the same as using
e4850f36
DR
1363alignment, but not equivalent when packing.
1364
1365If both MS bit-fields and @samp{__attribute__((packed))} are used,
8a36672b 1366the latter will take precedence. If @samp{__attribute__((packed))} is
e4850f36
DR
1367used on a single field when MS bit-fields are in use, it will take
1368precedence for that field, but the alignment of the rest of the structure
1369may affect its placement.
f913c102
AO
1370@end deftypefn
1371
9ddb66ef 1372@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_DECIMAL_FLOAT_SUPPORTED_P (void)
9a8ce21f 1373Returns true if the target supports decimal floating point.
9a8ce21f
JG
1374@end deftypefn
1375
9ddb66ef 1376@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FIXED_POINT_SUPPORTED_P (void)
ab22c1fa
CF
1377Returns true if the target supports fixed-point arithmetic.
1378@end deftypefn
1379
e41b2a33
PB
1380@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_EXPAND_TO_RTL_HOOK (void)
1381This hook is called just before expansion into rtl, allowing the target
1382to perform additional initializations or analysis before the expansion.
1383For example, the rs6000 port uses it to allocate a scratch stack slot
1384for use in copying SDmode values between memory and floating point
1385registers whenever the function being expanded has any SDmode
1386usage.
1387@end deftypefn
1388
1389@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INSTANTIATE_DECLS (void)
1390This hook allows the backend to perform additional instantiations on rtl
1391that are not actually in any insns yet, but will be later.
1392@end deftypefn
1393
9ddb66ef 1394@deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_MANGLE_TYPE (const_tree @var{type})
608063c3
JB
1395If your target defines any fundamental types, or any types your target
1396uses should be mangled differently from the default, define this hook
1397to return the appropriate encoding for these types as part of a C++
1398mangled name. The @var{type} argument is the tree structure representing
1399the type to be mangled. The hook may be applied to trees which are
1400not target-specific fundamental types; it should return @code{NULL}
1401for all such types, as well as arguments it does not recognize. If the
1402return value is not @code{NULL}, it must point to a statically-allocated
1403string constant.
f18eca82
ZL
1404
1405Target-specific fundamental types might be new fundamental types or
1406qualified versions of ordinary fundamental types. Encode new
1407fundamental types as @samp{@w{u @var{n} @var{name}}}, where @var{name}
1408is the name used for the type in source code, and @var{n} is the
1409length of @var{name} in decimal. Encode qualified versions of
1410ordinary types as @samp{@w{U @var{n} @var{name} @var{code}}}, where
1411@var{name} is the name used for the type qualifier in source code,
1412@var{n} is the length of @var{name} as above, and @var{code} is the
1413code used to represent the unqualified version of this type. (See
1414@code{write_builtin_type} in @file{cp/mangle.c} for the list of
1415codes.) In both cases the spaces are for clarity; do not include any
1416spaces in your string.
1417
608063c3
JB
1418This hook is applied to types prior to typedef resolution. If the mangled
1419name for a particular type depends only on that type's main variant, you
1420can perform typedef resolution yourself using @code{TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT}
1421before mangling.
1422
f18eca82
ZL
1423The default version of this hook always returns @code{NULL}, which is
1424appropriate for a target that does not define any new fundamental
1425types.
1426@end deftypefn
1427
feca2ed3
JW
1428@node Type Layout
1429@section Layout of Source Language Data Types
1430
1431These macros define the sizes and other characteristics of the standard
1432basic data types used in programs being compiled. Unlike the macros in
1433the previous section, these apply to specific features of C and related
1434languages, rather than to fundamental aspects of storage layout.
1435
a2c4f8e0 1436@defmac INT_TYPE_SIZE
feca2ed3
JW
1437A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{int} on the
1438target machine. If you don't define this, the default is one word.
a2c4f8e0 1439@end defmac
feca2ed3 1440
a2c4f8e0 1441@defmac SHORT_TYPE_SIZE
feca2ed3
JW
1442A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{short} on the
1443target machine. If you don't define this, the default is half a word.
1444(If this would be less than one storage unit, it is rounded up to one
1445unit.)
a2c4f8e0 1446@end defmac
feca2ed3 1447
a2c4f8e0 1448@defmac LONG_TYPE_SIZE
feca2ed3
JW
1449A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long} on the
1450target machine. If you don't define this, the default is one word.
a2c4f8e0 1451@end defmac
feca2ed3 1452
a2c4f8e0 1453@defmac ADA_LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1615c261 1454On some machines, the size used for the Ada equivalent of the type
8a36672b 1455@code{long} by a native Ada compiler differs from that used by C@. In
1615c261
RK
1456that situation, define this macro to be a C expression to be used for
1457the size of that type. If you don't define this, the default is the
1458value of @code{LONG_TYPE_SIZE}.
a2c4f8e0 1459@end defmac
1615c261 1460
a2c4f8e0 1461@defmac LONG_LONG_TYPE_SIZE
feca2ed3
JW
1462A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long long} on the
1463target machine. If you don't define this, the default is two
047c1c92 1464words. If you want to support GNU Ada on your machine, the value of this
feca2ed3 1465macro must be at least 64.
a2c4f8e0 1466@end defmac
feca2ed3 1467
a2c4f8e0 1468@defmac CHAR_TYPE_SIZE
feca2ed3 1469A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{char} on the
c294bd99
HPN
1470target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1471@code{BITS_PER_UNIT}.
a2c4f8e0 1472@end defmac
feca2ed3 1473
a2c4f8e0 1474@defmac BOOL_TYPE_SIZE
3d1ad9e5
JM
1475A C expression for the size in bits of the C++ type @code{bool} and
1476C99 type @code{_Bool} on the target machine. If you don't define
1477this, and you probably shouldn't, the default is @code{CHAR_TYPE_SIZE}.
a2c4f8e0 1478@end defmac
68eb4fb9 1479
a2c4f8e0 1480@defmac FLOAT_TYPE_SIZE
feca2ed3
JW
1481A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{float} on the
1482target machine. If you don't define this, the default is one word.
a2c4f8e0 1483@end defmac
feca2ed3 1484
a2c4f8e0 1485@defmac DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
feca2ed3
JW
1486A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{double} on the
1487target machine. If you don't define this, the default is two
1488words.
a2c4f8e0 1489@end defmac
feca2ed3 1490
a2c4f8e0 1491@defmac LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
feca2ed3
JW
1492A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long double} on
1493the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is two
1494words.
a2c4f8e0 1495@end defmac
feca2ed3 1496
325217ed
CF
1497@defmac SHORT_FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1498A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{short _Fract} on
1499the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1500@code{BITS_PER_UNIT}.
1501@end defmac
1502
1503@defmac FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1504A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{_Fract} on
1505the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1506@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 2}.
1507@end defmac
1508
1509@defmac LONG_FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1510A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long _Fract} on
1511the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1512@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 4}.
1513@end defmac
1514
1515@defmac LONG_LONG_FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1516A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long long _Fract} on
1517the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1518@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 8}.
1519@end defmac
1520
1521@defmac SHORT_ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1522A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{short _Accum} on
1523the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1524@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 2}.
1525@end defmac
1526
1527@defmac ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1528A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{_Accum} on
1529the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1530@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 4}.
1531@end defmac
1532
1533@defmac LONG_ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1534A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long _Accum} on
1535the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1536@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 8}.
1537@end defmac
1538
1539@defmac LONG_LONG_ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1540A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long long _Accum} on
1541the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1542@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 16}.
1543@end defmac
1544
4e9db8b2
SE
1545@defmac LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
1546Define this macro if @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is not constant or
1547if you want routines in @file{libgcc2.a} for a size other than
1548@code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}. If you don't define this, the
1549default is @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}.
1550@end defmac
1551
cdbf4541
BS
1552@defmac LIBGCC2_GNU_PREFIX
1553This macro corresponds to the @code{TARGET_LIBFUNC_GNU_PREFIX} target
1554hook and should be defined if that hook is overriden to be true. It
1555causes function names in libgcc to be changed to use a @code{__gnu_}
1556prefix for their name rather than the default @code{__}. A port which
1557uses this macro should also arrange to use @file{t-gnu-prefix} in
1558the libgcc @file{config.host}.
1559@end defmac
1560
a2c4f8e0 1561@defmac TARGET_FLT_EVAL_METHOD
d57a4b98
RH
1562A C expression for the value for @code{FLT_EVAL_METHOD} in @file{float.h},
1563assuming, if applicable, that the floating-point control word is in its
1564default state. If you do not define this macro the value of
1565@code{FLT_EVAL_METHOD} will be zero.
a2c4f8e0 1566@end defmac
aaa2e8ef 1567
a2c4f8e0 1568@defmac WIDEST_HARDWARE_FP_SIZE
e9a25f70
JL
1569A C expression for the size in bits of the widest floating-point format
1570supported by the hardware. If you define this macro, you must specify a
1571value less than or equal to the value of @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}.
1572If you do not define this macro, the value of @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}
1573is the default.
a2c4f8e0 1574@end defmac
e9a25f70 1575
a2c4f8e0 1576@defmac DEFAULT_SIGNED_CHAR
feca2ed3
JW
1577An expression whose value is 1 or 0, according to whether the type
1578@code{char} should be signed or unsigned by default. The user can
630d3d5a
JM
1579always override this default with the options @option{-fsigned-char}
1580and @option{-funsigned-char}.
a2c4f8e0 1581@end defmac
feca2ed3 1582
221ee7c9
KH
1583@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_DEFAULT_SHORT_ENUMS (void)
1584This target hook should return true if the compiler should give an
1585@code{enum} type only as many bytes as it takes to represent the range
1586of possible values of that type. It should return false if all
35afa569
KH
1587@code{enum} types should be allocated like @code{int}.
1588
221ee7c9
KH
1589The default is to return false.
1590@end deftypefn
35afa569 1591
a2c4f8e0 1592@defmac SIZE_TYPE
feca2ed3
JW
1593A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1594for size values. The typedef name @code{size_t} is defined using the
1595contents of the string.
1596
1597The string can contain more than one keyword. If so, separate them with
1598spaces, and write first any length keyword, then @code{unsigned} if
1599appropriate, and finally @code{int}. The string must exactly match one
1600of the data type names defined in the function
176a96de
HPN
1601@code{c_common_nodes_and_builtins} in the file @file{c-family/c-common.c}.
1602You may not omit @code{int} or change the order---that would cause the
1603compiler to crash on startup.
feca2ed3
JW
1604
1605If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"long unsigned
1606int"}.
a2c4f8e0 1607@end defmac
feca2ed3 1608
18dae016
TG
1609@defmac SIZETYPE
1610GCC defines internal types (@code{sizetype}, @code{ssizetype},
1611@code{bitsizetype} and @code{sbitsizetype}) for expressions
1612dealing with size. This macro is a C expression for a string describing
1613the name of the data type from which the precision of @code{sizetype}
1614is extracted.
1615
1616The string has the same restrictions as @code{SIZE_TYPE} string.
1617
1618If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{SIZE_TYPE}.
1619@end defmac
1620
a2c4f8e0 1621@defmac PTRDIFF_TYPE
feca2ed3
JW
1622A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1623for the result of subtracting two pointers. The typedef name
1624@code{ptrdiff_t} is defined using the contents of the string. See
1625@code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1626
1627If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"long int"}.
a2c4f8e0 1628@end defmac
feca2ed3 1629
a2c4f8e0 1630@defmac WCHAR_TYPE
feca2ed3
JW
1631A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1632for wide characters. The typedef name @code{wchar_t} is defined using
1633the contents of the string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more
1634information.
1635
1636If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"int"}.
a2c4f8e0 1637@end defmac
feca2ed3 1638
a2c4f8e0 1639@defmac WCHAR_TYPE_SIZE
feca2ed3
JW
1640A C expression for the size in bits of the data type for wide
1641characters. This is used in @code{cpp}, which cannot make use of
1642@code{WCHAR_TYPE}.
a2c4f8e0 1643@end defmac
feca2ed3 1644
a2c4f8e0 1645@defmac WINT_TYPE
1a67c7d3
JL
1646A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to
1647use for wide characters passed to @code{printf} and returned from
1648@code{getwc}. The typedef name @code{wint_t} is defined using the
1649contents of the string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more
1650information.
1651
1652If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"unsigned int"}.
a2c4f8e0 1653@end defmac
1a67c7d3 1654
a2c4f8e0 1655@defmac INTMAX_TYPE
b15ad712
JM
1656A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type that
1657can represent any value of any standard or extended signed integer type.
1658The typedef name @code{intmax_t} is defined using the contents of the
1659string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1660
1661If you don't define this macro, the default is the first of
1662@code{"int"}, @code{"long int"}, or @code{"long long int"} that has as
1663much precision as @code{long long int}.
a2c4f8e0 1664@end defmac
b15ad712 1665
a2c4f8e0 1666@defmac UINTMAX_TYPE
b15ad712
JM
1667A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type that
1668can represent any value of any standard or extended unsigned integer
1669type. The typedef name @code{uintmax_t} is defined using the contents
1670of the string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1671
1672If you don't define this macro, the default is the first of
1673@code{"unsigned int"}, @code{"long unsigned int"}, or @code{"long long
1674unsigned int"} that has as much precision as @code{long long unsigned
1675int}.
a2c4f8e0 1676@end defmac
b15ad712 1677
207bf79d
JM
1678@defmac SIG_ATOMIC_TYPE
1679@defmacx INT8_TYPE
1680@defmacx INT16_TYPE
1681@defmacx INT32_TYPE
1682@defmacx INT64_TYPE
1683@defmacx UINT8_TYPE
1684@defmacx UINT16_TYPE
1685@defmacx UINT32_TYPE
1686@defmacx UINT64_TYPE
1687@defmacx INT_LEAST8_TYPE
1688@defmacx INT_LEAST16_TYPE
1689@defmacx INT_LEAST32_TYPE
1690@defmacx INT_LEAST64_TYPE
1691@defmacx UINT_LEAST8_TYPE
1692@defmacx UINT_LEAST16_TYPE
1693@defmacx UINT_LEAST32_TYPE
1694@defmacx UINT_LEAST64_TYPE
1695@defmacx INT_FAST8_TYPE
1696@defmacx INT_FAST16_TYPE
1697@defmacx INT_FAST32_TYPE
1698@defmacx INT_FAST64_TYPE
1699@defmacx UINT_FAST8_TYPE
1700@defmacx UINT_FAST16_TYPE
1701@defmacx UINT_FAST32_TYPE
1702@defmacx UINT_FAST64_TYPE
1703@defmacx INTPTR_TYPE
1704@defmacx UINTPTR_TYPE
1705C expressions for the standard types @code{sig_atomic_t},
1706@code{int8_t}, @code{int16_t}, @code{int32_t}, @code{int64_t},
1707@code{uint8_t}, @code{uint16_t}, @code{uint32_t}, @code{uint64_t},
1708@code{int_least8_t}, @code{int_least16_t}, @code{int_least32_t},
1709@code{int_least64_t}, @code{uint_least8_t}, @code{uint_least16_t},
1710@code{uint_least32_t}, @code{uint_least64_t}, @code{int_fast8_t},
1711@code{int_fast16_t}, @code{int_fast32_t}, @code{int_fast64_t},
1712@code{uint_fast8_t}, @code{uint_fast16_t}, @code{uint_fast32_t},
1713@code{uint_fast64_t}, @code{intptr_t}, and @code{uintptr_t}. See
1714@code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1715
1716If any of these macros evaluates to a null pointer, the corresponding
1717type is not supported; if GCC is configured to provide
1718@code{<stdint.h>} in such a case, the header provided may not conform
1719to C99, depending on the type in question. The defaults for all of
1720these macros are null pointers.
1721@end defmac
1722
a2c4f8e0 1723@defmac TARGET_PTRMEMFUNC_VBIT_LOCATION
f3c55c97
AO
1724The C++ compiler represents a pointer-to-member-function with a struct
1725that looks like:
1726
3ab51846 1727@smallexample
f3c55c97
AO
1728 struct @{
1729 union @{
1730 void (*fn)();
1731 ptrdiff_t vtable_index;
1732 @};
1733 ptrdiff_t delta;
1734 @};
3ab51846 1735@end smallexample
f3c55c97
AO
1736
1737@noindent
1738The C++ compiler must use one bit to indicate whether the function that
1739will be called through a pointer-to-member-function is virtual.
1740Normally, we assume that the low-order bit of a function pointer must
1741always be zero. Then, by ensuring that the vtable_index is odd, we can
1742distinguish which variant of the union is in use. But, on some
1743platforms function pointers can be odd, and so this doesn't work. In
1744that case, we use the low-order bit of the @code{delta} field, and shift
1745the remainder of the @code{delta} field to the left.
1746
1747GCC will automatically make the right selection about where to store
1748this bit using the @code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY} setting for your platform.
1749However, some platforms such as ARM/Thumb have @code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY}
1750set such that functions always start at even addresses, but the lowest
1751bit of pointers to functions indicate whether the function at that
1752address is in ARM or Thumb mode. If this is the case of your
1753architecture, you should define this macro to
1754@code{ptrmemfunc_vbit_in_delta}.
1755
1756In general, you should not have to define this macro. On architectures
1757in which function addresses are always even, according to
1758@code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY}, GCC will automatically define this macro to
1759@code{ptrmemfunc_vbit_in_pfn}.
a2c4f8e0 1760@end defmac
67231816 1761
a2c4f8e0 1762@defmac TARGET_VTABLE_USES_DESCRIPTORS
67231816 1763Normally, the C++ compiler uses function pointers in vtables. This
f282ffb3 1764macro allows the target to change to use ``function descriptors''
67231816
RH
1765instead. Function descriptors are found on targets for whom a
1766function pointer is actually a small data structure. Normally the
f282ffb3 1767data structure consists of the actual code address plus a data
67231816
RH
1768pointer to which the function's data is relative.
1769
1770If vtables are used, the value of this macro should be the number
1771of words that the function descriptor occupies.
a2c4f8e0 1772@end defmac
a6f5e048 1773
a2c4f8e0 1774@defmac TARGET_VTABLE_ENTRY_ALIGN
a6f5e048
RH
1775By default, the vtable entries are void pointers, the so the alignment
1776is the same as pointer alignment. The value of this macro specifies
1777the alignment of the vtable entry in bits. It should be defined only
1778when special alignment is necessary. */
a2c4f8e0 1779@end defmac
a6f5e048 1780
a2c4f8e0 1781@defmac TARGET_VTABLE_DATA_ENTRY_DISTANCE
a6f5e048
RH
1782There are a few non-descriptor entries in the vtable at offsets below
1783zero. If these entries must be padded (say, to preserve the alignment
1784specified by @code{TARGET_VTABLE_ENTRY_ALIGN}), set this to the number
1785of words in each data entry.
a2c4f8e0 1786@end defmac
b2b263e1 1787
feca2ed3
JW
1788@node Registers
1789@section Register Usage
1790@cindex register usage
1791
1792This section explains how to describe what registers the target machine
1793has, and how (in general) they can be used.
1794
1795The description of which registers a specific instruction can use is
1796done with register classes; see @ref{Register Classes}. For information
1797on using registers to access a stack frame, see @ref{Frame Registers}.
1798For passing values in registers, see @ref{Register Arguments}.
1799For returning values in registers, see @ref{Scalar Return}.
1800
1801@menu
6ccde948
RW
1802* Register Basics:: Number and kinds of registers.
1803* Allocation Order:: Order in which registers are allocated.
1804* Values in Registers:: What kinds of values each reg can hold.
1805* Leaf Functions:: Renumbering registers for leaf functions.
1806* Stack Registers:: Handling a register stack such as 80387.
feca2ed3
JW
1807@end menu
1808
1809@node Register Basics
1810@subsection Basic Characteristics of Registers
1811
1812@c prevent bad page break with this line
1813Registers have various characteristics.
1814
a2c4f8e0 1815@defmac FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
feca2ed3
JW
1816Number of hardware registers known to the compiler. They receive
1817numbers 0 through @code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER-1}; thus, the first
1818pseudo register's number really is assigned the number
1819@code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER}.
a2c4f8e0 1820@end defmac
feca2ed3 1821
a2c4f8e0 1822@defmac FIXED_REGISTERS
feca2ed3
JW
1823@cindex fixed register
1824An initializer that says which registers are used for fixed purposes
1825all throughout the compiled code and are therefore not available for
1826general allocation. These would include the stack pointer, the frame
1827pointer (except on machines where that can be used as a general
1828register when no frame pointer is needed), the program counter on
1829machines where that is considered one of the addressable registers,
1830and any other numbered register with a standard use.
1831
1832This information is expressed as a sequence of numbers, separated by
1833commas and surrounded by braces. The @var{n}th number is 1 if
1834register @var{n} is fixed, 0 otherwise.
1835
1836The table initialized from this macro, and the table initialized by
1837the following one, may be overridden at run time either automatically,
1838by the actions of the macro @code{CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE}, or by
630d3d5a
JM
1839the user with the command options @option{-ffixed-@var{reg}},
1840@option{-fcall-used-@var{reg}} and @option{-fcall-saved-@var{reg}}.
a2c4f8e0 1841@end defmac
feca2ed3 1842
a2c4f8e0 1843@defmac CALL_USED_REGISTERS
feca2ed3
JW
1844@cindex call-used register
1845@cindex call-clobbered register
1846@cindex call-saved register
1847Like @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} but has 1 for each register that is
1848clobbered (in general) by function calls as well as for fixed
1849registers. This macro therefore identifies the registers that are not
1850available for general allocation of values that must live across
1851function calls.
1852
1853If a register has 0 in @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS}, the compiler
1854automatically saves it on function entry and restores it on function
1855exit, if the register is used within the function.
a2c4f8e0 1856@end defmac
feca2ed3 1857
a2c4f8e0 1858@defmac CALL_REALLY_USED_REGISTERS
fc1296b7
AM
1859@cindex call-used register
1860@cindex call-clobbered register
1861@cindex call-saved register
f282ffb3
JM
1862Like @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} except this macro doesn't require
1863that the entire set of @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} be included.
fc1296b7 1864(@code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} must be a superset of @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}).
f282ffb3 1865This macro is optional. If not specified, it defaults to the value
fc1296b7 1866of @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS}.
a2c4f8e0 1867@end defmac
fc1296b7 1868
a2c4f8e0 1869@defmac HARD_REGNO_CALL_PART_CLOBBERED (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
1e326708
MH
1870@cindex call-used register
1871@cindex call-clobbered register
1872@cindex call-saved register
df2a54e9 1873A C expression that is nonzero if it is not permissible to store a
1e326708
MH
1874value of mode @var{mode} in hard register number @var{regno} across a
1875call without some part of it being clobbered. For most machines this
1876macro need not be defined. It is only required for machines that do not
1877preserve the entire contents of a register across a call.
a2c4f8e0 1878@end defmac
1e326708 1879
feca2ed3
JW
1880@findex fixed_regs
1881@findex call_used_regs
a2c4f8e0
ZW
1882@findex global_regs
1883@findex reg_names
1884@findex reg_class_contents
5efd84c5
NF
1885@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE (void)
1886This hook may conditionally modify five variables
055177dc 1887@code{fixed_regs}, @code{call_used_regs}, @code{global_regs},
c237e94a
ZW
1888@code{reg_names}, and @code{reg_class_contents}, to take into account
1889any dependence of these register sets on target flags. The first three
1890of these are of type @code{char []} (interpreted as Boolean vectors).
1891@code{global_regs} is a @code{const char *[]}, and
1892@code{reg_class_contents} is a @code{HARD_REG_SET}. Before the macro is
1893called, @code{fixed_regs}, @code{call_used_regs},
1894@code{reg_class_contents}, and @code{reg_names} have been initialized
055177dc 1895from @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}, @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS},
c237e94a 1896@code{REG_CLASS_CONTENTS}, and @code{REGISTER_NAMES}, respectively.
630d3d5a 1897@code{global_regs} has been cleared, and any @option{-ffixed-@var{reg}},
c237e94a
ZW
1898@option{-fcall-used-@var{reg}} and @option{-fcall-saved-@var{reg}}
1899command options have been applied.
feca2ed3 1900
feca2ed3
JW
1901@cindex disabling certain registers
1902@cindex controlling register usage
1903If the usage of an entire class of registers depends on the target
1904flags, you may indicate this to GCC by using this macro to modify
1905@code{fixed_regs} and @code{call_used_regs} to 1 for each of the
b48e9677
RS
1906registers in the classes which should not be used by GCC@. Also make
1907@code{define_register_constraint}s return @code{NO_REGS} for constraints
1908that shouldn't be used.
feca2ed3
JW
1909
1910(However, if this class is not included in @code{GENERAL_REGS} and all
1911of the insn patterns whose constraints permit this class are
1912controlled by target switches, then GCC will automatically avoid using
1913these registers when the target switches are opposed to them.)
5efd84c5 1914@end deftypefn
feca2ed3 1915
a2c4f8e0 1916@defmac INCOMING_REGNO (@var{out})
feca2ed3
JW
1917Define this macro if the target machine has register windows. This C
1918expression returns the register number as seen by the called function
1919corresponding to the register number @var{out} as seen by the calling
1920function. Return @var{out} if register number @var{out} is not an
1921outbound register.
a2c4f8e0 1922@end defmac
feca2ed3 1923
a2c4f8e0 1924@defmac OUTGOING_REGNO (@var{in})
feca2ed3
JW
1925Define this macro if the target machine has register windows. This C
1926expression returns the register number as seen by the calling function
1927corresponding to the register number @var{in} as seen by the called
1928function. Return @var{in} if register number @var{in} is not an inbound
1929register.
a2c4f8e0 1930@end defmac
feca2ed3 1931
a2c4f8e0 1932@defmac LOCAL_REGNO (@var{regno})
fa80e43d
JL
1933Define this macro if the target machine has register windows. This C
1934expression returns true if the register is call-saved but is in the
1935register window. Unlike most call-saved registers, such registers
1936need not be explicitly restored on function exit or during non-local
1937gotos.
a2c4f8e0 1938@end defmac
fa80e43d 1939
a2c4f8e0 1940@defmac PC_REGNUM
feca2ed3
JW
1941If the program counter has a register number, define this as that
1942register number. Otherwise, do not define it.
a2c4f8e0 1943@end defmac
feca2ed3
JW
1944
1945@node Allocation Order
1946@subsection Order of Allocation of Registers
1947@cindex order of register allocation
1948@cindex register allocation order
1949
1950@c prevent bad page break with this line
1951Registers are allocated in order.
1952
a2c4f8e0 1953@defmac REG_ALLOC_ORDER
feca2ed3 1954If defined, an initializer for a vector of integers, containing the
a3a15b4d 1955numbers of hard registers in the order in which GCC should prefer
feca2ed3
JW
1956to use them (from most preferred to least).
1957
1958If this macro is not defined, registers are used lowest numbered first
1959(all else being equal).
1960
1961One use of this macro is on machines where the highest numbered
1962registers must always be saved and the save-multiple-registers
1963instruction supports only sequences of consecutive registers. On such
1964machines, define @code{REG_ALLOC_ORDER} to be an initializer that lists
956d6950 1965the highest numbered allocable register first.
a2c4f8e0 1966@end defmac
feca2ed3 1967
5a733826 1968@defmac ADJUST_REG_ALLOC_ORDER
feca2ed3
JW
1969A C statement (sans semicolon) to choose the order in which to allocate
1970hard registers for pseudo-registers local to a basic block.
1971
1972Store the desired register order in the array @code{reg_alloc_order}.
1973Element 0 should be the register to allocate first; element 1, the next
1974register; and so on.
1975
1976The macro body should not assume anything about the contents of
1977@code{reg_alloc_order} before execution of the macro.
1978
1979On most machines, it is not necessary to define this macro.
a2c4f8e0 1980@end defmac
feca2ed3 1981
5a733826
BS
1982@defmac HONOR_REG_ALLOC_ORDER
1983Normally, IRA tries to estimate the costs for saving a register in the
1984prologue and restoring it in the epilogue. This discourages it from
1985using call-saved registers. If a machine wants to ensure that IRA
1986allocates registers in the order given by REG_ALLOC_ORDER even if some
ed15c598
KC
1987call-saved registers appear earlier than call-used ones, then define this
1988macro as a C expression to nonzero. Default is 0.
5a733826
BS
1989@end defmac
1990
058e97ec
VM
1991@defmac IRA_HARD_REGNO_ADD_COST_MULTIPLIER (@var{regno})
1992In some case register allocation order is not enough for the
1993Integrated Register Allocator (@acronym{IRA}) to generate a good code.
1994If this macro is defined, it should return a floating point value
1995based on @var{regno}. The cost of using @var{regno} for a pseudo will
1996be increased by approximately the pseudo's usage frequency times the
1997value returned by this macro. Not defining this macro is equivalent
1998to having it always return @code{0.0}.
1999
2000On most machines, it is not necessary to define this macro.
2001@end defmac
2002
feca2ed3
JW
2003@node Values in Registers
2004@subsection How Values Fit in Registers
2005
2006This section discusses the macros that describe which kinds of values
2007(specifically, which machine modes) each register can hold, and how many
2008consecutive registers are needed for a given mode.
2009
a2c4f8e0 2010@defmac HARD_REGNO_NREGS (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
feca2ed3
JW
2011A C expression for the number of consecutive hard registers, starting
2012at register number @var{regno}, required to hold a value of mode
79e168da
DD
2013@var{mode}. This macro must never return zero, even if a register
2014cannot hold the requested mode - indicate that with HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK
2015and/or CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS instead.
feca2ed3
JW
2016
2017On a machine where all registers are exactly one word, a suitable
2018definition of this macro is
2019
2020@smallexample
2021#define HARD_REGNO_NREGS(REGNO, MODE) \
2022 ((GET_MODE_SIZE (MODE) + UNITS_PER_WORD - 1) \
32bd3974 2023 / UNITS_PER_WORD)
feca2ed3 2024@end smallexample
a2c4f8e0 2025@end defmac
feca2ed3 2026
8521c414
JM
2027@defmac HARD_REGNO_NREGS_HAS_PADDING (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2028A C expression that is nonzero if a value of mode @var{mode}, stored
2029in memory, ends with padding that causes it to take up more space than
2030in registers starting at register number @var{regno} (as determined by
2031multiplying GCC's notion of the size of the register when containing
2032this mode by the number of registers returned by
2033@code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS}). By default this is zero.
2034
2035For example, if a floating-point value is stored in three 32-bit
2036registers but takes up 128 bits in memory, then this would be
2037nonzero.
2038
2039This macros only needs to be defined if there are cases where
f1f4e530 2040@code{subreg_get_info}
8521c414
JM
2041would otherwise wrongly determine that a @code{subreg} can be
2042represented by an offset to the register number, when in fact such a
2043@code{subreg} would contain some of the padding not stored in
2044registers and so not be representable.
2045@end defmac
2046
2047@defmac HARD_REGNO_NREGS_WITH_PADDING (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2048For values of @var{regno} and @var{mode} for which
2049@code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS_HAS_PADDING} returns nonzero, a C expression
2050returning the greater number of registers required to hold the value
2051including any padding. In the example above, the value would be four.
2052@end defmac
2053
ca0b6e3b
EB
2054@defmac REGMODE_NATURAL_SIZE (@var{mode})
2055Define this macro if the natural size of registers that hold values
2056of mode @var{mode} is not the word size. It is a C expression that
2057should give the natural size in bytes for the specified mode. It is
2058used by the register allocator to try to optimize its results. This
2059happens for example on SPARC 64-bit where the natural size of
2060floating-point registers is still 32-bit.
2061@end defmac
2062
a2c4f8e0 2063@defmac HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
feca2ed3
JW
2064A C expression that is nonzero if it is permissible to store a value
2065of mode @var{mode} in hard register number @var{regno} (or in several
2066registers starting with that one). For a machine where all registers
2067are equivalent, a suitable definition is
2068
2069@smallexample
2070#define HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK(REGNO, MODE) 1
2071@end smallexample
2072
e9a25f70
JL
2073You need not include code to check for the numbers of fixed registers,
2074because the allocation mechanism considers them to be always occupied.
feca2ed3
JW
2075
2076@cindex register pairs
2077On some machines, double-precision values must be kept in even/odd
e9a25f70
JL
2078register pairs. You can implement that by defining this macro to reject
2079odd register numbers for such modes.
feca2ed3
JW
2080
2081The minimum requirement for a mode to be OK in a register is that the
2082@samp{mov@var{mode}} instruction pattern support moves between the
e9a25f70
JL
2083register and other hard register in the same class and that moving a
2084value into the register and back out not alter it.
feca2ed3 2085
e9a25f70
JL
2086Since the same instruction used to move @code{word_mode} will work for
2087all narrower integer modes, it is not necessary on any machine for
feca2ed3
JW
2088@code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK} to distinguish between these modes, provided
2089you define patterns @samp{movhi}, etc., to take advantage of this. This
2090is useful because of the interaction between @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}
2091and @code{MODES_TIEABLE_P}; it is very desirable for all integer modes
2092to be tieable.
2093
2094Many machines have special registers for floating point arithmetic.
2095Often people assume that floating point machine modes are allowed only
2096in floating point registers. This is not true. Any registers that
2097can hold integers can safely @emph{hold} a floating point machine
2098mode, whether or not floating arithmetic can be done on it in those
2099registers. Integer move instructions can be used to move the values.
2100
2101On some machines, though, the converse is true: fixed-point machine
2102modes may not go in floating registers. This is true if the floating
2103registers normalize any value stored in them, because storing a
2104non-floating value there would garble it. In this case,
2105@code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK} should reject fixed-point machine modes in
2106floating registers. But if the floating registers do not automatically
2107normalize, if you can store any bit pattern in one and retrieve it
2108unchanged without a trap, then any machine mode may go in a floating
2109register, so you can define this macro to say so.
2110
2111The primary significance of special floating registers is rather that
2112they are the registers acceptable in floating point arithmetic
2113instructions. However, this is of no concern to
2114@code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}. You handle it by writing the proper
2115constraints for those instructions.
2116
2117On some machines, the floating registers are especially slow to access,
2118so that it is better to store a value in a stack frame than in such a
2119register if floating point arithmetic is not being done. As long as the
2120floating registers are not in class @code{GENERAL_REGS}, they will not
2121be used unless some pattern's constraint asks for one.
a2c4f8e0 2122@end defmac
feca2ed3 2123
150c9fe8
KH
2124@defmac HARD_REGNO_RENAME_OK (@var{from}, @var{to})
2125A C expression that is nonzero if it is OK to rename a hard register
2126@var{from} to another hard register @var{to}.
2127
2128One common use of this macro is to prevent renaming of a register to
2129another register that is not saved by a prologue in an interrupt
2130handler.
2131
2132The default is always nonzero.
2133@end defmac
2134
a2c4f8e0 2135@defmac MODES_TIEABLE_P (@var{mode1}, @var{mode2})
e9a25f70 2136A C expression that is nonzero if a value of mode
956d6950 2137@var{mode1} is accessible in mode @var{mode2} without copying.
feca2ed3
JW
2138
2139If @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{r}, @var{mode1})} and
e9a25f70
JL
2140@code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{r}, @var{mode2})} are always the same for
2141any @var{r}, then @code{MODES_TIEABLE_P (@var{mode1}, @var{mode2})}
2142should be nonzero. If they differ for any @var{r}, you should define
2143this macro to return zero unless some other mechanism ensures the
956d6950 2144accessibility of the value in a narrower mode.
e9a25f70
JL
2145
2146You should define this macro to return nonzero in as many cases as
a3a15b4d 2147possible since doing so will allow GCC to perform better register
e9a25f70 2148allocation.
a2c4f8e0 2149@end defmac
7506f491 2150
dbc42c44
AS
2151@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HARD_REGNO_SCRATCH_OK (unsigned int @var{regno})
2152This target hook should return @code{true} if it is OK to use a hard register
2153@var{regno} as scratch reg in peephole2.
2154
2155One common use of this macro is to prevent using of a register that
2156is not saved by a prologue in an interrupt handler.
2157
2158The default version of this hook always returns @code{true}.
2159@end deftypefn
2160
a2c4f8e0 2161@defmac AVOID_CCMODE_COPIES
7506f491 2162Define this macro if the compiler should avoid copies to/from @code{CCmode}
a89608cb 2163registers. You should only define this macro if support for copying to/from
7506f491 2164@code{CCmode} is incomplete.
a2c4f8e0 2165@end defmac
feca2ed3
JW
2166
2167@node Leaf Functions
2168@subsection Handling Leaf Functions
2169
2170@cindex leaf functions
2171@cindex functions, leaf
2172On some machines, a leaf function (i.e., one which makes no calls) can run
2173more efficiently if it does not make its own register window. Often this
2174means it is required to receive its arguments in the registers where they
2175are passed by the caller, instead of the registers where they would
2176normally arrive.
2177
2178The special treatment for leaf functions generally applies only when
2179other conditions are met; for example, often they may use only those
2180registers for its own variables and temporaries. We use the term ``leaf
2181function'' to mean a function that is suitable for this special
2182handling, so that functions with no calls are not necessarily ``leaf
2183functions''.
2184
a3a15b4d 2185GCC assigns register numbers before it knows whether the function is
feca2ed3
JW
2186suitable for leaf function treatment. So it needs to renumber the
2187registers in order to output a leaf function. The following macros
2188accomplish this.
2189
a2c4f8e0 2190@defmac LEAF_REGISTERS
7d167afd 2191Name of a char vector, indexed by hard register number, which
feca2ed3
JW
2192contains 1 for a register that is allowable in a candidate for leaf
2193function treatment.
2194
2195If leaf function treatment involves renumbering the registers, then the
2196registers marked here should be the ones before renumbering---those that
a3a15b4d 2197GCC would ordinarily allocate. The registers which will actually be
feca2ed3
JW
2198used in the assembler code, after renumbering, should not be marked with 1
2199in this vector.
2200
2201Define this macro only if the target machine offers a way to optimize
2202the treatment of leaf functions.
a2c4f8e0 2203@end defmac
feca2ed3 2204
a2c4f8e0 2205@defmac LEAF_REG_REMAP (@var{regno})
feca2ed3
JW
2206A C expression whose value is the register number to which @var{regno}
2207should be renumbered, when a function is treated as a leaf function.
2208
2209If @var{regno} is a register number which should not appear in a leaf
630d3d5a 2210function before renumbering, then the expression should yield @minus{}1, which
feca2ed3
JW
2211will cause the compiler to abort.
2212
2213Define this macro only if the target machine offers a way to optimize the
2214treatment of leaf functions, and registers need to be renumbered to do
2215this.
a2c4f8e0 2216@end defmac
feca2ed3 2217
54ff41b7
JW
2218@findex current_function_is_leaf
2219@findex current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs
c237e94a
ZW
2220@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} and
2221@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must usually treat leaf functions
2222specially. They can test the C variable @code{current_function_is_leaf}
2223which is nonzero for leaf functions. @code{current_function_is_leaf} is
2224set prior to local register allocation and is valid for the remaining
08c148a8
NB
2225compiler passes. They can also test the C variable
2226@code{current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs} which is nonzero for leaf
2227functions which only use leaf registers.
9ac617d4
EB
2228@code{current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs} is valid after all passes
2229that modify the instructions have been run and is only useful if
2230@code{LEAF_REGISTERS} is defined.
feca2ed3
JW
2231@c changed this to fix overfull. ALSO: why the "it" at the beginning
2232@c of the next paragraph?! --mew 2feb93
2233
2234@node Stack Registers
2235@subsection Registers That Form a Stack
2236
2237There are special features to handle computers where some of the
a2c4f8e0
ZW
2238``registers'' form a stack. Stack registers are normally written by
2239pushing onto the stack, and are numbered relative to the top of the
2240stack.
feca2ed3 2241
a3a15b4d 2242Currently, GCC can only handle one group of stack-like registers, and
a2c4f8e0
ZW
2243they must be consecutively numbered. Furthermore, the existing
2244support for stack-like registers is specific to the 80387 floating
2245point coprocessor. If you have a new architecture that uses
2246stack-like registers, you will need to do substantial work on
2247@file{reg-stack.c} and write your machine description to cooperate
2248with it, as well as defining these macros.
2249
2250@defmac STACK_REGS
feca2ed3 2251Define this if the machine has any stack-like registers.
a2c4f8e0 2252@end defmac
feca2ed3 2253
1833192f
VM
2254@defmac STACK_REG_COVER_CLASS
2255This is a cover class containing the stack registers. Define this if
2256the machine has any stack-like registers.
2257@end defmac
2258
a2c4f8e0 2259@defmac FIRST_STACK_REG
feca2ed3
JW
2260The number of the first stack-like register. This one is the top
2261of the stack.
a2c4f8e0 2262@end defmac
feca2ed3 2263
a2c4f8e0 2264@defmac LAST_STACK_REG
feca2ed3
JW
2265The number of the last stack-like register. This one is the bottom of
2266the stack.
a2c4f8e0 2267@end defmac
feca2ed3 2268
feca2ed3
JW
2269@node Register Classes
2270@section Register Classes
2271@cindex register class definitions
2272@cindex class definitions, register
2273
2274On many machines, the numbered registers are not all equivalent.
2275For example, certain registers may not be allowed for indexed addressing;
2276certain registers may not be allowed in some instructions. These machine
2277restrictions are described to the compiler using @dfn{register classes}.
2278
2279You define a number of register classes, giving each one a name and saying
2280which of the registers belong to it. Then you can specify register classes
2281that are allowed as operands to particular instruction patterns.
2282
2283@findex ALL_REGS
2284@findex NO_REGS
2285In general, each register will belong to several classes. In fact, one
2286class must be named @code{ALL_REGS} and contain all the registers. Another
2287class must be named @code{NO_REGS} and contain no registers. Often the
2288union of two classes will be another class; however, this is not required.
2289
2290@findex GENERAL_REGS
2291One of the classes must be named @code{GENERAL_REGS}. There is nothing
2292terribly special about the name, but the operand constraint letters
2293@samp{r} and @samp{g} specify this class. If @code{GENERAL_REGS} is
2294the same as @code{ALL_REGS}, just define it as a macro which expands
2295to @code{ALL_REGS}.
2296
2297Order the classes so that if class @var{x} is contained in class @var{y}
2298then @var{x} has a lower class number than @var{y}.
2299
2300The way classes other than @code{GENERAL_REGS} are specified in operand
2301constraints is through machine-dependent operand constraint letters.
2302You can define such letters to correspond to various classes, then use
2303them in operand constraints.
2304
6049a4c8
HPN
2305You must define the narrowest register classes for allocatable
2306registers, so that each class either has no subclasses, or that for
2307some mode, the move cost between registers within the class is
2308cheaper than moving a register in the class to or from memory
2309(@pxref{Costs}).
2310
feca2ed3
JW
2311You should define a class for the union of two classes whenever some
2312instruction allows both classes. For example, if an instruction allows
2313either a floating point (coprocessor) register or a general register for a
2314certain operand, you should define a class @code{FLOAT_OR_GENERAL_REGS}
b899fd78
JR
2315which includes both of them. Otherwise you will get suboptimal code,
2316or even internal compiler errors when reload cannot find a register in the
dd5a833e 2317class computed via @code{reg_class_subunion}.
feca2ed3
JW
2318
2319You must also specify certain redundant information about the register
2320classes: for each class, which classes contain it and which ones are
2321contained in it; for each pair of classes, the largest class contained
2322in their union.
2323
2324When a value occupying several consecutive registers is expected in a
2325certain class, all the registers used must belong to that class.
2326Therefore, register classes cannot be used to enforce a requirement for
2327a register pair to start with an even-numbered register. The way to
2328specify this requirement is with @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}.
2329
2330Register classes used for input-operands of bitwise-and or shift
2331instructions have a special requirement: each such class must have, for
2332each fixed-point machine mode, a subclass whose registers can transfer that
2333mode to or from memory. For example, on some machines, the operations for
2334single-byte values (@code{QImode}) are limited to certain registers. When
2335this is so, each register class that is used in a bitwise-and or shift
2336instruction must have a subclass consisting of registers from which
2337single-byte values can be loaded or stored. This is so that
2338@code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} can always have a possible value to return.
2339
a2c4f8e0 2340@deftp {Data type} {enum reg_class}
2eac577f
JM
2341An enumerated type that must be defined with all the register class names
2342as enumerated values. @code{NO_REGS} must be first. @code{ALL_REGS}
2343must be the last register class, followed by one more enumerated value,
feca2ed3
JW
2344@code{LIM_REG_CLASSES}, which is not a register class but rather
2345tells how many classes there are.
2346
2347Each register class has a number, which is the value of casting
2348the class name to type @code{int}. The number serves as an index
2349in many of the tables described below.
a2c4f8e0 2350@end deftp
feca2ed3 2351
a2c4f8e0 2352@defmac N_REG_CLASSES
feca2ed3
JW
2353The number of distinct register classes, defined as follows:
2354
3ab51846 2355@smallexample
feca2ed3 2356#define N_REG_CLASSES (int) LIM_REG_CLASSES
3ab51846 2357@end smallexample
a2c4f8e0 2358@end defmac
feca2ed3 2359
a2c4f8e0 2360@defmac REG_CLASS_NAMES
feca2ed3
JW
2361An initializer containing the names of the register classes as C string
2362constants. These names are used in writing some of the debugging dumps.
a2c4f8e0 2363@end defmac
feca2ed3 2364
a2c4f8e0 2365@defmac REG_CLASS_CONTENTS
feca2ed3
JW
2366An initializer containing the contents of the register classes, as integers
2367which are bit masks. The @var{n}th integer specifies the contents of class
2368@var{n}. The way the integer @var{mask} is interpreted is that
2369register @var{r} is in the class if @code{@var{mask} & (1 << @var{r})} is 1.
2370
2371When the machine has more than 32 registers, an integer does not suffice.
2372Then the integers are replaced by sub-initializers, braced groupings containing
2373several integers. Each sub-initializer must be suitable as an initializer
2374for the type @code{HARD_REG_SET} which is defined in @file{hard-reg-set.h}.
7c272079
MP
2375In this situation, the first integer in each sub-initializer corresponds to
2376registers 0 through 31, the second integer to registers 32 through 63, and
2377so on.
a2c4f8e0 2378@end defmac
feca2ed3 2379
a2c4f8e0 2380@defmac REGNO_REG_CLASS (@var{regno})
feca2ed3
JW
2381A C expression whose value is a register class containing hard register
2382@var{regno}. In general there is more than one such class; choose a class
2383which is @dfn{minimal}, meaning that no smaller class also contains the
2384register.
a2c4f8e0 2385@end defmac
feca2ed3 2386
a2c4f8e0 2387@defmac BASE_REG_CLASS
feca2ed3
JW
2388A macro whose definition is the name of the class to which a valid
2389base register must belong. A base register is one used in an address
2390which is the register value plus a displacement.
a2c4f8e0 2391@end defmac
feca2ed3 2392
a2c4f8e0 2393@defmac MODE_BASE_REG_CLASS (@var{mode})
3dcc68a4 2394This is a variation of the @code{BASE_REG_CLASS} macro which allows
c0478a66 2395the selection of a base register in a mode dependent manner. If
3dcc68a4
NC
2396@var{mode} is VOIDmode then it should return the same value as
2397@code{BASE_REG_CLASS}.
a2c4f8e0 2398@end defmac
3dcc68a4 2399
888d2cd6
DJ
2400@defmac MODE_BASE_REG_REG_CLASS (@var{mode})
2401A C expression whose value is the register class to which a valid
2402base register must belong in order to be used in a base plus index
2403register address. You should define this macro if base plus index
2404addresses have different requirements than other base register uses.
2405@end defmac
2406
86fc3d06 2407@defmac MODE_CODE_BASE_REG_CLASS (@var{mode}, @var{address_space}, @var{outer_code}, @var{index_code})
c4963a0a 2408A C expression whose value is the register class to which a valid
86fc3d06
UW
2409base register for a memory reference in mode @var{mode} to address
2410space @var{address_space} must belong. @var{outer_code} and @var{index_code}
2411define the context in which the base register occurs. @var{outer_code} is
2412the code of the immediately enclosing expression (@code{MEM} for the top level
2413of an address, @code{ADDRESS} for something that occurs in an
c4963a0a
BS
2414@code{address_operand}). @var{index_code} is the code of the corresponding
2415index expression if @var{outer_code} is @code{PLUS}; @code{SCRATCH} otherwise.
2416@end defmac
2417
a2c4f8e0 2418@defmac INDEX_REG_CLASS
feca2ed3
JW
2419A macro whose definition is the name of the class to which a valid
2420index register must belong. An index register is one used in an
2421address where its value is either multiplied by a scale factor or
2422added to another register (as well as added to a displacement).
a2c4f8e0 2423@end defmac
feca2ed3 2424
a2c4f8e0 2425@defmac REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num})
feca2ed3 2426A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is
1c62e8f2 2427suitable for use as a base register in operand addresses.
a2c4f8e0 2428@end defmac
feca2ed3 2429
a2c4f8e0 2430@defmac REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num}, @var{mode})
861bb6c1
JL
2431A C expression that is just like @code{REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P}, except that
2432that expression may examine the mode of the memory reference in
2433@var{mode}. You should define this macro if the mode of the memory
2434reference affects whether a register may be used as a base register. If
2435you define this macro, the compiler will use it instead of
ab873839
RW
2436@code{REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P}. The mode may be @code{VOIDmode} for
2437addresses that appear outside a @code{MEM}, i.e., as an
2438@code{address_operand}.
a2c4f8e0 2439@end defmac
861bb6c1 2440
888d2cd6
DJ
2441@defmac REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_REG_BASE_P (@var{num}, @var{mode})
2442A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is suitable for
2443use as a base register in base plus index operand addresses, accessing
2444memory in mode @var{mode}. It may be either a suitable hard register or a
2445pseudo register that has been allocated such a hard register. You should
2446define this macro if base plus index addresses have different requirements
2447than other base register uses.
c4963a0a
BS
2448
2449Use of this macro is deprecated; please use the more general
2450@code{REGNO_MODE_CODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P}.
2451@end defmac
2452
86fc3d06
UW
2453@defmac REGNO_MODE_CODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num}, @var{mode}, @var{address_space}, @var{outer_code}, @var{index_code})
2454A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is
2455suitable for use as a base register in operand addresses, accessing
2456memory in mode @var{mode} in address space @var{address_space}.
2457This is similar to @code{REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P}, except
ab873839
RW
2458that that expression may examine the context in which the register
2459appears in the memory reference. @var{outer_code} is the code of the
2460immediately enclosing expression (@code{MEM} if at the top level of the
2461address, @code{ADDRESS} for something that occurs in an
2462@code{address_operand}). @var{index_code} is the code of the
2463corresponding index expression if @var{outer_code} is @code{PLUS};
c4963a0a 2464@code{SCRATCH} otherwise. The mode may be @code{VOIDmode} for addresses
ab873839 2465that appear outside a @code{MEM}, i.e., as an @code{address_operand}.
888d2cd6
DJ
2466@end defmac
2467
a2c4f8e0 2468@defmac REGNO_OK_FOR_INDEX_P (@var{num})
feca2ed3
JW
2469A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is
2470suitable for use as an index register in operand addresses. It may be
2471either a suitable hard register or a pseudo register that has been
2472allocated such a hard register.
2473
2474The difference between an index register and a base register is that
2475the index register may be scaled. If an address involves the sum of
2476two registers, neither one of them scaled, then either one may be
2477labeled the ``base'' and the other the ``index''; but whichever
2478labeling is used must fit the machine's constraints of which registers
2479may serve in each capacity. The compiler will try both labelings,
2480looking for one that is valid, and will reload one or both registers
2481only if neither labeling works.
a2c4f8e0 2482@end defmac
feca2ed3 2483
5f286f4a 2484@deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_PREFERRED_RENAME_CLASS (reg_class_t @var{rclass})
6d3fbe2f 2485A target hook that places additional preference on the register class to use when it is necessary to rename a register in class @var{rclass} to another class, or perhaps @var{NO_REGS}, if no preferred register class is found or hook @code{preferred_rename_class} is not implemented. Sometimes returning a more restrictive class makes better code. For example, on ARM, thumb-2 instructions using @code{LO_REGS} may be smaller than instructions using @code{GENERIC_REGS}. By returning @code{LO_REGS} from @code{preferred_rename_class}, code size can be reduced.
5f286f4a
YQ
2486@end deftypefn
2487
fba42e24
AS
2488@deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS (rtx @var{x}, reg_class_t @var{rclass})
2489A target hook that places additional restrictions on the register class
2490to use when it is necessary to copy value @var{x} into a register in class
2491@var{rclass}. The value is a register class; perhaps @var{rclass}, or perhaps
2492another, smaller class.
2493
2494The default version of this hook always returns value of @code{rclass} argument.
2495
2496Sometimes returning a more restrictive class makes better code. For
2497example, on the 68000, when @var{x} is an integer constant that is in range
2498for a @samp{moveq} instruction, the value of this macro is always
2499@code{DATA_REGS} as long as @var{rclass} includes the data registers.
2500Requiring a data register guarantees that a @samp{moveq} will be used.
2501
2502One case where @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} must not return
2503@var{rclass} is if @var{x} is a legitimate constant which cannot be
2504loaded into some register class. By returning @code{NO_REGS} you can
2505force @var{x} into a memory location. For example, rs6000 can load
2506immediate values into general-purpose registers, but does not have an
2507instruction for loading an immediate value into a floating-point
2508register, so @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} returns @code{NO_REGS} when
2509@var{x} is a floating-point constant. If the constant can't be loaded
2510into any kind of register, code generation will be better if
1a627b35 2511@code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P} makes the constant illegitimate instead
fba42e24
AS
2512of using @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}.
2513
2514If an insn has pseudos in it after register allocation, reload will go
2515through the alternatives and call repeatedly @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}
2516to find the best one. Returning @code{NO_REGS}, in this case, makes
2517reload add a @code{!} in front of the constraint: the x86 back-end uses
2518this feature to discourage usage of 387 registers when math is done in
2519the SSE registers (and vice versa).
2520@end deftypefn
2521
a2c4f8e0 2522@defmac PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{x}, @var{class})
feca2ed3
JW
2523A C expression that places additional restrictions on the register class
2524to use when it is necessary to copy value @var{x} into a register in class
2525@var{class}. The value is a register class; perhaps @var{class}, or perhaps
2526another, smaller class. On many machines, the following definition is
2527safe:
2528
3ab51846 2529@smallexample
feca2ed3 2530#define PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS(X,CLASS) CLASS
3ab51846 2531@end smallexample
feca2ed3
JW
2532
2533Sometimes returning a more restrictive class makes better code. For
2534example, on the 68000, when @var{x} is an integer constant that is in range
2535for a @samp{moveq} instruction, the value of this macro is always
2536@code{DATA_REGS} as long as @var{class} includes the data registers.
2537Requiring a data register guarantees that a @samp{moveq} will be used.
2538
222a2f1a
GK
2539One case where @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} must not return
2540@var{class} is if @var{x} is a legitimate constant which cannot be
2541loaded into some register class. By returning @code{NO_REGS} you can
2542force @var{x} into a memory location. For example, rs6000 can load
2543immediate values into general-purpose registers, but does not have an
2544instruction for loading an immediate value into a floating-point
2545register, so @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} returns @code{NO_REGS} when
2546@var{x} is a floating-point constant. If the constant can't be loaded
2547into any kind of register, code generation will be better if
1a627b35
RS
2548@code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P} makes the constant illegitimate instead
2549of using @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}.
b5c82fa1
PB
2550
2551If an insn has pseudos in it after register allocation, reload will go
2552through the alternatives and call repeatedly @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}
2553to find the best one. Returning @code{NO_REGS}, in this case, makes
2554reload add a @code{!} in front of the constraint: the x86 back-end uses
2555this feature to discourage usage of 387 registers when math is done in
2556the SSE registers (and vice versa).
a2c4f8e0 2557@end defmac
feca2ed3 2558
abd26bfb
AS
2559@deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_PREFERRED_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (rtx @var{x}, reg_class_t @var{rclass})
2560Like @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}, but for output reloads instead of
2561input reloads.
2562
2563The default version of this hook always returns value of @code{rclass}
2564argument.
2565
2566You can also use @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS} to discourage
2567reload from using some alternatives, like @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}.
2568@end deftypefn
2569
a2c4f8e0 2570@defmac LIMIT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{mode}, @var{class})
feca2ed3
JW
2571A C expression that places additional restrictions on the register class
2572to use when it is necessary to be able to hold a value of mode
2573@var{mode} in a reload register for which class @var{class} would
2574ordinarily be used.
2575
2576Unlike @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}, this macro should be used when
2577there are certain modes that simply can't go in certain reload classes.
2578
2579The value is a register class; perhaps @var{class}, or perhaps another,
2580smaller class.
2581
2582Don't define this macro unless the target machine has limitations which
2583require the macro to do something nontrivial.
a2c4f8e0 2584@end defmac
feca2ed3 2585
a87cf97e 2586@deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD (bool @var{in_p}, rtx @var{x}, reg_class_t @var{reload_class}, enum machine_mode @var{reload_mode}, secondary_reload_info *@var{sri})
feca2ed3
JW
2587Many machines have some registers that cannot be copied directly to or
2588from memory or even from other types of registers. An example is the
2589@samp{MQ} register, which on most machines, can only be copied to or
8a99f6f9
R
2590from general registers, but not memory. Below, we shall be using the
2591term 'intermediate register' when a move operation cannot be performed
2592directly, but has to be done by copying the source into the intermediate
2593register first, and then copying the intermediate register to the
2594destination. An intermediate register always has the same mode as
2595source and destination. Since it holds the actual value being copied,
2596reload might apply optimizations to re-use an intermediate register
2597and eliding the copy from the source when it can determine that the
2598intermediate register still holds the required value.
2599
2600Another kind of secondary reload is required on some machines which
2601allow copying all registers to and from memory, but require a scratch
2602register for stores to some memory locations (e.g., those with symbolic
2603address on the RT, and those with certain symbolic address on the SPARC
2604when compiling PIC)@. Scratch registers need not have the same mode
e4ae5e77 2605as the value being copied, and usually hold a different value than
8a99f6f9
R
2606that being copied. Special patterns in the md file are needed to
2607describe how the copy is performed with the help of the scratch register;
2608these patterns also describe the number, register class(es) and mode(s)
2609of the scratch register(s).
2610
2611In some cases, both an intermediate and a scratch register are required.
2612
2613For input reloads, this target hook is called with nonzero @var{in_p},
9bdf23b2 2614and @var{x} is an rtx that needs to be copied to a register of class
8a99f6f9 2615@var{reload_class} in @var{reload_mode}. For output reloads, this target
9bdf23b2 2616hook is called with zero @var{in_p}, and a register of class @var{reload_class}
8a99f6f9
R
2617needs to be copied to rtx @var{x} in @var{reload_mode}.
2618
2619If copying a register of @var{reload_class} from/to @var{x} requires
2620an intermediate register, the hook @code{secondary_reload} should
2621return the register class required for this intermediate register.
2622If no intermediate register is required, it should return NO_REGS.
2623If more than one intermediate register is required, describe the one
2624that is closest in the copy chain to the reload register.
2625
2626If scratch registers are needed, you also have to describe how to
2627perform the copy from/to the reload register to/from this
2628closest intermediate register. Or if no intermediate register is
2629required, but still a scratch register is needed, describe the
2630copy from/to the reload register to/from the reload operand @var{x}.
2631
2632You do this by setting @code{sri->icode} to the instruction code of a pattern
2633in the md file which performs the move. Operands 0 and 1 are the output
2634and input of this copy, respectively. Operands from operand 2 onward are
2635for scratch operands. These scratch operands must have a mode, and a
2636single-register-class
2637@c [later: or memory]
2638output constraint.
2639
2640When an intermediate register is used, the @code{secondary_reload}
2641hook will be called again to determine how to copy the intermediate
2642register to/from the reload operand @var{x}, so your hook must also
2643have code to handle the register class of the intermediate operand.
2644
2645@c [For later: maybe we'll allow multi-alternative reload patterns -
2646@c the port maintainer could name a mov<mode> pattern that has clobbers -
2647@c and match the constraints of input and output to determine the required
2648@c alternative. A restriction would be that constraints used to match
2649@c against reloads registers would have to be written as register class
2650@c constraints, or we need a new target macro / hook that tells us if an
2651@c arbitrary constraint can match an unknown register of a given class.
2652@c Such a macro / hook would also be useful in other places.]
2653
2654
2655@var{x} might be a pseudo-register or a @code{subreg} of a
2656pseudo-register, which could either be in a hard register or in memory.
2657Use @code{true_regnum} to find out; it will return @minus{}1 if the pseudo is
2658in memory and the hard register number if it is in a register.
2659
2660Scratch operands in memory (constraint @code{"=m"} / @code{"=&m"}) are
2661currently not supported. For the time being, you will have to continue
2662to use @code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} for that purpose.
2663
2664@code{copy_cost} also uses this target hook to find out how values are
2665copied. If you want it to include some extra cost for the need to allocate
2666(a) scratch register(s), set @code{sri->extra_cost} to the additional cost.
2667Or if two dependent moves are supposed to have a lower cost than the sum
2668of the individual moves due to expected fortuitous scheduling and/or special
2669forwarding logic, you can set @code{sri->extra_cost} to a negative amount.
2670@end deftypefn
2671
2672@defmac SECONDARY_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
2673@defmacx SECONDARY_INPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
2674@defmacx SECONDARY_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
083cad55 2675These macros are obsolete, new ports should use the target hook
8a99f6f9
R
2676@code{TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD} instead.
2677
2678These are obsolete macros, replaced by the @code{TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD}
2679target hook. Older ports still define these macros to indicate to the
2680reload phase that it may
feca2ed3
JW
2681need to allocate at least one register for a reload in addition to the
2682register to contain the data. Specifically, if copying @var{x} to a
2683register @var{class} in @var{mode} requires an intermediate register,
8a99f6f9 2684you were supposed to define @code{SECONDARY_INPUT_RELOAD_CLASS} to return the
feca2ed3
JW
2685largest register class all of whose registers can be used as
2686intermediate registers or scratch registers.
2687
2688If copying a register @var{class} in @var{mode} to @var{x} requires an
2689intermediate or scratch register, @code{SECONDARY_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS}
8a99f6f9
R
2690was supposed to be defined be defined to return the largest register
2691class required. If the
2692requirements for input and output reloads were the same, the macro
2693@code{SECONDARY_RELOAD_CLASS} should have been used instead of defining both
feca2ed3
JW
2694macros identically.
2695
2696The values returned by these macros are often @code{GENERAL_REGS}.
2697Return @code{NO_REGS} if no spare register is needed; i.e., if @var{x}
2698can be directly copied to or from a register of @var{class} in
2699@var{mode} without requiring a scratch register. Do not define this
2700macro if it would always return @code{NO_REGS}.
2701
2702If a scratch register is required (either with or without an
8a99f6f9 2703intermediate register), you were supposed to define patterns for
feca2ed3 2704@samp{reload_in@var{m}} or @samp{reload_out@var{m}}, as required
8a99f6f9 2705(@pxref{Standard Names}. These patterns, which were normally
feca2ed3
JW
2706implemented with a @code{define_expand}, should be similar to the
2707@samp{mov@var{m}} patterns, except that operand 2 is the scratch
2708register.
2709
8a99f6f9
R
2710These patterns need constraints for the reload register and scratch
2711register that
feca2ed3
JW
2712contain a single register class. If the original reload register (whose
2713class is @var{class}) can meet the constraint given in the pattern, the
2714value returned by these macros is used for the class of the scratch
2715register. Otherwise, two additional reload registers are required.
2716Their classes are obtained from the constraints in the insn pattern.
2717
2718@var{x} might be a pseudo-register or a @code{subreg} of a
2719pseudo-register, which could either be in a hard register or in memory.
630d3d5a 2720Use @code{true_regnum} to find out; it will return @minus{}1 if the pseudo is
feca2ed3
JW
2721in memory and the hard register number if it is in a register.
2722
2723These macros should not be used in the case where a particular class of
2724registers can only be copied to memory and not to another class of
2725registers. In that case, secondary reload registers are not needed and
2726would not be helpful. Instead, a stack location must be used to perform
a8154559 2727the copy and the @code{mov@var{m}} pattern should use memory as an
feca2ed3
JW
2728intermediate storage. This case often occurs between floating-point and
2729general registers.
a2c4f8e0 2730@end defmac
feca2ed3 2731
a2c4f8e0 2732@defmac SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED (@var{class1}, @var{class2}, @var{m})
feca2ed3
JW
2733Certain machines have the property that some registers cannot be copied
2734to some other registers without using memory. Define this macro on
df2a54e9 2735those machines to be a C expression that is nonzero if objects of mode
feca2ed3
JW
2736@var{m} in registers of @var{class1} can only be copied to registers of
2737class @var{class2} by storing a register of @var{class1} into memory
2738and loading that memory location into a register of @var{class2}.
2739
2740Do not define this macro if its value would always be zero.
a2c4f8e0 2741@end defmac
feca2ed3 2742
a2c4f8e0 2743@defmac SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED_RTX (@var{mode})
feca2ed3
JW
2744Normally when @code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} is defined, the compiler
2745allocates a stack slot for a memory location needed for register copies.
2746If this macro is defined, the compiler instead uses the memory location
2747defined by this macro.
2748
2749Do not define this macro if you do not define
2750@code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED}.
a2c4f8e0 2751@end defmac
feca2ed3 2752
a2c4f8e0 2753@defmac SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED_MODE (@var{mode})
feca2ed3
JW
2754When the compiler needs a secondary memory location to copy between two
2755registers of mode @var{mode}, it normally allocates sufficient memory to
2756hold a quantity of @code{BITS_PER_WORD} bits and performs the store and
2757load operations in a mode that many bits wide and whose class is the
2758same as that of @var{mode}.
2759
2760This is right thing to do on most machines because it ensures that all
2761bits of the register are copied and prevents accesses to the registers
2762in a narrower mode, which some machines prohibit for floating-point
2763registers.
2764
2765However, this default behavior is not correct on some machines, such as
2766the DEC Alpha, that store short integers in floating-point registers
2767differently than in integer registers. On those machines, the default
2768widening will not work correctly and you must define this macro to
2769suppress that widening in some cases. See the file @file{alpha.h} for
2770details.
2771
2772Do not define this macro if you do not define
2773@code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} or if widening @var{mode} to a mode that
2774is @code{BITS_PER_WORD} bits wide is correct for your machine.
a2c4f8e0 2775@end defmac
feca2ed3 2776
07b8f0a8
AS
2777@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CLASS_LIKELY_SPILLED_P (reg_class_t @var{rclass})
2778A target hook which returns @code{true} if pseudos that have been assigned
2779to registers of class @var{rclass} would likely be spilled because
2780registers of @var{rclass} are needed for spill registers.
2781
2782The default version of this target hook returns @code{true} if @var{rclass}
2783has exactly one register and @code{false} otherwise. On most machines, this
aeb9f7cf
SB
2784default should be used. For generally register-starved machines, such as
2785i386, or machines with right register constraints, such as SH, this hook
2786can be used to avoid excessive spilling.
2787
2788This hook is also used by some of the global intra-procedural code
2789transformations to throtle code motion, to avoid increasing register
2790pressure.
07b8f0a8
AS
2791@end deftypefn
2792
a8c44c52
AS
2793@deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned char} TARGET_CLASS_MAX_NREGS (reg_class_t @var{rclass}, enum machine_mode @var{mode})
2794A target hook returns the maximum number of consecutive registers
2795of class @var{rclass} needed to hold a value of mode @var{mode}.
2796
2797This is closely related to the macro @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS}. In fact,
1c7836f0 2798the value returned by @code{TARGET_CLASS_MAX_NREGS (@var{rclass},
a8c44c52
AS
2799@var{mode})} target hook should be the maximum value of
2800@code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS (@var{regno}, @var{mode})} for all @var{regno}
2801values in the class @var{rclass}.
2802
2803This target hook helps control the handling of multiple-word values
2804in the reload pass.
2805
2806The default version of this target hook returns the size of @var{mode}
2807in words.
2808@end deftypefn
2809
a2c4f8e0 2810@defmac CLASS_MAX_NREGS (@var{class}, @var{mode})
feca2ed3
JW
2811A C expression for the maximum number of consecutive registers
2812of class @var{class} needed to hold a value of mode @var{mode}.
2813
2814This is closely related to the macro @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS}. In fact,
2815the value of the macro @code{CLASS_MAX_NREGS (@var{class}, @var{mode})}
2816should be the maximum value of @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS (@var{regno},
2817@var{mode})} for all @var{regno} values in the class @var{class}.
2818
2819This macro helps control the handling of multiple-word values
2820in the reload pass.
a2c4f8e0 2821@end defmac
feca2ed3 2822
a2c4f8e0 2823@defmac CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS (@var{from}, @var{to}, @var{class})
b0c42aed
JH
2824If defined, a C expression that returns nonzero for a @var{class} for which
2825a change from mode @var{from} to mode @var{to} is invalid.
feca2ed3
JW
2826
2827For the example, loading 32-bit integer or floating-point objects into
57694e40 2828floating-point registers on the Alpha extends them to 64 bits.
feca2ed3 2829Therefore loading a 64-bit object and then storing it as a 32-bit object
57694e40 2830does not store the low-order 32 bits, as would be the case for a normal
cff9f8d5
AH
2831register. Therefore, @file{alpha.h} defines @code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS}
2832as below:
02188693 2833
3ab51846 2834@smallexample
b0c42aed
JH
2835#define CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS(FROM, TO, CLASS) \
2836 (GET_MODE_SIZE (FROM) != GET_MODE_SIZE (TO) \
2837 ? reg_classes_intersect_p (FLOAT_REGS, (CLASS)) : 0)
3ab51846 2838@end smallexample
a2c4f8e0 2839@end defmac
feca2ed3 2840
55a2c322
VM
2841@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LRA_P (void)
2842A target hook which returns true if we use LRA instead of reload pass. It means that LRA was ported to the target. The default version of this target hook returns always false.
2843@end deftypefn
2844
2845@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_REGISTER_PRIORITY (int)
2846A target hook which returns the register priority number to which the register @var{hard_regno} belongs to. The bigger the number, the more preferable the hard register usage (when all other conditions are the same). This hook can be used to prefer some hard register over others in LRA. For example, some x86-64 register usage needs additional prefix which makes instructions longer. The hook can return lower priority number for such registers make them less favorable and as result making the generated code smaller. The default version of this target hook returns always zero.
2847@end deftypefn
2848
3b9ceb4b
VM
2849@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_REGISTER_USAGE_LEVELING_P (void)
2850A target hook which returns true if we need register usage leveling. That means if a few hard registers are equally good for the assignment, we choose the least used hard register. The register usage leveling may be profitable for some targets. Don't use the usage leveling for targets with conditional execution or targets with big register files as it hurts if-conversion and cross-jumping optimizations. The default version of this target hook returns always false.
2851@end deftypefn
2852
55a2c322
VM
2853@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_DIFFERENT_ADDR_DISPLACEMENT_P (void)
2854A target hook which returns true if an address with the same structure can have different maximal legitimate displacement. For example, the displacement can depend on memory mode or on operand combinations in the insn. The default version of this target hook returns always false.
2855@end deftypefn
2856
2857@deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_SPILL_CLASS (reg_class_t, enum @var{machine_mode})
2858This hook defines a class of registers which could be used for spilling pseudos of the given mode and class, or @code{NO_REGS} if only memory should be used. Not defining this hook is equivalent to returning @code{NO_REGS} for all inputs.
2859@end deftypefn
2860
42e37616
DM
2861@deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum machine_mode} TARGET_CSTORE_MODE (enum insn_code @var{icode})
2862This hook defines the machine mode to use for the boolean result of conditional store patterns. The ICODE argument is the instruction code for the cstore being performed. Not definiting this hook is the same as accepting the mode encoded into operand 0 of the cstore expander patterns.
2863@end deftypefn
2864
feca2ed3
JW
2865@node Stack and Calling
2866@section Stack Layout and Calling Conventions
2867@cindex calling conventions
2868
2869@c prevent bad page break with this line
2870This describes the stack layout and calling conventions.
2871
2872@menu
2873* Frame Layout::
7c16328b 2874* Exception Handling::
861bb6c1 2875* Stack Checking::
feca2ed3
JW
2876* Frame Registers::
2877* Elimination::
2878* Stack Arguments::
2879* Register Arguments::
2880* Scalar Return::
2881* Aggregate Return::
2882* Caller Saves::
2883* Function Entry::
2884* Profiling::
91d231cb 2885* Tail Calls::
7d69de61 2886* Stack Smashing Protection::
aaeaa9a9 2887* Miscellaneous Register Hooks::
feca2ed3
JW
2888@end menu
2889
2890@node Frame Layout
2891@subsection Basic Stack Layout
2892@cindex stack frame layout
2893@cindex frame layout
2894
2895@c prevent bad page break with this line
2896Here is the basic stack layout.
2897
a2c4f8e0 2898@defmac STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
feca2ed3
JW
2899Define this macro if pushing a word onto the stack moves the stack
2900pointer to a smaller address.
2901
d78aa55c 2902When we say, ``define this macro if @dots{}'', it means that the
feca2ed3
JW
2903compiler checks this macro only with @code{#ifdef} so the precise
2904definition used does not matter.
a2c4f8e0 2905@end defmac
feca2ed3 2906
a2c4f8e0 2907@defmac STACK_PUSH_CODE
918a6124
GK
2908This macro defines the operation used when something is pushed
2909on the stack. In RTL, a push operation will be
04a5176a 2910@code{(set (mem (STACK_PUSH_CODE (reg sp))) @dots{})}
918a6124
GK
2911
2912The choices are @code{PRE_DEC}, @code{POST_DEC}, @code{PRE_INC},
2913and @code{POST_INC}. Which of these is correct depends on
2914the stack direction and on whether the stack pointer points
2915to the last item on the stack or whether it points to the
2916space for the next item on the stack.
2917
2918The default is @code{PRE_DEC} when @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is
2919defined, which is almost always right, and @code{PRE_INC} otherwise,
2920which is often wrong.
a2c4f8e0 2921@end defmac
918a6124 2922
a2c4f8e0 2923@defmac FRAME_GROWS_DOWNWARD
a4d05547 2924Define this macro to nonzero value if the addresses of local variable slots
f62c8a5c 2925are at negative offsets from the frame pointer.
a2c4f8e0 2926@end defmac
feca2ed3 2927
a2c4f8e0 2928@defmac ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD
feca2ed3
JW
2929Define this macro if successive arguments to a function occupy decreasing
2930addresses on the stack.
a2c4f8e0 2931@end defmac
feca2ed3 2932
a2c4f8e0 2933@defmac STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET
feca2ed3
JW
2934Offset from the frame pointer to the first local variable slot to be allocated.
2935
2936If @code{FRAME_GROWS_DOWNWARD}, find the next slot's offset by
2937subtracting the first slot's length from @code{STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET}.
2938Otherwise, it is found by adding the length of the first slot to the
2939value @code{STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET}.
2940@c i'm not sure if the above is still correct.. had to change it to get
2941@c rid of an overfull. --mew 2feb93
a2c4f8e0 2942@end defmac
feca2ed3 2943
a2c4f8e0 2944@defmac STACK_ALIGNMENT_NEEDED
95f3f59e 2945Define to zero to disable final alignment of the stack during reload.
0b4be7de 2946The nonzero default for this macro is suitable for most ports.
95f3f59e 2947
0b4be7de 2948On ports where @code{STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET} is nonzero or where there
95f3f59e
JDA
2949is a register save block following the local block that doesn't require
2950alignment to @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}, it may be beneficial to disable
2951stack alignment and do it in the backend.
a2c4f8e0 2952@end defmac
95f3f59e 2953
a2c4f8e0 2954@defmac STACK_POINTER_OFFSET
feca2ed3
JW
2955Offset from the stack pointer register to the first location at which
2956outgoing arguments are placed. If not specified, the default value of
2957zero is used. This is the proper value for most machines.
2958
2959If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, this is the offset to the location above
2960the first location at which outgoing arguments are placed.
a2c4f8e0 2961@end defmac
feca2ed3 2962
a2c4f8e0 2963@defmac FIRST_PARM_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
feca2ed3
JW
2964Offset from the argument pointer register to the first argument's
2965address. On some machines it may depend on the data type of the
2966function.
2967
2968If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, this is the offset to the location above
2969the first argument's address.
a2c4f8e0 2970@end defmac
feca2ed3 2971
a2c4f8e0 2972@defmac STACK_DYNAMIC_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
feca2ed3
JW
2973Offset from the stack pointer register to an item dynamically allocated
2974on the stack, e.g., by @code{alloca}.
2975
2976The default value for this macro is @code{STACK_POINTER_OFFSET} plus the
2977length of the outgoing arguments. The default is correct for most
2978machines. See @file{function.c} for details.
a2c4f8e0 2979@end defmac
feca2ed3 2980
c6d01079
AK
2981@defmac INITIAL_FRAME_ADDRESS_RTX
2982A C expression whose value is RTL representing the address of the initial
083cad55 2983stack frame. This address is passed to @code{RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and
c8f27794
JW
2984@code{DYNAMIC_CHAIN_ADDRESS}. If you don't define this macro, a reasonable
2985default value will be used. Define this macro in order to make frame pointer
083cad55 2986elimination work in the presence of @code{__builtin_frame_address (count)} and
c8f27794 2987@code{__builtin_return_address (count)} for @code{count} not equal to zero.
c6d01079
AK
2988@end defmac
2989
a2c4f8e0 2990@defmac DYNAMIC_CHAIN_ADDRESS (@var{frameaddr})
feca2ed3
JW
2991A C expression whose value is RTL representing the address in a stack
2992frame where the pointer to the caller's frame is stored. Assume that
2993@var{frameaddr} is an RTL expression for the address of the stack frame
2994itself.
2995
2996If you don't define this macro, the default is to return the value
2997of @var{frameaddr}---that is, the stack frame address is also the
2998address of the stack word that points to the previous frame.
a2c4f8e0 2999@end defmac
feca2ed3 3000
a2c4f8e0 3001@defmac SETUP_FRAME_ADDRESSES
feca2ed3
JW
3002If defined, a C expression that produces the machine-specific code to
3003setup the stack so that arbitrary frames can be accessed. For example,
981f6289 3004on the SPARC, we must flush all of the register windows to the stack
0bc02db4
MS
3005before we can access arbitrary stack frames. You will seldom need to
3006define this macro.
a2c4f8e0 3007@end defmac
0bc02db4 3008
9ddb66ef 3009@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_BUILTIN_SETJMP_FRAME_VALUE (void)
d6da68b9 3010This target hook should return an rtx that is used to store
0bc02db4
MS
3011the address of the current frame into the built in @code{setjmp} buffer.
3012The default value, @code{virtual_stack_vars_rtx}, is correct for most
d6da68b9 3013machines. One reason you may need to define this target hook is if
0bc02db4 3014@code{hard_frame_pointer_rtx} is the appropriate value on your machine.
d6da68b9 3015@end deftypefn
feca2ed3 3016
224869d9
EB
3017@defmac FRAME_ADDR_RTX (@var{frameaddr})
3018A C expression whose value is RTL representing the value of the frame
3019address for the current frame. @var{frameaddr} is the frame pointer
3020of the current frame. This is used for __builtin_frame_address.
3021You need only define this macro if the frame address is not the same
3022as the frame pointer. Most machines do not need to define it.
3023@end defmac
3024
a2c4f8e0 3025@defmac RETURN_ADDR_RTX (@var{count}, @var{frameaddr})
feca2ed3 3026A C expression whose value is RTL representing the value of the return
861bb6c1
JL
3027address for the frame @var{count} steps up from the current frame, after
3028the prologue. @var{frameaddr} is the frame pointer of the @var{count}
3029frame, or the frame pointer of the @var{count} @minus{} 1 frame if
feca2ed3
JW
3030@code{RETURN_ADDR_IN_PREVIOUS_FRAME} is defined.
3031
e9a25f70 3032The value of the expression must always be the correct address when
4830ba1f 3033@var{count} is zero, but may be @code{NULL_RTX} if there is no way to
e9a25f70 3034determine the return address of other frames.
a2c4f8e0 3035@end defmac
e9a25f70 3036
a2c4f8e0 3037@defmac RETURN_ADDR_IN_PREVIOUS_FRAME
feca2ed3
JW
3038Define this if the return address of a particular stack frame is accessed
3039from the frame pointer of the previous stack frame.
a2c4f8e0 3040@end defmac
861bb6c1 3041
a2c4f8e0 3042@defmac INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX
861bb6c1
JL
3043A C expression whose value is RTL representing the location of the
3044incoming return address at the beginning of any function, before the
3045prologue. This RTL is either a @code{REG}, indicating that the return
3046value is saved in @samp{REG}, or a @code{MEM} representing a location in
3047the stack.
3048
3049You only need to define this macro if you want to support call frame
3050debugging information like that provided by DWARF 2.
3051
2c849145 3052If this RTL is a @code{REG}, you should also define
aee96fe9 3053@code{DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN} to @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO)}.
a2c4f8e0 3054@end defmac
2c849145 3055
ed80cd68 3056@defmac DWARF_ALT_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN
73774972 3057A C expression whose value is an integer giving a DWARF 2 column
5cd0f915
RS
3058number that may be used as an alternative return column. The column
3059must not correspond to any gcc hard register (that is, it must not
3060be in the range of @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM}).
3061
3062This macro can be useful if @code{DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN} is set to a
3063general register, but an alternative column needs to be used for signal
3064frames. Some targets have also used different frame return columns
3065over time.
ed80cd68
RH
3066@end defmac
3067
282efe1c
RH
3068@defmac DWARF_ZERO_REG
3069A C expression whose value is an integer giving a DWARF 2 register
3070number that is considered to always have the value zero. This should
3071only be defined if the target has an architected zero register, and
3072someone decided it was a good idea to use that register number to
3073terminate the stack backtrace. New ports should avoid this.
3074@end defmac
3075
e54c7471
EB
3076@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_DWARF_HANDLE_FRAME_UNSPEC (const char *@var{label}, rtx @var{pattern}, int @var{index})
3077This target hook allows the backend to emit frame-related insns that
3078contain UNSPECs or UNSPEC_VOLATILEs. The DWARF 2 call frame debugging
3079info engine will invoke it on insns of the form
3080@smallexample
923158be 3081(set (reg) (unspec [@dots{}] UNSPEC_INDEX))
e54c7471
EB
3082@end smallexample
3083and
3084@smallexample
923158be 3085(set (reg) (unspec_volatile [@dots{}] UNSPECV_INDEX)).
e54c7471
EB
3086@end smallexample
3087to let the backend emit the call frame instructions. @var{label} is
3088the CFI label attached to the insn, @var{pattern} is the pattern of
3089the insn and @var{index} is @code{UNSPEC_INDEX} or @code{UNSPECV_INDEX}.
3090@end deftypefn
3091
a2c4f8e0 3092@defmac INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET
861bb6c1
JL
3093A C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset, in bytes,
3094from the value of the stack pointer register to the top of the stack
3095frame at the beginning of any function, before the prologue. The top of
3096the frame is defined to be the value of the stack pointer in the
3097previous frame, just before the call instruction.
3098
71038426
RH
3099You only need to define this macro if you want to support call frame
3100debugging information like that provided by DWARF 2.
a2c4f8e0 3101@end defmac
71038426 3102
a2c4f8e0 3103@defmac ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
71038426
RH
3104A C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset, in bytes,
3105from the argument pointer to the canonical frame address (cfa). The
02f52e19 3106final value should coincide with that calculated by
71038426
RH
3107@code{INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET}. Which is unfortunately not usable
3108during virtual register instantiation.
3109
d17c29c3
PB
3110The default value for this macro is
3111@code{FIRST_PARM_OFFSET (fundecl) + crtl->args.pretend_args_size},
2c849145 3112which is correct for most machines; in general, the arguments are found
208e52d9
JM
3113immediately before the stack frame. Note that this is not the case on
3114some targets that save registers into the caller's frame, such as SPARC
3115and rs6000, and so such targets need to define this macro.
2c849145 3116
208e52d9 3117You only need to define this macro if the default is incorrect, and you
2c849145
JM
3118want to support call frame debugging information like that provided by
3119DWARF 2.
a2c4f8e0 3120@end defmac
512b62fb 3121
f6672e8e
RH
3122@defmac FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3123If defined, a C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset
3124in bytes from the frame pointer to the canonical frame address (cfa).
6fc0bb99 3125The final value should coincide with that calculated by
f6672e8e
RH
3126@code{INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET}.
3127
3128Normally the CFA is calculated as an offset from the argument pointer,
083cad55 3129via @code{ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET}, but if the argument pointer is
f6672e8e 3130variable due to the ABI, this may not be possible. If this macro is
6416ae7f 3131defined, it implies that the virtual register instantiation should be
f6672e8e
RH
3132based on the frame pointer instead of the argument pointer. Only one
3133of @code{FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET} and @code{ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET}
3134should be defined.
3135@end defmac
3136
35d177a2
AO
3137@defmac CFA_FRAME_BASE_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3138If defined, a C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset
3139in bytes from the canonical frame address (cfa) to the frame base used
3140in DWARF 2 debug information. The default is zero. A different value
3141may reduce the size of debug information on some ports.
3142@end defmac
3143
7c16328b
RH
3144@node Exception Handling
3145@subsection Exception Handling Support
3146@cindex exception handling
3147
a2c4f8e0 3148@defmac EH_RETURN_DATA_REGNO (@var{N})
52a11cbf
RH
3149A C expression whose value is the @var{N}th register number used for
3150data by exception handlers, or @code{INVALID_REGNUM} if fewer than
3151@var{N} registers are usable.
3152
3153The exception handling library routines communicate with the exception
3154handlers via a set of agreed upon registers. Ideally these registers
3155should be call-clobbered; it is possible to use call-saved registers,
3156but may negatively impact code size. The target must support at least
31572 data registers, but should define 4 if there are enough free registers.
3158
3159You must define this macro if you want to support call frame exception
3160handling like that provided by DWARF 2.
a2c4f8e0 3161@end defmac
52a11cbf 3162
a2c4f8e0 3163@defmac EH_RETURN_STACKADJ_RTX
52a11cbf
RH
3164A C expression whose value is RTL representing a location in which
3165to store a stack adjustment to be applied before function return.
3166This is used to unwind the stack to an exception handler's call frame.
3167It will be assigned zero on code paths that return normally.
3168
02f52e19 3169Typically this is a call-clobbered hard register that is otherwise
52a11cbf
RH
3170untouched by the epilogue, but could also be a stack slot.
3171
34dc173c 3172Do not define this macro if the stack pointer is saved and restored
73774972
EC
3173by the regular prolog and epilog code in the call frame itself; in
3174this case, the exception handling library routines will update the
3175stack location to be restored in place. Otherwise, you must define
3176this macro if you want to support call frame exception handling like
34dc173c 3177that provided by DWARF 2.
a2c4f8e0 3178@end defmac
52a11cbf 3179
a2c4f8e0 3180@defmac EH_RETURN_HANDLER_RTX
52a11cbf 3181A C expression whose value is RTL representing a location in which
02f52e19 3182to store the address of an exception handler to which we should
52a11cbf
RH
3183return. It will not be assigned on code paths that return normally.
3184
3185Typically this is the location in the call frame at which the normal
02f52e19
AJ
3186return address is stored. For targets that return by popping an
3187address off the stack, this might be a memory address just below
52a11cbf 3188the @emph{target} call frame rather than inside the current call
73774972
EC
3189frame. If defined, @code{EH_RETURN_STACKADJ_RTX} will have already
3190been assigned, so it may be used to calculate the location of the
34dc173c 3191target call frame.
52a11cbf
RH
3192
3193Some targets have more complex requirements than storing to an
3194address calculable during initial code generation. In that case
3195the @code{eh_return} instruction pattern should be used instead.
3196
3197If you want to support call frame exception handling, you must
3198define either this macro or the @code{eh_return} instruction pattern.
a2c4f8e0 3199@end defmac
52a11cbf 3200
1e60c057
R
3201@defmac RETURN_ADDR_OFFSET
3202If defined, an integer-valued C expression for which rtl will be generated
3203to add it to the exception handler address before it is searched in the
3204exception handling tables, and to subtract it again from the address before
3205using it to return to the exception handler.
3206@end defmac
3207
a2c4f8e0 3208@defmac ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (@var{code}, @var{global})
2a1ee410
RH
3209This macro chooses the encoding of pointers embedded in the exception
3210handling sections. If at all possible, this should be defined such
3211that the exception handling section will not require dynamic relocations,
3212and so may be read-only.
3213
aee96fe9
JM
3214@var{code} is 0 for data, 1 for code labels, 2 for function pointers.
3215@var{global} is true if the symbol may be affected by dynamic relocations.
2a1ee410
RH
3216The macro should return a combination of the @code{DW_EH_PE_*} defines
3217as found in @file{dwarf2.h}.
3218
ebb48a4d 3219If this macro is not defined, pointers will not be encoded but
2a1ee410 3220represented directly.
a2c4f8e0 3221@end defmac
2a1ee410 3222
a2c4f8e0 3223@defmac ASM_MAYBE_OUTPUT_ENCODED_ADDR_RTX (@var{file}, @var{encoding}, @var{size}, @var{addr}, @var{done})
2a1ee410
RH
3224This macro allows the target to emit whatever special magic is required
3225to represent the encoding chosen by @code{ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT}.
3226Generic code takes care of pc-relative and indirect encodings; this must
3227be defined if the target uses text-relative or data-relative encodings.
3228
aee96fe9
JM
3229This is a C statement that branches to @var{done} if the format was
3230handled. @var{encoding} is the format chosen, @var{size} is the number
3231of bytes that the format occupies, @var{addr} is the @code{SYMBOL_REF}
2a1ee410 3232to be emitted.
a2c4f8e0 3233@end defmac
2a1ee410 3234
8662eb14 3235@defmac MD_FALLBACK_FRAME_STATE_FOR (@var{context}, @var{fs})
44082375 3236This macro allows the target to add CPU and operating system specific
7c16328b
RH
3237code to the call-frame unwinder for use when there is no unwind data
3238available. The most common reason to implement this macro is to unwind
3239through signal frames.
3240
614e5a7d
BE
3241This macro is called from @code{uw_frame_state_for} in
3242@file{unwind-dw2.c}, @file{unwind-dw2-xtensa.c} and
3243@file{unwind-ia64.c}. @var{context} is an @code{_Unwind_Context};
7c16328b
RH
3244@var{fs} is an @code{_Unwind_FrameState}. Examine @code{context->ra}
3245for the address of the code being executed and @code{context->cfa} for
614e5a7d
BE
3246the stack pointer value. If the frame can be decoded, the register
3247save addresses should be updated in @var{fs} and the macro should
3248evaluate to @code{_URC_NO_REASON}. If the frame cannot be decoded,
3249the macro should evaluate to @code{_URC_END_OF_STACK}.
8207b189
FS
3250
3251For proper signal handling in Java this macro is accompanied by
3252@code{MAKE_THROW_FRAME}, defined in @file{libjava/include/*-signal.h} headers.
a2c4f8e0 3253@end defmac
861bb6c1 3254
3950dcdf
JJ
3255@defmac MD_HANDLE_UNWABI (@var{context}, @var{fs})
3256This macro allows the target to add operating system specific code to the
3257call-frame unwinder to handle the IA-64 @code{.unwabi} unwinding directive,
3258usually used for signal or interrupt frames.
3259
0c93ed52
SB
3260This macro is called from @code{uw_update_context} in libgcc's
3261@file{unwind-ia64.c}. @var{context} is an @code{_Unwind_Context};
3950dcdf
JJ
3262@var{fs} is an @code{_Unwind_FrameState}. Examine @code{fs->unwabi}
3263for the abi and context in the @code{.unwabi} directive. If the
3264@code{.unwabi} directive can be handled, the register save addresses should
3265be updated in @var{fs}.
3266@end defmac
3267
4746cf84
MA
3268@defmac TARGET_USES_WEAK_UNWIND_INFO
3269A C expression that evaluates to true if the target requires unwind
3270info to be given comdat linkage. Define it to be @code{1} if comdat
3271linkage is necessary. The default is @code{0}.
3272@end defmac
3273
861bb6c1
JL
3274@node Stack Checking
3275@subsection Specifying How Stack Checking is Done
3276
b38f3813
EB
3277GCC will check that stack references are within the boundaries of the
3278stack, if the option @option{-fstack-check} is specified, in one of
3279three ways:
861bb6c1
JL
3280
3281@enumerate
3282@item
a3a15b4d 3283If the value of the @code{STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN} macro is nonzero, GCC
b38f3813
EB
3284will assume that you have arranged for full stack checking to be done
3285at appropriate places in the configuration files. GCC will not do
3286other special processing.
861bb6c1
JL
3287
3288@item
b38f3813
EB
3289If @code{STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN} is zero and the value of the
3290@code{STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN} macro is nonzero, GCC will assume
3291that you have arranged for static stack checking (checking of the
3292static stack frame of functions) to be done at appropriate places
3293in the configuration files. GCC will only emit code to do dynamic
3294stack checking (checking on dynamic stack allocations) using the third
3295approach below.
861bb6c1
JL
3296
3297@item
a3a15b4d 3298If neither of the above are true, GCC will generate code to periodically
861bb6c1
JL
3299``probe'' the stack pointer using the values of the macros defined below.
3300@end enumerate
3301
b38f3813
EB
3302If neither STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN nor STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN is defined,
3303GCC will change its allocation strategy for large objects if the option
3304@option{-fstack-check} is specified: they will always be allocated
3305dynamically if their size exceeds @code{STACK_CHECK_MAX_VAR_SIZE} bytes.
861bb6c1 3306
a2c4f8e0 3307@defmac STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN
861bb6c1 3308A nonzero value if stack checking is done by the configuration files in a
02f52e19 3309machine-dependent manner. You should define this macro if stack checking
65a324b4 3310is required by the ABI of your machine or if you would like to do stack
b38f3813
EB
3311checking in some more efficient way than the generic approach. The default
3312value of this macro is zero.
3313@end defmac
3314
3315@defmac STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN
3316A nonzero value if static stack checking is done by the configuration files
3317in a machine-dependent manner. You should define this macro if you would
3318like to do static stack checking in some more efficient way than the generic
3319approach. The default value of this macro is zero.
a2c4f8e0 3320@end defmac
861bb6c1 3321
d809253a
EB
3322@defmac STACK_CHECK_PROBE_INTERVAL_EXP
3323An integer specifying the interval at which GCC must generate stack probe
3324instructions, defined as 2 raised to this integer. You will normally
3325define this macro so that the interval be no larger than the size of
3326the ``guard pages'' at the end of a stack area. The default value
3327of 12 (4096-byte interval) is suitable for most systems.
a2c4f8e0 3328@end defmac
861bb6c1 3329
d809253a
EB
3330@defmac STACK_CHECK_MOVING_SP
3331An integer which is nonzero if GCC should move the stack pointer page by page
3332when doing probes. This can be necessary on systems where the stack pointer
3333contains the bottom address of the memory area accessible to the executing
3334thread at any point in time. In this situation an alternate signal stack
3335is required in order to be able to recover from a stack overflow. The
3336default value of this macro is zero.
3337@end defmac
3338
a2c4f8e0 3339@defmac STACK_CHECK_PROTECT
507d0069
EB
3340The number of bytes of stack needed to recover from a stack overflow, for
3341languages where such a recovery is supported. The default value of 75 words
3342with the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based exception handling mechanism and
33438192 bytes with other exception handling mechanisms should be adequate for
3344most machines.
a2c4f8e0 3345@end defmac
861bb6c1 3346
b38f3813
EB
3347The following macros are relevant only if neither STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN
3348nor STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN is defined; you can omit them altogether
3349in the opposite case.
3350
a2c4f8e0 3351@defmac STACK_CHECK_MAX_FRAME_SIZE
a3a15b4d 3352The maximum size of a stack frame, in bytes. GCC will generate probe
861bb6c1
JL
3353instructions in non-leaf functions to ensure at least this many bytes of
3354stack are available. If a stack frame is larger than this size, stack
a3a15b4d
JL
3355checking will not be reliable and GCC will issue a warning. The
3356default is chosen so that GCC only generates one instruction on most
861bb6c1 3357systems. You should normally not change the default value of this macro.
a2c4f8e0 3358@end defmac
861bb6c1 3359
a2c4f8e0 3360@defmac STACK_CHECK_FIXED_FRAME_SIZE
a3a15b4d 3361GCC uses this value to generate the above warning message. It
861bb6c1
JL
3362represents the amount of fixed frame used by a function, not including
3363space for any callee-saved registers, temporaries and user variables.
3364You need only specify an upper bound for this amount and will normally
3365use the default of four words.
a2c4f8e0 3366@end defmac
861bb6c1 3367
a2c4f8e0 3368@defmac STACK_CHECK_MAX_VAR_SIZE
a3a15b4d 3369The maximum size, in bytes, of an object that GCC will place in the
861bb6c1 3370fixed area of the stack frame when the user specifies
630d3d5a 3371@option{-fstack-check}.
a3a15b4d 3372GCC computed the default from the values of the above macros and you will
861bb6c1 3373normally not need to override that default.
a2c4f8e0 3374@end defmac
feca2ed3
JW
3375
3376@need 2000
3377@node Frame Registers
3378@subsection Registers That Address the Stack Frame
3379
3380@c prevent bad page break with this line
3381This discusses registers that address the stack frame.
3382
a2c4f8e0 3383@defmac STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
feca2ed3
JW
3384The register number of the stack pointer register, which must also be a
3385fixed register according to @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}. On most machines,
3386the hardware determines which register this is.
a2c4f8e0 3387@end defmac
feca2ed3 3388
a2c4f8e0 3389@defmac FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
feca2ed3
JW
3390The register number of the frame pointer register, which is used to
3391access automatic variables in the stack frame. On some machines, the
3392hardware determines which register this is. On other machines, you can
3393choose any register you wish for this purpose.
a2c4f8e0 3394@end defmac
feca2ed3 3395
a2c4f8e0 3396@defmac HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
feca2ed3
JW
3397On some machines the offset between the frame pointer and starting
3398offset of the automatic variables is not known until after register
3399allocation has been done (for example, because the saved registers are
3400between these two locations). On those machines, define
3401@code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} the number of a special, fixed register to
3402be used internally until the offset is known, and define
556e0f21 3403@code{HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} to be the actual hard register number
feca2ed3
JW
3404used for the frame pointer.
3405
3406You should define this macro only in the very rare circumstances when it
3407is not possible to calculate the offset between the frame pointer and
3408the automatic variables until after register allocation has been
3409completed. When this macro is defined, you must also indicate in your
3410definition of @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} how to eliminate
3411@code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} into either @code{HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM}
3412or @code{STACK_POINTER_REGNUM}.
3413
3414Do not define this macro if it would be the same as
3415@code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM}.
a2c4f8e0 3416@end defmac
feca2ed3 3417
a2c4f8e0 3418@defmac ARG_POINTER_REGNUM
feca2ed3
JW
3419The register number of the arg pointer register, which is used to access
3420the function's argument list. On some machines, this is the same as the
3421frame pointer register. On some machines, the hardware determines which
3422register this is. On other machines, you can choose any register you
3423wish for this purpose. If this is not the same register as the frame
3424pointer register, then you must mark it as a fixed register according to
3425@code{FIXED_REGISTERS}, or arrange to be able to eliminate it
3426(@pxref{Elimination}).
a2c4f8e0 3427@end defmac
feca2ed3 3428
e3339d0f
JM
3429@defmac HARD_FRAME_POINTER_IS_FRAME_POINTER
3430Define this to a preprocessor constant that is nonzero if
3431@code{hard_frame_pointer_rtx} and @code{frame_pointer_rtx} should be
3432the same. The default definition is @samp{(HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3433== FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM)}; you only need to define this macro if that
3434definition is not suitable for use in preprocessor conditionals.
3435@end defmac
3436
3437@defmac HARD_FRAME_POINTER_IS_ARG_POINTER
3438Define this to a preprocessor constant that is nonzero if
3439@code{hard_frame_pointer_rtx} and @code{arg_pointer_rtx} should be the
3440same. The default definition is @samp{(HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM ==
3441ARG_POINTER_REGNUM)}; you only need to define this macro if that
3442definition is not suitable for use in preprocessor conditionals.
3443@end defmac
3444
a2c4f8e0 3445@defmac RETURN_ADDRESS_POINTER_REGNUM
feca2ed3
JW
3446The register number of the return address pointer register, which is used to
3447access the current function's return address from the stack. On some
3448machines, the return address is not at a fixed offset from the frame
3449pointer or stack pointer or argument pointer. This register can be defined
3450to point to the return address on the stack, and then be converted by
3451@code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} into either the frame pointer or stack pointer.
3452
3453Do not define this macro unless there is no other way to get the return
3454address from the stack.
a2c4f8e0 3455@end defmac
feca2ed3 3456
a2c4f8e0
ZW
3457@defmac STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM
3458@defmacx STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM
feca2ed3
JW
3459Register numbers used for passing a function's static chain pointer. If
3460register windows are used, the register number as seen by the called
3461function is @code{STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM}, while the register
3462number as seen by the calling function is @code{STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM}. If
3463these registers are the same, @code{STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM} need
bd819a4a 3464not be defined.
feca2ed3
JW
3465
3466The static chain register need not be a fixed register.
3467
3468If the static chain is passed in memory, these macros should not be
2b4fa409 3469defined; instead, the @code{TARGET_STATIC_CHAIN} hook should be used.
a2c4f8e0 3470@end defmac
919543ab 3471
531ca746
RH
3472@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_STATIC_CHAIN (const_tree @var{fndecl}, bool @var{incoming_p})
3473This hook replaces the use of @code{STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM} et al for
3474targets that may use different static chain locations for different
3475nested functions. This may be required if the target has function
3476attributes that affect the calling conventions of the function and
3477those calling conventions use different static chain locations.
3478
3479The default version of this hook uses @code{STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM} et al.
2b4fa409
RH
3480
3481If the static chain is passed in memory, this hook should be used to
3482provide rtx giving @code{mem} expressions that denote where they are stored.
3483Often the @code{mem} expression as seen by the caller will be at an offset
3484from the stack pointer and the @code{mem} expression as seen by the callee
3485will be at an offset from the frame pointer.
3486@findex stack_pointer_rtx
3487@findex frame_pointer_rtx
3488@findex arg_pointer_rtx
3489The variables @code{stack_pointer_rtx}, @code{frame_pointer_rtx}, and
3490@code{arg_pointer_rtx} will have been initialized and should be used
3491to refer to those items.
531ca746
RH
3492@end deftypefn
3493
a2c4f8e0 3494@defmac DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS
919543ab
AH
3495This macro specifies the maximum number of hard registers that can be
3496saved in a call frame. This is used to size data structures used in
3497DWARF2 exception handling.
3498
3499Prior to GCC 3.0, this macro was needed in order to establish a stable
3500exception handling ABI in the face of adding new hard registers for ISA
3501extensions. In GCC 3.0 and later, the EH ABI is insulated from changes
3502in the number of hard registers. Nevertheless, this macro can still be
3503used to reduce the runtime memory requirements of the exception handling
3504routines, which can be substantial if the ISA contains a lot of
3505registers that are not call-saved.
3506
3507If this macro is not defined, it defaults to
3508@code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER}.
a2c4f8e0 3509@end defmac
919543ab 3510
a2c4f8e0 3511@defmac PRE_GCC3_DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS
919543ab
AH
3512
3513This macro is similar to @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS}, but is provided
3514for backward compatibility in pre GCC 3.0 compiled code.
3515
3516If this macro is not defined, it defaults to
3517@code{DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS}.
a2c4f8e0 3518@end defmac
919543ab 3519
a2c4f8e0 3520@defmac DWARF_REG_TO_UNWIND_COLUMN (@var{regno})
41f3a930
AH
3521
3522Define this macro if the target's representation for dwarf registers
3523is different than the internal representation for unwind column.
61aeb06f 3524Given a dwarf register, this macro should return the internal unwind
41f3a930
AH
3525column number to use instead.
3526
73774972 3527See the PowerPC's SPE target for an example.
a2c4f8e0 3528@end defmac
feca2ed3 3529
34c80057
AM
3530@defmac DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (@var{regno})
3531
3532Define this macro if the target's representation for dwarf registers
3533used in .eh_frame or .debug_frame is different from that used in other
2dd76960 3534debug info sections. Given a GCC hard register number, this macro
34c80057
AM
3535should return the .eh_frame register number. The default is
3536@code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (@var{regno})}.
3537
3538@end defmac
3539
3540@defmac DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (@var{regno}, @var{for_eh})
3541
3542Define this macro to map register numbers held in the call frame info
2dd76960 3543that GCC has collected using @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM} to those that
34c80057 3544should be output in .debug_frame (@code{@var{for_eh}} is zero) and
f676971a 3545.eh_frame (@code{@var{for_eh}} is nonzero). The default is to
34c80057
AM
3546return @code{@var{regno}}.
3547
3548@end defmac
3549
cca2207a
L
3550@defmac REG_VALUE_IN_UNWIND_CONTEXT
3551
3552Define this macro if the target stores register values as
3553@code{_Unwind_Word} type in unwind context. It should be defined if
3554target register size is larger than the size of @code{void *}. The
3555default is to store register values as @code{void *} type.
3556
3557@end defmac
3558
3559@defmac ASSUME_EXTENDED_UNWIND_CONTEXT
3560
3561Define this macro to be 1 if the target always uses extended unwind
3562context with version, args_size and by_value fields. If it is undefined,
3563it will be defined to 1 when @code{REG_VALUE_IN_UNWIND_CONTEXT} is
3564defined and 0 otherwise.
3565
3566@end defmac
3567
feca2ed3
JW
3568@node Elimination
3569@subsection Eliminating Frame Pointer and Arg Pointer
3570
3571@c prevent bad page break with this line
3572This is about eliminating the frame pointer and arg pointer.
3573
b52b1749
AS
3574@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED (void)
3575This target hook should return @code{true} if a function must have and use
3576a frame pointer. This target hook is called in the reload pass. If its return
3577value is @code{true} the function will have a frame pointer.
feca2ed3 3578
b52b1749 3579This target hook can in principle examine the current function and decide
aea88c05
AS
3580according to the facts, but on most machines the constant @code{false} or the
3581constant @code{true} suffices. Use @code{false} when the machine allows code
3582to be generated with no frame pointer, and doing so saves some time or space.
3583Use @code{true} when there is no possible advantage to avoiding a frame
3584pointer.
feca2ed3
JW
3585
3586In certain cases, the compiler does not know how to produce valid code
3587without a frame pointer. The compiler recognizes those cases and
3588automatically gives the function a frame pointer regardless of what
b52b1749 3589@code{TARGET_FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED} returns. You don't need to worry about
bd819a4a 3590them.
feca2ed3
JW
3591
3592In a function that does not require a frame pointer, the frame pointer
3593register can be allocated for ordinary usage, unless you mark it as a
3594fixed register. See @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} for more information.
aea88c05 3595
b52b1749
AS
3596Default return value is @code{false}.
3597@end deftypefn
feca2ed3 3598
feca2ed3 3599@findex get_frame_size
a2c4f8e0 3600@defmac INITIAL_FRAME_POINTER_OFFSET (@var{depth-var})
feca2ed3
JW
3601A C statement to store in the variable @var{depth-var} the difference
3602between the frame pointer and the stack pointer values immediately after
3603the function prologue. The value would be computed from information
3604such as the result of @code{get_frame_size ()} and the tables of
3605registers @code{regs_ever_live} and @code{call_used_regs}.
3606
3607If @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} is defined, this macro will be not be used and
3608need not be defined. Otherwise, it must be defined even if
65a324b4 3609@code{TARGET_FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED} always returns true; in that
feca2ed3 3610case, you may set @var{depth-var} to anything.
a2c4f8e0 3611@end defmac
feca2ed3 3612
a2c4f8e0 3613@defmac ELIMINABLE_REGS
feca2ed3
JW
3614If defined, this macro specifies a table of register pairs used to
3615eliminate unneeded registers that point into the stack frame. If it is not
3616defined, the only elimination attempted by the compiler is to replace
3617references to the frame pointer with references to the stack pointer.
3618
3619The definition of this macro is a list of structure initializations, each
3620of which specifies an original and replacement register.
3621
3622On some machines, the position of the argument pointer is not known until
3623the compilation is completed. In such a case, a separate hard register
3624must be used for the argument pointer. This register can be eliminated by
3625replacing it with either the frame pointer or the argument pointer,
3626depending on whether or not the frame pointer has been eliminated.
3627
3628In this case, you might specify:
3ab51846 3629@smallexample
feca2ed3
JW
3630#define ELIMINABLE_REGS \
3631@{@{ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM@}, \
3632 @{ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM@}, \
3633 @{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM@}@}
3ab51846 3634@end smallexample
feca2ed3
JW
3635
3636Note that the elimination of the argument pointer with the stack pointer is
3637specified first since that is the preferred elimination.
a2c4f8e0 3638@end defmac
feca2ed3 3639
9ddb66ef 3640@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CAN_ELIMINATE (const int @var{from_reg}, const int @var{to_reg})
7b5cbb57 3641This target hook should returns @code{true} if the compiler is allowed to
9ddb66ef
JR
3642try to replace register number @var{from_reg} with register number
3643@var{to_reg}. This target hook need only be defined if @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS}
3be639f7 3644is defined, and will usually be @code{true}, since most of the cases
feca2ed3
JW
3645preventing register elimination are things that the compiler already
3646knows about.
3be639f7 3647
7b5cbb57
AS
3648Default return value is @code{true}.
3649@end deftypefn
feca2ed3 3650
a2c4f8e0 3651@defmac INITIAL_ELIMINATION_OFFSET (@var{from-reg}, @var{to-reg}, @var{offset-var})
feca2ed3
JW
3652This macro is similar to @code{INITIAL_FRAME_POINTER_OFFSET}. It
3653specifies the initial difference between the specified pair of
3654registers. This macro must be defined if @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} is
3655defined.
a2c4f8e0 3656@end defmac
feca2ed3
JW
3657
3658@node Stack Arguments
3659@subsection Passing Function Arguments on the Stack
3660@cindex arguments on stack
3661@cindex stack arguments
3662
3663The macros in this section control how arguments are passed
3664on the stack. See the following section for other macros that
3665control passing certain arguments in registers.
3666
9ddb66ef 3667@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_PROMOTE_PROTOTYPES (const_tree @var{fntype})
61f71b34
DD
3668This target hook returns @code{true} if an argument declared in a
3669prototype as an integral type smaller than @code{int} should actually be
3670passed as an @code{int}. In addition to avoiding errors in certain
3671cases of mismatch, it also makes for better code on certain machines.
3672The default is to not promote prototypes.
3673@end deftypefn
feca2ed3 3674
a2c4f8e0 3675@defmac PUSH_ARGS
767094dd 3676A C expression. If nonzero, push insns will be used to pass
f73ad30e
JH
3677outgoing arguments.
3678If the target machine does not have a push instruction, set it to zero.
3679That directs GCC to use an alternate strategy: to
3680allocate the entire argument block and then store the arguments into
aee96fe9 3681it. When @code{PUSH_ARGS} is nonzero, @code{PUSH_ROUNDING} must be defined too.
a2c4f8e0 3682@end defmac
f73ad30e 3683
9d6bef95
JM
3684@defmac PUSH_ARGS_REVERSED
3685A C expression. If nonzero, function arguments will be evaluated from
3686last to first, rather than from first to last. If this macro is not
3687defined, it defaults to @code{PUSH_ARGS} on targets where the stack
3688and args grow in opposite directions, and 0 otherwise.
3689@end defmac
3690
a2c4f8e0 3691@defmac PUSH_ROUNDING (@var{npushed})
feca2ed3
JW
3692A C expression that is the number of bytes actually pushed onto the
3693stack when an instruction attempts to push @var{npushed} bytes.
feca2ed3
JW
3694
3695On some machines, the definition
3696
3ab51846 3697@smallexample
feca2ed3 3698#define PUSH_ROUNDING(BYTES) (BYTES)
3ab51846 3699@end smallexample
feca2ed3
JW
3700
3701@noindent
3702will suffice. But on other machines, instructions that appear
3703to push one byte actually push two bytes in an attempt to maintain
3704alignment. Then the definition should be
3705
3ab51846 3706@smallexample
feca2ed3 3707#define PUSH_ROUNDING(BYTES) (((BYTES) + 1) & ~1)
3ab51846 3708@end smallexample
4a6336ad 3709
64ad7c99 3710If the value of this macro has a type, it should be an unsigned type.
a2c4f8e0 3711@end defmac
feca2ed3 3712
29454ff5
SL
3713@findex outgoing_args_size
3714@findex crtl->outgoing_args_size
a2c4f8e0 3715@defmac ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS
767094dd 3716A C expression. If nonzero, the maximum amount of space required for outgoing arguments
29454ff5
SL
3717will be computed and placed into
3718@code{crtl->outgoing_args_size}. No space will be pushed
feca2ed3
JW
3719onto the stack for each call; instead, the function prologue should
3720increase the stack frame size by this amount.
3721
f73ad30e 3722Setting both @code{PUSH_ARGS} and @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS}
feca2ed3 3723is not proper.
a2c4f8e0 3724@end defmac
feca2ed3 3725
a2c4f8e0 3726@defmac REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE (@var{fndecl})
feca2ed3
JW
3727Define this macro if functions should assume that stack space has been
3728allocated for arguments even when their values are passed in
3729registers.
3730
3731The value of this macro is the size, in bytes, of the area reserved for
ab87f8c8 3732arguments passed in registers for the function represented by @var{fndecl},
a3a15b4d 3733which can be zero if GCC is calling a library function.
5d059ed9
KT
3734The argument @var{fndecl} can be the FUNCTION_DECL, or the type itself
3735of the function.
feca2ed3
JW
3736
3737This space can be allocated by the caller, or be a part of the
3738machine-dependent stack frame: @code{OUTGOING_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} says
3739which.
a2c4f8e0 3740@end defmac
feca2ed3
JW
3741@c above is overfull. not sure what to do. --mew 5feb93 did
3742@c something, not sure if it looks good. --mew 10feb93
3743
ddbb449f
AM
3744@defmac INCOMING_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE (@var{fndecl})
3745Like @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE}, but for incoming register arguments.
3746Define this macro if space guaranteed when compiling a function body
3747is different to space required when making a call, a situation that
3748can arise with K&R style function definitions.
3749@end defmac
3750
81464b2c
KT
3751@defmac OUTGOING_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE (@var{fntype})
3752Define this to a nonzero value if it is the responsibility of the
3753caller to allocate the area reserved for arguments passed in registers
3754when calling a function of @var{fntype}. @var{fntype} may be NULL
3755if the function called is a library function.
feca2ed3
JW
3756
3757If @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} is defined, this macro controls
3758whether the space for these arguments counts in the value of
29454ff5 3759@code{crtl->outgoing_args_size}.
a2c4f8e0 3760@end defmac
feca2ed3 3761
a2c4f8e0 3762@defmac STACK_PARMS_IN_REG_PARM_AREA
feca2ed3
JW
3763Define this macro if @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} is defined, but the
3764stack parameters don't skip the area specified by it.
3765@c i changed this, makes more sens and it should have taken care of the
3766@c overfull.. not as specific, tho. --mew 5feb93
3767
3768Normally, when a parameter is not passed in registers, it is placed on the
3769stack beyond the @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} area. Defining this macro
3770suppresses this behavior and causes the parameter to be passed on the
3771stack in its natural location.
a2c4f8e0 3772@end defmac
feca2ed3 3773
893d13d5 3774@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_RETURN_POPS_ARGS (tree @var{fundecl}, tree @var{funtype}, int @var{size})
079e7538
NF
3775This target hook returns the number of bytes of its own arguments that
3776a function pops on returning, or 0 if the function pops no arguments
3777and the caller must therefore pop them all after the function returns.
feca2ed3
JW
3778
3779@var{fundecl} is a C variable whose value is a tree node that describes
3780the function in question. Normally it is a node of type
3781@code{FUNCTION_DECL} that describes the declaration of the function.
91d231cb 3782From this you can obtain the @code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES} of the function.
feca2ed3
JW
3783
3784@var{funtype} is a C variable whose value is a tree node that
3785describes the function in question. Normally it is a node of type
3786@code{FUNCTION_TYPE} that describes the data type of the function.
3787From this it is possible to obtain the data types of the value and
3788arguments (if known).
3789
861bb6c1 3790When a call to a library function is being considered, @var{fundecl}
feca2ed3
JW
3791will contain an identifier node for the library function. Thus, if
3792you need to distinguish among various library functions, you can do so
3793by their names. Note that ``library function'' in this context means
3794a function used to perform arithmetic, whose name is known specially
3795in the compiler and was not mentioned in the C code being compiled.
3796
893d13d5 3797@var{size} is the number of bytes of arguments passed on the
feca2ed3
JW
3798stack. If a variable number of bytes is passed, it is zero, and
3799argument popping will always be the responsibility of the calling function.
3800
8aeea6e6 3801On the VAX, all functions always pop their arguments, so the definition
893d13d5 3802of this macro is @var{size}. On the 68000, using the standard
feca2ed3
JW
3803calling convention, no functions pop their arguments, so the value of
3804the macro is always 0 in this case. But an alternative calling
3805convention is available in which functions that take a fixed number of
3806arguments pop them but other functions (such as @code{printf}) pop
3807nothing (the caller pops all). When this convention is in use,
3808@var{funtype} is examined to determine whether a function takes a fixed
3809number of arguments.
079e7538 3810@end deftypefn
fa5322fa 3811
a2c4f8e0 3812@defmac CALL_POPS_ARGS (@var{cum})
fa5322fa
AO
3813A C expression that should indicate the number of bytes a call sequence
3814pops off the stack. It is added to the value of @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS}
3815when compiling a function call.
3816
3817@var{cum} is the variable in which all arguments to the called function
3818have been accumulated.
3819
3820On certain architectures, such as the SH5, a call trampoline is used
3821that pops certain registers off the stack, depending on the arguments
3822that have been passed to the function. Since this is a property of the
3823call site, not of the called function, @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS} is not
3824appropriate.
a2c4f8e0 3825@end defmac
feca2ed3
JW
3826
3827@node Register Arguments
3828@subsection Passing Arguments in Registers
3829@cindex arguments in registers
3830@cindex registers arguments
3831
3832This section describes the macros which let you control how various
3833types of arguments are passed in registers or how they are arranged in
3834the stack.
3835
d5cc9181 3836@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG (cumulative_args_t @var{ca}, enum machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type}, bool @var{named})
b25b9e8f
NF
3837Return an RTX indicating whether a function argument is passed in a
3838register and if so, which register.
feca2ed3 3839
b25b9e8f 3840The arguments are @var{ca}, which summarizes all the previous
feca2ed3
JW
3841arguments; @var{mode}, the machine mode of the argument; @var{type},
3842the data type of the argument as a tree node or 0 if that is not known
3843(which happens for C support library functions); and @var{named},
b25b9e8f
NF
3844which is @code{true} for an ordinary argument and @code{false} for
3845nameless arguments that correspond to @samp{@dots{}} in the called
3846function's prototype. @var{type} can be an incomplete type if a
3847syntax error has previously occurred.
feca2ed3 3848
b25b9e8f
NF
3849The return value is usually either a @code{reg} RTX for the hard
3850register in which to pass the argument, or zero to pass the argument
3851on the stack.
feca2ed3 3852
161d7b59 3853The value of the expression can also be a @code{parallel} RTX@. This is
feca2ed3 3854used when an argument is passed in multiple locations. The mode of the
ce376beb 3855@code{parallel} should be the mode of the entire argument. The
feca2ed3 3856@code{parallel} holds any number of @code{expr_list} pairs; each one
f797c10b
NC
3857describes where part of the argument is passed. In each
3858@code{expr_list} the first operand must be a @code{reg} RTX for the hard
3859register in which to pass this part of the argument, and the mode of the
3860register RTX indicates how large this part of the argument is. The
3861second operand of the @code{expr_list} is a @code{const_int} which gives
3862the offset in bytes into the entire argument of where this part starts.
02f52e19 3863As a special exception the first @code{expr_list} in the @code{parallel}
c980b85b
NC
3864RTX may have a first operand of zero. This indicates that the entire
3865argument is also stored on the stack.
feca2ed3 3866
b25b9e8f 3867The last time this hook is called, it is called with @code{MODE ==
1cc5e432
GK
3868VOIDmode}, and its result is passed to the @code{call} or @code{call_value}
3869pattern as operands 2 and 3 respectively.
3870
feca2ed3 3871@cindex @file{stdarg.h} and register arguments
b25b9e8f
NF
3872The usual way to make the ISO library @file{stdarg.h} work on a
3873machine where some arguments are usually passed in registers, is to
3874cause nameless arguments to be passed on the stack instead. This is
3875done by making @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} return 0 whenever
3876@var{named} is @code{false}.
3877
3878@cindex @code{TARGET_MUST_PASS_IN_STACK}, and @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG}
3879@cindex @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE}, and @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG}
fe984136 3880You may use the hook @code{targetm.calls.must_pass_in_stack}
feca2ed3
JW
3881in the definition of this macro to determine if this argument is of a
3882type that must be passed in the stack. If @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE}
b25b9e8f 3883is not defined and @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} returns nonzero for such an
feca2ed3
JW
3884argument, the compiler will abort. If @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} is
3885defined, the argument will be computed in the stack and then loaded into
3886a register.
b25b9e8f 3887@end deftypefn
feca2ed3 3888
9ddb66ef 3889@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_MUST_PASS_IN_STACK (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type})
fe984136
RH
3890This target hook should return @code{true} if we should not pass @var{type}
3891solely in registers. The file @file{expr.h} defines a
d9a4ee00
JL
3892definition that is usually appropriate, refer to @file{expr.h} for additional
3893documentation.
fe984136 3894@end deftypefn
d9a4ee00 3895
d5cc9181 3896@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG (cumulative_args_t @var{ca}, enum machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type}, bool @var{named})
b25b9e8f 3897Define this hook if the target machine has ``register windows'', so
feca2ed3
JW
3898that the register in which a function sees an arguments is not
3899necessarily the same as the one in which the caller passed the
3900argument.
3901
b25b9e8f
NF
3902For such machines, @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} computes the register in
3903which the caller passes the value, and
3904@code{TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG} should be defined in a similar
3905fashion to tell the function being called where the arguments will
3906arrive.
feca2ed3 3907
b25b9e8f
NF
3908If @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG} is not defined,
3909@code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} serves both purposes.
3910@end deftypefn
feca2ed3 3911
d5cc9181 3912@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ARG_PARTIAL_BYTES (cumulative_args_t @var{cum}, enum machine_mode @var{mode}, tree @var{type}, bool @var{named})
78a52f11
RH
3913This target hook returns the number of bytes at the beginning of an
3914argument that must be put in registers. The value must be zero for
feca2ed3
JW
3915arguments that are passed entirely in registers or that are entirely
3916pushed on the stack.
3917
3918On some machines, certain arguments must be passed partially in
3919registers and partially in memory. On these machines, typically the
78a52f11 3920first few words of arguments are passed in registers, and the rest
feca2ed3
JW
3921on the stack. If a multi-word argument (a @code{double} or a
3922structure) crosses that boundary, its first few words must be passed
3923in registers and the rest must be pushed. This macro tells the
78a52f11 3924compiler when this occurs, and how many bytes should go in registers.
feca2ed3 3925
b25b9e8f 3926@code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} for these arguments should return the first
feca2ed3 3927register to be used by the caller for this argument; likewise
b25b9e8f 3928@code{TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG}, for the called function.
78a52f11 3929@end deftypefn
feca2ed3 3930
d5cc9181 3931@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_PASS_BY_REFERENCE (cumulative_args_t @var{cum}, enum machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type}, bool @var{named})
f676971a 3932This target hook should return @code{true} if an argument at the
8cd5a4e0 3933position indicated by @var{cum} should be passed by reference. This
f676971a 3934predicate is queried after target independent reasons for being
8cd5a4e0
RH
3935passed by reference, such as @code{TREE_ADDRESSABLE (type)}.
3936
3937If the hook returns true, a copy of that argument is made in memory and a
feca2ed3
JW
3938pointer to the argument is passed instead of the argument itself.
3939The pointer is passed in whatever way is appropriate for passing a pointer
3940to that type.
8cd5a4e0 3941@end deftypefn
feca2ed3 3942
d5cc9181 3943@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CALLEE_COPIES (cumulative_args_t @var{cum}, enum machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type}, bool @var{named})
6cdd5672
RH
3944The function argument described by the parameters to this hook is
3945known to be passed by reference. The hook should return true if the
3946function argument should be copied by the callee instead of copied
3947by the caller.
3948
a1c496cb 3949For any argument for which the hook returns true, if it can be
6cdd5672
RH
3950determined that the argument is not modified, then a copy need
3951not be generated.
3952
3953The default version of this hook always returns false.
3954@end deftypefn
feca2ed3 3955
a2c4f8e0 3956@defmac CUMULATIVE_ARGS
b25b9e8f
NF
3957A C type for declaring a variable that is used as the first argument
3958of @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} and other related values. For some
3959target machines, the type @code{int} suffices and can hold the number
3960of bytes of argument so far.
feca2ed3
JW
3961
3962There is no need to record in @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS} anything about the
3963arguments that have been passed on the stack. The compiler has other
3964variables to keep track of that. For target machines on which all
3965arguments are passed on the stack, there is no need to store anything in
3966@code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS}; however, the data structure must exist and
3967should not be empty, so use @code{int}.
a2c4f8e0 3968@end defmac
feca2ed3 3969
7c800926
KT
3970@defmac OVERRIDE_ABI_FORMAT (@var{fndecl})
3971If defined, this macro is called before generating any code for a
3972function, but after the @var{cfun} descriptor for the function has been
3973created. The back end may use this macro to update @var{cfun} to
3974reflect an ABI other than that which would normally be used by default.
3975If the compiler is generating code for a compiler-generated function,
3976@var{fndecl} may be @code{NULL}.
3977@end defmac
3978
0f6937fe 3979@defmac INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{fntype}, @var{libname}, @var{fndecl}, @var{n_named_args})
a2c4f8e0
ZW
3980A C statement (sans semicolon) for initializing the variable
3981@var{cum} for the state at the beginning of the argument list. The
3982variable has type @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS}. The value of @var{fntype}
3983is the tree node for the data type of the function which will receive
3984the args, or 0 if the args are to a compiler support library function.
3985For direct calls that are not libcalls, @var{fndecl} contain the
3986declaration node of the function. @var{fndecl} is also set when
3987@code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} is used to find arguments for the function
0f6937fe
AM
3988being compiled. @var{n_named_args} is set to the number of named
3989arguments, including a structure return address if it is passed as a
3990parameter, when making a call. When processing incoming arguments,
78466c0e 3991@var{n_named_args} is set to @minus{}1.
feca2ed3
JW
3992
3993When processing a call to a compiler support library function,
3994@var{libname} identifies which one. It is a @code{symbol_ref} rtx which
3995contains the name of the function, as a string. @var{libname} is 0 when
3996an ordinary C function call is being processed. Thus, each time this
3997macro is called, either @var{libname} or @var{fntype} is nonzero, but
3998never both of them at once.
a2c4f8e0 3999@end defmac
feca2ed3 4000
a2c4f8e0 4001@defmac INIT_CUMULATIVE_LIBCALL_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{mode}, @var{libname})
97fc4caf
AO
4002Like @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} but only used for outgoing libcalls,
4003it gets a @code{MODE} argument instead of @var{fntype}, that would be
4004@code{NULL}. @var{indirect} would always be zero, too. If this macro
4005is not defined, @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS (cum, NULL_RTX, libname,
40060)} is used instead.
a2c4f8e0 4007@end defmac
97fc4caf 4008
a2c4f8e0 4009@defmac INIT_CUMULATIVE_INCOMING_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{fntype}, @var{libname})
feca2ed3
JW
4010Like @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} but overrides it for the purposes of
4011finding the arguments for the function being compiled. If this macro is
4012undefined, @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} is used instead.
4013
4014The value passed for @var{libname} is always 0, since library routines
161d7b59 4015with special calling conventions are never compiled with GCC@. The
feca2ed3
JW
4016argument @var{libname} exists for symmetry with
4017@code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS}.
4018@c could use "this macro" in place of @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS}, maybe.
4019@c --mew 5feb93 i switched the order of the sentences. --mew 10feb93
a2c4f8e0 4020@end defmac
feca2ed3 4021
d5cc9181 4022@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_ADVANCE (cumulative_args_t @var{ca}, enum machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type}, bool @var{named})
b25b9e8f
NF
4023This hook updates the summarizer variable pointed to by @var{ca} to
4024advance past an argument in the argument list. The values @var{mode},
4025@var{type} and @var{named} describe that argument. Once this is done,
4026the variable @var{cum} is suitable for analyzing the @emph{following}
4027argument with @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG}, etc.
feca2ed3 4028
b25b9e8f 4029This hook need not do anything if the argument in question was passed
feca2ed3
JW
4030on the stack. The compiler knows how to track the amount of stack space
4031used for arguments without any special help.
b25b9e8f 4032@end deftypefn
feca2ed3 4033
099590dc
MM
4034@defmac FUNCTION_ARG_OFFSET (@var{mode}, @var{type})
4035If defined, a C expression that is the number of bytes to add to the
4036offset of the argument passed in memory. This is needed for the SPU,
4037which passes @code{char} and @code{short} arguments in the preferred
4038slot that is in the middle of the quad word instead of starting at the
4039top.
4040@end defmac
4041
a2c4f8e0 4042@defmac FUNCTION_ARG_PADDING (@var{mode}, @var{type})
feca2ed3
JW
4043If defined, a C expression which determines whether, and in which direction,
4044to pad out an argument with extra space. The value should be of type
4045@code{enum direction}: either @code{upward} to pad above the argument,
4046@code{downward} to pad below, or @code{none} to inhibit padding.
4047
123148b5
BS
4048The @emph{amount} of padding is not controlled by this macro, but by the
4049target hook @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_ROUND_BOUNDARY}. It is
4050always just enough to reach the next multiple of that boundary.
feca2ed3
JW
4051
4052This macro has a default definition which is right for most systems.
4053For little-endian machines, the default is to pad upward. For
4054big-endian machines, the default is to pad downward for an argument of
4055constant size shorter than an @code{int}, and upward otherwise.
a2c4f8e0 4056@end defmac
feca2ed3 4057
a2c4f8e0 4058@defmac PAD_VARARGS_DOWN
02f52e19
AJ
4059If defined, a C expression which determines whether the default
4060implementation of va_arg will attempt to pad down before reading the
5e4f6244
CP
4061next argument, if that argument is smaller than its aligned space as
4062controlled by @code{PARM_BOUNDARY}. If this macro is not defined, all such
4063arguments are padded down if @code{BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN} is true.
a2c4f8e0 4064@end defmac
5e4f6244 4065
6e985040
AM
4066@defmac BLOCK_REG_PADDING (@var{mode}, @var{type}, @var{first})
4067Specify padding for the last element of a block move between registers and
4068memory. @var{first} is nonzero if this is the only element. Defining this
4069macro allows better control of register function parameters on big-endian
4070machines, without using @code{PARALLEL} rtl. In particular,
4071@code{MUST_PASS_IN_STACK} need not test padding and mode of types in
4072registers, as there is no longer a "wrong" part of a register; For example,
4073a three byte aggregate may be passed in the high part of a register if so
4074required.
4075@end defmac
4076
c2ed6cf8 4077@deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_BOUNDARY (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type})
2b0d3573 4078This hook returns the alignment boundary, in bits, of an argument
c2ed6cf8
NF
4079with the specified mode and type. The default hook returns
4080@code{PARM_BOUNDARY} for all arguments.
4081@end deftypefn
feca2ed3 4082
123148b5
BS
4083@deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_ROUND_BOUNDARY (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type})
4084Normally, the size of an argument is rounded up to @code{PARM_BOUNDARY},
4085which is the default value for this hook. You can define this hook to
4086return a different value if an argument size must be rounded to a larger
4087value.
4088@end deftypefn
4089
a2c4f8e0 4090@defmac FUNCTION_ARG_REGNO_P (@var{regno})
feca2ed3
JW
4091A C expression that is nonzero if @var{regno} is the number of a hard
4092register in which function arguments are sometimes passed. This does
4093@emph{not} include implicit arguments such as the static chain and
4094the structure-value address. On many machines, no registers can be
4095used for this purpose since all function arguments are pushed on the
4096stack.
a2c4f8e0 4097@end defmac
bb1b857a 4098
9ddb66ef 4099@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SPLIT_COMPLEX_ARG (const_tree @var{type})
42ba5130
RH
4100This hook should return true if parameter of type @var{type} are passed
4101as two scalar parameters. By default, GCC will attempt to pack complex
4102arguments into the target's word size. Some ABIs require complex arguments
4103to be split and treated as their individual components. For example, on
4104AIX64, complex floats should be passed in a pair of floating point
4105registers, even though a complex float would fit in one 64-bit floating
4106point register.
4107
4108The default value of this hook is @code{NULL}, which is treated as always
4109false.
4110@end deftypefn
ded9bf77 4111
d3da4d14
RH
4112@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_BUILD_BUILTIN_VA_LIST (void)
4113This hook returns a type node for @code{va_list} for the target.
4114The default version of the hook returns @code{void*}.
4115@end deftypefn
4116
07a5b2bc 4117@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ENUM_VA_LIST_P (int @var{idx}, const char **@var{pname}, tree *@var{ptree})
d4048208
KT
4118This target hook is used in function @code{c_common_nodes_and_builtins}
4119to iterate through the target specific builtin types for va_list. The
4120variable @var{idx} is used as iterator. @var{pname} has to be a pointer
07a5b2bc 4121to a @code{const char *} and @var{ptree} a pointer to a @code{tree} typed
d4048208 4122variable.
07a5b2bc 4123The arguments @var{pname} and @var{ptree} are used to store the result of
d4048208
KT
4124this macro and are set to the name of the va_list builtin type and its
4125internal type.
4126If the return value of this macro is zero, then there is no more element.
4127Otherwise the @var{IDX} should be increased for the next call of this
4128macro to iterate through all types.
4129@end deftypefn
4130
35cbb299
KT
4131@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_FN_ABI_VA_LIST (tree @var{fndecl})
4132This hook returns the va_list type of the calling convention specified by
4133@var{fndecl}.
4134The default version of this hook returns @code{va_list_type_node}.
4135@end deftypefn
4136
4137@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CANONICAL_VA_LIST_TYPE (tree @var{type})
4138This hook returns the va_list type of the calling convention specified by the
4139type of @var{type}. If @var{type} is not a valid va_list type, it returns
4140@code{NULL_TREE}.
4141@end deftypefn
4142
9ddb66ef 4143@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_GIMPLIFY_VA_ARG_EXPR (tree @var{valist}, tree @var{type}, gimple_seq *@var{pre_p}, gimple_seq *@var{post_p})
23a60a04
JM
4144This hook performs target-specific gimplification of
4145@code{VA_ARG_EXPR}. The first two parameters correspond to the
4146arguments to @code{va_arg}; the latter two are as in
4147@code{gimplify.c:gimplify_expr}.
23a60a04
JM
4148@end deftypefn
4149
e09ec166
EC
4150@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VALID_POINTER_MODE (enum machine_mode @var{mode})
4151Define this to return nonzero if the port can handle pointers
4152with machine mode @var{mode}. The default version of this
4153hook returns true for both @code{ptr_mode} and @code{Pmode}.
4154@end deftypefn
4155
84562394 4156@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_REF_MAY_ALIAS_ERRNO (struct ao_ref *@var{ref})
7352c013
RG
4157Define this to return nonzero if the memory reference @var{ref} may alias with the system C library errno location. The default version of this hook assumes the system C library errno location is either a declaration of type int or accessed by dereferencing a pointer to int.
4158@end deftypefn
4159
6dd53648
RH
4160@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCALAR_MODE_SUPPORTED_P (enum machine_mode @var{mode})
4161Define this to return nonzero if the port is prepared to handle
4162insns involving scalar mode @var{mode}. For a scalar mode to be
4163considered supported, all the basic arithmetic and comparisons
4164must work.
4165
4166The default version of this hook returns true for any mode
4167required to handle the basic C types (as defined by the port).
4168Included here are the double-word arithmetic supported by the
4169code in @file{optabs.c}.
4170@end deftypefn
4171
f676971a
EC
4172@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VECTOR_MODE_SUPPORTED_P (enum machine_mode @var{mode})
4173Define this to return nonzero if the port is prepared to handle
4174insns involving vector mode @var{mode}. At the very least, it
4175must have move patterns for this mode.
4176@end deftypefn
4177
0f6d54f7
RS
4178@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ARRAY_MODE_SUPPORTED_P (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT @var{nelems})
4179Return true if GCC should try to use a scalar mode to store an array
4180of @var{nelems} elements, given that each element has mode @var{mode}.
4181Returning true here overrides the usual @code{MAX_FIXED_MODE} limit
4182and allows GCC to use any defined integer mode.
4183
4184One use of this hook is to support vector load and store operations
4185that operate on several homogeneous vectors. For example, ARM NEON
4186has operations like:
4187
4188@smallexample
4189int8x8x3_t vld3_s8 (const int8_t *)
4190@end smallexample
4191
4192where the return type is defined as:
4193
4194@smallexample
4195typedef struct int8x8x3_t
4196@{
4197 int8x8_t val[3];
4198@} int8x8x3_t;
4199@end smallexample
4200
4201If this hook allows @code{val} to have a scalar mode, then
4202@code{int8x8x3_t} can have the same mode. GCC can then store
4203@code{int8x8x3_t}s in registers rather than forcing them onto the stack.
4204@end deftypefn
4205
8cc4b7a2
JM
4206@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LIBGCC_FLOATING_MODE_SUPPORTED_P (enum machine_mode @var{mode})
4207Define this to return nonzero if libgcc provides support for the
4208floating-point mode @var{mode}, which is known to pass
4209@code{TARGET_SCALAR_MODE_SUPPORTED_P}. The default version of this
4210hook returns true for all of @code{SFmode}, @code{DFmode},
4211@code{XFmode} and @code{TFmode}, if such modes exist.
4212@end deftypefn
4213
42db504c
SB
4214@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SMALL_REGISTER_CLASSES_FOR_MODE_P (enum machine_mode @var{mode})
4215Define this to return nonzero for machine modes for which the port has
4216small register classes. If this target hook returns nonzero for a given
4217@var{mode}, the compiler will try to minimize the lifetime of registers
4218in @var{mode}. The hook may be called with @code{VOIDmode} as argument.
4219In this case, the hook is expected to return nonzero if it returns nonzero
4220for any mode.
4221
4222On some machines, it is risky to let hard registers live across arbitrary
4223insns. Typically, these machines have instructions that require values
4224to be in specific registers (like an accumulator), and reload will fail
4225if the required hard register is used for another purpose across such an
4226insn.
4227
4228Passes before reload do not know which hard registers will be used
4229in an instruction, but the machine modes of the registers set or used in
4230the instruction are already known. And for some machines, register
4231classes are small for, say, integer registers but not for floating point
4232registers. For example, the AMD x86-64 architecture requires specific
4233registers for the legacy x86 integer instructions, but there are many
4234SSE registers for floating point operations. On such targets, a good
4235strategy may be to return nonzero from this hook for @code{INTEGRAL_MODE_P}
4236machine modes but zero for the SSE register classes.
4237
2b0d3573 4238The default version of this hook returns false for any mode. It is always
42db504c
SB
4239safe to redefine this hook to return with a nonzero value. But if you
4240unnecessarily define it, you will reduce the amount of optimizations
4241that can be performed in some cases. If you do not define this hook
4242to return a nonzero value when it is required, the compiler will run out
4243of spill registers and print a fatal error message.
4244@end deftypefn
4245
e692f276
RH
4246@deftypevr {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_FLAGS_REGNUM
4247If the target has a dedicated flags register, and it needs to use the post-reload comparison elimination pass, then this value should be set appropriately.
4248@end deftypevr
4249
feca2ed3
JW
4250@node Scalar Return
4251@subsection How Scalar Function Values Are Returned
4252@cindex return values in registers
4253@cindex values, returned by functions
4254@cindex scalars, returned as values
4255
4256This section discusses the macros that control returning scalars as
4257values---values that can fit in registers.
4258
9ddb66ef 4259@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE (const_tree @var{ret_type}, const_tree @var{fn_decl_or_type}, bool @var{outgoing})
1b03c58a
RG
4260
4261Define this to return an RTX representing the place where a function
4262returns or receives a value of data type @var{ret_type}, a tree node
e4ae5e77 4263representing a data type. @var{fn_decl_or_type} is a tree node
1b03c58a
RG
4264representing @code{FUNCTION_DECL} or @code{FUNCTION_TYPE} of a
4265function being called. If @var{outgoing} is false, the hook should
4266compute the register in which the caller will see the return value.
4267Otherwise, the hook should return an RTX representing the place where
4268a function returns a value.
4269
4270On many machines, only @code{TYPE_MODE (@var{ret_type})} is relevant.
4271(Actually, on most machines, scalar values are returned in the same
4272place regardless of mode.) The value of the expression is usually a
4273@code{reg} RTX for the hard register where the return value is stored.
4274The value can also be a @code{parallel} RTX, if the return value is in
b25b9e8f 4275multiple places. See @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} for an explanation of the
576c9028
KH
4276@code{parallel} form. Note that the callee will populate every
4277location specified in the @code{parallel}, but if the first element of
4278the @code{parallel} contains the whole return value, callers will use
4279that element as the canonical location and ignore the others. The m68k
4280port uses this type of @code{parallel} to return pointers in both
4281@samp{%a0} (the canonical location) and @samp{%d0}.
1b03c58a
RG
4282
4283If @code{TARGET_PROMOTE_FUNCTION_RETURN} returns true, you must apply
4284the same promotion rules specified in @code{PROMOTE_MODE} if
4285@var{valtype} is a scalar type.
feca2ed3
JW
4286
4287If the precise function being called is known, @var{func} is a tree
4288node (@code{FUNCTION_DECL}) for it; otherwise, @var{func} is a null
4289pointer. This makes it possible to use a different value-returning
4290convention for specific functions when all their calls are
bd819a4a 4291known.
feca2ed3 4292
1b03c58a
RG
4293Some target machines have ``register windows'' so that the register in
4294which a function returns its value is not the same as the one in which
4295the caller sees the value. For such machines, you should return
4296different RTX depending on @var{outgoing}.
4297
4298@code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} is not used for return values with
4299aggregate data types, because these are returned in another way. See
cea28603 4300@code{TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX} and related macros, below.
1b03c58a
RG
4301@end deftypefn
4302
4303@defmac FUNCTION_VALUE (@var{valtype}, @var{func})
4304This macro has been deprecated. Use @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} for
4305a new target instead.
a2c4f8e0 4306@end defmac
feca2ed3 4307
a2c4f8e0 4308@defmac LIBCALL_VALUE (@var{mode})
feca2ed3 4309A C expression to create an RTX representing the place where a library
dc672951 4310function returns a value of mode @var{mode}.
feca2ed3
JW
4311
4312Note that ``library function'' in this context means a compiler
4313support routine, used to perform arithmetic, whose name is known
4314specially by the compiler and was not mentioned in the C code being
4315compiled.
a2c4f8e0 4316@end defmac
feca2ed3 4317
38f8b050 4318@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_LIBCALL_VALUE (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, const_rtx @var{fun})
390b17c2 4319Define this hook if the back-end needs to know the name of the libcall
ff2ce160 4320function in order to determine where the result should be returned.
390b17c2
RE
4321
4322The mode of the result is given by @var{mode} and the name of the called
ff2ce160 4323library function is given by @var{fun}. The hook should return an RTX
390b17c2
RE
4324representing the place where the library function result will be returned.
4325
4326If this hook is not defined, then LIBCALL_VALUE will be used.
4327@end deftypefn
4328
a2c4f8e0 4329@defmac FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P (@var{regno})
feca2ed3
JW
4330A C expression that is nonzero if @var{regno} is the number of a hard
4331register in which the values of called function may come back.
4332
4333A register whose use for returning values is limited to serving as the
4334second of a pair (for a value of type @code{double}, say) need not be
4335recognized by this macro. So for most machines, this definition
4336suffices:
4337
3ab51846 4338@smallexample
feca2ed3 4339#define FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P(N) ((N) == 0)
3ab51846 4340@end smallexample
feca2ed3
JW
4341
4342If the machine has register windows, so that the caller and the called
4343function use different registers for the return value, this macro
4344should recognize only the caller's register numbers.
82f81f18
AS
4345
4346This macro has been deprecated. Use @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P}
4347for a new target instead.
a2c4f8e0 4348@end defmac
feca2ed3 4349
82f81f18
AS
4350@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P (const unsigned int @var{regno})
4351A target hook that return @code{true} if @var{regno} is the number of a hard
4352register in which the values of called function may come back.
4353
4354A register whose use for returning values is limited to serving as the
4355second of a pair (for a value of type @code{double}, say) need not be
4356recognized by this target hook.
4357
4358If the machine has register windows, so that the caller and the called
4359function use different registers for the return value, this target hook
4360should recognize only the caller's register numbers.
4361
4362If this hook is not defined, then FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P will be used.
4363@end deftypefn
4364
a2c4f8e0 4365@defmac APPLY_RESULT_SIZE
feca2ed3
JW
4366Define this macro if @samp{untyped_call} and @samp{untyped_return}
4367need more space than is implied by @code{FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P} for
4368saving and restoring an arbitrary return value.
a2c4f8e0 4369@end defmac
feca2ed3 4370
9ddb66ef 4371@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_RETURN_IN_MSB (const_tree @var{type})
c988af2b
RS
4372This hook should return true if values of type @var{type} are returned
4373at the most significant end of a register (in other words, if they are
4374padded at the least significant end). You can assume that @var{type}
4375is returned in a register; the caller is required to check this.
4376
1b03c58a
RG
4377Note that the register provided by @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} must
4378be able to hold the complete return value. For example, if a 1-, 2-
4379or 3-byte structure is returned at the most significant end of a
43804-byte register, @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} should provide an
4381@code{SImode} rtx.
c988af2b
RS
4382@end deftypefn
4383
feca2ed3
JW
4384@node Aggregate Return
4385@subsection How Large Values Are Returned
4386@cindex aggregates as return values
4387@cindex large return values
4388@cindex returning aggregate values
4389@cindex structure value address
4390
4391When a function value's mode is @code{BLKmode} (and in some other
1b03c58a
RG
4392cases), the value is not returned according to
4393@code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} (@pxref{Scalar Return}). Instead, the
4394caller passes the address of a block of memory in which the value
4395should be stored. This address is called the @dfn{structure value
4396address}.
feca2ed3
JW
4397
4398This section describes how to control returning structure values in
4399memory.
4400
9ddb66ef 4401@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_RETURN_IN_MEMORY (const_tree @var{type}, const_tree @var{fntype})
61f71b34
DD
4402This target hook should return a nonzero value to say to return the
4403function value in memory, just as large structures are always returned.
4404Here @var{type} will be the data type of the value, and @var{fntype}
4405will be the type of the function doing the returning, or @code{NULL} for
4406libcalls.
feca2ed3
JW
4407
4408Note that values of mode @code{BLKmode} must be explicitly handled
61f71b34 4409by this function. Also, the option @option{-fpcc-struct-return}
feca2ed3 4410takes effect regardless of this macro. On most systems, it is
61f71b34 4411possible to leave the hook undefined; this causes a default
feca2ed3
JW
4412definition to be used, whose value is the constant 1 for @code{BLKmode}
4413values, and 0 otherwise.
4414
61f71b34 4415Do not use this hook to indicate that structures and unions should always
feca2ed3
JW
4416be returned in memory. You should instead use @code{DEFAULT_PCC_STRUCT_RETURN}
4417to indicate this.
61f71b34 4418@end deftypefn
feca2ed3 4419
a2c4f8e0 4420@defmac DEFAULT_PCC_STRUCT_RETURN
feca2ed3
JW
4421Define this macro to be 1 if all structure and union return values must be
4422in memory. Since this results in slower code, this should be defined
161d7b59 4423only if needed for compatibility with other compilers or with an ABI@.
feca2ed3 4424If you define this macro to be 0, then the conventions used for structure
d624465f
KH
4425and union return values are decided by the @code{TARGET_RETURN_IN_MEMORY}
4426target hook.
feca2ed3
JW
4427
4428If not defined, this defaults to the value 1.
a2c4f8e0 4429@end defmac
feca2ed3 4430
61f71b34
DD
4431@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX (tree @var{fndecl}, int @var{incoming})
4432This target hook should return the location of the structure value
4433address (normally a @code{mem} or @code{reg}), or 0 if the address is
4434passed as an ``invisible'' first argument. Note that @var{fndecl} may
1f6acb82
KH
4435be @code{NULL}, for libcalls. You do not need to define this target
4436hook if the address is always passed as an ``invisible'' first
4437argument.
feca2ed3 4438
feca2ed3
JW
4439On some architectures the place where the structure value address
4440is found by the called function is not the same place that the
4441caller put it. This can be due to register windows, or it could
4442be because the function prologue moves it to a different place.
2225b57c
CD
4443@var{incoming} is @code{1} or @code{2} when the location is needed in
4444the context of the called function, and @code{0} in the context of
61f71b34 4445the caller.
feca2ed3 4446
917f1b7e 4447If @var{incoming} is nonzero and the address is to be found on the
2225b57c
CD
4448stack, return a @code{mem} which refers to the frame pointer. If
4449@var{incoming} is @code{2}, the result is being used to fetch the
64ee9490 4450structure value address at the beginning of a function. If you need
2225b57c 4451to emit adjusting code, you should do it at this point.
61f71b34 4452@end deftypefn
feca2ed3 4453
a2c4f8e0 4454@defmac PCC_STATIC_STRUCT_RETURN
feca2ed3
JW
4455Define this macro if the usual system convention on the target machine
4456for returning structures and unions is for the called function to return
4457the address of a static variable containing the value.
4458
4459Do not define this if the usual system convention is for the caller to
4460pass an address to the subroutine.
4461
630d3d5a
JM
4462This macro has effect in @option{-fpcc-struct-return} mode, but it does
4463nothing when you use @option{-freg-struct-return} mode.
a2c4f8e0 4464@end defmac
feca2ed3 4465
ffa88471
SE
4466@deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum machine_mode} TARGET_GET_RAW_RESULT_MODE (int @var{regno})
4467This target hook returns the mode to be used when accessing raw return registers in @code{__builtin_return}. Define this macro if the value in @var{reg_raw_mode} is not correct.
4468@end deftypefn
4469
4470@deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum machine_mode} TARGET_GET_RAW_ARG_MODE (int @var{regno})
4471This target hook returns the mode to be used when accessing raw argument registers in @code{__builtin_apply_args}. Define this macro if the value in @var{reg_raw_mode} is not correct.
4472@end deftypefn
4473
feca2ed3
JW
4474@node Caller Saves
4475@subsection Caller-Saves Register Allocation
4476
a3a15b4d 4477If you enable it, GCC can save registers around function calls. This
feca2ed3
JW
4478makes it possible to use call-clobbered registers to hold variables that
4479must live across calls.
4480
a2c4f8e0 4481@defmac HARD_REGNO_CALLER_SAVE_MODE (@var{regno}, @var{nregs})
8d5c8167
JL
4482A C expression specifying which mode is required for saving @var{nregs}
4483of a pseudo-register in call-clobbered hard register @var{regno}. If
4484@var{regno} is unsuitable for caller save, @code{VOIDmode} should be
4485returned. For most machines this macro need not be defined since GCC
4486will select the smallest suitable mode.
a2c4f8e0 4487@end defmac
feca2ed3
JW
4488
4489@node Function Entry
4490@subsection Function Entry and Exit
4491@cindex function entry and exit
4492@cindex prologue
4493@cindex epilogue
4494
4495This section describes the macros that output function entry
4496(@dfn{prologue}) and exit (@dfn{epilogue}) code.
4497
08c148a8
NB
4498@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE (FILE *@var{file}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{size})
4499If defined, a function that outputs the assembler code for entry to a
feca2ed3
JW
4500function. The prologue is responsible for setting up the stack frame,
4501initializing the frame pointer register, saving registers that must be
4502saved, and allocating @var{size} additional bytes of storage for the
4503local variables. @var{size} is an integer. @var{file} is a stdio
4504stream to which the assembler code should be output.
4505
4506The label for the beginning of the function need not be output by this
4507macro. That has already been done when the macro is run.
4508
4509@findex regs_ever_live
4510To determine which registers to save, the macro can refer to the array
4511@code{regs_ever_live}: element @var{r} is nonzero if hard register
4512@var{r} is used anywhere within the function. This implies the function
4513prologue should save register @var{r}, provided it is not one of the
08c148a8 4514call-used registers. (@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must likewise use
feca2ed3
JW
4515@code{regs_ever_live}.)
4516
4517On machines that have ``register windows'', the function entry code does
4518not save on the stack the registers that are in the windows, even if
4519they are supposed to be preserved by function calls; instead it takes
4520appropriate steps to ``push'' the register stack, if any non-call-used
4521registers are used in the function.
4522
4523@findex frame_pointer_needed
4524On machines where functions may or may not have frame-pointers, the
4525function entry code must vary accordingly; it must set up the frame
4526pointer if one is wanted, and not otherwise. To determine whether a
4527frame pointer is in wanted, the macro can refer to the variable
4528@code{frame_pointer_needed}. The variable's value will be 1 at run
4529time in a function that needs a frame pointer. @xref{Elimination}.
4530
4531The function entry code is responsible for allocating any stack space
4532required for the function. This stack space consists of the regions
4533listed below. In most cases, these regions are allocated in the
4534order listed, with the last listed region closest to the top of the
4535stack (the lowest address if @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is defined, and
4536the highest address if it is not defined). You can use a different order
4537for a machine if doing so is more convenient or required for
4538compatibility reasons. Except in cases where required by standard
4539or by a debugger, there is no reason why the stack layout used by GCC
4540need agree with that used by other compilers for a machine.
08c148a8
NB
4541@end deftypefn
4542
17b53c33
NB
4543@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_END_PROLOGUE (FILE *@var{file})
4544If defined, a function that outputs assembler code at the end of a
4545prologue. This should be used when the function prologue is being
4546emitted as RTL, and you have some extra assembler that needs to be
4547emitted. @xref{prologue instruction pattern}.
4548@end deftypefn
4549
4550@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_BEGIN_EPILOGUE (FILE *@var{file})
4551If defined, a function that outputs assembler code at the start of an
4552epilogue. This should be used when the function epilogue is being
4553emitted as RTL, and you have some extra assembler that needs to be
4554emitted. @xref{epilogue instruction pattern}.
4555@end deftypefn
4556
08c148a8
NB
4557@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE (FILE *@var{file}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{size})
4558If defined, a function that outputs the assembler code for exit from a
4559function. The epilogue is responsible for restoring the saved
4560registers and stack pointer to their values when the function was
4561called, and returning control to the caller. This macro takes the
4562same arguments as the macro @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE}, and the
4563registers to restore are determined from @code{regs_ever_live} and
4564@code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} in the same way.
4565
4566On some machines, there is a single instruction that does all the work
4567of returning from the function. On these machines, give that
4568instruction the name @samp{return} and do not define the macro
4569@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} at all.
4570
4571Do not define a pattern named @samp{return} if you want the
4572@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} to be used. If you want the target
4573switches to control whether return instructions or epilogues are used,
4574define a @samp{return} pattern with a validity condition that tests the
4575target switches appropriately. If the @samp{return} pattern's validity
4576condition is false, epilogues will be used.
4577
4578On machines where functions may or may not have frame-pointers, the
4579function exit code must vary accordingly. Sometimes the code for these
4580two cases is completely different. To determine whether a frame pointer
4581is wanted, the macro can refer to the variable
4582@code{frame_pointer_needed}. The variable's value will be 1 when compiling
4583a function that needs a frame pointer.
4584
4585Normally, @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} and
4586@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must treat leaf functions specially.
4587The C variable @code{current_function_is_leaf} is nonzero for such a
4588function. @xref{Leaf Functions}.
4589
4590On some machines, some functions pop their arguments on exit while
4591others leave that for the caller to do. For example, the 68020 when
4592given @option{-mrtd} pops arguments in functions that take a fixed
4593number of arguments.
4594
29454ff5
SL
4595@findex pops_args
4596@findex crtl->args.pops_args
08c148a8
NB
4597Your definition of the macro @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS} decides which
4598functions pop their own arguments. @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE}
72392b81
JR
4599needs to know what was decided. The number of bytes of the current
4600function's arguments that this function should pop is available in
4601@code{crtl->args.pops_args}. @xref{Scalar Return}.
08c148a8
NB
4602@end deftypefn
4603
feca2ed3
JW
4604@itemize @bullet
4605@item
29454ff5
SL
4606@findex pretend_args_size
4607@findex crtl->args.pretend_args_size
4608A region of @code{crtl->args.pretend_args_size} bytes of
feca2ed3
JW
4609uninitialized space just underneath the first argument arriving on the
4610stack. (This may not be at the very start of the allocated stack region
4611if the calling sequence has pushed anything else since pushing the stack
4612arguments. But usually, on such machines, nothing else has been pushed
4613yet, because the function prologue itself does all the pushing.) This
4614region is used on machines where an argument may be passed partly in
4615registers and partly in memory, and, in some cases to support the
6c535c69 4616features in @code{<stdarg.h>}.
feca2ed3
JW
4617
4618@item
4619An area of memory used to save certain registers used by the function.
4620The size of this area, which may also include space for such things as
4621the return address and pointers to previous stack frames, is
4622machine-specific and usually depends on which registers have been used
4623in the function. Machines with register windows often do not require
4624a save area.
4625
4626@item
4627A region of at least @var{size} bytes, possibly rounded up to an allocation
4628boundary, to contain the local variables of the function. On some machines,
4629this region and the save area may occur in the opposite order, with the
4630save area closer to the top of the stack.
4631
4632@item
4633@cindex @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} and stack frames
4634Optionally, when @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} is defined, a region of
29454ff5 4635@code{crtl->outgoing_args_size} bytes to be used for outgoing
feca2ed3
JW
4636argument lists of the function. @xref{Stack Arguments}.
4637@end itemize
4638
a2c4f8e0 4639@defmac EXIT_IGNORE_STACK
feca2ed3
JW
4640Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if the return
4641instruction or the function epilogue ignores the value of the stack
4642pointer; in other words, if it is safe to delete an instruction to
9d05bbce
KH
4643adjust the stack pointer before a return from the function. The
4644default is 0.
feca2ed3
JW
4645
4646Note that this macro's value is relevant only for functions for which
4647frame pointers are maintained. It is never safe to delete a final
4648stack adjustment in a function that has no frame pointer, and the
4649compiler knows this regardless of @code{EXIT_IGNORE_STACK}.
a2c4f8e0 4650@end defmac
feca2ed3 4651
a2c4f8e0 4652@defmac EPILOGUE_USES (@var{regno})
8760eaae 4653Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero for registers that are
feca2ed3 4654used by the epilogue or the @samp{return} pattern. The stack and frame
86c33cd0 4655pointer registers are already assumed to be used as needed.
a2c4f8e0 4656@end defmac
feca2ed3 4657
a2c4f8e0 4658@defmac EH_USES (@var{regno})
15b5aef3
RH
4659Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero for registers that are
4660used by the exception handling mechanism, and so should be considered live
4661on entry to an exception edge.
a2c4f8e0 4662@end defmac
15b5aef3 4663
65e71cd6 4664@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK (FILE *@var{file}, tree @var{thunk_fndecl}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{delta}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{vcall_offset}, tree @var{function})
483ab821 4665A function that outputs the assembler code for a thunk
feca2ed3
JW
4666function, used to implement C++ virtual function calls with multiple
4667inheritance. The thunk acts as a wrapper around a virtual function,
4668adjusting the implicit object parameter before handing control off to
4669the real function.
4670
4671First, emit code to add the integer @var{delta} to the location that
4672contains the incoming first argument. Assume that this argument
4673contains a pointer, and is the one used to pass the @code{this} pointer
4674in C++. This is the incoming argument @emph{before} the function prologue,
e979f9e8 4675e.g.@: @samp{%o0} on a sparc. The addition must preserve the values of
feca2ed3
JW
4676all other incoming arguments.
4677
65e71cd6
EB
4678Then, if @var{vcall_offset} is nonzero, an additional adjustment should be
4679made after adding @code{delta}. In particular, if @var{p} is the
4680adjusted pointer, the following adjustment should be made:
4681
4682@smallexample
4683p += (*((ptrdiff_t **)p))[vcall_offset/sizeof(ptrdiff_t)]
4684@end smallexample
4685
4686After the additions, emit code to jump to @var{function}, which is a
feca2ed3
JW
4687@code{FUNCTION_DECL}. This is a direct pure jump, not a call, and does
4688not touch the return address. Hence returning from @var{FUNCTION} will
4689return to whoever called the current @samp{thunk}.
4690
4691The effect must be as if @var{function} had been called directly with
4692the adjusted first argument. This macro is responsible for emitting all
08c148a8
NB
4693of the code for a thunk function; @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE}
4694and @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} are not invoked.
feca2ed3
JW
4695
4696The @var{thunk_fndecl} is redundant. (@var{delta} and @var{function}
4697have already been extracted from it.) It might possibly be useful on
4698some targets, but probably not.
4699
861bb6c1 4700If you do not define this macro, the target-independent code in the C++
c771326b 4701front end will generate a less efficient heavyweight thunk that calls
861bb6c1
JL
4702@var{function} instead of jumping to it. The generic approach does
4703not support varargs.
483ab821
MM
4704@end deftypefn
4705
9ddb66ef 4706@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_CAN_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK (const_tree @var{thunk_fndecl}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{delta}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{vcall_offset}, const_tree @var{function})
65e71cd6
EB
4707A function that returns true if TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK would be able
4708to output the assembler code for the thunk function specified by the
4709arguments it is passed, and false otherwise. In the latter case, the
4710generic approach will be used by the C++ front end, with the limitations
4711previously exposed.
483ab821 4712@end deftypefn
feca2ed3
JW
4713
4714@node Profiling
4715@subsection Generating Code for Profiling
4716@cindex profiling, code generation
4717
4718These macros will help you generate code for profiling.
4719
a2c4f8e0 4720@defmac FUNCTION_PROFILER (@var{file}, @var{labelno})
feca2ed3
JW
4721A C statement or compound statement to output to @var{file} some
4722assembler code to call the profiling subroutine @code{mcount}.
feca2ed3
JW
4723
4724@findex mcount
980e2067 4725The details of how @code{mcount} expects to be called are determined by
161d7b59 4726your operating system environment, not by GCC@. To figure them out,
980e2067
JL
4727compile a small program for profiling using the system's installed C
4728compiler and look at the assembler code that results.
4729
4730Older implementations of @code{mcount} expect the address of a counter
4731variable to be loaded into some register. The name of this variable is
4732@samp{LP} followed by the number @var{labelno}, so you would generate
4733the name using @samp{LP%d} in a @code{fprintf}.
a2c4f8e0 4734@end defmac
980e2067 4735
a2c4f8e0 4736@defmac PROFILE_HOOK
411707f4
CC
4737A C statement or compound statement to output to @var{file} some assembly
4738code to call the profiling subroutine @code{mcount} even the target does
4739not support profiling.
a2c4f8e0 4740@end defmac
411707f4 4741
a2c4f8e0 4742@defmac NO_PROFILE_COUNTERS
8b65a354
JZ
4743Define this macro to be an expression with a nonzero value if the
4744@code{mcount} subroutine on your system does not need a counter variable
4745allocated for each function. This is true for almost all modern
4746implementations. If you define this macro, you must not use the
4747@var{labelno} argument to @code{FUNCTION_PROFILER}.
a2c4f8e0 4748@end defmac
feca2ed3 4749
a2c4f8e0 4750@defmac PROFILE_BEFORE_PROLOGUE
feca2ed3
JW
4751Define this macro if the code for function profiling should come before
4752the function prologue. Normally, the profiling code comes after.
a2c4f8e0 4753@end defmac
feca2ed3 4754
d56a43a0
AK
4755@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_KEEP_LEAF_WHEN_PROFILED (void)
4756This target hook returns true if the target wants the leaf flag for the current function to stay true even if it calls mcount. This might make sense for targets using the leaf flag only to determine whether a stack frame needs to be generated or not and for which the call to mcount is generated before the function prologue.
4757@end deftypefn
4758
91d231cb
JM
4759@node Tail Calls
4760@subsection Permitting tail calls
4761@cindex tail calls
b36f4ed3 4762
4977bab6 4763@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FUNCTION_OK_FOR_SIBCALL (tree @var{decl}, tree @var{exp})
5bd40ade 4764True if it is OK to do sibling call optimization for the specified
4977bab6
ZW
4765call expression @var{exp}. @var{decl} will be the called function,
4766or @code{NULL} if this is an indirect call.
4cb1433c
RH
4767
4768It is not uncommon for limitations of calling conventions to prevent
4769tail calls to functions outside the current unit of translation, or
4977bab6 4770during PIC compilation. The hook is used to enforce these restrictions,
02f52e19 4771as the @code{sibcall} md pattern can not fail, or fall over to a
4977bab6
ZW
4772``normal'' call. The criteria for successful sibling call optimization
4773may vary greatly between different architectures.
4774@end deftypefn
4cb1433c 4775
9ddb66ef 4776@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_EXTRA_LIVE_ON_ENTRY (bitmap @var{regs})
912f2dac
DB
4777Add any hard registers to @var{regs} that are live on entry to the
4778function. This hook only needs to be defined to provide registers that
4779cannot be found by examination of FUNCTION_ARG_REGNO_P, the callee saved
4780registers, STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM, STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM,
4781TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX, FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, EH_USES,
4782FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, and the PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM.
4783@end deftypefn
4784
ee3d2ecd
JJ
4785@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SET_UP_BY_PROLOGUE (struct hard_reg_set_container *@var{})
4786This hook should add additional registers that are computed by the prologue to the hard regset for shrink-wrapping optimization purposes.
4787@end deftypefn
4788
d45eae79
SL
4789@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_WARN_FUNC_RETURN (tree)
4790True if a function's return statements should be checked for matching the function's return type. This includes checking for falling off the end of a non-void function. Return false if no such check should be made.
4791@end deftypefn
4792
7d69de61
RH
4793@node Stack Smashing Protection
4794@subsection Stack smashing protection
4795@cindex stack smashing protection
4796
4797@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_STACK_PROTECT_GUARD (void)
4798This hook returns a @code{DECL} node for the external variable to use
083cad55 4799for the stack protection guard. This variable is initialized by the
7d69de61
RH
4800runtime to some random value and is used to initialize the guard value
4801that is placed at the top of the local stack frame. The type of this
4802variable must be @code{ptr_type_node}.
4803
4804The default version of this hook creates a variable called
4805@samp{__stack_chk_guard}, which is normally defined in @file{libgcc2.c}.
4806@end deftypefn
4807
4808@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_STACK_PROTECT_FAIL (void)
b3c144a3 4809This hook returns a @code{CALL_EXPR} that alerts the runtime that the
7d69de61
RH
4810stack protect guard variable has been modified. This expression should
4811involve a call to a @code{noreturn} function.
4812
4813The default version of this hook invokes a function called
083cad55 4814@samp{__stack_chk_fail}, taking no arguments. This function is
7d69de61
RH
4815normally defined in @file{libgcc2.c}.
4816@end deftypefn
4817
677f3fa8 4818@deftypefn {Common Target Hook} bool TARGET_SUPPORTS_SPLIT_STACK (bool @var{report}, struct gcc_options *@var{opts})
d5fabb58 4819Whether this target supports splitting the stack when the options described in @var{opts} have been passed. This is called after options have been parsed, so the target may reject splitting the stack in some configurations. The default version of this hook returns false. If @var{report} is true, this function may issue a warning or error; if @var{report} is false, it must simply return a value
7458026b
ILT
4820@end deftypefn
4821
aaeaa9a9
RO
4822@node Miscellaneous Register Hooks
4823@subsection Miscellaneous register hooks
4824@cindex miscellaneous register hooks
4825
4826@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CALL_FUSAGE_CONTAINS_NON_CALLEE_CLOBBERS
73b3e61b
TV
4827Set to true if each call that binds to a local definition explicitly
4828clobbers or sets all non-fixed registers modified by performing the call.
4829That is, by the call pattern itself, or by code that might be inserted by the
4830linker (e.g. stubs, veneers, branch islands), but not including those
4831modifiable by the callee. The affected registers may be mentioned explicitly
4832in the call pattern, or included as clobbers in CALL_INSN_FUNCTION_USAGE.
4833The default version of this hook is set to false. The purpose of this hook
4834is to enable the fuse-caller-save optimization.
aaeaa9a9
RO
4835@end deftypevr
4836
feca2ed3
JW
4837@node Varargs
4838@section Implementing the Varargs Macros
4839@cindex varargs implementation
4840
aee96fe9
JM
4841GCC comes with an implementation of @code{<varargs.h>} and
4842@code{<stdarg.h>} that work without change on machines that pass arguments
feca2ed3
JW
4843on the stack. Other machines require their own implementations of
4844varargs, and the two machine independent header files must have
4845conditionals to include it.
4846
aee96fe9 4847ISO @code{<stdarg.h>} differs from traditional @code{<varargs.h>} mainly in
feca2ed3
JW
4848the calling convention for @code{va_start}. The traditional
4849implementation takes just one argument, which is the variable in which
5490d604 4850to store the argument pointer. The ISO implementation of
feca2ed3
JW
4851@code{va_start} takes an additional second argument. The user is
4852supposed to write the last named argument of the function here.
4853
4854However, @code{va_start} should not use this argument. The way to find
4855the end of the named arguments is with the built-in functions described
4856below.
4857
a2c4f8e0 4858@defmac __builtin_saveregs ()
feca2ed3 4859Use this built-in function to save the argument registers in memory so
5490d604 4860that the varargs mechanism can access them. Both ISO and traditional
feca2ed3 4861versions of @code{va_start} must use @code{__builtin_saveregs}, unless
c2379679 4862you use @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} (see below) instead.
feca2ed3
JW
4863
4864On some machines, @code{__builtin_saveregs} is open-coded under the
f61c92c3
KH
4865control of the target hook @code{TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS}. On
4866other machines, it calls a routine written in assembler language,
4867found in @file{libgcc2.c}.
feca2ed3
JW
4868
4869Code generated for the call to @code{__builtin_saveregs} appears at the
4870beginning of the function, as opposed to where the call to
4871@code{__builtin_saveregs} is written, regardless of what the code is.
4872This is because the registers must be saved before the function starts
4873to use them for its own purposes.
4874@c i rewrote the first sentence above to fix an overfull hbox. --mew
4875@c 10feb93
a2c4f8e0 4876@end defmac
feca2ed3 4877
a2c4f8e0 4878@defmac __builtin_next_arg (@var{lastarg})
c59a0a1d 4879This builtin returns the address of the first anonymous stack
767094dd 4880argument, as type @code{void *}. If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, it
feca2ed3
JW
4881returns the address of the location above the first anonymous stack
4882argument. Use it in @code{va_start} to initialize the pointer for
4883fetching arguments from the stack. Also use it in @code{va_start} to
4884verify that the second parameter @var{lastarg} is the last named argument
4885of the current function.
a2c4f8e0 4886@end defmac
feca2ed3 4887
a2c4f8e0 4888@defmac __builtin_classify_type (@var{object})
feca2ed3
JW
4889Since each machine has its own conventions for which data types are
4890passed in which kind of register, your implementation of @code{va_arg}
4891has to embody these conventions. The easiest way to categorize the
4892specified data type is to use @code{__builtin_classify_type} together
4893with @code{sizeof} and @code{__alignof__}.
4894
4895@code{__builtin_classify_type} ignores the value of @var{object},
4896considering only its data type. It returns an integer describing what
4897kind of type that is---integer, floating, pointer, structure, and so on.
4898
4899The file @file{typeclass.h} defines an enumeration that you can use to
4900interpret the values of @code{__builtin_classify_type}.
a2c4f8e0 4901@end defmac
feca2ed3
JW
4902
4903These machine description macros help implement varargs:
4904
61f71b34
DD
4905@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS (void)
4906If defined, this hook produces the machine-specific code for a call to
4907@code{__builtin_saveregs}. This code will be moved to the very
4908beginning of the function, before any parameter access are made. The
4909return value of this function should be an RTX that contains the value
4910to use as the return of @code{__builtin_saveregs}.
4911@end deftypefn
feca2ed3 4912
d5cc9181 4913@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS (cumulative_args_t @var{args_so_far}, enum machine_mode @var{mode}, tree @var{type}, int *@var{pretend_args_size}, int @var{second_time})
61f71b34
DD
4914This target hook offers an alternative to using
4915@code{__builtin_saveregs} and defining the hook
4916@code{TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS}. Use it to store the anonymous
4917register arguments into the stack so that all the arguments appear to
4918have been passed consecutively on the stack. Once this is done, you can
4919use the standard implementation of varargs that works for machines that
4920pass all their arguments on the stack.
feca2ed3 4921
61f71b34 4922The argument @var{args_so_far} points to the @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS} data
8760eaae 4923structure, containing the values that are obtained after processing the
feca2ed3
JW
4924named arguments. The arguments @var{mode} and @var{type} describe the
4925last named argument---its machine mode and its data type as a tree node.
4926
61f71b34
DD
4927The target hook should do two things: first, push onto the stack all the
4928argument registers @emph{not} used for the named arguments, and second,
4929store the size of the data thus pushed into the @code{int}-valued
4930variable pointed to by @var{pretend_args_size}. The value that you
4931store here will serve as additional offset for setting up the stack
4932frame.
feca2ed3
JW
4933
4934Because you must generate code to push the anonymous arguments at
4935compile time without knowing their data types,
61f71b34
DD
4936@code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} is only useful on machines that
4937have just a single category of argument register and use it uniformly
4938for all data types.
feca2ed3
JW
4939
4940If the argument @var{second_time} is nonzero, it means that the
4941arguments of the function are being analyzed for the second time. This
4942happens for an inline function, which is not actually compiled until the
61f71b34 4943end of the source file. The hook @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} should
feca2ed3 4944not generate any instructions in this case.
61f71b34 4945@end deftypefn
feca2ed3 4946
d5cc9181 4947@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_STRICT_ARGUMENT_NAMING (cumulative_args_t @var{ca})
61f71b34 4948Define this hook to return @code{true} if the location where a function
e5e809f4 4949argument is passed depends on whether or not it is a named argument.
feca2ed3 4950
b25b9e8f 4951This hook controls how the @var{named} argument to @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG}
61f71b34
DD
4952is set for varargs and stdarg functions. If this hook returns
4953@code{true}, the @var{named} argument is always true for named
4954arguments, and false for unnamed arguments. If it returns @code{false},
5b4ef0b1 4955but @code{TARGET_PRETEND_OUTGOING_VARARGS_NAMED} returns @code{true},
61f71b34
DD
4956then all arguments are treated as named. Otherwise, all named arguments
4957except the last are treated as named.
e5e809f4 4958
9ddb66ef 4959You need not define this hook if it always returns @code{false}.
61f71b34 4960@end deftypefn
9ab70a9b 4961
d5cc9181 4962@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_PRETEND_OUTGOING_VARARGS_NAMED (cumulative_args_t @var{ca})
9ab70a9b 4963If you need to conditionally change ABIs so that one works with
61f71b34
DD
4964@code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS}, but the other works like neither
4965@code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} nor @code{TARGET_STRICT_ARGUMENT_NAMING} was
4966defined, then define this hook to return @code{true} if
c2379679 4967@code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} is used, @code{false} otherwise.
61f71b34
DD
4968Otherwise, you should not define this hook.
4969@end deftypefn
feca2ed3
JW
4970
4971@node Trampolines
4972@section Trampolines for Nested Functions
4973@cindex trampolines for nested functions
4974@cindex nested functions, trampolines for
4975
4976A @dfn{trampoline} is a small piece of code that is created at run time
4977when the address of a nested function is taken. It normally resides on
4978the stack, in the stack frame of the containing function. These macros
a3a15b4d 4979tell GCC how to generate code to allocate and initialize a
feca2ed3
JW
4980trampoline.
4981
4982The instructions in the trampoline must do two things: load a constant
4983address into the static chain register, and jump to the real address of
4984the nested function. On CISC machines such as the m68k, this requires
4985two instructions, a move immediate and a jump. Then the two addresses
4986exist in the trampoline as word-long immediate operands. On RISC
4987machines, it is often necessary to load each address into a register in
4988two parts. Then pieces of each address form separate immediate
4989operands.
4990
4991The code generated to initialize the trampoline must store the variable
4992parts---the static chain value and the function address---into the
4993immediate operands of the instructions. On a CISC machine, this is
4994simply a matter of copying each address to a memory reference at the
4995proper offset from the start of the trampoline. On a RISC machine, it
4996may be necessary to take out pieces of the address and store them
4997separately.
4998
531ca746
RH
4999@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_TRAMPOLINE_TEMPLATE (FILE *@var{f})
5000This hook is called by @code{assemble_trampoline_template} to output,
5001on the stream @var{f}, assembler code for a block of data that contains
5002the constant parts of a trampoline. This code should not include a
5003label---the label is taken care of automatically.
feca2ed3 5004
531ca746
RH
5005If you do not define this hook, it means no template is needed
5006for the target. Do not define this hook on systems where the block move
feca2ed3
JW
5007code to copy the trampoline into place would be larger than the code
5008to generate it on the spot.
531ca746 5009@end deftypefn
feca2ed3 5010
a2c4f8e0 5011@defmac TRAMPOLINE_SECTION
d6b5193b
RS
5012Return the section into which the trampoline template is to be placed
5013(@pxref{Sections}). The default value is @code{readonly_data_section}.
a2c4f8e0 5014@end defmac
feca2ed3 5015
a2c4f8e0 5016@defmac TRAMPOLINE_SIZE
feca2ed3 5017A C expression for the size in bytes of the trampoline, as an integer.
a2c4f8e0 5018@end defmac
feca2ed3 5019
a2c4f8e0 5020@defmac TRAMPOLINE_ALIGNMENT
feca2ed3
JW
5021Alignment required for trampolines, in bits.
5022
531ca746 5023If you don't define this macro, the value of @code{FUNCTION_ALIGNMENT}
feca2ed3 5024is used for aligning trampolines.
a2c4f8e0 5025@end defmac
feca2ed3 5026
531ca746
RH
5027@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_INIT (rtx @var{m_tramp}, tree @var{fndecl}, rtx @var{static_chain})
5028This hook is called to initialize a trampoline.
5029@var{m_tramp} is an RTX for the memory block for the trampoline; @var{fndecl}
5030is the @code{FUNCTION_DECL} for the nested function; @var{static_chain} is an
feca2ed3
JW
5031RTX for the static chain value that should be passed to the function
5032when it is called.
5033
531ca746
RH
5034If the target defines @code{TARGET_ASM_TRAMPOLINE_TEMPLATE}, then the
5035first thing this hook should do is emit a block move into @var{m_tramp}
5036from the memory block returned by @code{assemble_trampoline_template}.
ff2ce160 5037Note that the block move need only cover the constant parts of the
531ca746
RH
5038trampoline. If the target isolates the variable parts of the trampoline
5039to the end, not all @code{TRAMPOLINE_SIZE} bytes need be copied.
b33493e3 5040
531ca746 5041If the target requires any other actions, such as flushing caches or
ff2ce160 5042enabling stack execution, these actions should be performed after
531ca746
RH
5043initializing the trampoline proper.
5044@end deftypefn
5045
5046@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_ADJUST_ADDRESS (rtx @var{addr})
5047This hook should perform any machine-specific adjustment in
5048the address of the trampoline. Its argument contains the address of the
5049memory block that was passed to @code{TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_INIT}. In case
5050the address to be used for a function call should be different from the
5051address at which the template was stored, the different address should
5052be returned; otherwise @var{addr} should be returned unchanged.
5053If this hook is not defined, @var{addr} will be used for function calls.
5054@end deftypefn
feca2ed3
JW
5055
5056Implementing trampolines is difficult on many machines because they have
5057separate instruction and data caches. Writing into a stack location
5058fails to clear the memory in the instruction cache, so when the program
5059jumps to that location, it executes the old contents.
5060
5061Here are two possible solutions. One is to clear the relevant parts of
5062the instruction cache whenever a trampoline is set up. The other is to
5063make all trampolines identical, by having them jump to a standard
5064subroutine. The former technique makes trampoline execution faster; the
5065latter makes initialization faster.
5066
5067To clear the instruction cache when a trampoline is initialized, define
f691dc3b 5068the following macro.
feca2ed3 5069
a2c4f8e0 5070@defmac CLEAR_INSN_CACHE (@var{beg}, @var{end})
feca2ed3 5071If defined, expands to a C expression clearing the @emph{instruction
f691dc3b
AJ
5072cache} in the specified interval. The definition of this macro would
5073typically be a series of @code{asm} statements. Both @var{beg} and
5074@var{end} are both pointer expressions.
a2c4f8e0 5075@end defmac
feca2ed3
JW
5076
5077To use a standard subroutine, define the following macro. In addition,
5078you must make sure that the instructions in a trampoline fill an entire
5079cache line with identical instructions, or else ensure that the
5080beginning of the trampoline code is always aligned at the same point in
5081its cache line. Look in @file{m68k.h} as a guide.
5082
a2c4f8e0 5083@defmac TRANSFER_FROM_TRAMPOLINE
feca2ed3
JW
5084Define this macro if trampolines need a special subroutine to do their
5085work. The macro should expand to a series of @code{asm} statements
161d7b59 5086which will be compiled with GCC@. They go in a library function named
feca2ed3
JW
5087@code{__transfer_from_trampoline}.
5088
5089If you need to avoid executing the ordinary prologue code of a compiled
5090C function when you jump to the subroutine, you can do so by placing a
5091special label of your own in the assembler code. Use one @code{asm}
5092statement to generate an assembler label, and another to make the label
5093global. Then trampolines can use that label to jump directly to your
5094special assembler code.
a2c4f8e0 5095@end defmac
feca2ed3
JW
5096
5097@node Library Calls
5098@section Implicit Calls to Library Routines
5099@cindex library subroutine names
5100@cindex @file{libgcc.a}
5101
5102@c prevent bad page break with this line
5103Here is an explanation of implicit calls to library routines.
5104
a2c4f8e0 5105@defmac DECLARE_LIBRARY_RENAMES
d8088c6f
BS
5106This macro, if defined, should expand to a piece of C code that will get
5107expanded when compiling functions for libgcc.a. It can be used to
2dd76960 5108provide alternate names for GCC's internal library functions if there
d8088c6f 5109are ABI-mandated names that the compiler should provide.
a2c4f8e0 5110@end defmac
d8088c6f 5111
c15c90bb 5112@findex set_optab_libfunc
914d25dc 5113@findex init_one_libfunc
c15c90bb
ZW
5114@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INIT_LIBFUNCS (void)
5115This hook should declare additional library routines or rename
5116existing ones, using the functions @code{set_optab_libfunc} and
5117@code{init_one_libfunc} defined in @file{optabs.c}.
5118@code{init_optabs} calls this macro after initializing all the normal
5119library routines.
feca2ed3 5120
c15c90bb
ZW
5121The default is to do nothing. Most ports don't need to define this hook.
5122@end deftypefn
c5c60e15 5123
cdbf4541
BS
5124@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LIBFUNC_GNU_PREFIX
5125If false (the default), internal library routines start with two
5126underscores. If set to true, these routines start with @code{__gnu_}
5127instead. E.g., @code{__muldi3} changes to @code{__gnu_muldi3}. This
5128currently only affects functions defined in @file{libgcc2.c}. If this
5129is set to true, the @file{tm.h} file must also
5130@code{#define LIBGCC2_GNU_PREFIX}.
5131@end deftypevr
5132
9c917669 5133@defmac FLOAT_LIB_COMPARE_RETURNS_BOOL (@var{mode}, @var{comparison})
c15c90bb
ZW
5134This macro should return @code{true} if the library routine that
5135implements the floating point comparison operator @var{comparison} in
5136mode @var{mode} will return a boolean, and @var{false} if it will
5137return a tristate.
5138
5139GCC's own floating point libraries return tristates from the
5140comparison operators, so the default returns false always. Most ports
5141don't need to define this macro.
5142@end defmac
5143
b3f8d95d
MM
5144@defmac TARGET_LIB_INT_CMP_BIASED
5145This macro should evaluate to @code{true} if the integer comparison
5146functions (like @code{__cmpdi2}) return 0 to indicate that the first
5147operand is smaller than the second, 1 to indicate that they are equal,
5148and 2 to indicate that the first operand is greater than the second.
38b974a6 5149If this macro evaluates to @code{false} the comparison functions return
78466c0e 5150@minus{}1, 0, and 1 instead of 0, 1, and 2. If the target uses the routines
b3f8d95d
MM
5151in @file{libgcc.a}, you do not need to define this macro.
5152@end defmac
5153
30b8f78b
KV
5154@defmac TARGET_HAS_NO_HW_DIVIDE
5155This macro should be defined if the target has no hardware divide
5156instructions. If this macro is defined, GCC will use an algorithm which
5157make use of simple logical and arithmetic operations for 64-bit
5158division. If the macro is not defined, GCC will use an algorithm which
5159make use of a 64-bit by 32-bit divide primitive.
5160@end defmac
5161
feca2ed3 5162@cindex @code{EDOM}, implicit usage
a2c4f8e0
ZW
5163@findex matherr
5164@defmac TARGET_EDOM
feca2ed3 5165The value of @code{EDOM} on the target machine, as a C integer constant
a3a15b4d 5166expression. If you don't define this macro, GCC does not attempt to
feca2ed3
JW
5167deposit the value of @code{EDOM} into @code{errno} directly. Look in
5168@file{/usr/include/errno.h} to find the value of @code{EDOM} on your
5169system.
5170
5171If you do not define @code{TARGET_EDOM}, then compiled code reports
5172domain errors by calling the library function and letting it report the
5173error. If mathematical functions on your system use @code{matherr} when
5174there is an error, then you should leave @code{TARGET_EDOM} undefined so
5175that @code{matherr} is used normally.
a2c4f8e0 5176@end defmac
feca2ed3 5177
feca2ed3 5178@cindex @code{errno}, implicit usage
a2c4f8e0 5179@defmac GEN_ERRNO_RTX
feca2ed3
JW
5180Define this macro as a C expression to create an rtl expression that
5181refers to the global ``variable'' @code{errno}. (On certain systems,
5182@code{errno} may not actually be a variable.) If you don't define this
5183macro, a reasonable default is used.
a2c4f8e0 5184@end defmac
feca2ed3 5185
d33d9e47
AI
5186@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LIBC_HAS_FUNCTION (enum function_class @var{fn_class})
5187This hook determines whether a function from a class of functions
5188@var{fn_class} is present at the runtime.
5189@end deftypefn
006339cd 5190
a2c4f8e0 5191@defmac NEXT_OBJC_RUNTIME
fea3ca91
IS
5192Set this macro to 1 to use the "NeXT" Objective-C message sending conventions
5193by default. This calling convention involves passing the object, the selector
5194and the method arguments all at once to the method-lookup library function.
5195This is the usual setting when targeting Darwin/Mac OS X systems, which have
5196the NeXT runtime installed.
5197
5198If the macro is set to 0, the "GNU" Objective-C message sending convention
5199will be used by default. This convention passes just the object and the
5200selector to the method-lookup function, which returns a pointer to the method.
5201
5202In either case, it remains possible to select code-generation for the alternate
5203scheme, by means of compiler command line switches.
a2c4f8e0 5204@end defmac
feca2ed3
JW
5205
5206@node Addressing Modes
5207@section Addressing Modes
5208@cindex addressing modes
5209
5210@c prevent bad page break with this line
5211This is about addressing modes.
5212
a2c4f8e0
ZW
5213@defmac HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT
5214@defmacx HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT
5215@defmacx HAVE_POST_INCREMENT
5216@defmacx HAVE_POST_DECREMENT
df2a54e9 5217A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre-increment,
7a6bd5ae 5218pre-decrement, post-increment, or post-decrement addressing respectively.
a2c4f8e0 5219@end defmac
feca2ed3 5220
a2c4f8e0
ZW
5221@defmac HAVE_PRE_MODIFY_DISP
5222@defmacx HAVE_POST_MODIFY_DISP
df2a54e9 5223A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre- or
7a6bd5ae
JL
5224post-address side-effect generation involving constants other than
5225the size of the memory operand.
a2c4f8e0 5226@end defmac
864bcaa7 5227
a2c4f8e0
ZW
5228@defmac HAVE_PRE_MODIFY_REG
5229@defmacx HAVE_POST_MODIFY_REG
df2a54e9 5230A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre- or
7a6bd5ae 5231post-address side-effect generation involving a register displacement.
a2c4f8e0 5232@end defmac
864bcaa7 5233
a2c4f8e0 5234@defmac CONSTANT_ADDRESS_P (@var{x})
feca2ed3 5235A C expression that is 1 if the RTX @var{x} is a constant which
65a324b4
NC
5236is a valid address. On most machines the default definition of
5237@code{(CONSTANT_P (@var{x}) && GET_CODE (@var{x}) != CONST_DOUBLE)}
5238is acceptable, but a few machines are more restrictive as to which
ff2ce160 5239constant addresses are supported.
a2c4f8e0 5240@end defmac
feca2ed3 5241
a2c4f8e0
ZW
5242@defmac CONSTANT_P (@var{x})
5243@code{CONSTANT_P}, which is defined by target-independent code,
5244accepts integer-values expressions whose values are not explicitly
5245known, such as @code{symbol_ref}, @code{label_ref}, and @code{high}
5246expressions and @code{const} arithmetic expressions, in addition to
5247@code{const_int} and @code{const_double} expressions.
5248@end defmac
feca2ed3 5249
a2c4f8e0 5250@defmac MAX_REGS_PER_ADDRESS
feca2ed3
JW
5251A number, the maximum number of registers that can appear in a valid
5252memory address. Note that it is up to you to specify a value equal to
c6c3dba9 5253the maximum number that @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P} would ever
feca2ed3 5254accept.
a2c4f8e0 5255@end defmac
feca2ed3 5256
914d25dc 5257@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{x}, bool @var{strict})
c6c3dba9
PB
5258A function that returns whether @var{x} (an RTX) is a legitimate memory
5259address on the target machine for a memory operand of mode @var{mode}.
feca2ed3 5260
c6c3dba9 5261Legitimate addresses are defined in two variants: a strict variant and a
914d25dc 5262non-strict one. The @var{strict} parameter chooses which variant is
c6c3dba9 5263desired by the caller.
feca2ed3 5264
c6c3dba9
PB
5265The strict variant is used in the reload pass. It must be defined so
5266that any pseudo-register that has not been allocated a hard register is
5267considered a memory reference. This is because in contexts where some
5268kind of register is required, a pseudo-register with no hard register
5269must be rejected. For non-hard registers, the strict variant should look
5270up the @code{reg_renumber} array; it should then proceed using the hard
5271register number in the array, or treat the pseudo as a memory reference
5272if the array holds @code{-1}.
feca2ed3
JW
5273
5274The non-strict variant is used in other passes. It must be defined to
5275accept all pseudo-registers in every context where some kind of
5276register is required.
5277
feca2ed3
JW
5278Normally, constant addresses which are the sum of a @code{symbol_ref}
5279and an integer are stored inside a @code{const} RTX to mark them as
5280constant. Therefore, there is no need to recognize such sums
5281specifically as legitimate addresses. Normally you would simply
5282recognize any @code{const} as legitimate.
5283
5284Usually @code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS} is not prepared to handle constant
5285sums that are not marked with @code{const}. It assumes that a naked
5286@code{plus} indicates indexing. If so, then you @emph{must} reject such
5287naked constant sums as illegitimate addresses, so that none of them will
5288be given to @code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS}.
5289
fb49053f 5290@cindex @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} and address validation
feca2ed3
JW
5291On some machines, whether a symbolic address is legitimate depends on
5292the section that the address refers to. On these machines, define the
fb49053f
RH
5293target hook @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} to store the information
5294into the @code{symbol_ref}, and then check for it here. When you see a
feca2ed3
JW
5295@code{const}, you will have to look inside it to find the
5296@code{symbol_ref} in order to determine the section. @xref{Assembler
5297Format}.
c6c3dba9
PB
5298
5299@cindex @code{GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS}
5300Some ports are still using a deprecated legacy substitute for
5301this hook, the @code{GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS} macro. This macro
5302has this syntax:
5303
5304@example
5305#define GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS (@var{mode}, @var{x}, @var{label})
5306@end example
5307
5308@noindent
5309and should @code{goto @var{label}} if the address @var{x} is a valid
5310address on the target machine for a memory operand of mode @var{mode}.
6f7b223b
PK
5311
5312@findex REG_OK_STRICT
5313Compiler source files that want to use the strict variant of this
5314macro define the macro @code{REG_OK_STRICT}. You should use an
5315@code{#ifdef REG_OK_STRICT} conditional to define the strict variant in
5316that case and the non-strict variant otherwise.
5317
c6c3dba9
PB
5318Using the hook is usually simpler because it limits the number of
5319files that are recompiled when changes are made.
5320@end deftypefn
feca2ed3 5321
a4edaf83
AK
5322@defmac TARGET_MEM_CONSTRAINT
5323A single character to be used instead of the default @code{'m'}
5324character for general memory addresses. This defines the constraint
5325letter which matches the memory addresses accepted by
c6c3dba9 5326@code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P}. Define this macro if you want to
a4edaf83
AK
5327support new address formats in your back end without changing the
5328semantics of the @code{'m'} constraint. This is necessary in order to
5329preserve functionality of inline assembly constructs using the
5330@code{'m'} constraint.
5331@end defmac
5332
a2c4f8e0 5333@defmac FIND_BASE_TERM (@var{x})
a9e6fc5a
RS
5334A C expression to determine the base term of address @var{x},
5335or to provide a simplified version of @var{x} from which @file{alias.c}
53451050
RS
5336can easily find the base term. This macro is used in only two places:
5337@code{find_base_value} and @code{find_base_term} in @file{alias.c}.
b949ea8b
JW
5338
5339It is always safe for this macro to not be defined. It exists so
5340that alias analysis can understand machine-dependent addresses.
5341
5342The typical use of this macro is to handle addresses containing
161d7b59 5343a label_ref or symbol_ref within an UNSPEC@.
a2c4f8e0 5344@end defmac
b949ea8b 5345
506d7b68
PB
5346@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS (rtx @var{x}, rtx @var{oldx}, enum machine_mode @var{mode})
5347This hook is given an invalid memory address @var{x} for an
5348operand of mode @var{mode} and should try to return a valid memory
5349address.
feca2ed3
JW
5350
5351@findex break_out_memory_refs
5352@var{x} will always be the result of a call to @code{break_out_memory_refs},
5353and @var{oldx} will be the operand that was given to that function to produce
5354@var{x}.
5355
506d7b68 5356The code of the hook should not alter the substructure of
feca2ed3 5357@var{x}. If it transforms @var{x} into a more legitimate form, it
506d7b68 5358should return the new @var{x}.
feca2ed3 5359
f938987f
HPN
5360It is not necessary for this hook to come up with a legitimate address,
5361with the exception of native TLS addresses (@pxref{Emulated TLS}).
5362The compiler has standard ways of doing so in all cases. In fact, if
5363the target supports only emulated TLS, it
506d7b68
PB
5364is safe to omit this hook or make it return @var{x} if it cannot find
5365a valid way to legitimize the address. But often a machine-dependent
5366strategy can generate better code.
5367@end deftypefn
feca2ed3 5368
a2c4f8e0 5369@defmac LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS (@var{x}, @var{mode}, @var{opnum}, @var{type}, @var{ind_levels}, @var{win})
a9a2595b
JR
5370A C compound statement that attempts to replace @var{x}, which is an address
5371that needs reloading, with a valid memory address for an operand of mode
5372@var{mode}. @var{win} will be a C statement label elsewhere in the code.
5373It is not necessary to define this macro, but it might be useful for
02f52e19 5374performance reasons.
a9a2595b
JR
5375
5376For example, on the i386, it is sometimes possible to use a single
5377reload register instead of two by reloading a sum of two pseudo
5378registers into a register. On the other hand, for number of RISC
5379processors offsets are limited so that often an intermediate address
5380needs to be generated in order to address a stack slot. By defining
aee96fe9 5381@code{LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS} appropriately, the intermediate addresses
a9a2595b
JR
5382generated for adjacent some stack slots can be made identical, and thus
5383be shared.
5384
39bdfaa0
RH
5385@emph{Note}: This macro should be used with caution. It is necessary
5386to know something of how reload works in order to effectively use this,
5387and it is quite easy to produce macros that build in too much knowledge
5388of reload internals.
a9a2595b 5389
5f0c590d
JL
5390@emph{Note}: This macro must be able to reload an address created by a
5391previous invocation of this macro. If it fails to handle such addresses
5392then the compiler may generate incorrect code or abort.
5393
a9a2595b 5394@findex push_reload
39bdfaa0
RH
5395The macro definition should use @code{push_reload} to indicate parts that
5396need reloading; @var{opnum}, @var{type} and @var{ind_levels} are usually
5397suitable to be passed unaltered to @code{push_reload}.
a9a2595b 5398
39bdfaa0 5399The code generated by this macro must not alter the substructure of
a9a2595b
JR
5400@var{x}. If it transforms @var{x} into a more legitimate form, it
5401should assign @var{x} (which will always be a C variable) a new value.
5402This also applies to parts that you change indirectly by calling
5403@code{push_reload}.
5404
39bdfaa0
RH
5405@findex strict_memory_address_p
5406The macro definition may use @code{strict_memory_address_p} to test if
5407the address has become legitimate.
5408
a9a2595b
JR
5409@findex copy_rtx
5410If you want to change only a part of @var{x}, one standard way of doing
ab873839 5411this is to use @code{copy_rtx}. Note, however, that it unshares only a
a9a2595b 5412single level of rtl. Thus, if the part to be changed is not at the
c771326b 5413top level, you'll need to replace first the top level.
a9a2595b
JR
5414It is not necessary for this macro to come up with a legitimate
5415address; but often a machine-dependent strategy can generate better code.
a2c4f8e0 5416@end defmac
a9a2595b 5417
5bfed9a9
GJL
5418@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_MODE_DEPENDENT_ADDRESS_P (const_rtx @var{addr}, addr_space_t @var{addrspace})
5419This hook returns @code{true} if memory address @var{addr} in address
5420space @var{addrspace} can have
cbda7dc6
AS
5421different meanings depending on the machine mode of the memory
5422reference it is used for or if the address is valid for some modes
5423but not others.
5424
5425Autoincrement and autodecrement addresses typically have mode-dependent
5426effects because the amount of the increment or decrement is the size
5427of the operand being addressed. Some machines have other mode-dependent
5428addresses. Many RISC machines have no mode-dependent addresses.
5429
5430You may assume that @var{addr} is a valid address for the machine.
5431
5432The default version of this hook returns @code{false}.
5433@end deftypefn
5434
1a627b35
RS
5435@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{x})
5436This hook returns true if @var{x} is a legitimate constant for a
5437@var{mode}-mode immediate operand on the target machine. You can assume that
5438@var{x} satisfies @code{CONSTANT_P}, so you need not check this.
5439
5440The default definition returns true.
5441@end deftypefn
feca2ed3 5442
73f8783a
RS
5443@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_DELEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS (rtx @var{x})
5444This hook is used to undo the possibly obfuscating effects of the
5445@code{LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS} and @code{LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS} target
5446macros. Some backend implementations of these macros wrap symbol
5447references inside an @code{UNSPEC} rtx to represent PIC or similar
5448addressing modes. This target hook allows GCC's optimizers to understand
5449the semantics of these opaque @code{UNSPEC}s by converting them back
5450into their original form.
5451@end deftypefn
93bcc8c9
JJ
5452
5453@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CONST_NOT_OK_FOR_DEBUG_P (rtx @var{x})
5454This hook should return true if @var{x} should not be emitted into
5455debug sections.
5456@end deftypefn
73f8783a 5457
fbbf66e7 5458@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CANNOT_FORCE_CONST_MEM (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{x})
d3da4d14 5459This hook should return true if @var{x} is of a form that cannot (or
fbbf66e7
RS
5460should not) be spilled to the constant pool. @var{mode} is the mode
5461of @var{x}.
5462
5463The default version of this hook returns false.
d3da4d14
RH
5464
5465The primary reason to define this hook is to prevent reload from
5466deciding that a non-legitimate constant would be better reloaded
5467from the constant pool instead of spilling and reloading a register
5468holding the constant. This restriction is often true of addresses
5469of TLS symbols for various targets.
5470@end deftypefn
5471
b6fd8800 5472@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_USE_BLOCKS_FOR_CONSTANT_P (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, const_rtx @var{x})
aacd3885
RS
5473This hook should return true if pool entries for constant @var{x} can
5474be placed in an @code{object_block} structure. @var{mode} is the mode
5475of @var{x}.
5476
5477The default version returns false for all constants.
5478@end deftypefn
5479
361a58da
DE
5480@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_USE_BLOCKS_FOR_DECL_P (const_tree @var{decl})
5481This hook should return true if pool entries for @var{decl} should
5482be placed in an @code{object_block} structure.
5483
5484The default version returns true for all decls.
5485@end deftypefn
5486
5eb7ce91 5487@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_BUILTIN_RECIPROCAL (unsigned @var{fn}, bool @var{md_fn}, bool @var{sqrt})
6b889d89 5488This hook should return the DECL of a function that implements reciprocal of
ac10986f 5489the builtin function with builtin function code @var{fn}, or
5eb7ce91 5490@code{NULL_TREE} if such a function is not available. @var{md_fn} is true
ac10986f
UB
5491when @var{fn} is a code of a machine-dependent builtin function. When
5492@var{sqrt} is true, additional optimizations that apply only to the reciprocal
5493of a square root function are performed, and only reciprocals of @code{sqrt}
5494function are valid.
6b889d89
UB
5495@end deftypefn
5496
d16b59fa
DN
5497@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_MASK_FOR_LOAD (void)
5498This hook should return the DECL of a function @var{f} that given an
5499address @var{addr} as an argument returns a mask @var{m} that can be
083cad55 5500used to extract from two vectors the relevant data that resides in
d16b59fa
DN
5501@var{addr} in case @var{addr} is not properly aligned.
5502
ab873839 5503The autovectorizer, when vectorizing a load operation from an address
d16b59fa
DN
5504@var{addr} that may be unaligned, will generate two vector loads from
5505the two aligned addresses around @var{addr}. It then generates a
5506@code{REALIGN_LOAD} operation to extract the relevant data from the
5507two loaded vectors. The first two arguments to @code{REALIGN_LOAD},
5508@var{v1} and @var{v2}, are the two vectors, each of size @var{VS}, and
5509the third argument, @var{OFF}, defines how the data will be extracted
5510from these two vectors: if @var{OFF} is 0, then the returned vector is
083cad55
EC
5511@var{v2}; otherwise, the returned vector is composed from the last
5512@var{VS}-@var{OFF} elements of @var{v1} concatenated to the first
d16b59fa
DN
5513@var{OFF} elements of @var{v2}.
5514
5515If this hook is defined, the autovectorizer will generate a call
5516to @var{f} (using the DECL tree that this hook returns) and will
5517use the return value of @var{f} as the argument @var{OFF} to
5518@code{REALIGN_LOAD}. Therefore, the mask @var{m} returned by @var{f}
083cad55 5519should comply with the semantics expected by @code{REALIGN_LOAD}
d16b59fa
DN
5520described above.
5521If this hook is not defined, then @var{addr} will be used as
5522the argument @var{OFF} to @code{REALIGN_LOAD}, in which case the low
8ad1dde7 5523log2(@var{VS}) @minus{} 1 bits of @var{addr} will be considered.
d16b59fa
DN
5524@end deftypefn
5525
720f5239 5526@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_VECTORIZATION_COST (enum vect_cost_for_stmt @var{type_of_cost}, tree @var{vectype}, int @var{misalign})
35e1a5e7 5527Returns cost of different scalar or vector statements for vectorization cost model.
ff2ce160 5528For vector memory operations the cost may depend on type (@var{vectype}) and
720f5239 5529misalignment value (@var{misalign}).
a934eb2d
JR
5530@end deftypefn
5531
5532@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VECTORIZE_VECTOR_ALIGNMENT_REACHABLE (const_tree @var{type}, bool @var{is_packed})
5533Return true if vector alignment is reachable (by peeling N iterations) for the given type.
5534@end deftypefn
5535
22e4dee7 5536@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VECTORIZE_VEC_PERM_CONST_OK (enum @var{machine_mode}, const unsigned char *@var{sel})
5dea5b2a 5537Return true if a vector created for @code{vec_perm_const} is valid.
a934eb2d
JR
5538@end deftypefn
5539
88dd7150 5540@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_CONVERSION (unsigned @var{code}, tree @var{dest_type}, tree @var{src_type})
f57d17f1 5541This hook should return the DECL of a function that implements conversion of the
88dd7150 5542input vector of type @var{src_type} to type @var{dest_type}.
a934eb2d
JR
5543The value of @var{code} is one of the enumerators in @code{enum tree_code} and
5544specifies how the conversion is to be applied
f57d17f1
TM
5545(truncation, rounding, etc.).
5546
5547If this hook is defined, the autovectorizer will use the
5548@code{TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_CONVERSION} target hook when vectorizing
5549conversion. Otherwise, it will return @code{NULL_TREE}.
5550@end deftypefn
5551
62f7fd21
MM
5552@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_VECTORIZED_FUNCTION (tree @var{fndecl}, tree @var{vec_type_out}, tree @var{vec_type_in})
5553This hook should return the decl of a function that implements the
5554vectorized variant of the builtin function with builtin function code
5555@var{code} or @code{NULL_TREE} if such a function is not available.
5556The value of @var{fndecl} is the builtin function declaration. The
5557return type of the vectorized function shall be of vector type
5558@var{vec_type_out} and the argument types should be @var{vec_type_in}.
2505a3f2
RG
5559@end deftypefn
5560
38f8b050 5561@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VECTORIZE_SUPPORT_VECTOR_MISALIGNMENT (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type}, int @var{misalignment}, bool @var{is_packed})
0601d0cf
RE
5562This hook should return true if the target supports misaligned vector
5563store/load of a specific factor denoted in the @var{misalignment}
5564parameter. The vector store/load should be of machine mode @var{mode} and
5565the elements in the vectors should be of type @var{type}. @var{is_packed}
5566parameter is true if the memory access is defined in a packed struct.
5567@end deftypefn
5568
cc4b5170
RG
5569@deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum machine_mode} TARGET_VECTORIZE_PREFERRED_SIMD_MODE (enum machine_mode @var{mode})
5570This hook should return the preferred mode for vectorizing scalar
5571mode @var{mode}. The default is
5572equal to @code{word_mode}, because the vectorizer can do some
26983c22
L
5573transformations even in absence of specialized @acronym{SIMD} hardware.
5574@end deftypefn
5575
767f865f
RG
5576@deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_VECTORIZE_AUTOVECTORIZE_VECTOR_SIZES (void)
5577This hook should return a mask of sizes that should be iterated over
5578after trying to autovectorize using the vector size derived from the
5579mode returned by @code{TARGET_VECTORIZE_PREFERRED_SIMD_MODE}.
5580The default is zero which means to not iterate over other vector sizes.
5581@end deftypefn
5582
c3e7ee41 5583@deftypefn {Target Hook} {void *} TARGET_VECTORIZE_INIT_COST (struct loop *@var{loop_info})
92345349 5584This hook should initialize target-specific data structures in preparation for modeling the costs of vectorizing a loop or basic block. The default allocates three unsigned integers for accumulating costs for the prologue, body, and epilogue of the loop or basic block. If @var{loop_info} is non-NULL, it identifies the loop being vectorized; otherwise a single block is being vectorized.
c3e7ee41
BS
5585@end deftypefn
5586
92345349
BS
5587@deftypefn {Target Hook} unsigned TARGET_VECTORIZE_ADD_STMT_COST (void *@var{data}, int @var{count}, enum vect_cost_for_stmt @var{kind}, struct _stmt_vec_info *@var{stmt_info}, int @var{misalign}, enum vect_cost_model_location @var{where})
5588This hook should update the target-specific @var{data} in response to adding @var{count} copies of the given @var{kind} of statement to a loop or basic block. The default adds the builtin vectorizer cost for the copies of the statement to the accumulator specified by @var{where}, (the prologue, body, or epilogue) and returns the amount added. The return value should be viewed as a tentative cost that may later be revised.
c3e7ee41
BS
5589@end deftypefn
5590
92345349
BS
5591@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_VECTORIZE_FINISH_COST (void *@var{data}, unsigned *@var{prologue_cost}, unsigned *@var{body_cost}, unsigned *@var{epilogue_cost})
5592This hook should complete calculations of the cost of vectorizing a loop or basic block based on @var{data}, and return the prologue, body, and epilogue costs as unsigned integers. The default returns the value of the three accumulators.
c3e7ee41
BS
5593@end deftypefn
5594
5595@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_VECTORIZE_DESTROY_COST_DATA (void *@var{data})
5596This hook should release @var{data} and any related data structures allocated by TARGET_VECTORIZE_INIT_COST. The default releases the accumulator.
5597@end deftypefn
5598
0a35513e
AH
5599@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_TM_LOAD (tree)
5600This hook should return the built-in decl needed to load a vector of the given type within a transaction.
5601@end deftypefn
5602
5603@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_TM_STORE (tree)
5604This hook should return the built-in decl needed to store a vector of the given type within a transaction.
5605@end deftypefn
5606
aec7ae7d
JJ
5607@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_GATHER (const_tree @var{mem_vectype}, const_tree @var{index_type}, int @var{scale})
5608Target builtin that implements vector gather operation. @var{mem_vectype}
5609is the vector type of the load and @var{index_type} is scalar type of
5610the index, scaled by @var{scale}.
5611The default is @code{NULL_TREE} which means to not vectorize gather
5612loads.
5613@end deftypefn
5614
0136f8f0
AH
5615@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SIMD_CLONE_COMPUTE_VECSIZE_AND_SIMDLEN (struct cgraph_node *@var{}, struct cgraph_simd_clone *@var{}, @var{tree}, @var{int})
5616This hook should set @var{vecsize_mangle}, @var{vecsize_int}, @var{vecsize_float}
5617fields in @var{simd_clone} structure pointed by @var{clone_info} argument and also
5618@var{simdlen} field if it was previously 0.
5619The hook should return 0 if SIMD clones shouldn't be emitted,
5620or number of @var{vecsize_mangle} variants that should be emitted.
5621@end deftypefn
5622
5623@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SIMD_CLONE_ADJUST (struct cgraph_node *@var{})
5624This hook should add implicit @code{attribute(target("..."))} attribute
5625to SIMD clone @var{node} if needed.
5626@end deftypefn
5627
5628@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SIMD_CLONE_USABLE (struct cgraph_node *@var{})
5629This hook should return -1 if SIMD clone @var{node} shouldn't be used
5630in vectorized loops in current function, or non-negative number if it is
5631usable. In that case, the smaller the number is, the more desirable it is
5632to use it.
5633@end deftypefn
5634
aacd3885
RS
5635@node Anchored Addresses
5636@section Anchored Addresses
5637@cindex anchored addresses
5638@cindex @option{-fsection-anchors}
5639
5640GCC usually addresses every static object as a separate entity.
5641For example, if we have:
5642
5643@smallexample
5644static int a, b, c;
5645int foo (void) @{ return a + b + c; @}
5646@end smallexample
5647
5648the code for @code{foo} will usually calculate three separate symbolic
5649addresses: those of @code{a}, @code{b} and @code{c}. On some targets,
5650it would be better to calculate just one symbolic address and access
5651the three variables relative to it. The equivalent pseudocode would
5652be something like:
5653
5654@smallexample
5655int foo (void)
5656@{
5657 register int *xr = &x;
5658 return xr[&a - &x] + xr[&b - &x] + xr[&c - &x];
5659@}
5660@end smallexample
5661
5662(which isn't valid C). We refer to shared addresses like @code{x} as
5663``section anchors''. Their use is controlled by @option{-fsection-anchors}.
5664
5665The hooks below describe the target properties that GCC needs to know
5666in order to make effective use of section anchors. It won't use
5667section anchors at all unless either @code{TARGET_MIN_ANCHOR_OFFSET}
5668or @code{TARGET_MAX_ANCHOR_OFFSET} is set to a nonzero value.
5669
9e3be889 5670@deftypevr {Target Hook} HOST_WIDE_INT TARGET_MIN_ANCHOR_OFFSET
aacd3885
RS
5671The minimum offset that should be applied to a section anchor.
5672On most targets, it should be the smallest offset that can be
5673applied to a base register while still giving a legitimate address
5674for every mode. The default value is 0.
9e3be889 5675@end deftypevr
aacd3885 5676
9e3be889 5677@deftypevr {Target Hook} HOST_WIDE_INT TARGET_MAX_ANCHOR_OFFSET
aacd3885
RS
5678Like @code{TARGET_MIN_ANCHOR_OFFSET}, but the maximum (inclusive)
5679offset that should be applied to section anchors. The default
5680value is 0.
9e3be889 5681@end deftypevr
aacd3885
RS
5682
5683@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_ANCHOR (rtx @var{x})
5684Write the assembly code to define section anchor @var{x}, which is a
5685@code{SYMBOL_REF} for which @samp{SYMBOL_REF_ANCHOR_P (@var{x})} is true.
5686The hook is called with the assembly output position set to the beginning
5687of @code{SYMBOL_REF_BLOCK (@var{x})}.
5688
5689If @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} is available, the hook's default definition uses
5690it to define the symbol as @samp{. + SYMBOL_REF_BLOCK_OFFSET (@var{x})}.
5691If @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} is not available, the hook's default definition
5692is @code{NULL}, which disables the use of section anchors altogether.
5693@end deftypefn
5694
b6fd8800 5695@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_USE_ANCHORS_FOR_SYMBOL_P (const_rtx @var{x})
aacd3885 5696Return true if GCC should attempt to use anchors to access @code{SYMBOL_REF}
3fa9c136 5697@var{x}. You can assume @samp{SYMBOL_REF_HAS_BLOCK_INFO_P (@var{x})} and
aacd3885
RS
5698@samp{!SYMBOL_REF_ANCHOR_P (@var{x})}.
5699
5700The default version is correct for most targets, but you might need to
5701intercept this hook to handle things like target-specific attributes
5702or target-specific sections.
5703@end deftypefn
5704
feca2ed3
JW
5705@node Condition Code
5706@section Condition Code Status
5707@cindex condition code status
5708
f90b7a5a
PB
5709The macros in this section can be split in two families, according to the
5710two ways of representing condition codes in GCC.
5711
5712The first representation is the so called @code{(cc0)} representation
5713(@pxref{Jump Patterns}), where all instructions can have an implicit
5714clobber of the condition codes. The second is the condition code
5715register representation, which provides better schedulability for
5716architectures that do have a condition code register, but on which
5717most instructions do not affect it. The latter category includes
5718most RISC machines.
5719
5720The implicit clobbering poses a strong restriction on the placement of
728acca0
MP
5721the definition and use of the condition code. In the past the definition
5722and use were always adjacent. However, recent changes to support trapping
5723arithmatic may result in the definition and user being in different blocks.
5724Thus, there may be a @code{NOTE_INSN_BASIC_BLOCK} between them. Additionally,
5725the definition may be the source of exception handling edges.
5726
5727These restrictions can prevent important
f90b7a5a
PB
5728optimizations on some machines. For example, on the IBM RS/6000, there
5729is a delay for taken branches unless the condition code register is set
5730three instructions earlier than the conditional branch. The instruction
5731scheduler cannot perform this optimization if it is not permitted to
5732separate the definition and use of the condition code register.
5733
5734For this reason, it is possible and suggested to use a register to
5735represent the condition code for new ports. If there is a specific
5736condition code register in the machine, use a hard register. If the
5737condition code or comparison result can be placed in any general register,
5738or if there are multiple condition registers, use a pseudo register.
5739Registers used to store the condition code value will usually have a mode
5740that is in class @code{MODE_CC}.
5741
5742Alternatively, you can use @code{BImode} if the comparison operator is
5743specified already in the compare instruction. In this case, you are not
5744interested in most macros in this section.
5745
5746@menu
5747* CC0 Condition Codes:: Old style representation of condition codes.
5748* MODE_CC Condition Codes:: Modern representation of condition codes.
f90b7a5a
PB
5749@end menu
5750
5751@node CC0 Condition Codes
5752@subsection Representation of condition codes using @code{(cc0)}
5753@findex cc0
feca2ed3
JW
5754
5755@findex cc_status
5756The file @file{conditions.h} defines a variable @code{cc_status} to
5757describe how the condition code was computed (in case the interpretation of
5758the condition code depends on the instruction that it was set by). This
5759variable contains the RTL expressions on which the condition code is
5760currently based, and several standard flags.
5761
5762Sometimes additional machine-specific flags must be defined in the machine
5763description header file. It can also add additional machine-specific
5764information by defining @code{CC_STATUS_MDEP}.
5765
a2c4f8e0 5766@defmac CC_STATUS_MDEP
feca2ed3
JW
5767C code for a data type which is used for declaring the @code{mdep}
5768component of @code{cc_status}. It defaults to @code{int}.
5769
5770This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
a2c4f8e0 5771@end defmac
feca2ed3 5772
a2c4f8e0 5773@defmac CC_STATUS_MDEP_INIT
feca2ed3
JW
5774A C expression to initialize the @code{mdep} field to ``empty''.
5775The default definition does nothing, since most machines don't use
5776the field anyway. If you want to use the field, you should probably
5777define this macro to initialize it.
5778
5779This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
a2c4f8e0 5780@end defmac
feca2ed3 5781
a2c4f8e0 5782@defmac NOTICE_UPDATE_CC (@var{exp}, @var{insn})
feca2ed3
JW
5783A C compound statement to set the components of @code{cc_status}
5784appropriately for an insn @var{insn} whose body is @var{exp}. It is
5785this macro's responsibility to recognize insns that set the condition
5786code as a byproduct of other activity as well as those that explicitly
5787set @code{(cc0)}.
5788
5789This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
5790
5791If there are insns that do not set the condition code but do alter
5792other machine registers, this macro must check to see whether they
5793invalidate the expressions that the condition code is recorded as
5794reflecting. For example, on the 68000, insns that store in address
5795registers do not set the condition code, which means that usually
5796@code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} can leave @code{cc_status} unaltered for such
5797insns. But suppose that the previous insn set the condition code
5798based on location @samp{a4@@(102)} and the current insn stores a new
5799value in @samp{a4}. Although the condition code is not changed by
5800this, it will no longer be true that it reflects the contents of
5801@samp{a4@@(102)}. Therefore, @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} must alter
5802@code{cc_status} in this case to say that nothing is known about the
5803condition code value.
5804
5805The definition of @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} must be prepared to deal
5806with the results of peephole optimization: insns whose patterns are
5807@code{parallel} RTXs containing various @code{reg}, @code{mem} or
5808constants which are just the operands. The RTL structure of these
5809insns is not sufficient to indicate what the insns actually do. What
5810@code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} should do when it sees one is just to run
5811@code{CC_STATUS_INIT}.
5812
5813A possible definition of @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} is to call a function
5814that looks at an attribute (@pxref{Insn Attributes}) named, for example,
5815@samp{cc}. This avoids having detailed information about patterns in
5816two places, the @file{md} file and in @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC}.
a2c4f8e0 5817@end defmac
feca2ed3 5818
f90b7a5a
PB
5819@node MODE_CC Condition Codes
5820@subsection Representation of condition codes using registers
5821@findex CCmode
5822@findex MODE_CC
5823
a2c4f8e0 5824@defmac SELECT_CC_MODE (@var{op}, @var{x}, @var{y})
f90b7a5a
PB
5825On many machines, the condition code may be produced by other instructions
5826than compares, for example the branch can use directly the condition
5827code set by a subtract instruction. However, on some machines
5828when the condition code is set this way some bits (such as the overflow
5829bit) are not set in the same way as a test instruction, so that a different
5830branch instruction must be used for some conditional branches. When
5831this happens, use the machine mode of the condition code register to
5832record different formats of the condition code register. Modes can
5833also be used to record which compare instruction (e.g. a signed or an
5834unsigned comparison) produced the condition codes.
5835
5836If other modes than @code{CCmode} are required, add them to
5837@file{@var{machine}-modes.def} and define @code{SELECT_CC_MODE} to choose
5838a mode given an operand of a compare. This is needed because the modes
5839have to be chosen not only during RTL generation but also, for example,
5840by instruction combination. The result of @code{SELECT_CC_MODE} should
5841be consistent with the mode used in the patterns; for example to support
5842the case of the add on the SPARC discussed above, we have the pattern
5843
5844@smallexample
5845(define_insn ""
5846 [(set (reg:CC_NOOV 0)
5847 (compare:CC_NOOV
5848 (plus:SI (match_operand:SI 0 "register_operand" "%r")
5849 (match_operand:SI 1 "arith_operand" "rI"))
5850 (const_int 0)))]
5851 ""
5852 "@dots{}")
5853@end smallexample
5854
5855@noindent
5856together with a @code{SELECT_CC_MODE} that returns @code{CC_NOOVmode}
5857for comparisons whose argument is a @code{plus}:
feca2ed3
JW
5858
5859@smallexample
5860#define SELECT_CC_MODE(OP,X,Y) \
5861 (GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (X)) == MODE_FLOAT \
5862 ? ((OP == EQ || OP == NE) ? CCFPmode : CCFPEmode) \
5863 : ((GET_CODE (X) == PLUS || GET_CODE (X) == MINUS \
5864 || GET_CODE (X) == NEG) \
5865 ? CC_NOOVmode : CCmode))
5866@end smallexample
5867
f90b7a5a
PB
5868Another reason to use modes is to retain information on which operands
5869were used by the comparison; see @code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE} later in
5870this section.
5871
94134f42
ZW
5872You should define this macro if and only if you define extra CC modes
5873in @file{@var{machine}-modes.def}.
a2c4f8e0 5874@end defmac
feca2ed3 5875
d331d374 5876@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_CANONICALIZE_COMPARISON (int *@var{code}, rtx *@var{op0}, rtx *@var{op1}, bool @var{op0_preserve_value})
8760eaae 5877On some machines not all possible comparisons are defined, but you can
feca2ed3
JW
5878convert an invalid comparison into a valid one. For example, the Alpha
5879does not have a @code{GT} comparison, but you can use an @code{LT}
5880comparison instead and swap the order of the operands.
5881
c354951b
AK
5882On such machines, implement this hook to do any required conversions.
5883@var{code} is the initial comparison code and @var{op0} and @var{op1}
5884are the left and right operands of the comparison, respectively. If
5885@var{op0_preserve_value} is @code{true} the implementation is not
5886allowed to change the value of @var{op0} since the value might be used
5887in RTXs which aren't comparisons. E.g. the implementation is not
5888allowed to swap operands in that case.
feca2ed3 5889
a3a15b4d 5890GCC will not assume that the comparison resulting from this macro is
feca2ed3
JW
5891valid but will see if the resulting insn matches a pattern in the
5892@file{md} file.
5893
c354951b
AK
5894You need not to implement this hook if it would never change the
5895comparison code or operands.
5896@end deftypefn
feca2ed3 5897
a2c4f8e0 5898@defmac REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})
feca2ed3
JW
5899A C expression whose value is one if it is always safe to reverse a
5900comparison whose mode is @var{mode}. If @code{SELECT_CC_MODE}
5901can ever return @var{mode} for a floating-point inequality comparison,
5902then @code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})} must be zero.
5903
5904You need not define this macro if it would always returns zero or if the
5905floating-point format is anything other than @code{IEEE_FLOAT_FORMAT}.
981f6289 5906For example, here is the definition used on the SPARC, where floating-point
feca2ed3
JW
5907inequality comparisons are always given @code{CCFPEmode}:
5908
5909@smallexample
5910#define REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE(MODE) ((MODE) != CCFPEmode)
5911@end smallexample
a2c4f8e0 5912@end defmac
feca2ed3 5913
a2c4f8e0 5914@defmac REVERSE_CONDITION (@var{code}, @var{mode})
9e7adcb3
JH
5915A C expression whose value is reversed condition code of the @var{code} for
5916comparison done in CC_MODE @var{mode}. The macro is used only in case
5917@code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})} is nonzero. Define this macro in case
5918machine has some non-standard way how to reverse certain conditionals. For
5919instance in case all floating point conditions are non-trapping, compiler may
5920freely convert unordered compares to ordered one. Then definition may look
5921like:
5922
5923@smallexample
5924#define REVERSE_CONDITION(CODE, MODE) \
c771326b 5925 ((MODE) != CCFPmode ? reverse_condition (CODE) \
9e7adcb3
JH
5926 : reverse_condition_maybe_unordered (CODE))
5927@end smallexample
a2c4f8e0 5928@end defmac
9e7adcb3 5929
ab7e224a 5930@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FIXED_CONDITION_CODE_REGS (unsigned int *@var{p1}, unsigned int *@var{p2})
e129d93a
ILT
5931On targets which do not use @code{(cc0)}, and which use a hard
5932register rather than a pseudo-register to hold condition codes, the
5933regular CSE passes are often not able to identify cases in which the
5934hard register is set to a common value. Use this hook to enable a
5935small pass which optimizes such cases. This hook should return true
5936to enable this pass, and it should set the integers to which its
5937arguments point to the hard register numbers used for condition codes.
5938When there is only one such register, as is true on most systems, the
ab7e224a 5939integer pointed to by @var{p2} should be set to
e129d93a
ILT
5940@code{INVALID_REGNUM}.
5941
5942The default version of this hook returns false.
5943@end deftypefn
5944
ab7e224a 5945@deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum machine_mode} TARGET_CC_MODES_COMPATIBLE (enum machine_mode @var{m1}, enum machine_mode @var{m2})
e129d93a
ILT
5946On targets which use multiple condition code modes in class
5947@code{MODE_CC}, it is sometimes the case that a comparison can be
5948validly done in more than one mode. On such a system, define this
5949target hook to take two mode arguments and to return a mode in which
5950both comparisons may be validly done. If there is no such mode,
5951return @code{VOIDmode}.
5952
5953The default version of this hook checks whether the modes are the
5954same. If they are, it returns that mode. If they are different, it
5955returns @code{VOIDmode}.
5956@end deftypefn
5957
feca2ed3
JW
5958@node Costs
5959@section Describing Relative Costs of Operations
5960@cindex costs of instructions
5961@cindex relative costs
5962@cindex speed of instructions
5963
5964These macros let you describe the relative speed of various operations
5965on the target machine.
5966
a2c4f8e0 5967@defmac REGISTER_MOVE_COST (@var{mode}, @var{from}, @var{to})
e56b4594
AO
5968A C expression for the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode} from a
5969register in class @var{from} to one in class @var{to}. The classes are
5970expressed using the enumeration values such as @code{GENERAL_REGS}. A
5971value of 2 is the default; other values are interpreted relative to
5972that.
feca2ed3
JW
5973
5974It is not required that the cost always equal 2 when @var{from} is the
5975same as @var{to}; on some machines it is expensive to move between
5976registers if they are not general registers.
5977
5978If reload sees an insn consisting of a single @code{set} between two
5979hard registers, and if @code{REGISTER_MOVE_COST} applied to their
5980classes returns a value of 2, reload does not check to ensure that the
5981constraints of the insn are met. Setting a cost of other than 2 will
5982allow reload to verify that the constraints are met. You should do this
5983if the @samp{mov@var{m}} pattern's constraints do not allow such copying.
de8f4b07
AS
5984
5985These macros are obsolete, new ports should use the target hook
5986@code{TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST} instead.
a2c4f8e0 5987@end defmac
feca2ed3 5988
a87cf97e 5989@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, reg_class_t @var{from}, reg_class_t @var{to})
de8f4b07
AS
5990This target hook should return the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode}
5991from a register in class @var{from} to one in class @var{to}. The classes
5992are expressed using the enumeration values such as @code{GENERAL_REGS}.
5993A value of 2 is the default; other values are interpreted relative to
5994that.
5995
5996It is not required that the cost always equal 2 when @var{from} is the
5997same as @var{to}; on some machines it is expensive to move between
5998registers if they are not general registers.
5999
6000If reload sees an insn consisting of a single @code{set} between two
6001hard registers, and if @code{TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST} applied to their
6002classes returns a value of 2, reload does not check to ensure that the
6003constraints of the insn are met. Setting a cost of other than 2 will
6004allow reload to verify that the constraints are met. You should do this
6005if the @samp{mov@var{m}} pattern's constraints do not allow such copying.
6006
6007The default version of this function returns 2.
6008@end deftypefn
6009
a2c4f8e0 6010@defmac MEMORY_MOVE_COST (@var{mode}, @var{class}, @var{in})
cbd5b9a2
KR
6011A C expression for the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode} between a
6012register of class @var{class} and memory; @var{in} is zero if the value
df2a54e9 6013is to be written to memory, nonzero if it is to be read in. This cost
473fe49b
KR
6014is relative to those in @code{REGISTER_MOVE_COST}. If moving between
6015registers and memory is more expensive than between two registers, you
6016should define this macro to express the relative cost.
6017
a3a15b4d 6018If you do not define this macro, GCC uses a default cost of 4 plus
38e01259 6019the cost of copying via a secondary reload register, if one is
473fe49b
KR
6020needed. If your machine requires a secondary reload register to copy
6021between memory and a register of @var{class} but the reload mechanism is
6022more complex than copying via an intermediate, define this macro to
6023reflect the actual cost of the move.
6024
a3a15b4d 6025GCC defines the function @code{memory_move_secondary_cost} if
473fe49b
KR
6026secondary reloads are needed. It computes the costs due to copying via
6027a secondary register. If your machine copies from memory using a
6028secondary register in the conventional way but the default base value of
60294 is not correct for your machine, define this macro to add some other
6030value to the result of that function. The arguments to that function
6031are the same as to this macro.
f5c21ef3
AS
6032
6033These macros are obsolete, new ports should use the target hook
6034@code{TARGET_MEMORY_MOVE_COST} instead.
a2c4f8e0 6035@end defmac
cbd5b9a2 6036
a87cf97e 6037@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_MEMORY_MOVE_COST (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, reg_class_t @var{rclass}, bool @var{in})
f5c21ef3 6038This target hook should return the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode}
911852ff 6039between a register of class @var{rclass} and memory; @var{in} is @code{false}
f5c21ef3 6040if the value is to be written to memory, @code{true} if it is to be read in.
de8f4b07
AS
6041This cost is relative to those in @code{TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST}.
6042If moving between registers and memory is more expensive than between two
6043registers, you should add this target hook to express the relative cost.
f5c21ef3
AS
6044
6045If you do not add this target hook, GCC uses a default cost of 4 plus
6046the cost of copying via a secondary reload register, if one is
6047needed. If your machine requires a secondary reload register to copy
911852ff 6048between memory and a register of @var{rclass} but the reload mechanism is
f5c21ef3
AS
6049more complex than copying via an intermediate, use this target hook to
6050reflect the actual cost of the move.
6051
6052GCC defines the function @code{memory_move_secondary_cost} if
6053secondary reloads are needed. It computes the costs due to copying via
6054a secondary register. If your machine copies from memory using a
6055secondary register in the conventional way but the default base value of
60564 is not correct for your machine, use this target hook to add some other
6057value to the result of that function. The arguments to that function
6058are the same as to this target hook.
6059@end deftypefn
6060
3a4fd356 6061@defmac BRANCH_COST (@var{speed_p}, @var{predictable_p})
525d13b0
MS
6062A C expression for the cost of a branch instruction. A value of 1 is
6063the default; other values are interpreted relative to that. Parameter
6064@var{speed_p} is true when the branch in question should be optimized
6065for speed. When it is false, @code{BRANCH_COST} should return a value
6066optimal for code size rather than performance. @var{predictable_p} is
6067true for well-predicted branches. On many architectures the
6068@code{BRANCH_COST} can be reduced then.
a2c4f8e0 6069@end defmac
feca2ed3
JW
6070
6071Here are additional macros which do not specify precise relative costs,
a3a15b4d 6072but only that certain actions are more expensive than GCC would
feca2ed3
JW
6073ordinarily expect.
6074
a2c4f8e0 6075@defmac SLOW_BYTE_ACCESS
feca2ed3 6076Define this macro as a C expression which is nonzero if accessing less
e979f9e8 6077than a word of memory (i.e.@: a @code{char} or a @code{short}) is no
feca2ed3
JW
6078faster than accessing a word of memory, i.e., if such access
6079require more than one instruction or if there is no difference in cost
6080between byte and (aligned) word loads.
6081
6082When this macro is not defined, the compiler will access a field by
6083finding the smallest containing object; when it is defined, a fullword
6084load will be used if alignment permits. Unless bytes accesses are
6085faster than word accesses, using word accesses is preferable since it
6086may eliminate subsequent memory access if subsequent accesses occur to
6087other fields in the same word of the structure, but to different bytes.
a2c4f8e0 6088@end defmac
feca2ed3 6089
a2c4f8e0 6090@defmac SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS (@var{mode}, @var{alignment})
5fad8ebf
DE
6091Define this macro to be the value 1 if memory accesses described by the
6092@var{mode} and @var{alignment} parameters have a cost many times greater
6093than aligned accesses, for example if they are emulated in a trap
6094handler.
feca2ed3 6095
df2a54e9
JM
6096When this macro is nonzero, the compiler will act as if
6097@code{STRICT_ALIGNMENT} were nonzero when generating code for block
feca2ed3 6098moves. This can cause significantly more instructions to be produced.
df2a54e9 6099Therefore, do not set this macro nonzero if unaligned accesses only add a
feca2ed3
JW
6100cycle or two to the time for a memory access.
6101
6be57663 6102If the value of this macro is always zero, it need not be defined. If
df2a54e9
JM
6103this macro is defined, it should produce a nonzero value when
6104@code{STRICT_ALIGNMENT} is nonzero.
a2c4f8e0 6105@end defmac
feca2ed3 6106
65a324b4 6107@defmac MOVE_RATIO (@var{speed})
9862dea9 6108The threshold of number of scalar memory-to-memory move insns, @emph{below}
c5c76735 6109which a sequence of insns should be generated instead of a
feca2ed3
JW
6110string move insn or a library call. Increasing the value will always
6111make code faster, but eventually incurs high cost in increased code size.
6112
c5c76735
JL
6113Note that on machines where the corresponding move insn is a
6114@code{define_expand} that emits a sequence of insns, this macro counts
6115the number of such sequences.
9862dea9 6116
65a324b4
NC
6117The parameter @var{speed} is true if the code is currently being
6118optimized for speed rather than size.
6119
feca2ed3 6120If you don't define this, a reasonable default is used.
a2c4f8e0 6121@end defmac
feca2ed3 6122
a2c4f8e0 6123@defmac MOVE_BY_PIECES_P (@var{size}, @var{alignment})
fbe1758d
AM
6124A C expression used to determine whether @code{move_by_pieces} will be used to
6125copy a chunk of memory, or whether some other block move mechanism
6e01bd94 6126will be used. Defaults to 1 if @code{move_by_pieces_ninsns} returns less
fbe1758d 6127than @code{MOVE_RATIO}.
a2c4f8e0 6128@end defmac
fbe1758d 6129
a2c4f8e0 6130@defmac MOVE_MAX_PIECES
fbe1758d 6131A C expression used by @code{move_by_pieces} to determine the largest unit
6e01bd94 6132a load or store used to copy memory is. Defaults to @code{MOVE_MAX}.
a2c4f8e0 6133@end defmac
fbe1758d 6134
65a324b4 6135@defmac CLEAR_RATIO (@var{speed})
78762e3b
RS
6136The threshold of number of scalar move insns, @emph{below} which a sequence
6137of insns should be generated to clear memory instead of a string clear insn
6138or a library call. Increasing the value will always make code faster, but
6139eventually incurs high cost in increased code size.
6140
65a324b4
NC
6141The parameter @var{speed} is true if the code is currently being
6142optimized for speed rather than size.
6143
78762e3b 6144If you don't define this, a reasonable default is used.
a2c4f8e0 6145@end defmac
78762e3b 6146
a2c4f8e0 6147@defmac CLEAR_BY_PIECES_P (@var{size}, @var{alignment})
78762e3b
RS
6148A C expression used to determine whether @code{clear_by_pieces} will be used
6149to clear a chunk of memory, or whether some other block clear mechanism
6150will be used. Defaults to 1 if @code{move_by_pieces_ninsns} returns less
6151than @code{CLEAR_RATIO}.
a2c4f8e0 6152@end defmac
78762e3b 6153
65a324b4 6154@defmac SET_RATIO (@var{speed})
cfa31150
SL
6155The threshold of number of scalar move insns, @emph{below} which a sequence
6156of insns should be generated to set memory to a constant value, instead of
ff2ce160 6157a block set insn or a library call.
cfa31150
SL
6158Increasing the value will always make code faster, but
6159eventually incurs high cost in increased code size.
6160
65a324b4
NC
6161The parameter @var{speed} is true if the code is currently being
6162optimized for speed rather than size.
6163
cfa31150
SL
6164If you don't define this, it defaults to the value of @code{MOVE_RATIO}.
6165@end defmac
6166
6167@defmac SET_BY_PIECES_P (@var{size}, @var{alignment})
6168A C expression used to determine whether @code{store_by_pieces} will be
ff2ce160
MS
6169used to set a chunk of memory to a constant value, or whether some
6170other mechanism will be used. Used by @code{__builtin_memset} when
cfa31150
SL
6171storing values other than constant zero.
6172Defaults to 1 if @code{move_by_pieces_ninsns} returns less
6173than @code{SET_RATIO}.
6174@end defmac
6175
a2c4f8e0 6176@defmac STORE_BY_PIECES_P (@var{size}, @var{alignment})
4977bab6 6177A C expression used to determine whether @code{store_by_pieces} will be
65a324b4 6178used to set a chunk of memory to a constant string value, or whether some
cfa31150
SL
6179other mechanism will be used. Used by @code{__builtin_strcpy} when
6180called with a constant source string.
0bdcd332 6181Defaults to 1 if @code{move_by_pieces_ninsns} returns less
45d78e7f 6182than @code{MOVE_RATIO}.
a2c4f8e0 6183@end defmac
4977bab6 6184
a2c4f8e0 6185@defmac USE_LOAD_POST_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6e01bd94
MH
6186A C expression used to determine whether a load postincrement is a good
6187thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6188@code{HAVE_POST_INCREMENT}.
a2c4f8e0 6189@end defmac
6e01bd94 6190
a2c4f8e0 6191@defmac USE_LOAD_POST_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6e01bd94
MH
6192A C expression used to determine whether a load postdecrement is a good
6193thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6194@code{HAVE_POST_DECREMENT}.
a2c4f8e0 6195@end defmac
fbe1758d 6196
a2c4f8e0 6197@defmac USE_LOAD_PRE_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6e01bd94
MH
6198A C expression used to determine whether a load preincrement is a good
6199thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6200@code{HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT}.
a2c4f8e0 6201@end defmac
6e01bd94 6202
a2c4f8e0 6203@defmac USE_LOAD_PRE_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6e01bd94
MH
6204A C expression used to determine whether a load predecrement is a good
6205thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6206@code{HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT}.
a2c4f8e0 6207@end defmac
fbe1758d 6208
a2c4f8e0 6209@defmac USE_STORE_POST_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6e01bd94
MH
6210A C expression used to determine whether a store postincrement is a good
6211thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6212@code{HAVE_POST_INCREMENT}.
a2c4f8e0 6213@end defmac
6e01bd94 6214
a2c4f8e0 6215@defmac USE_STORE_POST_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
c771326b 6216A C expression used to determine whether a store postdecrement is a good
6e01bd94
MH
6217thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6218@code{HAVE_POST_DECREMENT}.
a2c4f8e0 6219@end defmac
fbe1758d 6220
a2c4f8e0 6221@defmac USE_STORE_PRE_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6e01bd94
MH
6222This macro is used to determine whether a store preincrement is a good
6223thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6224@code{HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT}.
a2c4f8e0 6225@end defmac
6e01bd94 6226
a2c4f8e0 6227@defmac USE_STORE_PRE_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6e01bd94
MH
6228This macro is used to determine whether a store predecrement is a good
6229thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6230@code{HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT}.
a2c4f8e0 6231@end defmac
fbe1758d 6232
a2c4f8e0 6233@defmac NO_FUNCTION_CSE
feca2ed3
JW
6234Define this macro if it is as good or better to call a constant
6235function address than to call an address kept in a register.
a2c4f8e0 6236@end defmac
feca2ed3 6237
a8d56c30
SB
6238@defmac LOGICAL_OP_NON_SHORT_CIRCUIT
6239Define this macro if a non-short-circuit operation produced by
6240@samp{fold_range_test ()} is optimal. This macro defaults to true if
6241@code{BRANCH_COST} is greater than or equal to the value 2.
6242@end defmac
6243
68f932c4 6244@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_RTX_COSTS (rtx @var{x}, int @var{code}, int @var{outer_code}, int @var{opno}, int *@var{total}, bool @var{speed})
3c50106f
RH
6245This target hook describes the relative costs of RTL expressions.
6246
6247The cost may depend on the precise form of the expression, which is
68f932c4
RS
6248available for examination in @var{x}, and the fact that @var{x} appears
6249as operand @var{opno} of an expression with rtx code @var{outer_code}.
6250That is, the hook can assume that there is some rtx @var{y} such
6251that @samp{GET_CODE (@var{y}) == @var{outer_code}} and such that
6252either (a) @samp{XEXP (@var{y}, @var{opno}) == @var{x}} or
6253(b) @samp{XVEC (@var{y}, @var{opno})} contains @var{x}.
6254
6255@var{code} is @var{x}'s expression code---redundant, since it can be
6256obtained with @code{GET_CODE (@var{x})}.
3c50106f
RH
6257
6258In implementing this hook, you can use the construct
6259@code{COSTS_N_INSNS (@var{n})} to specify a cost equal to @var{n} fast
6260instructions.
6261
6262On entry to the hook, @code{*@var{total}} contains a default estimate
6263for the cost of the expression. The hook should modify this value as
31a52b86
RS
6264necessary. Traditionally, the default costs are @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (5)}
6265for multiplications, @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (7)} for division and modulus
6266operations, and @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (1)} for all other operations.
6267
65a324b4
NC
6268When optimizing for code size, i.e.@: when @code{speed} is
6269false, this target hook should be used to estimate the relative
31a52b86 6270size cost of an expression, again relative to @code{COSTS_N_INSNS}.
3c50106f
RH
6271
6272The hook returns true when all subexpressions of @var{x} have been
6273processed, and false when @code{rtx_cost} should recurse.
6274@end deftypefn
6275
b413068c 6276@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ADDRESS_COST (rtx @var{address}, enum machine_mode @var{mode}, addr_space_t @var{as}, bool @var{speed})
10154ff8
RH
6277This hook computes the cost of an addressing mode that contains
6278@var{address}. If not defined, the cost is computed from
6279the @var{address} expression and the @code{TARGET_RTX_COST} hook.
6280
6281For most CISC machines, the default cost is a good approximation of the
6282true cost of the addressing mode. However, on RISC machines, all
6283instructions normally have the same length and execution time. Hence
6284all addresses will have equal costs.
6285
6286In cases where more than one form of an address is known, the form with
6287the lowest cost will be used. If multiple forms have the same, lowest,
6288cost, the one that is the most complex will be used.
6289
6290For example, suppose an address that is equal to the sum of a register
6291and a constant is used twice in the same basic block. When this macro
6292is not defined, the address will be computed in a register and memory
6293references will be indirect through that register. On machines where
6294the cost of the addressing mode containing the sum is no higher than
6295that of a simple indirect reference, this will produce an additional
6296instruction and possibly require an additional register. Proper
6297specification of this macro eliminates this overhead for such machines.
6298
6299This hook is never called with an invalid address.
6300
6301On machines where an address involving more than one register is as
6302cheap as an address computation involving only one register, defining
6303@code{TARGET_ADDRESS_COST} to reflect this can cause two registers to
6304be live over a region of code where only one would have been if
6305@code{TARGET_ADDRESS_COST} were not defined in that manner. This effect
6306should be considered in the definition of this macro. Equivalent costs
6307should probably only be given to addresses with different numbers of
6308registers on machines with lots of registers.
6309@end deftypefn
6310
c237e94a
ZW
6311@node Scheduling
6312@section Adjusting the Instruction Scheduler
6313
6314The instruction scheduler may need a fair amount of machine-specific
6315adjustment in order to produce good code. GCC provides several target
6316hooks for this purpose. It is usually enough to define just a few of
6317them: try the first ones in this list first.
6318
6319@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_ISSUE_RATE (void)
fae15c93
VM
6320This hook returns the maximum number of instructions that can ever
6321issue at the same time on the target machine. The default is one.
6322Although the insn scheduler can define itself the possibility of issue
6323an insn on the same cycle, the value can serve as an additional
6324constraint to issue insns on the same simulated processor cycle (see
6325hooks @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER} and @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2}).
6326This value must be constant over the entire compilation. If you need
6327it to vary depending on what the instructions are, you must use
c237e94a
ZW
6328@samp{TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE}.
6329@end deftypefn
6330
ac44248e 6331@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, rtx_insn *@var{insn}, int @var{more})
c237e94a
ZW
6332This hook is executed by the scheduler after it has scheduled an insn
6333from the ready list. It should return the number of insns which can
3ee04299
DE
6334still be issued in the current cycle. The default is
6335@samp{@w{@var{more} - 1}} for insns other than @code{CLOBBER} and
6336@code{USE}, which normally are not counted against the issue rate.
6337You should define this hook if some insns take more machine resources
6338than others, so that fewer insns can follow them in the same cycle.
6339@var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any
6340debug output to. @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
6341@option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}. @var{insn} is the instruction that
6342was scheduled.
c237e94a
ZW
6343@end deftypefn
6344
ac44248e 6345@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_ADJUST_COST (rtx_insn *@var{insn}, rtx @var{link}, rtx_insn *@var{dep_insn}, int @var{cost})
fae15c93
VM
6346This function corrects the value of @var{cost} based on the
6347relationship between @var{insn} and @var{dep_insn} through the
6348dependence @var{link}. It should return the new value. The default
6349is to make no adjustment to @var{cost}. This can be used for example
6350to specify to the scheduler using the traditional pipeline description
c237e94a 6351that an output- or anti-dependence does not incur the same cost as a
fae15c93
VM
6352data-dependence. If the scheduler using the automaton based pipeline
6353description, the cost of anti-dependence is zero and the cost of
6354output-dependence is maximum of one and the difference of latency
6355times of the first and the second insns. If these values are not
6356acceptable, you could use the hook to modify them too. See also
fa0aee89 6357@pxref{Processor pipeline description}.
c237e94a
ZW
6358@end deftypefn
6359
ac44248e 6360@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_ADJUST_PRIORITY (rtx_insn *@var{insn}, int @var{priority})
c237e94a 6361This hook adjusts the integer scheduling priority @var{priority} of
496d7bb0
MK
6362@var{insn}. It should return the new priority. Increase the priority to
6363execute @var{insn} earlier, reduce the priority to execute @var{insn}
c237e94a
ZW
6364later. Do not define this hook if you do not need to adjust the
6365scheduling priorities of insns.
6366@end deftypefn
6367
ce1ce33a 6368@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_REORDER (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, rtx_insn **@var{ready}, int *@var{n_readyp}, int @var{clock})
c237e94a
ZW
6369This hook is executed by the scheduler after it has scheduled the ready
6370list, to allow the machine description to reorder it (for example to
6371combine two small instructions together on @samp{VLIW} machines).
6372@var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any
6373debug output to. @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
6374@option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}. @var{ready} is a pointer to the ready
6375list of instructions that are ready to be scheduled. @var{n_readyp} is
6376a pointer to the number of elements in the ready list. The scheduler
6377reads the ready list in reverse order, starting with
65a324b4 6378@var{ready}[@var{*n_readyp} @minus{} 1] and going to @var{ready}[0]. @var{clock}
c237e94a
ZW
6379is the timer tick of the scheduler. You may modify the ready list and
6380the number of ready insns. The return value is the number of insns that
6381can issue this cycle; normally this is just @code{issue_rate}. See also
6382@samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2}.
6383@end deftypefn
6384
ce1ce33a 6385@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2 (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, rtx_insn **@var{ready}, int *@var{n_readyp}, int @var{clock})
c237e94a
ZW
6386Like @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER}, but called at a different time. That
6387function is called whenever the scheduler starts a new cycle. This one
6388is called once per iteration over a cycle, immediately after
6389@samp{TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE}; it can reorder the ready list and
6390return the number of insns to be scheduled in the same cycle. Defining
6391this hook can be useful if there are frequent situations where
6392scheduling one insn causes other insns to become ready in the same
6393cycle. These other insns can then be taken into account properly.
6394@end deftypefn
6395
0dc41f28
WM
6396@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_MACRO_FUSION_P (void)
6397This hook is used to check whether target platform supports macro fusion.
6398@end deftypefn
6399
ac44248e 6400@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_MACRO_FUSION_PAIR_P (rtx_insn *@var{condgen}, rtx_insn *@var{condjmp})
0dc41f28
WM
6401This hook is used to check whether two insns could be macro fused for
6402target microarchitecture. If this hook returns true for the given insn pair
6403(@var{condgen} and @var{condjmp}), scheduler will put them into a sched
6404group, and they will not be scheduled apart.
6405@end deftypefn
6406
ce1ce33a 6407@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_DEPENDENCIES_EVALUATION_HOOK (rtx_insn *@var{head}, rtx_insn *@var{tail})
30028c85
VM
6408This hook is called after evaluation forward dependencies of insns in
6409chain given by two parameter values (@var{head} and @var{tail}
6410correspondingly) but before insns scheduling of the insn chain. For
6411example, it can be used for better insn classification if it requires
6412analysis of dependencies. This hook can use backward and forward
6413dependencies of the insn scheduler because they are already
6414calculated.
6415@end deftypefn
6416
c237e94a
ZW
6417@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, int @var{max_ready})
6418This hook is executed by the scheduler at the beginning of each block of
6419instructions that are to be scheduled. @var{file} is either a null
6420pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output to. @var{verbose}
6421is the verbose level provided by @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6422@var{max_ready} is the maximum number of insns in the current scheduling
6423region that can be live at the same time. This can be used to allocate
431ae0bf 6424scratch space if it is needed, e.g.@: by @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER}.
c237e94a
ZW
6425@end deftypefn
6426
6427@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FINISH (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose})
6428This hook is executed by the scheduler at the end of each block of
6429instructions that are to be scheduled. It can be used to perform
6430cleanup of any actions done by the other scheduling hooks. @var{file}
6431is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output
6432to. @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
6433@option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6434@end deftypefn
6435
58565a33
SKG
6436@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT_GLOBAL (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, int @var{old_max_uid})
6437This hook is executed by the scheduler after function level initializations.
6438@var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output to.
6439@var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6440@var{old_max_uid} is the maximum insn uid when scheduling begins.
6441@end deftypefn
6442
6443@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FINISH_GLOBAL (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose})
8a36672b 6444This is the cleanup hook corresponding to @code{TARGET_SCHED_INIT_GLOBAL}.
58565a33
SKG
6445@var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output to.
6446@var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6447@end deftypefn
6448
914d25dc 6449@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN (void)
fae15c93
VM
6450The hook returns an RTL insn. The automaton state used in the
6451pipeline hazard recognizer is changed as if the insn were scheduled
6452when the new simulated processor cycle starts. Usage of the hook may
6453simplify the automaton pipeline description for some @acronym{VLIW}
6454processors. If the hook is defined, it is used only for the automaton
6455based pipeline description. The default is not to change the state
6456when the new simulated processor cycle starts.
6457@end deftypefn
6458
6459@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN (void)
6460The hook can be used to initialize data used by the previous hook.
6461@end deftypefn
6462
ac44248e 6463@deftypefn {Target Hook} {rtx_insn *} TARGET_SCHED_DFA_POST_CYCLE_INSN (void)
fae15c93
VM
6464The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN} but used
6465to changed the state as if the insn were scheduled when the new
6466simulated processor cycle finishes.
6467@end deftypefn
6468
6469@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_POST_CYCLE_INSN (void)
6470The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN} but
6471used to initialize data used by the previous hook.
6472@end deftypefn
6473
914d25dc 6474@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_ADVANCE_CYCLE (void)
1c3d0d93
MK
6475The hook to notify target that the current simulated cycle is about to finish.
6476The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN} but used
021efafc 6477to change the state in more complicated situations - e.g., when advancing
1c3d0d93
MK
6478state on a single insn is not enough.
6479@end deftypefn
6480
914d25dc 6481@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_DFA_POST_ADVANCE_CYCLE (void)
1c3d0d93
MK
6482The hook to notify target that new simulated cycle has just started.
6483The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_DFA_POST_CYCLE_INSN} but used
021efafc 6484to change the state in more complicated situations - e.g., when advancing
1c3d0d93
MK
6485state on a single insn is not enough.
6486@end deftypefn
6487
fae15c93
VM
6488@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD (void)
6489This hook controls better choosing an insn from the ready insn queue
6490for the @acronym{DFA}-based insn scheduler. Usually the scheduler
6491chooses the first insn from the queue. If the hook returns a positive
6492value, an additional scheduler code tries all permutations of
6493@samp{TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD ()}
6494subsequent ready insns to choose an insn whose issue will result in
6495maximal number of issued insns on the same cycle. For the
6496@acronym{VLIW} processor, the code could actually solve the problem of
6497packing simple insns into the @acronym{VLIW} insn. Of course, if the
6498rules of @acronym{VLIW} packing are described in the automaton.
6499
6500This code also could be used for superscalar @acronym{RISC}
6501processors. Let us consider a superscalar @acronym{RISC} processor
6502with 3 pipelines. Some insns can be executed in pipelines @var{A} or
6503@var{B}, some insns can be executed only in pipelines @var{B} or
6504@var{C}, and one insn can be executed in pipeline @var{B}. The
6505processor may issue the 1st insn into @var{A} and the 2nd one into
6506@var{B}. In this case, the 3rd insn will wait for freeing @var{B}
6507until the next cycle. If the scheduler issues the 3rd insn the first,
6508the processor could issue all 3 insns per cycle.
6509
6510Actually this code demonstrates advantages of the automaton based
6511pipeline hazard recognizer. We try quickly and easy many insn
6512schedules to choose the best one.
6513
6514The default is no multipass scheduling.
6515@end deftypefn
6516
ac44248e 6517@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD_GUARD (rtx_insn *@var{insn}, int @var{ready_index})
30028c85
VM
6518
6519This hook controls what insns from the ready insn queue will be
6520considered for the multipass insn scheduling. If the hook returns
4960a0cb
MK
6521zero for @var{insn}, the insn will be considered in multipass scheduling.
6522Positive return values will remove @var{insn} from consideration on
6523the current round of multipass scheduling.
6524Negative return values will remove @var{insn} from consideration for given
6525number of cycles.
6526Backends should be careful about returning non-zero for highest priority
6527instruction at position 0 in the ready list. @var{ready_index} is passed
6528to allow backends make correct judgements.
30028c85 6529
62b9c42c 6530The default is that any ready insns can be chosen to be issued.
30028c85
VM
6531@end deftypefn
6532
4960a0cb 6533@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_BEGIN (void *@var{data}, signed char *@var{ready_try}, int @var{n_ready}, bool @var{first_cycle_insn_p})
894fd6f2
MK
6534This hook prepares the target backend for a new round of multipass
6535scheduling.
6536@end deftypefn
6537
ac44248e 6538@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_ISSUE (void *@var{data}, signed char *@var{ready_try}, int @var{n_ready}, rtx_insn *@var{insn}, const void *@var{prev_data})
894fd6f2
MK
6539This hook is called when multipass scheduling evaluates instruction INSN.
6540@end deftypefn
6541
4960a0cb 6542@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_BACKTRACK (const void *@var{data}, signed char *@var{ready_try}, int @var{n_ready})
894fd6f2
MK
6543This is called when multipass scheduling backtracks from evaluation of
6544an instruction.
6545@end deftypefn
6546
6547@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_END (const void *@var{data})
6548This hook notifies the target about the result of the concluded current
6549round of multipass scheduling.
6550@end deftypefn
6551
6552@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_INIT (void *@var{data})
2b0d3573 6553This hook initializes target-specific data used in multipass scheduling.
894fd6f2
MK
6554@end deftypefn
6555
6556@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_FINI (void *@var{data})
2b0d3573 6557This hook finalizes target-specific data used in multipass scheduling.
894fd6f2
MK
6558@end deftypefn
6559
ac44248e 6560@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_DFA_NEW_CYCLE (FILE *@var{dump}, int @var{verbose}, rtx_insn *@var{insn}, int @var{last_clock}, int @var{clock}, int *@var{sort_p})
a934eb2d
JR
6561This hook is called by the insn scheduler before issuing @var{insn}
6562on cycle @var{clock}. If the hook returns nonzero,
6563@var{insn} is not issued on this processor cycle. Instead,
6564the processor cycle is advanced. If *@var{sort_p}
6565is zero, the insn ready queue is not sorted on the new cycle
6566start as usually. @var{dump} and @var{verbose} specify the file and
6567verbosity level to use for debugging output.
6568@var{last_clock} and @var{clock} are, respectively, the
6569processor cycle on which the previous insn has been issued,
6570and the current processor cycle.
30028c85
VM
6571@end deftypefn
6572
72392b81 6573@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_IS_COSTLY_DEPENDENCE (struct _dep *@var{_dep}, int @var{cost}, int @var{distance})
569fa502 6574This hook is used to define which dependences are considered costly by
daf2f129 6575the target, so costly that it is not advisable to schedule the insns that
569fa502 6576are involved in the dependence too close to one another. The parameters
b198261f
MK
6577to this hook are as follows: The first parameter @var{_dep} is the dependence
6578being evaluated. The second parameter @var{cost} is the cost of the
72392b81 6579dependence as estimated by the scheduler, and the third
daf2f129 6580parameter @var{distance} is the distance in cycles between the two insns.
569fa502
DN
6581The hook returns @code{true} if considering the distance between the two
6582insns the dependence between them is considered costly by the target,
6583and @code{false} otherwise.
6584
6585Defining this hook can be useful in multiple-issue out-of-order machines,
daf2f129 6586where (a) it's practically hopeless to predict the actual data/resource
569fa502 6587delays, however: (b) there's a better chance to predict the actual grouping
daf2f129 6588that will be formed, and (c) correctly emulating the grouping can be very
569fa502 6589important. In such targets one may want to allow issuing dependent insns
78466c0e 6590closer to one another---i.e., closer than the dependence distance; however,
72392b81 6591not in cases of ``costly dependences'', which this hooks allows to define.
569fa502
DN
6592@end deftypefn
6593
496d7bb0
MK
6594@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_H_I_D_EXTENDED (void)
6595This hook is called by the insn scheduler after emitting a new instruction to
6596the instruction stream. The hook notifies a target backend to extend its
6597per instruction data structures.
6598@end deftypefn
6599
b6fd8800 6600@deftypefn {Target Hook} {void *} TARGET_SCHED_ALLOC_SCHED_CONTEXT (void)
e855c69d
AB
6601Return a pointer to a store large enough to hold target scheduling context.
6602@end deftypefn
6603
6604@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT_SCHED_CONTEXT (void *@var{tc}, bool @var{clean_p})
6605Initialize store pointed to by @var{tc} to hold target scheduling context.
6606It @var{clean_p} is true then initialize @var{tc} as if scheduler is at the
ab7e224a 6607beginning of the block. Otherwise, copy the current context into @var{tc}.
e855c69d
AB
6608@end deftypefn
6609
6610@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_SET_SCHED_CONTEXT (void *@var{tc})
914d25dc 6611Copy target scheduling context pointed to by @var{tc} to the current context.
e855c69d
AB
6612@end deftypefn
6613
6614@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_CLEAR_SCHED_CONTEXT (void *@var{tc})
6615Deallocate internal data in target scheduling context pointed to by @var{tc}.
6616@end deftypefn
6617
6618@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FREE_SCHED_CONTEXT (void *@var{tc})
6619Deallocate a store for target scheduling context pointed to by @var{tc}.
6620@end deftypefn
6621
ac44248e 6622@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_SPECULATE_INSN (rtx_insn *@var{insn}, unsigned int @var{dep_status}, rtx *@var{new_pat})
64ee9490
EC
6623This hook is called by the insn scheduler when @var{insn} has only
6624speculative dependencies and therefore can be scheduled speculatively.
6625The hook is used to check if the pattern of @var{insn} has a speculative
6626version and, in case of successful check, to generate that speculative
6627pattern. The hook should return 1, if the instruction has a speculative form,
8ad1dde7 6628or @minus{}1, if it doesn't. @var{request} describes the type of requested
496d7bb0
MK
6629speculation. If the return value equals 1 then @var{new_pat} is assigned
6630the generated speculative pattern.
6631@end deftypefn
6632
8e90de43 6633@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_NEEDS_BLOCK_P (unsigned int @var{dep_status})
496d7bb0 6634This hook is called by the insn scheduler during generation of recovery code
72392b81
JR
6635for @var{insn}. It should return @code{true}, if the corresponding check
6636instruction should branch to recovery code, or @code{false} otherwise.
496d7bb0
MK
6637@end deftypefn
6638
ac44248e 6639@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_SCHED_GEN_SPEC_CHECK (rtx_insn *@var{insn}, rtx_insn *@var{label}, unsigned int @var{ds})
496d7bb0 6640This hook is called by the insn scheduler to generate a pattern for recovery
64ee9490
EC
6641check instruction. If @var{mutate_p} is zero, then @var{insn} is a
6642speculative instruction for which the check should be generated.
6643@var{label} is either a label of a basic block, where recovery code should
6644be emitted, or a null pointer, when requested check doesn't branch to
6645recovery code (a simple check). If @var{mutate_p} is nonzero, then
6646a pattern for a branchy check corresponding to a simple check denoted by
496d7bb0
MK
6647@var{insn} should be generated. In this case @var{label} can't be null.
6648@end deftypefn
6649
50e87e30 6650@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_SET_SCHED_FLAGS (struct spec_info_def *@var{spec_info})
64ee9490 6651This hook is used by the insn scheduler to find out what features should be
50e87e30
JR
6652enabled/used.
6653The structure *@var{spec_info} should be filled in by the target.
496d7bb0
MK
6654The structure describes speculation types that can be used in the scheduler.
6655@end deftypefn
6656
67186a97
TS
6657@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_SMS_RES_MII (struct ddg *@var{g})
6658This hook is called by the swing modulo scheduler to calculate a
6659resource-based lower bound which is based on the resources available in
6660the machine and the resources required by each instruction. The target
6661backend can use @var{g} to calculate such bound. A very simple lower
6662bound will be used in case this hook is not implemented: the total number
6663of instructions divided by the issue rate.
6664@end deftypefn
6665
ac44248e 6666@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_DISPATCH (rtx_insn *@var{insn}, int @var{x})
7942e47e
RY
6667This hook is called by Haifa Scheduler. It returns true if dispatch scheduling
6668is supported in hardware and the condition specified in the parameter is true.
6669@end deftypefn
6670
ac44248e 6671@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_DISPATCH_DO (rtx_insn *@var{insn}, int @var{x})
7942e47e
RY
6672This hook is called by Haifa Scheduler. It performs the operation specified
6673in its second parameter.
6674@end deftypefn
6675
b0bd15f7
BS
6676@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_EXPOSED_PIPELINE
6677True if the processor has an exposed pipeline, which means that not just
6678the order of instructions is important for correctness when scheduling, but
6679also the latencies of operations.
6680@end deftypevr
6681
df7b0cc4
EI
6682@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_REASSOCIATION_WIDTH (unsigned int @var{opc}, enum machine_mode @var{mode})
6683This hook is called by tree reassociator to determine a level of
6684parallelism required in output calculations chain.
6685@end deftypefn
6686
feca2ed3
JW
6687@node Sections
6688@section Dividing the Output into Sections (Texts, Data, @dots{})
6689@c the above section title is WAY too long. maybe cut the part between
6690@c the (...)? --mew 10feb93
6691
6692An object file is divided into sections containing different types of
6693data. In the most common case, there are three sections: the @dfn{text
6694section}, which holds instructions and read-only data; the @dfn{data
6695section}, which holds initialized writable data; and the @dfn{bss
6696section}, which holds uninitialized data. Some systems have other kinds
6697of sections.
6698
d6b5193b
RS
6699@file{varasm.c} provides several well-known sections, such as
6700@code{text_section}, @code{data_section} and @code{bss_section}.
6701The normal way of controlling a @code{@var{foo}_section} variable
6702is to define the associated @code{@var{FOO}_SECTION_ASM_OP} macro,
6703as described below. The macros are only read once, when @file{varasm.c}
6704initializes itself, so their values must be run-time constants.
6705They may however depend on command-line flags.
6706
6707@emph{Note:} Some run-time files, such @file{crtstuff.c}, also make
6708use of the @code{@var{FOO}_SECTION_ASM_OP} macros, and expect them
6709to be string literals.
6710
6711Some assemblers require a different string to be written every time a
6712section is selected. If your assembler falls into this category, you
6713should define the @code{TARGET_ASM_INIT_SECTIONS} hook and use
6714@code{get_unnamed_section} to set up the sections.
6715
6716You must always create a @code{text_section}, either by defining
6717@code{TEXT_SECTION_ASM_OP} or by initializing @code{text_section}
6718in @code{TARGET_ASM_INIT_SECTIONS}. The same is true of
6719@code{data_section} and @code{DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP}. If you do not
6720create a distinct @code{readonly_data_section}, the default is to
6721reuse @code{text_section}.
6722
6723All the other @file{varasm.c} sections are optional, and are null
6724if the target does not provide them.
feca2ed3 6725
a2c4f8e0 6726@defmac TEXT_SECTION_ASM_OP
047c1c92
HPN
6727A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
6728assembler operation that should precede instructions and read-only data.
6729Normally @code{"\t.text"} is right.
a2c4f8e0 6730@end defmac
33c09f2f 6731
a2c4f8e0 6732@defmac HOT_TEXT_SECTION_NAME
194734e9
JH
6733If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing most
6734frequently executed functions of the program. If not defined, GCC will provide
6735a default definition if the target supports named sections.
a2c4f8e0 6736@end defmac
194734e9 6737
a2c4f8e0 6738@defmac UNLIKELY_EXECUTED_TEXT_SECTION_NAME
194734e9
JH
6739If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing unlikely
6740executed functions in the program.
a2c4f8e0 6741@end defmac
194734e9 6742
a2c4f8e0 6743@defmac DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
047c1c92
HPN
6744A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
6745assembler operation to identify the following data as writable initialized
6746data. Normally @code{"\t.data"} is right.
a2c4f8e0 6747@end defmac
feca2ed3 6748
d6b5193b
RS
6749@defmac SDATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
6750If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6751containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6752initialized, writable small data.
6753@end defmac
6754
a2c4f8e0 6755@defmac READONLY_DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
d48bc59a
RH
6756A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
6757assembler operation to identify the following data as read-only initialized
6758data.
a2c4f8e0 6759@end defmac
d48bc59a 6760
a2c4f8e0 6761@defmac BSS_SECTION_ASM_OP
047c1c92
HPN
6762If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6763containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
ddf72388 6764uninitialized global data. If not defined, and
07c5f94e 6765@code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_BSS} not defined,
047c1c92 6766uninitialized global data will be output in the data section if
630d3d5a 6767@option{-fno-common} is passed, otherwise @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} will be
047c1c92 6768used.
a2c4f8e0 6769@end defmac
feca2ed3 6770
d6b5193b
RS
6771@defmac SBSS_SECTION_ASM_OP
6772If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6773containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6774uninitialized, writable small data.
6775@end defmac
6776
9b7e6950
RO
6777@defmac TLS_COMMON_ASM_OP
6778If defined, a C expression whose value is a string containing the
6779assembler operation to identify the following data as thread-local
6780common data. The default is @code{".tls_common"}.
6781@end defmac
6782
6783@defmac TLS_SECTION_ASM_FLAG
6784If defined, a C expression whose value is a character constant
6785containing the flag used to mark a section as a TLS section. The
6786default is @code{'T'}.
6787@end defmac
6788
a2c4f8e0 6789@defmac INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP
047c1c92
HPN
6790If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6791containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6792initialization code. If not defined, GCC will assume such a section does
98bfa2fb
RS
6793not exist. This section has no corresponding @code{init_section}
6794variable; it is used entirely in runtime code.
a2c4f8e0 6795@end defmac
feca2ed3 6796
a2c4f8e0 6797@defmac FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP
047c1c92
HPN
6798If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6799containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6800finalization code. If not defined, GCC will assume such a section does
98bfa2fb
RS
6801not exist. This section has no corresponding @code{fini_section}
6802variable; it is used entirely in runtime code.
a2c4f8e0 6803@end defmac
750054a2 6804
7abc66b1
JB
6805@defmac INIT_ARRAY_SECTION_ASM_OP
6806If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6807containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6808part of the @code{.init_array} (or equivalent) section. If not
6809defined, GCC will assume such a section does not exist. Do not define
6810both this macro and @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}.
6811@end defmac
083cad55 6812
7abc66b1
JB
6813@defmac FINI_ARRAY_SECTION_ASM_OP
6814If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6815containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6816part of the @code{.fini_array} (or equivalent) section. If not
6817defined, GCC will assume such a section does not exist. Do not define
6818both this macro and @code{FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP}.
6819@end defmac
6820
a2c4f8e0 6821@defmac CRT_CALL_STATIC_FUNCTION (@var{section_op}, @var{function})
cea3bd3e
RH
6822If defined, an ASM statement that switches to a different section
6823via @var{section_op}, calls @var{function}, and switches back to
6824the text section. This is used in @file{crtstuff.c} if
6825@code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP} or @code{FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP} to calls
6826to initialization and finalization functions from the init and fini
6827sections. By default, this macro uses a simple function call. Some
1b2dd04a
AO
6828ports need hand-crafted assembly code to avoid dependencies on
6829registers initialized in the function prologue or to ensure that
6830constant pools don't end up too far way in the text section.
a2c4f8e0 6831@end defmac
1b2dd04a 6832
a0cfeb0f
DD
6833@defmac TARGET_LIBGCC_SDATA_SECTION
6834If defined, a string which names the section into which small
6835variables defined in crtstuff and libgcc should go. This is useful
6836when the target has options for optimizing access to small data, and
6837you want the crtstuff and libgcc routines to be conservative in what
6838they expect of your application yet liberal in what your application
6839expects. For example, for targets with a @code{.sdata} section (like
6840MIPS), you could compile crtstuff with @code{-G 0} so that it doesn't
6841require small data support from your application, but use this macro
6842to put small data into @code{.sdata} so that your application can
6843access these variables whether it uses small data or not.
726e9992 6844@end defmac
a0cfeb0f 6845
a2c4f8e0 6846@defmac FORCE_CODE_SECTION_ALIGN
cea3bd3e
RH
6847If defined, an ASM statement that aligns a code section to some
6848arbitrary boundary. This is used to force all fragments of the
6849@code{.init} and @code{.fini} sections to have to same alignment
6850and thus prevent the linker from having to add any padding.
a2c4f8e0 6851@end defmac
cea3bd3e 6852
a2c4f8e0 6853@defmac JUMP_TABLES_IN_TEXT_SECTION
df2a54e9 6854Define this macro to be an expression with a nonzero value if jump
75197b37
BS
6855tables (for @code{tablejump} insns) should be output in the text
6856section, along with the assembler instructions. Otherwise, the
6857readonly data section is used.
feca2ed3
JW
6858
6859This macro is irrelevant if there is no separate readonly data section.
a2c4f8e0 6860@end defmac
feca2ed3 6861
d6b5193b
RS
6862@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_INIT_SECTIONS (void)
6863Define this hook if you need to do something special to set up the
6864@file{varasm.c} sections, or if your target has some special sections
6865of its own that you need to create.
6866
6867GCC calls this hook after processing the command line, but before writing
6868any assembly code, and before calling any of the section-returning hooks
6869described below.
6870@end deftypefn
6871
914d25dc 6872@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ASM_RELOC_RW_MASK (void)
9b580a0b
RH
6873Return a mask describing how relocations should be treated when
6874selecting sections. Bit 1 should be set if global relocations
6875should be placed in a read-write section; bit 0 should be set if
6876local relocations should be placed in a read-write section.
6877
6878The default version of this function returns 3 when @option{-fpic}
6879is in effect, and 0 otherwise. The hook is typically redefined
6880when the target cannot support (some kinds of) dynamic relocations
6881in read-only sections even in executables.
6882@end deftypefn
6883
d6b5193b
RS
6884@deftypefn {Target Hook} {section *} TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION (tree @var{exp}, int @var{reloc}, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT @var{align})
6885Return the section into which @var{exp} should be placed. You can
ae46c4e0
RH
6886assume that @var{exp} is either a @code{VAR_DECL} node or a constant of
6887some sort. @var{reloc} indicates whether the initial value of @var{exp}
6888requires link-time relocations. Bit 0 is set when variable contains
6889local relocations only, while bit 1 is set for global relocations.
d6b5193b 6890@var{align} is the constant alignment in bits.
ae46c4e0
RH
6891
6892The default version of this function takes care of putting read-only
6893variables in @code{readonly_data_section}.
09afda70
GK
6894
6895See also @var{USE_SELECT_SECTION_FOR_FUNCTIONS}.
ae46c4e0
RH
6896@end deftypefn
6897
09afda70
GK
6898@defmac USE_SELECT_SECTION_FOR_FUNCTIONS
6899Define this macro if you wish TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION to be called
6900for @code{FUNCTION_DECL}s as well as for variables and constants.
6901
6902In the case of a @code{FUNCTION_DECL}, @var{reloc} will be zero if the
6903function has been determined to be likely to be called, and nonzero if
6904it is unlikely to be called.
6905@end defmac
6906
ae46c4e0
RH
6907@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_UNIQUE_SECTION (tree @var{decl}, int @var{reloc})
6908Build up a unique section name, expressed as a @code{STRING_CST} node,
6909and assign it to @samp{DECL_SECTION_NAME (@var{decl})}.
6910As with @code{TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION}, @var{reloc} indicates whether
6911the initial value of @var{exp} requires link-time relocations.
6912
6913The default version of this function appends the symbol name to the
6914ELF section name that would normally be used for the symbol. For
6915example, the function @code{foo} would be placed in @code{.text.foo}.
6916Whatever the actual target object format, this is often good enough.
6917@end deftypefn
6918
d6b5193b
RS
6919@deftypefn {Target Hook} {section *} TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_RODATA_SECTION (tree @var{decl})
6920Return the readonly data section associated with
ab5c8549 6921@samp{DECL_SECTION_NAME (@var{decl})}.
d6b5193b
RS
6922The default version of this function selects @code{.gnu.linkonce.r.name} if
6923the function's section is @code{.gnu.linkonce.t.name}, @code{.rodata.name}
6924if function is in @code{.text.name}, and the normal readonly-data section
6925otherwise.
ab5c8549
JJ
6926@end deftypefn
6927
727a65e6
BS
6928@deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_MERGEABLE_RODATA_PREFIX
6929Usually, the compiler uses the prefix @code{".rodata"} to construct
6930section names for mergeable constant data. Define this macro to override
6931the string if a different section name should be used.
6932@end deftypevr
6933
50b0b78a
IS
6934@deftypefn {Target Hook} {section *} TARGET_ASM_TM_CLONE_TABLE_SECTION (void)
6935Return the section that should be used for transactional memory clone tables.
6936@end deftypefn
6937
d6b5193b
RS
6938@deftypefn {Target Hook} {section *} TARGET_ASM_SELECT_RTX_SECTION (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{x}, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT @var{align})
6939Return the section into which a constant @var{x}, of mode @var{mode},
6940should be placed. You can assume that @var{x} is some kind of
b64a1b53 6941constant in RTL@. The argument @var{mode} is redundant except in the
d6b5193b
RS
6942case of a @code{const_int} rtx. @var{align} is the constant alignment
6943in bits.
b64a1b53
RH
6944
6945The default version of this function takes care of putting symbolic
6946constants in @code{flag_pic} mode in @code{data_section} and everything
6947else in @code{readonly_data_section}.
6948@end deftypefn
6949
914d25dc 6950@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_MANGLE_DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (tree @var{decl}, tree @var{id})
5234b8f5
DS
6951Define this hook if you need to postprocess the assembler name generated
6952by target-independent code. The @var{id} provided to this hook will be
6953the computed name (e.g., the macro @code{DECL_NAME} of the @var{decl} in C,
6954or the mangled name of the @var{decl} in C++). The return value of the
6955hook is an @code{IDENTIFIER_NODE} for the appropriate mangled name on
6956your target system. The default implementation of this hook just
6957returns the @var{id} provided.
6958@end deftypefn
6959
c6a2438a 6960@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO (tree @var{decl}, rtx @var{rtl}, int @var{new_decl_p})
fb49053f
RH
6961Define this hook if references to a symbol or a constant must be
6962treated differently depending on something about the variable or
6963function named by the symbol (such as what section it is in).
6964
c6a2438a
ZW
6965The hook is executed immediately after rtl has been created for
6966@var{decl}, which may be a variable or function declaration or
6967an entry in the constant pool. In either case, @var{rtl} is the
6968rtl in question. Do @emph{not} use @code{DECL_RTL (@var{decl})}
0864034e 6969in this hook; that field may not have been initialized yet.
c6a2438a
ZW
6970
6971In the case of a constant, it is safe to assume that the rtl is
6972a @code{mem} whose address is a @code{symbol_ref}. Most decls
6973will also have this form, but that is not guaranteed. Global
6974register variables, for instance, will have a @code{reg} for their
6975rtl. (Normally the right thing to do with such unusual rtl is
6976leave it alone.)
fb49053f
RH
6977
6978The @var{new_decl_p} argument will be true if this is the first time
c6a2438a 6979that @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} has been invoked on this decl. It will
fb49053f
RH
6980be false for subsequent invocations, which will happen for duplicate
6981declarations. Whether or not anything must be done for the duplicate
6982declaration depends on whether the hook examines @code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES}.
c6a2438a 6983@var{new_decl_p} is always true when the hook is called for a constant.
fb49053f
RH
6984
6985@cindex @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAG}, in @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}
c6a2438a
ZW
6986The usual thing for this hook to do is to record flags in the
6987@code{symbol_ref}, using @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAG} or @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS}.
6988Historically, the name string was modified if it was necessary to
6989encode more than one bit of information, but this practice is now
6990discouraged; use @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS}.
6991
6992The default definition of this hook, @code{default_encode_section_info}
6993in @file{varasm.c}, sets a number of commonly-useful bits in
6994@code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS}. Check whether the default does what you need
6995before overriding it.
fb49053f
RH
6996@end deftypefn
6997
914d25dc 6998@deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_STRIP_NAME_ENCODING (const char *@var{name})
772c5265
RH
6999Decode @var{name} and return the real name part, sans
7000the characters that @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}
7001may have added.
7002@end deftypefn
7003
b6fd8800 7004@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_IN_SMALL_DATA_P (const_tree @var{exp})
47754fd5
RH
7005Returns true if @var{exp} should be placed into a ``small data'' section.
7006The default version of this hook always returns false.
7007@end deftypefn
7008
9e3be889 7009@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_SRODATA_SECTION
e2a6476e
DE
7010Contains the value true if the target places read-only
7011``small data'' into a separate section. The default value is false.
9e3be889 7012@end deftypevr
e2a6476e 7013
3c5273a9
KT
7014@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_PROFILE_BEFORE_PROLOGUE (void)
7015It returns true if target wants profile code emitted before prologue.
7016
7017The default version of this hook use the target macro
7018@code{PROFILE_BEFORE_PROLOGUE}.
7019@end deftypefn
7020
b6fd8800 7021@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_BINDS_LOCAL_P (const_tree @var{exp})
47754fd5
RH
7022Returns true if @var{exp} names an object for which name resolution
7023rules must resolve to the current ``module'' (dynamic shared library
7024or executable image).
7025
7026The default version of this hook implements the name resolution rules
7027for ELF, which has a looser model of global name binding than other
7028currently supported object file formats.
7029@end deftypefn
7030
9e3be889 7031@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_TLS
e2a6476e
DE
7032Contains the value true if the target supports thread-local storage.
7033The default value is false.
9e3be889 7034@end deftypevr
e2a6476e
DE
7035
7036
feca2ed3
JW
7037@node PIC
7038@section Position Independent Code
7039@cindex position independent code
7040@cindex PIC
7041
7042This section describes macros that help implement generation of position
7043independent code. Simply defining these macros is not enough to
c6c3dba9
PB
7044generate valid PIC; you must also add support to the hook
7045@code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P} and to the macro
7046@code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS}, as well as @code{LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS}. You
7047must modify the definition of @samp{movsi} to do something appropriate
7048when the source operand contains a symbolic address. You may also
7049need to alter the handling of switch statements so that they use
7050relative addresses.
ff2ce160 7051@c i rearranged the order of the macros above to try to force one of
feca2ed3
JW
7052@c them to the next line, to eliminate an overfull hbox. --mew 10feb93
7053
a2c4f8e0 7054@defmac PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM
feca2ed3
JW
7055The register number of the register used to address a table of static
7056data addresses in memory. In some cases this register is defined by a
161d7b59 7057processor's ``application binary interface'' (ABI)@. When this macro
feca2ed3
JW
7058is defined, RTL is generated for this register once, as with the stack
7059pointer and frame pointer registers. If this macro is not defined, it
7060is up to the machine-dependent files to allocate such a register (if
003b9f78 7061necessary). Note that this register must be fixed when in use (e.g.@:
12beba6f 7062when @code{flag_pic} is true).
a2c4f8e0 7063@end defmac
feca2ed3 7064
a2c4f8e0 7065@defmac PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REG_CALL_CLOBBERED
f8fe0a4a
JM
7066A C expression that is nonzero if the register defined by
7067@code{PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM} is clobbered by calls. If not defined,
7068the default is zero. Do not define
ed4db1ee 7069this macro if @code{PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM} is not defined.
a2c4f8e0 7070@end defmac
feca2ed3 7071
a2c4f8e0 7072@defmac LEGITIMATE_PIC_OPERAND_P (@var{x})
feca2ed3
JW
7073A C expression that is nonzero if @var{x} is a legitimate immediate
7074operand on the target machine when generating position independent code.
7075You can assume that @var{x} satisfies @code{CONSTANT_P}, so you need not
7076check this. You can also assume @var{flag_pic} is true, so you need not
7077check it either. You need not define this macro if all constants
7078(including @code{SYMBOL_REF}) can be immediate operands when generating
7079position independent code.
a2c4f8e0 7080@end defmac
feca2ed3
JW
7081
7082@node Assembler Format
7083@section Defining the Output Assembler Language
7084
7085This section describes macros whose principal purpose is to describe how
648c546a 7086to write instructions in assembler language---rather than what the
feca2ed3
JW
7087instructions do.
7088
7089@menu
7090* File Framework:: Structural information for the assembler file.
7091* Data Output:: Output of constants (numbers, strings, addresses).
7092* Uninitialized Data:: Output of uninitialized variables.
7093* Label Output:: Output and generation of labels.
7094* Initialization:: General principles of initialization
6ccde948 7095 and termination routines.
feca2ed3 7096* Macros for Initialization::
6ccde948
RW
7097 Specific macros that control the handling of
7098 initialization and termination routines.
feca2ed3
JW
7099* Instruction Output:: Output of actual instructions.
7100* Dispatch Tables:: Output of jump tables.
7101* Exception Region Output:: Output of exception region code.
7102* Alignment Output:: Pseudo ops for alignment and skipping data.
7103@end menu
7104
7105@node File Framework
7106@subsection The Overall Framework of an Assembler File
7107@cindex assembler format
7108@cindex output of assembler code
7109
7110@c prevent bad page break with this line
1bc7c5b6
ZW
7111This describes the overall framework of an assembly file.
7112
1bc7c5b6 7113@findex default_file_start
914d25dc 7114@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FILE_START (void)
1bc7c5b6
ZW
7115Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects to
7116find at the beginning of a file. The default behavior is controlled
7117by two flags, documented below. Unless your target's assembler is
7118quite unusual, if you override the default, you should call
7119@code{default_file_start} at some point in your target hook. This
7120lets other target files rely on these variables.
7121@end deftypefn
feca2ed3 7122
1bc7c5b6
ZW
7123@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_FILE_START_APP_OFF
7124If this flag is true, the text of the macro @code{ASM_APP_OFF} will be
7125printed as the very first line in the assembly file, unless
7126@option{-fverbose-asm} is in effect. (If that macro has been defined
7127to the empty string, this variable has no effect.) With the normal
7128definition of @code{ASM_APP_OFF}, the effect is to notify the GNU
7129assembler that it need not bother stripping comments or extra
7130whitespace from its input. This allows it to work a bit faster.
7131
7132The default is false. You should not set it to true unless you have
7133verified that your port does not generate any extra whitespace or
7134comments that will cause GAS to issue errors in NO_APP mode.
7135@end deftypevr
7136
7137@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_FILE_START_FILE_DIRECTIVE
7138If this flag is true, @code{output_file_directive} will be called
7139for the primary source file, immediately after printing
7140@code{ASM_APP_OFF} (if that is enabled). Most ELF assemblers expect
7141this to be done. The default is false.
7142@end deftypevr
feca2ed3 7143
b6fd8800 7144@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FILE_END (void)
a5fe455b
ZW
7145Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects
7146to find at the end of a file. The default is to output nothing.
7147@end deftypefn
feca2ed3 7148
a5fe455b
ZW
7149@deftypefun void file_end_indicate_exec_stack ()
7150Some systems use a common convention, the @samp{.note.GNU-stack}
7151special section, to indicate whether or not an object file relies on
7152the stack being executable. If your system uses this convention, you
7153should define @code{TARGET_ASM_FILE_END} to this function. If you
7154need to do other things in that hook, have your hook function call
7155this function.
7156@end deftypefun
feca2ed3 7157
c082f9f3
SB
7158@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_LTO_START (void)
7159Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects
7160to find at the start of an LTO section. The default is to output
7161nothing.
7162@end deftypefn
7163
7164@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_LTO_END (void)
7165Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects
7166to find at the end of an LTO section. The default is to output
7167nothing.
7168@end deftypefn
7169
6d217c32
JJ
7170@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_CODE_END (void)
7171Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which is needed before emitting
7172unwind info and debug info at the end of a file. Some targets emit
7173here PIC setup thunks that cannot be emitted at the end of file,
7174because they couldn't have unwind info then. The default is to output
7175nothing.
7176@end deftypefn
7177
a2c4f8e0 7178@defmac ASM_COMMENT_START
feca2ed3
JW
7179A C string constant describing how to begin a comment in the target
7180assembler language. The compiler assumes that the comment will end at
7181the end of the line.
a2c4f8e0 7182@end defmac
feca2ed3 7183
a2c4f8e0 7184@defmac ASM_APP_ON
feca2ed3
JW
7185A C string constant for text to be output before each @code{asm}
7186statement or group of consecutive ones. Normally this is
7187@code{"#APP"}, which is a comment that has no effect on most
7188assemblers but tells the GNU assembler that it must check the lines
7189that follow for all valid assembler constructs.
a2c4f8e0 7190@end defmac
feca2ed3 7191
a2c4f8e0 7192@defmac ASM_APP_OFF
feca2ed3
JW
7193A C string constant for text to be output after each @code{asm}
7194statement or group of consecutive ones. Normally this is
7195@code{"#NO_APP"}, which tells the GNU assembler to resume making the
7196time-saving assumptions that are valid for ordinary compiler output.
a2c4f8e0 7197@end defmac
feca2ed3 7198
a2c4f8e0 7199@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SOURCE_FILENAME (@var{stream}, @var{name})
feca2ed3
JW
7200A C statement to output COFF information or DWARF debugging information
7201which indicates that filename @var{name} is the current source file to
7202the stdio stream @var{stream}.
7203
7204This macro need not be defined if the standard form of output
7205for the file format in use is appropriate.
a2c4f8e0 7206@end defmac
feca2ed3 7207
b5f5d41d
AS
7208@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_SOURCE_FILENAME (FILE *@var{file}, const char *@var{name})
7209Output COFF information or DWARF debugging information which indicates that filename @var{name} is the current source file to the stdio stream @var{file}.
edeab219 7210
b5f5d41d
AS
7211 This target hook need not be defined if the standard form of output for the file format in use is appropriate.
7212@end deftypefn
7213
a8781821
SB
7214@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_IDENT (const char *@var{name})
7215Output a string based on @var{name}, suitable for the @samp{#ident} directive, or the equivalent directive or pragma in non-C-family languages. If this hook is not defined, nothing is output for the @samp{#ident} directive.
7216@end deftypefn
7217
a2c4f8e0 7218@defmac OUTPUT_QUOTED_STRING (@var{stream}, @var{string})
e9a25f70
JL
7219A C statement to output the string @var{string} to the stdio stream
7220@var{stream}. If you do not call the function @code{output_quoted_string}
a3a15b4d 7221in your config files, GCC will only call it to output filenames to
e9a25f70
JL
7222the assembler source. So you can use it to canonicalize the format
7223of the filename using this macro.
a2c4f8e0 7224@end defmac
e9a25f70 7225
914d25dc 7226@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION (const char *@var{name}, unsigned int @var{flags}, tree @var{decl})
7c262518
RH
7227Output assembly directives to switch to section @var{name}. The section
7228should have attributes as specified by @var{flags}, which is a bit mask
914d25dc
JR
7229of the @code{SECTION_*} flags defined in @file{output.h}. If @var{decl}
7230is non-NULL, it is the @code{VAR_DECL} or @code{FUNCTION_DECL} with which
7231this section is associated.
7c262518
RH
7232@end deftypefn
7233
f16d3f39
JH
7234@deftypefn {Target Hook} {section *} TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_SECTION (tree @var{decl}, enum node_frequency @var{freq}, bool @var{startup}, bool @var{exit})
7235Return preferred text (sub)section for function @var{decl}.
7236Main purpose of this function is to separate cold, normal and hot
ff2ce160 7237functions. @var{startup} is true when function is known to be used only
f16d3f39
JH
7238at startup (from static constructors or it is @code{main()}).
7239@var{exit} is true when function is known to be used only at exit
7240(from static destructors).
7241Return NULL if function should go to default text section.
7242@end deftypefn
7243
14d11d40
IS
7244@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_SWITCHED_TEXT_SECTIONS (FILE *@var{file}, tree @var{decl}, bool @var{new_is_cold})
7245Used by the target to emit any assembler directives or additional labels needed when a function is partitioned between different sections. Output should be written to @var{file}. The function decl is available as @var{decl} and the new section is `cold' if @var{new_is_cold} is @code{true}.
7246@end deftypefn
7247
677f3fa8 7248@deftypevr {Common Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_NAMED_SECTIONS
7c262518 7249This flag is true if the target supports @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION}.
d5fabb58 7250It must not be modified by command-line option processing.
914d25dc 7251@end deftypevr
7c262518 7252
434aeebb 7253@anchor{TARGET_HAVE_SWITCHABLE_BSS_SECTIONS}
914d25dc 7254@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_SWITCHABLE_BSS_SECTIONS
434aeebb
RS
7255This flag is true if we can create zeroed data by switching to a BSS
7256section and then using @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP} to allocate the space.
7257This is true on most ELF targets.
914d25dc 7258@end deftypevr
434aeebb 7259
7c262518
RH
7260@deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_SECTION_TYPE_FLAGS (tree @var{decl}, const char *@var{name}, int @var{reloc})
7261Choose a set of section attributes for use by @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION}
7262based on a variable or function decl, a section name, and whether or not the
7263declaration's initializer may contain runtime relocations. @var{decl} may be
6ccde948 7264null, in which case read-write data should be assumed.
7c262518 7265
224504d2 7266The default version of this function handles choosing code vs data,
7c262518
RH
7267read-only vs read-write data, and @code{flag_pic}. You should only
7268need to override this if your target has special flags that might be
7269set via @code{__attribute__}.
7270@end deftypefn
7271
b6fd8800 7272@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES (print_switch_type @var{type}, const char *@var{text})
e0d9d0dd
NC
7273Provides the target with the ability to record the gcc command line
7274switches that have been passed to the compiler, and options that are
7275enabled. The @var{type} argument specifies what is being recorded.
7276It can take the following values:
7277
7278@table @gcctabopt
7279@item SWITCH_TYPE_PASSED
7280@var{text} is a command line switch that has been set by the user.
7281
7282@item SWITCH_TYPE_ENABLED
7283@var{text} is an option which has been enabled. This might be as a
7284direct result of a command line switch, or because it is enabled by
7285default or because it has been enabled as a side effect of a different
7286command line switch. For example, the @option{-O2} switch enables
7287various different individual optimization passes.
7288
7289@item SWITCH_TYPE_DESCRIPTIVE
7290@var{text} is either NULL or some descriptive text which should be
7291ignored. If @var{text} is NULL then it is being used to warn the
7292target hook that either recording is starting or ending. The first
7293time @var{type} is SWITCH_TYPE_DESCRIPTIVE and @var{text} is NULL, the
7294warning is for start up and the second time the warning is for
7295wind down. This feature is to allow the target hook to make any
7296necessary preparations before it starts to record switches and to
7297perform any necessary tidying up after it has finished recording
7298switches.
7299
7300@item SWITCH_TYPE_LINE_START
7301This option can be ignored by this target hook.
7302
7303@item SWITCH_TYPE_LINE_END
7304This option can be ignored by this target hook.
7305@end table
7306
7307The hook's return value must be zero. Other return values may be
7308supported in the future.
7309
7310By default this hook is set to NULL, but an example implementation is
7311provided for ELF based targets. Called @var{elf_record_gcc_switches},
7312it records the switches as ASCII text inside a new, string mergeable
7313section in the assembler output file. The name of the new section is
7314provided by the @code{TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES_SECTION} target
7315hook.
7316@end deftypefn
7317
914d25dc 7318@deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES_SECTION
e0d9d0dd
NC
7319This is the name of the section that will be created by the example
7320ELF implementation of the @code{TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES} target
7321hook.
914d25dc 7322@end deftypevr
e0d9d0dd 7323
feca2ed3
JW
7324@need 2000
7325@node Data Output
7326@subsection Output of Data
7327
301d03af
RS
7328
7329@deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP
7330@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_HI_OP
7331@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_SI_OP
7332@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_DI_OP
7333@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_TI_OP
7334@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_HI_OP
7335@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_SI_OP
7336@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_DI_OP
7337@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_TI_OP
7338These hooks specify assembly directives for creating certain kinds
7339of integer object. The @code{TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP} directive creates a
7340byte-sized object, the @code{TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_HI_OP} one creates an
7341aligned two-byte object, and so on. Any of the hooks may be
7342@code{NULL}, indicating that no suitable directive is available.
7343
7344The compiler will print these strings at the start of a new line,
7345followed immediately by the object's initial value. In most cases,
7346the string should contain a tab, a pseudo-op, and then another tab.
7347@end deftypevr
7348
7349@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_INTEGER (rtx @var{x}, unsigned int @var{size}, int @var{aligned_p})
7350The @code{assemble_integer} function uses this hook to output an
7351integer object. @var{x} is the object's value, @var{size} is its size
7352in bytes and @var{aligned_p} indicates whether it is aligned. The
7353function should return @code{true} if it was able to output the
7354object. If it returns false, @code{assemble_integer} will try to
7355split the object into smaller parts.
7356
7357The default implementation of this hook will use the
7358@code{TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP} family of strings, returning @code{false}
7359when the relevant string is @code{NULL}.
7360@end deftypefn
feca2ed3 7361
6cbd8875
AS
7362@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_CONST_EXTRA (FILE *@var{file}, rtx @var{x})
7363A target hook to recognize @var{rtx} patterns that @code{output_addr_const}
7364can't deal with, and output assembly code to @var{file} corresponding to
7365the pattern @var{x}. This may be used to allow machine-dependent
7366@code{UNSPEC}s to appear within constants.
7367
7368If target hook fails to recognize a pattern, it must return @code{false},
7369so that a standard error message is printed. If it prints an error message
7370itself, by calling, for example, @code{output_operand_lossage}, it may just
7371return @code{true}.
7372@end deftypefn
7373
a2c4f8e0 7374@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ASCII (@var{stream}, @var{ptr}, @var{len})
feca2ed3
JW
7375A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
7376instruction to assemble a string constant containing the @var{len}
7377bytes at @var{ptr}. @var{ptr} will be a C expression of type
7378@code{char *} and @var{len} a C expression of type @code{int}.
7379
7380If the assembler has a @code{.ascii} pseudo-op as found in the
7381Berkeley Unix assembler, do not define the macro
7382@code{ASM_OUTPUT_ASCII}.
a2c4f8e0 7383@end defmac
feca2ed3 7384
a2c4f8e0 7385@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_FDESC (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{n})
67231816
RH
7386A C statement to output word @var{n} of a function descriptor for
7387@var{decl}. This must be defined if @code{TARGET_VTABLE_USES_DESCRIPTORS}
7388is defined, and is otherwise unused.
a2c4f8e0 7389@end defmac
67231816 7390
a2c4f8e0 7391@defmac CONSTANT_POOL_BEFORE_FUNCTION
861bb6c1 7392You may define this macro as a C expression. You should define the
df2a54e9 7393expression to have a nonzero value if GCC should output the constant
861bb6c1 7394pool for a function before the code for the function, or a zero value if
a3a15b4d
JL
7395GCC should output the constant pool after the function. If you do
7396not define this macro, the usual case, GCC will output the constant
861bb6c1 7397pool before the function.
a2c4f8e0 7398@end defmac
861bb6c1 7399
a2c4f8e0 7400@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_POOL_PROLOGUE (@var{file}, @var{funname}, @var{fundecl}, @var{size})
feca2ed3
JW
7401A C statement to output assembler commands to define the start of the
7402constant pool for a function. @var{funname} is a string giving
7403the name of the function. Should the return type of the function
7404be required, it can be obtained via @var{fundecl}. @var{size}
7405is the size, in bytes, of the constant pool that will be written
7406immediately after this call.
7407
7408If no constant-pool prefix is required, the usual case, this macro need
7409not be defined.
a2c4f8e0 7410@end defmac
feca2ed3 7411
a2c4f8e0 7412@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SPECIAL_POOL_ENTRY (@var{file}, @var{x}, @var{mode}, @var{align}, @var{labelno}, @var{jumpto})
feca2ed3
JW
7413A C statement (with or without semicolon) to output a constant in the
7414constant pool, if it needs special treatment. (This macro need not do
7415anything for RTL expressions that can be output normally.)
7416
7417The argument @var{file} is the standard I/O stream to output the
7418assembler code on. @var{x} is the RTL expression for the constant to
7419output, and @var{mode} is the machine mode (in case @var{x} is a
7420@samp{const_int}). @var{align} is the required alignment for the value
7421@var{x}; you should output an assembler directive to force this much
7422alignment.
7423
7424The argument @var{labelno} is a number to use in an internal label for
7425the address of this pool entry. The definition of this macro is
7426responsible for outputting the label definition at the proper place.
7427Here is how to do this:
7428
3ab51846 7429@smallexample
4977bab6 7430@code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)} (@var{file}, "LC", @var{labelno});
3ab51846 7431@end smallexample
feca2ed3
JW
7432
7433When you output a pool entry specially, you should end with a
7434@code{goto} to the label @var{jumpto}. This will prevent the same pool
7435entry from being output a second time in the usual manner.
7436
7437You need not define this macro if it would do nothing.
a2c4f8e0 7438@end defmac
feca2ed3 7439
a2c4f8e0 7440@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_POOL_EPILOGUE (@var{file} @var{funname} @var{fundecl} @var{size})
861bb6c1
JL
7441A C statement to output assembler commands to at the end of the constant
7442pool for a function. @var{funname} is a string giving the name of the
7443function. Should the return type of the function be required, you can
7444obtain it via @var{fundecl}. @var{size} is the size, in bytes, of the
a3a15b4d 7445constant pool that GCC wrote immediately before this call.
861bb6c1
JL
7446
7447If no constant-pool epilogue is required, the usual case, you need not
7448define this macro.
a2c4f8e0 7449@end defmac
861bb6c1 7450
980d8882 7451@defmac IS_ASM_LOGICAL_LINE_SEPARATOR (@var{C}, @var{STR})
feca2ed3 7452Define this macro as a C expression which is nonzero if @var{C} is
980d8882
BS
7453used as a logical line separator by the assembler. @var{STR} points
7454to the position in the string where @var{C} was found; this can be used if
7455a line separator uses multiple characters.
feca2ed3
JW
7456
7457If you do not define this macro, the default is that only
7458the character @samp{;} is treated as a logical line separator.
a2c4f8e0 7459@end defmac
feca2ed3 7460
8ca83838 7461@deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_OPEN_PAREN
baed53ac 7462@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_CLOSE_PAREN
17b53c33
NB
7463These target hooks are C string constants, describing the syntax in the
7464assembler for grouping arithmetic expressions. If not overridden, they
7465default to normal parentheses, which is correct for most assemblers.
8ca83838 7466@end deftypevr
17b53c33 7467
6ccde948 7468These macros are provided by @file{real.h} for writing the definitions
feca2ed3
JW
7469of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DOUBLE} and the like:
7470
a2c4f8e0
ZW
7471@defmac REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_SINGLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
7472@defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DOUBLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
7473@defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_LONG_DOUBLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
dadb213f
BE
7474@defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL32 (@var{x}, @var{l})
7475@defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL64 (@var{x}, @var{l})
7476@defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL128 (@var{x}, @var{l})
7477These translate @var{x}, of type @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE}, to the
7478target's floating point representation, and store its bit pattern in
7479the variable @var{l}. For @code{REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_SINGLE} and
7480@code{REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL32}, this variable should be a
7481simple @code{long int}. For the others, it should be an array of
7482@code{long int}. The number of elements in this array is determined
7483by the size of the desired target floating point data type: 32 bits of
7484it go in each @code{long int} array element. Each array element holds
748532 bits of the result, even if @code{long int} is wider than 32 bits
7486on the host machine.
feca2ed3
JW
7487
7488The array element values are designed so that you can print them out
7489using @code{fprintf} in the order they should appear in the target
7490machine's memory.
a2c4f8e0 7491@end defmac
feca2ed3
JW
7492
7493@node Uninitialized Data
7494@subsection Output of Uninitialized Variables
7495
7496Each of the macros in this section is used to do the whole job of
7497outputting a single uninitialized variable.
7498
a2c4f8e0 7499@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
feca2ed3
JW
7500A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7501@var{stream} the assembler definition of a common-label named
7502@var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes. The variable @var{rounded}
233215fe
DK
7503is the size rounded up to whatever alignment the caller wants. It is
7504possible that @var{size} may be zero, for instance if a struct with no
7505other member than a zero-length array is defined. In this case, the
7506backend must output a symbol definition that allocates at least one
7507byte, both so that the address of the resulting object does not compare
7508equal to any other, and because some object formats cannot even express
7509the concept of a zero-sized common symbol, as that is how they represent
7510an ordinary undefined external.
feca2ed3
JW
7511
7512Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
7513output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
7514assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline.
7515
7516This macro controls how the assembler definitions of uninitialized
7517common global variables are output.
a2c4f8e0 7518@end defmac
feca2ed3 7519
a2c4f8e0 7520@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
feca2ed3
JW
7521Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} except takes the required alignment as a
7522separate, explicit argument. If you define this macro, it is used in
7523place of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON}, and gives you more flexibility in
7524handling the required alignment of the variable. The alignment is specified
7525as the number of bits.
a2c4f8e0 7526@end defmac
feca2ed3 7527
a2c4f8e0 7528@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
e9a25f70
JL
7529Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON} except that @var{decl} of the
7530variable to be output, if there is one, or @code{NULL_TREE} if there
8760eaae 7531is no corresponding variable. If you define this macro, GCC will use it
e9a25f70
JL
7532in place of both @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} and
7533@code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON}. Define this macro when you need to see
7534the variable's decl in order to chose what to output.
a2c4f8e0 7535@end defmac
e9a25f70 7536
07c5f94e 7537@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_BSS (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
feca2ed3
JW
7538A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7539@var{stream} the assembler definition of uninitialized global @var{decl} named
07c5f94e
AS
7540@var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes. The variable @var{alignment}
7541is the alignment specified as the number of bits.
feca2ed3 7542
07c5f94e
AS
7543Try to use function @code{asm_output_aligned_bss} defined in file
7544@file{varasm.c} when defining this macro. If unable, use the expression
feca2ed3
JW
7545@code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to output the name itself;
7546before and after that, output the additional assembler syntax for defining
7547the name, and a newline.
7548
07c5f94e 7549There are two ways of handling global BSS@. One is to define this macro.
434aeebb
RS
7550The other is to have @code{TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION} return a
7551switchable BSS section (@pxref{TARGET_HAVE_SWITCHABLE_BSS_SECTIONS}).
7552You do not need to do both.
7553
7554Some languages do not have @code{common} data, and require a
7555non-common form of global BSS in order to handle uninitialized globals
7556efficiently. C++ is one example of this. However, if the target does
7557not support global BSS, the front end may choose to make globals
7558common in order to save space in the object file.
a2c4f8e0 7559@end defmac
feca2ed3 7560
a2c4f8e0 7561@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
feca2ed3
JW
7562A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7563@var{stream} the assembler definition of a local-common-label named
7564@var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes. The variable @var{rounded}
7565is the size rounded up to whatever alignment the caller wants.
7566
7567Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
7568output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
7569assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline.
7570
7571This macro controls how the assembler definitions of uninitialized
7572static variables are output.
a2c4f8e0 7573@end defmac
feca2ed3 7574
a2c4f8e0 7575@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
feca2ed3
JW
7576Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL} except takes the required alignment as a
7577separate, explicit argument. If you define this macro, it is used in
7578place of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL}, and gives you more flexibility in
7579handling the required alignment of the variable. The alignment is specified
7580as the number of bits.
a2c4f8e0 7581@end defmac
feca2ed3 7582
a2c4f8e0 7583@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
e9a25f70
JL
7584Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL} except that @var{decl} of the
7585variable to be output, if there is one, or @code{NULL_TREE} if there
8760eaae 7586is no corresponding variable. If you define this macro, GCC will use it
e9a25f70
JL
7587in place of both @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DECL} and
7588@code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL}. Define this macro when you need to see
7589the variable's decl in order to chose what to output.
a2c4f8e0 7590@end defmac
e9a25f70 7591
feca2ed3
JW
7592@node Label Output
7593@subsection Output and Generation of Labels
7594
7595@c prevent bad page break with this line
7596This is about outputting labels.
7597
feca2ed3 7598@findex assemble_name
a2c4f8e0 7599@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
feca2ed3
JW
7600A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7601@var{stream} the assembler definition of a label named @var{name}.
7602Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
7603output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
4ad5e05d
KG
7604assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline. A default
7605definition of this macro is provided which is correct for most systems.
a2c4f8e0 7606@end defmac
feca2ed3 7607
135a687e
KT
7608@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
7609A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7610@var{stream} the assembler definition of a label named @var{name} of
7611a function.
7612Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
7613output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
7614assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline. A default
7615definition of this macro is provided which is correct for most systems.
7616
7617If this macro is not defined, then the function name is defined in the
7618usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}).
7619@end defmac
7620
57829bc4
MM
7621@findex assemble_name_raw
7622@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_INTERNAL_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
e374d5c9 7623Identical to @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}, except that @var{name} is known
57829bc4
MM
7624to refer to a compiler-generated label. The default definition uses
7625@code{assemble_name_raw}, which is like @code{assemble_name} except
7626that it is more efficient.
7627@end defmac
7628
a2c4f8e0 7629@defmac SIZE_ASM_OP
2be2ac70
ZW
7630A C string containing the appropriate assembler directive to specify the
7631size of a symbol, without any arguments. On systems that use ELF, the
7632default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is @samp{"\t.size\t"}; on other
7633systems, the default is not to define this macro.
7634
7635Define this macro only if it is correct to use the default definitions
7636of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE} and @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE}
7637for your system. If you need your own custom definitions of those
7638macros, or if you do not need explicit symbol sizes at all, do not
7639define this macro.
a2c4f8e0 7640@end defmac
2be2ac70 7641
a2c4f8e0 7642@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size})
2be2ac70
ZW
7643A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7644@var{stream} a directive telling the assembler that the size of the
7645symbol @var{name} is @var{size}. @var{size} is a @code{HOST_WIDE_INT}.
7646If you define @code{SIZE_ASM_OP}, a default definition of this macro is
7647provided.
a2c4f8e0 7648@end defmac
2be2ac70 7649
a2c4f8e0 7650@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE (@var{stream}, @var{name})
2be2ac70
ZW
7651A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7652@var{stream} a directive telling the assembler to calculate the size of
99086d59 7653the symbol @var{name} by subtracting its address from the current
73774972 7654address.
99086d59
ZW
7655
7656If you define @code{SIZE_ASM_OP}, a default definition of this macro is
7657provided. The default assumes that the assembler recognizes a special
7658@samp{.} symbol as referring to the current address, and can calculate
7659the difference between this and another symbol. If your assembler does
7660not recognize @samp{.} or cannot do calculations with it, you will need
7661to redefine @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} to use some other technique.
a2c4f8e0 7662@end defmac
2be2ac70 7663
e537ef59
GP
7664@defmac NO_DOLLAR_IN_LABEL
7665Define this macro if the assembler does not accept the character
7666@samp{$} in label names. By default constructors and destructors in
7667G++ have @samp{$} in the identifiers. If this macro is defined,
7668@samp{.} is used instead.
7669@end defmac
7670
7671@defmac NO_DOT_IN_LABEL
7672Define this macro if the assembler does not accept the character
7673@samp{.} in label names. By default constructors and destructors in G++
7674have names that use @samp{.}. If this macro is defined, these names
7675are rewritten to avoid @samp{.}.
7676@end defmac
7677
a2c4f8e0 7678@defmac TYPE_ASM_OP
2be2ac70
ZW
7679A C string containing the appropriate assembler directive to specify the
7680type of a symbol, without any arguments. On systems that use ELF, the
7681default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is @samp{"\t.type\t"}; on other
7682systems, the default is not to define this macro.
7683
7684Define this macro only if it is correct to use the default definition of
7685@code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} for your system. If you need your own
7686custom definition of this macro, or if you do not need explicit symbol
7687types at all, do not define this macro.
a2c4f8e0 7688@end defmac
2be2ac70 7689
a2c4f8e0 7690@defmac TYPE_OPERAND_FMT
2be2ac70
ZW
7691A C string which specifies (using @code{printf} syntax) the format of
7692the second operand to @code{TYPE_ASM_OP}. On systems that use ELF, the
7693default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is @samp{"@@%s"}; on other systems,
7694the default is not to define this macro.
7695
7696Define this macro only if it is correct to use the default definition of
7697@code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} for your system. If you need your own
7698custom definition of this macro, or if you do not need explicit symbol
7699types at all, do not define this macro.
a2c4f8e0 7700@end defmac
2be2ac70 7701
a2c4f8e0 7702@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE (@var{stream}, @var{type})
2be2ac70
ZW
7703A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7704@var{stream} a directive telling the assembler that the type of the
7705symbol @var{name} is @var{type}. @var{type} is a C string; currently,
7706that string is always either @samp{"function"} or @samp{"object"}, but
7707you should not count on this.
7708
7709If you define @code{TYPE_ASM_OP} and @code{TYPE_OPERAND_FMT}, a default
7710definition of this macro is provided.
a2c4f8e0 7711@end defmac
2be2ac70 7712
a2c4f8e0 7713@defmac ASM_DECLARE_FUNCTION_NAME (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
feca2ed3
JW
7714A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7715@var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name @var{name} of a
7716function which is being defined. This macro is responsible for
7717outputting the label definition (perhaps using
135a687e 7718@code{ASM_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_LABEL}). The argument @var{decl} is the
feca2ed3
JW
7719@code{FUNCTION_DECL} tree node representing the function.
7720
7721If this macro is not defined, then the function name is defined in the
135a687e 7722usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_LABEL}).
feca2ed3 7723
2be2ac70
ZW
7724You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} in the definition
7725of this macro.
a2c4f8e0 7726@end defmac
2be2ac70 7727
a2c4f8e0 7728@defmac ASM_DECLARE_FUNCTION_SIZE (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
feca2ed3
JW
7729A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7730@var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the size of a function
7731which is being defined. The argument @var{name} is the name of the
7732function. The argument @var{decl} is the @code{FUNCTION_DECL} tree node
7733representing the function.
7734
7735If this macro is not defined, then the function size is not defined.
7736
2be2ac70
ZW
7737You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} in the definition
7738of this macro.
a2c4f8e0 7739@end defmac
2be2ac70 7740
a2c4f8e0 7741@defmac ASM_DECLARE_OBJECT_NAME (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
feca2ed3
JW
7742A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7743@var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name @var{name} of an
7744initialized variable which is being defined. This macro must output the
7745label definition (perhaps using @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}). The argument
7746@var{decl} is the @code{VAR_DECL} tree node representing the variable.
7747
7748If this macro is not defined, then the variable name is defined in the
7749usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}).
7750
2be2ac70
ZW
7751You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} and/or
7752@code{ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE} in the definition of this macro.
a2c4f8e0 7753@end defmac
2be2ac70 7754
ad78130c 7755@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_DECLARE_CONSTANT_NAME (FILE *@var{file}, const char *@var{name}, const_tree @var{expr}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{size})
e4f7c483
AS
7756A target hook to output to the stdio stream @var{file} any text necessary
7757for declaring the name @var{name} of a constant which is being defined. This
7758target hook is responsible for outputting the label definition (perhaps using
7759@code{assemble_label}). The argument @var{exp} is the value of the constant,
7760and @var{size} is the size of the constant in bytes. The @var{name}
7761will be an internal label.
18f3e349 7762
e4f7c483
AS
7763The default version of this target hook, define the @var{name} in the
7764usual manner as a label (by means of @code{assemble_label}).
18f3e349 7765
e4f7c483
AS
7766You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} in this target hook.
7767@end deftypefn
18f3e349 7768
a2c4f8e0 7769@defmac ASM_DECLARE_REGISTER_GLOBAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{regno}, @var{name})
1cb36a98
RH
7770A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7771@var{stream} any text necessary for claiming a register @var{regno}
7772for a global variable @var{decl} with name @var{name}.
7773
7774If you don't define this macro, that is equivalent to defining it to do
7775nothing.
a2c4f8e0 7776@end defmac
1cb36a98 7777
a2c4f8e0 7778@defmac ASM_FINISH_DECLARE_OBJECT (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{toplevel}, @var{atend})
feca2ed3
JW
7779A C statement (sans semicolon) to finish up declaring a variable name
7780once the compiler has processed its initializer fully and thus has had a
7781chance to determine the size of an array when controlled by an
7782initializer. This is used on systems where it's necessary to declare
7783something about the size of the object.
7784
7785If you don't define this macro, that is equivalent to defining it to do
7786nothing.
7787
2be2ac70
ZW
7788You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE} and/or
7789@code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} in the definition of this macro.
a2c4f8e0 7790@end defmac
2be2ac70 7791
5eb99654
KG
7792@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_GLOBALIZE_LABEL (FILE *@var{stream}, const char *@var{name})
7793This target hook is a function to output to the stdio stream
feca2ed3 7794@var{stream} some commands that will make the label @var{name} global;
5eb99654 7795that is, available for reference from other files.
feca2ed3 7796
5eb99654
KG
7797The default implementation relies on a proper definition of
7798@code{GLOBAL_ASM_OP}.
b65d23aa 7799@end deftypefn
072cdaed 7800
812b587e
SE
7801@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_GLOBALIZE_DECL_NAME (FILE *@var{stream}, tree @var{decl})
7802This target hook is a function to output to the stdio stream
7803@var{stream} some commands that will make the name associated with @var{decl}
7804global; that is, available for reference from other files.
7805
7806The default implementation uses the TARGET_ASM_GLOBALIZE_LABEL target hook.
7807@end deftypefn
7808
a2c4f8e0 7809@defmac ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
feca2ed3
JW
7810A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7811@var{stream} some commands that will make the label @var{name} weak;
7812that is, available for reference from other files but only used if
7813no other definition is available. Use the expression
7814@code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to output the name
7815itself; before and after that, output the additional assembler syntax
7816for making that name weak, and a newline.
7817
79c4e63f
AM
7818If you don't define this macro or @code{ASM_WEAKEN_DECL}, GCC will not
7819support weak symbols and you should not define the @code{SUPPORTS_WEAK}
7820macro.
a2c4f8e0 7821@end defmac
79c4e63f 7822
a2c4f8e0 7823@defmac ASM_WEAKEN_DECL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{value})
79c4e63f
AM
7824Combines (and replaces) the function of @code{ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL} and
7825@code{ASM_OUTPUT_WEAK_ALIAS}, allowing access to the associated function
7826or variable decl. If @var{value} is not @code{NULL}, this C statement
7827should output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code which
7828defines (equates) the weak symbol @var{name} to have the value
7829@var{value}. If @var{value} is @code{NULL}, it should output commands
7830to make @var{name} weak.
a2c4f8e0 7831@end defmac
feca2ed3 7832
ff2d10c1
AO
7833@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_WEAKREF (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{value})
7834Outputs a directive that enables @var{name} to be used to refer to
7835symbol @var{value} with weak-symbol semantics. @code{decl} is the
7836declaration of @code{name}.
7837@end defmac
7838
a2c4f8e0 7839@defmac SUPPORTS_WEAK
74b90fe2
JDA
7840A preprocessor constant expression which evaluates to true if the target
7841supports weak symbols.
feca2ed3
JW
7842
7843If you don't define this macro, @file{defaults.h} provides a default
79c4e63f 7844definition. If either @code{ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL} or @code{ASM_WEAKEN_DECL}
74b90fe2
JDA
7845is defined, the default definition is @samp{1}; otherwise, it is @samp{0}.
7846@end defmac
7847
7848@defmac TARGET_SUPPORTS_WEAK
7849A C expression which evaluates to true if the target supports weak symbols.
7850
7851If you don't define this macro, @file{defaults.h} provides a default
7852definition. The default definition is @samp{(SUPPORTS_WEAK)}. Define
7853this macro if you want to control weak symbol support with a compiler
7854flag such as @option{-melf}.
a2c4f8e0 7855@end defmac
feca2ed3 7856
a2c4f8e0 7857@defmac MAKE_DECL_ONE_ONLY (@var{decl})
feca2ed3
JW
7858A C statement (sans semicolon) to mark @var{decl} to be emitted as a
7859public symbol such that extra copies in multiple translation units will
7860be discarded by the linker. Define this macro if your object file
7861format provides support for this concept, such as the @samp{COMDAT}
7862section flags in the Microsoft Windows PE/COFF format, and this support
7863requires changes to @var{decl}, such as putting it in a separate section.
a2c4f8e0 7864@end defmac
feca2ed3 7865
a2c4f8e0 7866@defmac SUPPORTS_ONE_ONLY
feca2ed3
JW
7867A C expression which evaluates to true if the target supports one-only
7868semantics.
7869
7870If you don't define this macro, @file{varasm.c} provides a default
7871definition. If @code{MAKE_DECL_ONE_ONLY} is defined, the default
7872definition is @samp{1}; otherwise, it is @samp{0}. Define this macro if
e9a25f70 7873you want to control one-only symbol support with a compiler flag, or if
feca2ed3
JW
7874setting the @code{DECL_ONE_ONLY} flag is enough to mark a declaration to
7875be emitted as one-only.
a2c4f8e0 7876@end defmac
feca2ed3 7877
914d25dc 7878@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_ASSEMBLE_VISIBILITY (tree @var{decl}, int @var{visibility})
93638d7a
AM
7879This target hook is a function to output to @var{asm_out_file} some
7880commands that will make the symbol(s) associated with @var{decl} have
7881hidden, protected or internal visibility as specified by @var{visibility}.
7882@end deftypefn
7883
0524c91d 7884@defmac TARGET_WEAK_NOT_IN_ARCHIVE_TOC
4746cf84 7885A C expression that evaluates to true if the target's linker expects
0524c91d 7886that weak symbols do not appear in a static archive's table of contents.
f676971a 7887The default is @code{0}.
0524c91d
MA
7888
7889Leaving weak symbols out of an archive's table of contents means that,
7890if a symbol will only have a definition in one translation unit and
7891will have undefined references from other translation units, that
7892symbol should not be weak. Defining this macro to be nonzero will
7893thus have the effect that certain symbols that would normally be weak
7894(explicit template instantiations, and vtables for polymorphic classes
7895with noninline key methods) will instead be nonweak.
7896
7897The C++ ABI requires this macro to be zero. Define this macro for
7898targets where full C++ ABI compliance is impossible and where linker
7899restrictions require weak symbols to be left out of a static archive's
7900table of contents.
4746cf84
MA
7901@end defmac
7902
a2c4f8e0 7903@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_EXTERNAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name})
feca2ed3
JW
7904A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7905@var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name of an external
7906symbol named @var{name} which is referenced in this compilation but
7907not defined. The value of @var{decl} is the tree node for the
7908declaration.
7909
7910This macro need not be defined if it does not need to output anything.
7911The GNU assembler and most Unix assemblers don't require anything.
a2c4f8e0 7912@end defmac
feca2ed3 7913
6773a41c
RO
7914@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_EXTERNAL_LIBCALL (rtx @var{symref})
7915This target hook is a function to output to @var{asm_out_file} an assembler
feca2ed3 7916pseudo-op to declare a library function name external. The name of the
6773a41c
RO
7917library function is given by @var{symref}, which is a @code{symbol_ref}.
7918@end deftypefn
feca2ed3 7919
914d25dc 7920@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_MARK_DECL_PRESERVED (const char *@var{symbol})
8e3e233b 7921This target hook is a function to output to @var{asm_out_file} an assembler
914d25dc
JR
7922directive to annotate @var{symbol} as used. The Darwin target uses the
7923.no_dead_code_strip directive.
8e3e233b
DP
7924@end deftypefn
7925
a2c4f8e0 7926@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF (@var{stream}, @var{name})
feca2ed3
JW
7927A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7928@var{stream} a reference in assembler syntax to a label named
7929@var{name}. This should add @samp{_} to the front of the name, if that
7930is customary on your operating system, as it is in most Berkeley Unix
7931systems. This macro is used in @code{assemble_name}.
a2c4f8e0 7932@end defmac
feca2ed3 7933
77754180
DK
7934@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_MANGLE_ASSEMBLER_NAME (const char *@var{name})
7935Given a symbol @var{name}, perform same mangling as @code{varasm.c}'s @code{assemble_name}, but in memory rather than to a file stream, returning result as an @code{IDENTIFIER_NODE}. Required for correct LTO symtabs. The default implementation calls the @code{TARGET_STRIP_NAME_ENCODING} hook and then prepends the @code{USER_LABEL_PREFIX}, if any.
7936@end deftypefn
7937
a2c4f8e0 7938@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SYMBOL_REF (@var{stream}, @var{sym})
99c8c61c 7939A C statement (sans semicolon) to output a reference to
2f0b7af6 7940@code{SYMBOL_REF} @var{sym}. If not defined, @code{assemble_name}
99c8c61c
AO
7941will be used to output the name of the symbol. This macro may be used
7942to modify the way a symbol is referenced depending on information
fb49053f 7943encoded by @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}.
a2c4f8e0 7944@end defmac
99c8c61c 7945
a2c4f8e0 7946@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL_REF (@var{stream}, @var{buf})
2f0b7af6 7947A C statement (sans semicolon) to output a reference to @var{buf}, the
4226378a 7948result of @code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL}. If not defined,
2f0b7af6
GK
7949@code{assemble_name} will be used to output the name of the symbol.
7950This macro is not used by @code{output_asm_label}, or the @code{%l}
7951specifier that calls it; the intention is that this macro should be set
4226378a
PK
7952when it is necessary to output a label differently when its address is
7953being taken.
a2c4f8e0 7954@end defmac
2f0b7af6 7955
4977bab6
ZW
7956@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_INTERNAL_LABEL (FILE *@var{stream}, const char *@var{prefix}, unsigned long @var{labelno})
7957A function to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} a label whose
7958name is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number @var{labelno}.
feca2ed3
JW
7959
7960It is absolutely essential that these labels be distinct from the labels
7961used for user-level functions and variables. Otherwise, certain programs
7962will have name conflicts with internal labels.
7963
7964It is desirable to exclude internal labels from the symbol table of the
7965object file. Most assemblers have a naming convention for labels that
7966should be excluded; on many systems, the letter @samp{L} at the
7967beginning of a label has this effect. You should find out what
7968convention your system uses, and follow it.
7969
8a36672b 7970The default version of this function utilizes @code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL}.
4977bab6 7971@end deftypefn
feca2ed3 7972
a2c4f8e0 7973@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{prefix}, @var{num})
8215347e
JW
7974A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} a debug info
7975label whose name is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number
7976@var{num}. This is useful for VLIW targets, where debug info labels
7977may need to be treated differently than branch target labels. On some
7978systems, branch target labels must be at the beginning of instruction
7979bundles, but debug info labels can occur in the middle of instruction
7980bundles.
7981
4977bab6 7982If this macro is not defined, then @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)} will be
8215347e 7983used.
a2c4f8e0 7984@end defmac
8215347e 7985
a2c4f8e0 7986@defmac ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (@var{string}, @var{prefix}, @var{num})
feca2ed3
JW
7987A C statement to store into the string @var{string} a label whose name
7988is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number @var{num}.
7989
7990This string, when output subsequently by @code{assemble_name}, should
4977bab6 7991produce the output that @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)} would produce
feca2ed3
JW
7992with the same @var{prefix} and @var{num}.
7993
7994If the string begins with @samp{*}, then @code{assemble_name} will
7995output the rest of the string unchanged. It is often convenient for
7996@code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL} to use @samp{*} in this way. If the
7997string doesn't start with @samp{*}, then @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} gets
7998to output the string, and may change it. (Of course,
7999@code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} is also part of your machine description, so
8000you should know what it does on your machine.)
a2c4f8e0 8001@end defmac
feca2ed3 8002
a2c4f8e0 8003@defmac ASM_FORMAT_PRIVATE_NAME (@var{outvar}, @var{name}, @var{number})
feca2ed3
JW
8004A C expression to assign to @var{outvar} (which is a variable of type
8005@code{char *}) a newly allocated string made from the string
8006@var{name} and the number @var{number}, with some suitable punctuation
8007added. Use @code{alloca} to get space for the string.
8008
8009The string will be used as an argument to @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} to
8010produce an assembler label for an internal static variable whose name is
8011@var{name}. Therefore, the string must be such as to result in valid
8012assembler code. The argument @var{number} is different each time this
8013macro is executed; it prevents conflicts between similarly-named
8014internal static variables in different scopes.
8015
8016Ideally this string should not be a valid C identifier, to prevent any
8017conflict with the user's own symbols. Most assemblers allow periods
8018or percent signs in assembler symbols; putting at least one of these
8019between the name and the number will suffice.
8020
4977bab6
ZW
8021If this macro is not defined, a default definition will be provided
8022which is correct for most systems.
a2c4f8e0 8023@end defmac
4977bab6 8024
a2c4f8e0 8025@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DEF (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{value})
feca2ed3
JW
8026A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
8027which defines (equates) the symbol @var{name} to have the value @var{value}.
8028
203cb4ef 8029@findex SET_ASM_OP
aee96fe9 8030If @code{SET_ASM_OP} is defined, a default definition is provided which is
feca2ed3 8031correct for most systems.
a2c4f8e0 8032@end defmac
810e3c45 8033
a2c4f8e0 8034@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DEF_FROM_DECLS (@var{stream}, @var{decl_of_name}, @var{decl_of_value})
e4faf1eb 8035A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
3b7a2e58 8036which defines (equates) the symbol whose tree node is @var{decl_of_name}
e4faf1eb
NC
8037to have the value of the tree node @var{decl_of_value}. This macro will
8038be used in preference to @samp{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} if it is defined and if
8039the tree nodes are available.
8040
203cb4ef 8041@findex SET_ASM_OP
aee96fe9 8042If @code{SET_ASM_OP} is defined, a default definition is provided which is
956d6950 8043correct for most systems.
a2c4f8e0 8044@end defmac
956d6950 8045
083b6717
JDA
8046@defmac TARGET_DEFERRED_OUTPUT_DEFS (@var{decl_of_name}, @var{decl_of_value})
8047A C statement that evaluates to true if the assembler code which defines
8048(equates) the symbol whose tree node is @var{decl_of_name} to have the value
8049of the tree node @var{decl_of_value} should be emitted near the end of the
8050current compilation unit. The default is to not defer output of defines.
8051This macro affects defines output by @samp{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} and
8052@samp{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF_FROM_DECLS}.
8053@end defmac
8054
a2c4f8e0 8055@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_WEAK_ALIAS (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{value})
810e3c45
JM
8056A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
8057which defines (equates) the weak symbol @var{name} to have the value
3aa8ab7b
L
8058@var{value}. If @var{value} is @code{NULL}, it defines @var{name} as
8059an undefined weak symbol.
810e3c45
JM
8060
8061Define this macro if the target only supports weak aliases; define
aee96fe9 8062@code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} instead if possible.
a2c4f8e0 8063@end defmac
810e3c45 8064
a2c4f8e0 8065@defmac OBJC_GEN_METHOD_LABEL (@var{buf}, @var{is_inst}, @var{class_name}, @var{cat_name}, @var{sel_name})
feca2ed3 8066Define this macro to override the default assembler names used for
2147b154 8067Objective-C methods.
feca2ed3
JW
8068
8069The default name is a unique method number followed by the name of the
8070class (e.g.@: @samp{_1_Foo}). For methods in categories, the name of
8071the category is also included in the assembler name (e.g.@:
8072@samp{_1_Foo_Bar}).
8073
8074These names are safe on most systems, but make debugging difficult since
8075the method's selector is not present in the name. Therefore, particular
8076systems define other ways of computing names.
8077
8078@var{buf} is an expression of type @code{char *} which gives you a
8079buffer in which to store the name; its length is as long as
8080@var{class_name}, @var{cat_name} and @var{sel_name} put together, plus
808150 characters extra.
8082
8083The argument @var{is_inst} specifies whether the method is an instance
8084method or a class method; @var{class_name} is the name of the class;
59d42021 8085@var{cat_name} is the name of the category (or @code{NULL} if the method is not
feca2ed3
JW
8086in a category); and @var{sel_name} is the name of the selector.
8087
8088On systems where the assembler can handle quoted names, you can use this
8089macro to provide more human-readable names.
a2c4f8e0 8090@end defmac
28df0b5a 8091
feca2ed3
JW
8092@node Initialization
8093@subsection How Initialization Functions Are Handled
8094@cindex initialization routines
8095@cindex termination routines
8096@cindex constructors, output of
8097@cindex destructors, output of
8098
8099The compiled code for certain languages includes @dfn{constructors}
8100(also called @dfn{initialization routines})---functions to initialize
8101data in the program when the program is started. These functions need
8102to be called before the program is ``started''---that is to say, before
8103@code{main} is called.
8104
8105Compiling some languages generates @dfn{destructors} (also called
8106@dfn{termination routines}) that should be called when the program
8107terminates.
8108
8109To make the initialization and termination functions work, the compiler
8110must output something in the assembler code to cause those functions to
8111be called at the appropriate time. When you port the compiler to a new
8112system, you need to specify how to do this.
8113
8114There are two major ways that GCC currently supports the execution of
8115initialization and termination functions. Each way has two variants.
8116Much of the structure is common to all four variations.
8117
8118@findex __CTOR_LIST__
8119@findex __DTOR_LIST__
8120The linker must build two lists of these functions---a list of
8121initialization functions, called @code{__CTOR_LIST__}, and a list of
8122termination functions, called @code{__DTOR_LIST__}.
8123
8124Each list always begins with an ignored function pointer (which may hold
81250, @minus{}1, or a count of the function pointers after it, depending on
8126the environment). This is followed by a series of zero or more function
8127pointers to constructors (or destructors), followed by a function
8128pointer containing zero.
8129
8130Depending on the operating system and its executable file format, either
8131@file{crtstuff.c} or @file{libgcc2.c} traverses these lists at startup
8132time and exit time. Constructors are called in reverse order of the
8133list; destructors in forward order.
8134
8135The best way to handle static constructors works only for object file
8136formats which provide arbitrarily-named sections. A section is set
8137aside for a list of constructors, and another for a list of destructors.
8138Traditionally these are called @samp{.ctors} and @samp{.dtors}. Each
8139object file that defines an initialization function also puts a word in
8140the constructor section to point to that function. The linker
8141accumulates all these words into one contiguous @samp{.ctors} section.
8142Termination functions are handled similarly.
8143
2cc07db4
RH
8144This method will be chosen as the default by @file{target-def.h} if
8145@code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION} is defined. A target that does not
f282ffb3 8146support arbitrary sections, but does support special designated
2cc07db4
RH
8147constructor and destructor sections may define @code{CTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP}
8148and @code{DTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP} to achieve the same effect.
feca2ed3
JW
8149
8150When arbitrary sections are available, there are two variants, depending
8151upon how the code in @file{crtstuff.c} is called. On systems that
2cc07db4 8152support a @dfn{.init} section which is executed at program startup,
feca2ed3 8153parts of @file{crtstuff.c} are compiled into that section. The
05739753 8154program is linked by the @command{gcc} driver like this:
feca2ed3 8155
3ab51846 8156@smallexample
2cc07db4 8157ld -o @var{output_file} crti.o crtbegin.o @dots{} -lgcc crtend.o crtn.o
3ab51846 8158@end smallexample
feca2ed3 8159
2cc07db4
RH
8160The prologue of a function (@code{__init}) appears in the @code{.init}
8161section of @file{crti.o}; the epilogue appears in @file{crtn.o}. Likewise
8162for the function @code{__fini} in the @dfn{.fini} section. Normally these
8163files are provided by the operating system or by the GNU C library, but
8164are provided by GCC for a few targets.
8165
8166The objects @file{crtbegin.o} and @file{crtend.o} are (for most targets)
8167compiled from @file{crtstuff.c}. They contain, among other things, code
8168fragments within the @code{.init} and @code{.fini} sections that branch
8169to routines in the @code{.text} section. The linker will pull all parts
8170of a section together, which results in a complete @code{__init} function
8171that invokes the routines we need at startup.
feca2ed3
JW
8172
8173To use this variant, you must define the @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}
8174macro properly.
8175
2cc07db4
RH
8176If no init section is available, when GCC compiles any function called
8177@code{main} (or more accurately, any function designated as a program
8178entry point by the language front end calling @code{expand_main_function}),
8179it inserts a procedure call to @code{__main} as the first executable code
8180after the function prologue. The @code{__main} function is defined
8181in @file{libgcc2.c} and runs the global constructors.
feca2ed3
JW
8182
8183In file formats that don't support arbitrary sections, there are again
8184two variants. In the simplest variant, the GNU linker (GNU @code{ld})
8185and an `a.out' format must be used. In this case,
2cc07db4 8186@code{TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR} is defined to produce a @code{.stabs}
feca2ed3
JW
8187entry of type @samp{N_SETT}, referencing the name @code{__CTOR_LIST__},
8188and with the address of the void function containing the initialization
8189code as its value. The GNU linker recognizes this as a request to add
2cc07db4 8190the value to a @dfn{set}; the values are accumulated, and are eventually
feca2ed3
JW
8191placed in the executable as a vector in the format described above, with
8192a leading (ignored) count and a trailing zero element.
2cc07db4 8193@code{TARGET_ASM_DESTRUCTOR} is handled similarly. Since no init
feca2ed3
JW
8194section is available, the absence of @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP} causes
8195the compilation of @code{main} to call @code{__main} as above, starting
8196the initialization process.
8197
8198The last variant uses neither arbitrary sections nor the GNU linker.
8199This is preferable when you want to do dynamic linking and when using
161d7b59 8200file formats which the GNU linker does not support, such as `ECOFF'@. In
2cc07db4
RH
8201this case, @code{TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS} is false, initialization and
8202termination functions are recognized simply by their names. This requires
8203an extra program in the linkage step, called @command{collect2}. This program
8204pretends to be the linker, for use with GCC; it does its job by running
8205the ordinary linker, but also arranges to include the vectors of
8206initialization and termination functions. These functions are called
8207via @code{__main} as described above. In order to use this method,
8208@code{use_collect2} must be defined in the target in @file{config.gcc}.
feca2ed3
JW
8209
8210@ifinfo
8211The following section describes the specific macros that control and
8212customize the handling of initialization and termination functions.
8213@end ifinfo
8214
8215@node Macros for Initialization
8216@subsection Macros Controlling Initialization Routines
8217
8218Here are the macros that control how the compiler handles initialization
8219and termination functions:
8220
a2c4f8e0 8221@defmac INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP
047c1c92
HPN
8222If defined, a C string constant, including spacing, for the assembler
8223operation to identify the following data as initialization code. If not
8224defined, GCC will assume such a section does not exist. When you are
8225using special sections for initialization and termination functions, this
8226macro also controls how @file{crtstuff.c} and @file{libgcc2.c} arrange to
8227run the initialization functions.
a2c4f8e0 8228@end defmac
feca2ed3 8229
a2c4f8e0 8230@defmac HAS_INIT_SECTION
feca2ed3 8231If defined, @code{main} will not call @code{__main} as described above.
2cc07db4
RH
8232This macro should be defined for systems that control start-up code
8233on a symbol-by-symbol basis, such as OSF/1, and should not
8234be defined explicitly for systems that support @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}.
a2c4f8e0 8235@end defmac
feca2ed3 8236
a2c4f8e0 8237@defmac LD_INIT_SWITCH
feca2ed3
JW
8238If defined, a C string constant for a switch that tells the linker that
8239the following symbol is an initialization routine.
a2c4f8e0 8240@end defmac
feca2ed3 8241
a2c4f8e0 8242@defmac LD_FINI_SWITCH
feca2ed3
JW
8243If defined, a C string constant for a switch that tells the linker that
8244the following symbol is a finalization routine.
a2c4f8e0 8245@end defmac
feca2ed3 8246
a2c4f8e0 8247@defmac COLLECT_SHARED_INIT_FUNC (@var{stream}, @var{func})
414e05cf
RE
8248If defined, a C statement that will write a function that can be
8249automatically called when a shared library is loaded. The function
8250should call @var{func}, which takes no arguments. If not defined, and
8251the object format requires an explicit initialization function, then a
172270b3 8252function called @code{_GLOBAL__DI} will be generated.
414e05cf
RE
8253
8254This function and the following one are used by collect2 when linking a
f282ffb3 8255shared library that needs constructors or destructors, or has DWARF2
414e05cf 8256exception tables embedded in the code.
a2c4f8e0 8257@end defmac
414e05cf 8258
a2c4f8e0 8259@defmac COLLECT_SHARED_FINI_FUNC (@var{stream}, @var{func})
414e05cf
RE
8260If defined, a C statement that will write a function that can be
8261automatically called when a shared library is unloaded. The function
8262should call @var{func}, which takes no arguments. If not defined, and
8263the object format requires an explicit finalization function, then a
172270b3 8264function called @code{_GLOBAL__DD} will be generated.
a2c4f8e0 8265@end defmac
414e05cf 8266
a2c4f8e0 8267@defmac INVOKE__main
feca2ed3
JW
8268If defined, @code{main} will call @code{__main} despite the presence of
8269@code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}. This macro should be defined for systems
8270where the init section is not actually run automatically, but is still
8271useful for collecting the lists of constructors and destructors.
a2c4f8e0 8272@end defmac
feca2ed3 8273
a2c4f8e0 8274@defmac SUPPORTS_INIT_PRIORITY
ea4f1fce
JO
8275If nonzero, the C++ @code{init_priority} attribute is supported and the
8276compiler should emit instructions to control the order of initialization
8277of objects. If zero, the compiler will issue an error message upon
8278encountering an @code{init_priority} attribute.
a2c4f8e0 8279@end defmac
2cc07db4 8280
914d25dc 8281@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS
2cc07db4
RH
8282This value is true if the target supports some ``native'' method of
8283collecting constructors and destructors to be run at startup and exit.
8284It is false if we must use @command{collect2}.
914d25dc 8285@end deftypevr
2cc07db4
RH
8286
8287@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR (rtx @var{symbol}, int @var{priority})
8288If defined, a function that outputs assembler code to arrange to call
8289the function referenced by @var{symbol} at initialization time.
ea4f1fce 8290
2cc07db4
RH
8291Assume that @var{symbol} is a @code{SYMBOL_REF} for a function taking
8292no arguments and with no return value. If the target supports initialization
8293priorities, @var{priority} is a value between 0 and @code{MAX_INIT_PRIORITY};
8294otherwise it must be @code{DEFAULT_INIT_PRIORITY}.
8295
14976c58 8296If this macro is not defined by the target, a suitable default will
2cc07db4
RH
8297be chosen if (1) the target supports arbitrary section names, (2) the
8298target defines @code{CTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP}, or (3) @code{USE_COLLECT2}
8299is not defined.
8300@end deftypefn
8301
8302@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_DESTRUCTOR (rtx @var{symbol}, int @var{priority})
8303This is like @code{TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR} but used for termination
feca2ed3 8304functions rather than initialization functions.
2cc07db4 8305@end deftypefn
14686fcd 8306
2cc07db4
RH
8307If @code{TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS} is true, the initialization routine
8308generated for the generated object file will have static linkage.
feca2ed3 8309
2cc07db4
RH
8310If your system uses @command{collect2} as the means of processing
8311constructors, then that program normally uses @command{nm} to scan
8312an object file for constructor functions to be called.
14686fcd 8313
4a023207 8314On certain kinds of systems, you can define this macro to make
2cc07db4 8315@command{collect2} work faster (and, in some cases, make it work at all):
feca2ed3 8316
a2c4f8e0 8317@defmac OBJECT_FORMAT_COFF
feca2ed3 8318Define this macro if the system uses COFF (Common Object File Format)
2cc07db4 8319object files, so that @command{collect2} can assume this format and scan
feca2ed3 8320object files directly for dynamic constructor/destructor functions.
feca2ed3 8321
4a023207 8322This macro is effective only in a native compiler; @command{collect2} as
2cc07db4 8323part of a cross compiler always uses @command{nm} for the target machine.
a2c4f8e0 8324@end defmac
feca2ed3 8325
a2c4f8e0 8326@defmac REAL_NM_FILE_NAME
feca2ed3 8327Define this macro as a C string constant containing the file name to use
2cc07db4
RH
8328to execute @command{nm}. The default is to search the path normally for
8329@command{nm}.
3e794bfe
RO
8330@end defmac
8331
8332@defmac NM_FLAGS
8333@command{collect2} calls @command{nm} to scan object files for static
8334constructors and destructors and LTO info. By default, @option{-n} is
8335passed. Define @code{NM_FLAGS} to a C string constant if other options
2b0d3573 8336are needed to get the same output format as GNU @command{nm -n}
3e794bfe
RO
8337produces.
8338@end defmac
feca2ed3
JW
8339
8340If your system supports shared libraries and has a program to list the
8341dynamic dependencies of a given library or executable, you can define
8342these macros to enable support for running initialization and
8343termination functions in shared libraries:
8344
a2c4f8e0 8345@defmac LDD_SUFFIX
2cc07db4 8346Define this macro to a C string constant containing the name of the program
3e794bfe 8347which lists dynamic dependencies, like @command{ldd} under SunOS 4.
a2c4f8e0 8348@end defmac
feca2ed3 8349
a2c4f8e0 8350@defmac PARSE_LDD_OUTPUT (@var{ptr})
feca2ed3 8351Define this macro to be C code that extracts filenames from the output
aee96fe9 8352of the program denoted by @code{LDD_SUFFIX}. @var{ptr} is a variable
feca2ed3
JW
8353of type @code{char *} that points to the beginning of a line of output
8354from @code{LDD_SUFFIX}. If the line lists a dynamic dependency, the
aee96fe9
JM
8355code must advance @var{ptr} to the beginning of the filename on that
8356line. Otherwise, it must set @var{ptr} to @code{NULL}.
a2c4f8e0 8357@end defmac
feca2ed3 8358
881466d8
JDA
8359@defmac SHLIB_SUFFIX
8360Define this macro to a C string constant containing the default shared
8361library extension of the target (e.g., @samp{".so"}). @command{collect2}
8362strips version information after this suffix when generating global
8363constructor and destructor names. This define is only needed on targets
8364that use @command{collect2} to process constructors and destructors.
8365@end defmac
8366
feca2ed3
JW
8367@node Instruction Output
8368@subsection Output of Assembler Instructions
8369
8370@c prevent bad page break with this line
8371This describes assembler instruction output.
8372
a2c4f8e0 8373@defmac REGISTER_NAMES
feca2ed3
JW
8374A C initializer containing the assembler's names for the machine
8375registers, each one as a C string constant. This is what translates
8376register numbers in the compiler into assembler language.
a2c4f8e0 8377@end defmac
feca2ed3 8378
a2c4f8e0 8379@defmac ADDITIONAL_REGISTER_NAMES
feca2ed3
JW
8380If defined, a C initializer for an array of structures containing a name
8381and a register number. This macro defines additional names for hard
8382registers, thus allowing the @code{asm} option in declarations to refer
8383to registers using alternate names.
a2c4f8e0 8384@end defmac
feca2ed3 8385
0c6d290e
RE
8386@defmac OVERLAPPING_REGISTER_NAMES
8387If defined, a C initializer for an array of structures containing a
8388name, a register number and a count of the number of consecutive
8389machine registers the name overlaps. This macro defines additional
8390names for hard registers, thus allowing the @code{asm} option in
8391declarations to refer to registers using alternate names. Unlike
8392@code{ADDITIONAL_REGISTER_NAMES}, this macro should be used when the
8393register name implies multiple underlying registers.
8394
8395This macro should be used when it is important that a clobber in an
8396@code{asm} statement clobbers all the underlying values implied by the
8397register name. For example, on ARM, clobbering the double-precision
8398VFP register ``d0'' implies clobbering both single-precision registers
8399``s0'' and ``s1''.
8400@end defmac
8401
a2c4f8e0 8402@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_OPCODE (@var{stream}, @var{ptr})
feca2ed3
JW
8403Define this macro if you are using an unusual assembler that
8404requires different names for the machine instructions.
8405
8406The definition is a C statement or statements which output an
8407assembler instruction opcode to the stdio stream @var{stream}. The
8408macro-operand @var{ptr} is a variable of type @code{char *} which
8409points to the opcode name in its ``internal'' form---the form that is
8410written in the machine description. The definition should output the
8411opcode name to @var{stream}, performing any translation you desire, and
8412increment the variable @var{ptr} to point at the end of the opcode
8413so that it will not be output twice.
8414
8415In fact, your macro definition may process less than the entire opcode
8416name, or more than the opcode name; but if you want to process text
8417that includes @samp{%}-sequences to substitute operands, you must take
8418care of the substitution yourself. Just be sure to increment
8419@var{ptr} over whatever text should not be output normally.
8420
37bef197 8421@findex recog_data.operand
feca2ed3 8422If you need to look at the operand values, they can be found as the
37bef197 8423elements of @code{recog_data.operand}.
feca2ed3
JW
8424
8425If the macro definition does nothing, the instruction is output
8426in the usual way.
a2c4f8e0 8427@end defmac
feca2ed3 8428
a2c4f8e0 8429@defmac FINAL_PRESCAN_INSN (@var{insn}, @var{opvec}, @var{noperands})
feca2ed3
JW
8430If defined, a C statement to be executed just prior to the output of
8431assembler code for @var{insn}, to modify the extracted operands so
8432they will be output differently.
8433
8434Here the argument @var{opvec} is the vector containing the operands
8435extracted from @var{insn}, and @var{noperands} is the number of
8436elements of the vector which contain meaningful data for this insn.
8437The contents of this vector are what will be used to convert the insn
8438template into assembler code, so you can change the assembler output
8439by changing the contents of the vector.
8440
8441This macro is useful when various assembler syntaxes share a single
8442file of instruction patterns; by defining this macro differently, you
8443can cause a large class of instructions to be output differently (such
8444as with rearranged operands). Naturally, variations in assembler
8445syntax affecting individual insn patterns ought to be handled by
8446writing conditional output routines in those patterns.
8447
8448If this macro is not defined, it is equivalent to a null statement.
a2c4f8e0 8449@end defmac
feca2ed3 8450
ac44248e 8451@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FINAL_POSTSCAN_INSN (FILE *@var{file}, rtx_insn *@var{insn}, rtx *@var{opvec}, int @var{noperands})
1afc5373
CF
8452If defined, this target hook is a function which is executed just after the
8453output of assembler code for @var{insn}, to change the mode of the assembler
8454if necessary.
8455
8456Here the argument @var{opvec} is the vector containing the operands
8457extracted from @var{insn}, and @var{noperands} is the number of
8458elements of the vector which contain meaningful data for this insn.
8459The contents of this vector are what was used to convert the insn
8460template into assembler code, so you can change the assembler mode
8461by checking the contents of the vector.
8462@end deftypefn
8463
a2c4f8e0 8464@defmac PRINT_OPERAND (@var{stream}, @var{x}, @var{code})
feca2ed3
JW
8465A C compound statement to output to stdio stream @var{stream} the
8466assembler syntax for an instruction operand @var{x}. @var{x} is an
8467RTL expression.
8468
8469@var{code} is a value that can be used to specify one of several ways
8470of printing the operand. It is used when identical operands must be
8471printed differently depending on the context. @var{code} comes from
8472the @samp{%} specification that was used to request printing of the
8473operand. If the specification was just @samp{%@var{digit}} then
8474@var{code} is 0; if the specification was @samp{%@var{ltr}
8475@var{digit}} then @var{code} is the ASCII code for @var{ltr}.
8476
8477@findex reg_names
8478If @var{x} is a register, this macro should print the register's name.
8479The names can be found in an array @code{reg_names} whose type is
8480@code{char *[]}. @code{reg_names} is initialized from
8481@code{REGISTER_NAMES}.
8482
8483When the machine description has a specification @samp{%@var{punct}}
8484(a @samp{%} followed by a punctuation character), this macro is called
8485with a null pointer for @var{x} and the punctuation character for
8486@var{code}.
a2c4f8e0 8487@end defmac
feca2ed3 8488
a2c4f8e0 8489@defmac PRINT_OPERAND_PUNCT_VALID_P (@var{code})
feca2ed3
JW
8490A C expression which evaluates to true if @var{code} is a valid
8491punctuation character for use in the @code{PRINT_OPERAND} macro. If
8492@code{PRINT_OPERAND_PUNCT_VALID_P} is not defined, it means that no
8493punctuation characters (except for the standard one, @samp{%}) are used
8494in this way.
a2c4f8e0 8495@end defmac
feca2ed3 8496
a2c4f8e0 8497@defmac PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS (@var{stream}, @var{x})
feca2ed3
JW
8498A C compound statement to output to stdio stream @var{stream} the
8499assembler syntax for an instruction operand that is a memory reference
8500whose address is @var{x}. @var{x} is an RTL expression.
8501
fb49053f 8502@cindex @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} usage
feca2ed3 8503On some machines, the syntax for a symbolic address depends on the
fb49053f
RH
8504section that the address refers to. On these machines, define the hook
8505@code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} to store the information into the
a2c4f8e0
ZW
8506@code{symbol_ref}, and then check for it here. @xref{Assembler
8507Format}.
8508@end defmac
feca2ed3 8509
feca2ed3 8510@findex dbr_sequence_length
a2c4f8e0 8511@defmac DBR_OUTPUT_SEQEND (@var{file})
feca2ed3
JW
8512A C statement, to be executed after all slot-filler instructions have
8513been output. If necessary, call @code{dbr_sequence_length} to
8514determine the number of slots filled in a sequence (zero if not
8515currently outputting a sequence), to decide how many no-ops to output,
8516or whatever.
8517
8518Don't define this macro if it has nothing to do, but it is helpful in
8519reading assembly output if the extent of the delay sequence is made
e979f9e8 8520explicit (e.g.@: with white space).
a2c4f8e0 8521@end defmac
feca2ed3
JW
8522
8523@findex final_sequence
8524Note that output routines for instructions with delay slots must be
e979f9e8
JM
8525prepared to deal with not being output as part of a sequence
8526(i.e.@: when the scheduling pass is not run, or when no slot fillers could be
feca2ed3
JW
8527found.) The variable @code{final_sequence} is null when not
8528processing a sequence, otherwise it contains the @code{sequence} rtx
8529being output.
8530
feca2ed3 8531@findex asm_fprintf
a2c4f8e0
ZW
8532@defmac REGISTER_PREFIX
8533@defmacx LOCAL_LABEL_PREFIX
8534@defmacx USER_LABEL_PREFIX
8535@defmacx IMMEDIATE_PREFIX
feca2ed3
JW
8536If defined, C string expressions to be used for the @samp{%R}, @samp{%L},
8537@samp{%U}, and @samp{%I} options of @code{asm_fprintf} (see
8538@file{final.c}). These are useful when a single @file{md} file must
8539support multiple assembler formats. In that case, the various @file{tm.h}
8540files can define these macros differently.
a2c4f8e0 8541@end defmac
feca2ed3 8542
a2c4f8e0 8543@defmac ASM_FPRINTF_EXTENSIONS (@var{file}, @var{argptr}, @var{format})
3b7a2e58 8544If defined this macro should expand to a series of @code{case}
fe0503ea
NC
8545statements which will be parsed inside the @code{switch} statement of
8546the @code{asm_fprintf} function. This allows targets to define extra
8547printf formats which may useful when generating their assembler
4bd0bee9 8548statements. Note that uppercase letters are reserved for future
fe0503ea
NC
8549generic extensions to asm_fprintf, and so are not available to target
8550specific code. The output file is given by the parameter @var{file}.
8551The varargs input pointer is @var{argptr} and the rest of the format
8552string, starting the character after the one that is being switched
8553upon, is pointed to by @var{format}.
a2c4f8e0 8554@end defmac
fe0503ea 8555
a2c4f8e0 8556@defmac ASSEMBLER_DIALECT
feca2ed3
JW
8557If your target supports multiple dialects of assembler language (such as
8558different opcodes), define this macro as a C expression that gives the
8559numeric index of the assembler language dialect to use, with zero as the
8560first variant.
8561
8562If this macro is defined, you may use constructs of the form
c237e94a 8563@smallexample
f282ffb3 8564@samp{@{option0|option1|option2@dots{}@}}
c237e94a
ZW
8565@end smallexample
8566@noindent
8567in the output templates of patterns (@pxref{Output Template}) or in the
8568first argument of @code{asm_fprintf}. This construct outputs
8569@samp{option0}, @samp{option1}, @samp{option2}, etc., if the value of
8570@code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT} is zero, one, two, etc. Any special characters
8571within these strings retain their usual meaning. If there are fewer
8572alternatives within the braces than the value of
382522cb
MK
8573@code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT}, the construct outputs nothing. If it's needed
8574to print curly braces or @samp{|} character in assembler output directly,
8575@samp{%@{}, @samp{%@}} and @samp{%|} can be used.
feca2ed3
JW
8576
8577If you do not define this macro, the characters @samp{@{}, @samp{|} and
8578@samp{@}} do not have any special meaning when used in templates or
8579operands to @code{asm_fprintf}.
8580
8581Define the macros @code{REGISTER_PREFIX}, @code{LOCAL_LABEL_PREFIX},
8582@code{USER_LABEL_PREFIX} and @code{IMMEDIATE_PREFIX} if you can express
e5e809f4 8583the variations in assembler language syntax with that mechanism. Define
feca2ed3
JW
8584@code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT} and use the @samp{@{option0|option1@}} syntax
8585if the syntax variant are larger and involve such things as different
8586opcodes or operand order.
a2c4f8e0 8587@end defmac
feca2ed3 8588
a2c4f8e0 8589@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_REG_PUSH (@var{stream}, @var{regno})
feca2ed3
JW
8590A C expression to output to @var{stream} some assembler code
8591which will push hard register number @var{regno} onto the stack.
8592The code need not be optimal, since this macro is used only when
8593profiling.
a2c4f8e0 8594@end defmac
feca2ed3 8595
a2c4f8e0 8596@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_REG_POP (@var{stream}, @var{regno})
feca2ed3
JW
8597A C expression to output to @var{stream} some assembler code
8598which will pop hard register number @var{regno} off of the stack.
8599The code need not be optimal, since this macro is used only when
8600profiling.
a2c4f8e0 8601@end defmac
feca2ed3
JW
8602
8603@node Dispatch Tables
8604@subsection Output of Dispatch Tables
8605
8606@c prevent bad page break with this line
8607This concerns dispatch tables.
8608
feca2ed3 8609@cindex dispatch table
a2c4f8e0 8610@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_DIFF_ELT (@var{stream}, @var{body}, @var{value}, @var{rel})
feca2ed3
JW
8611A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
8612pseudo-instruction to generate a difference between two labels.
8613@var{value} and @var{rel} are the numbers of two internal labels. The
8614definitions of these labels are output using
4977bab6 8615@code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}, and they must be printed in the same
feca2ed3
JW
8616way here. For example,
8617
3ab51846 8618@smallexample
feca2ed3
JW
8619fprintf (@var{stream}, "\t.word L%d-L%d\n",
8620 @var{value}, @var{rel})
3ab51846 8621@end smallexample
feca2ed3
JW
8622
8623You must provide this macro on machines where the addresses in a
f0523f02 8624dispatch table are relative to the table's own address. If defined, GCC
161d7b59 8625will also use this macro on all machines when producing PIC@.
aee96fe9 8626@var{body} is the body of the @code{ADDR_DIFF_VEC}; it is provided so that the
33f7f353 8627mode and flags can be read.
a2c4f8e0 8628@end defmac
feca2ed3 8629
a2c4f8e0 8630@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_VEC_ELT (@var{stream}, @var{value})
feca2ed3
JW
8631This macro should be provided on machines where the addresses
8632in a dispatch table are absolute.
8633
8634The definition should be a C statement to output to the stdio stream
8635@var{stream} an assembler pseudo-instruction to generate a reference to
8636a label. @var{value} is the number of an internal label whose
4977bab6 8637definition is output using @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}.
feca2ed3
JW
8638For example,
8639
3ab51846 8640@smallexample
feca2ed3 8641fprintf (@var{stream}, "\t.word L%d\n", @var{value})
3ab51846 8642@end smallexample
a2c4f8e0 8643@end defmac
feca2ed3 8644
a2c4f8e0 8645@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_CASE_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{prefix}, @var{num}, @var{table})
feca2ed3
JW
8646Define this if the label before a jump-table needs to be output
8647specially. The first three arguments are the same as for
4977bab6 8648@code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}; the fourth argument is the
da5c6bde 8649jump-table which follows (a @code{jump_table_data} containing an
feca2ed3
JW
8650@code{addr_vec} or @code{addr_diff_vec}).
8651
8652This feature is used on system V to output a @code{swbeg} statement
8653for the table.
8654
8655If this macro is not defined, these labels are output with
4977bab6 8656@code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}.
a2c4f8e0 8657@end defmac
feca2ed3 8658
a2c4f8e0 8659@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_CASE_END (@var{stream}, @var{num}, @var{table})
feca2ed3
JW
8660Define this if something special must be output at the end of a
8661jump-table. The definition should be a C statement to be executed
8662after the assembler code for the table is written. It should write
8663the appropriate code to stdio stream @var{stream}. The argument
8664@var{table} is the jump-table insn, and @var{num} is the label-number
8665of the preceding label.
8666
8667If this macro is not defined, nothing special is output at the end of
8668the jump-table.
a2c4f8e0 8669@end defmac
feca2ed3 8670
914d25dc 8671@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_EMIT_UNWIND_LABEL (FILE *@var{stream}, tree @var{decl}, int @var{for_eh}, int @var{empty})
8a36672b 8672This target hook emits a label at the beginning of each FDE@. It
4746cf84
MA
8673should be defined on targets where FDEs need special labels, and it
8674should write the appropriate label, for the FDE associated with the
8675function declaration @var{decl}, to the stdio stream @var{stream}.
eeab4d81
MS
8676The third argument, @var{for_eh}, is a boolean: true if this is for an
8677exception table. The fourth argument, @var{empty}, is a boolean:
8a36672b 8678true if this is a placeholder label for an omitted FDE@.
4746cf84
MA
8679
8680The default is that FDEs are not given nonlocal labels.
8681@end deftypefn
8682
914d25dc 8683@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_EMIT_EXCEPT_TABLE_LABEL (FILE *@var{stream})
083cad55
EC
8684This target hook emits a label at the beginning of the exception table.
8685It should be defined on targets where it is desirable for the table
8686to be broken up according to function.
8687
8688The default is that no label is emitted.
8689@end deftypefn
8690
a68b5e52
RH
8691@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_EMIT_EXCEPT_PERSONALITY (rtx @var{personality})
8692If the target implements @code{TARGET_ASM_UNWIND_EMIT}, this hook may be used to emit a directive to install a personality hook into the unwind info. This hook should not be used if dwarf2 unwind info is used.
8693@end deftypefn
8694
ac44248e 8695@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_UNWIND_EMIT (FILE *@var{stream}, rtx_insn *@var{insn})
914d25dc 8696This target hook emits assembly directives required to unwind the
f0a0390e
RH
8697given instruction. This is only used when @code{TARGET_EXCEPT_UNWIND_INFO}
8698returns @code{UI_TARGET}.
951120ea
PB
8699@end deftypefn
8700
3bc6b3e6
RH
8701@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_UNWIND_EMIT_BEFORE_INSN
8702True if the @code{TARGET_ASM_UNWIND_EMIT} hook should be called before the assembly for @var{insn} has been emitted, false if the hook should be called afterward.
8703@end deftypevr
8704
02f52e19 8705@node Exception Region Output
feca2ed3
JW
8706@subsection Assembler Commands for Exception Regions
8707
8708@c prevent bad page break with this line
8709
8710This describes commands marking the start and the end of an exception
8711region.
8712
a2c4f8e0 8713@defmac EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME
7c262518
RH
8714If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing
8715exception handling frame unwind information. If not defined, GCC will
8716provide a default definition if the target supports named sections.
8717@file{crtstuff.c} uses this macro to switch to the appropriate section.
0021b564
JM
8718
8719You should define this symbol if your target supports DWARF 2 frame
8720unwind information and the default definition does not work.
a2c4f8e0 8721@end defmac
0021b564 8722
a2c4f8e0 8723@defmac EH_FRAME_IN_DATA_SECTION
02c9b1ca
RH
8724If defined, DWARF 2 frame unwind information will be placed in the
8725data section even though the target supports named sections. This
8726might be necessary, for instance, if the system linker does garbage
8727collection and sections cannot be marked as not to be collected.
8728
8729Do not define this macro unless @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION} is
8730also defined.
a2c4f8e0 8731@end defmac
02c9b1ca 8732
1a35e62d
MM
8733@defmac EH_TABLES_CAN_BE_READ_ONLY
8734Define this macro to 1 if your target is such that no frame unwind
8735information encoding used with non-PIC code will ever require a
8736runtime relocation, but the linker may not support merging read-only
8737and read-write sections into a single read-write section.
8738@end defmac
8739
a2c4f8e0 8740@defmac MASK_RETURN_ADDR
aee96fe9 8741An rtx used to mask the return address found via @code{RETURN_ADDR_RTX}, so
feca2ed3 8742that it does not contain any extraneous set bits in it.
a2c4f8e0 8743@end defmac
0021b564 8744
a2c4f8e0 8745@defmac DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO
0021b564
JM
8746Define this macro to 0 if your target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind
8747information, but it does not yet work with exception handling.
8748Otherwise, if your target supports this information (if it defines
01a07a64
SB
8749@code{INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and @code{OBJECT_FORMAT_ELF}),
8750GCC will provide a default definition of 1.
f0a0390e 8751@end defmac
0021b564 8752
677f3fa8 8753@deftypefn {Common Target Hook} {enum unwind_info_type} TARGET_EXCEPT_UNWIND_INFO (struct gcc_options *@var{opts})
f0a0390e
RH
8754This hook defines the mechanism that will be used for exception handling
8755by the target. If the target has ABI specified unwind tables, the hook
8756should return @code{UI_TARGET}. If the target is to use the
8757@code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based exception handling scheme, the hook
8758should return @code{UI_SJLJ}. If the target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind
8759information, the hook should return @code{UI_DWARF2}.
0021b564 8760
f0a0390e
RH
8761A target may, if exceptions are disabled, choose to return @code{UI_NONE}.
8762This may end up simplifying other parts of target-specific code. The
8763default implementation of this hook never returns @code{UI_NONE}.
0021b564 8764
f0a0390e 8765Note that the value returned by this hook should be constant. It should
d5fabb58
JM
8766not depend on anything except the command-line switches described by
8767@var{opts}. In particular, the
f0a0390e
RH
8768setting @code{UI_SJLJ} must be fixed at compiler start-up as C pre-processor
8769macros and builtin functions related to exception handling are set up
8770depending on this setting.
8771
8772The default implementation of the hook first honors the
8773@option{--enable-sjlj-exceptions} configure option, then
d5fabb58
JM
8774@code{DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO}, and finally defaults to @code{UI_SJLJ}. If
8775@code{DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO} depends on command-line options, the target
8776must define this hook so that @var{opts} is used correctly.
f0a0390e 8777@end deftypefn
951120ea 8778
677f3fa8 8779@deftypevr {Common Target Hook} bool TARGET_UNWIND_TABLES_DEFAULT
617a1b71 8780This variable should be set to @code{true} if the target ABI requires unwinding
d5fabb58
JM
8781tables even when exceptions are not used. It must not be modified by
8782command-line option processing.
9e3be889 8783@end deftypevr
617a1b71 8784
4f6c2131
EB
8785@defmac DONT_USE_BUILTIN_SETJMP
8786Define this macro to 1 if the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based scheme
8787should use the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp} functions from the C library
8788instead of the @code{__builtin_setjmp}/@code{__builtin_longjmp} machinery.
c14aea87
RO
8789@end defmac
8790
39ce30d8
SB
8791@defmac JMP_BUF_SIZE
8792This macro has no effect unless @code{DONT_USE_BUILTIN_SETJMP} is also
8793defined. Define this macro if the default size of @code{jmp_buf} buffer
8794for the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based exception handling mechanism
8795is not large enough, or if it is much too large.
8796The default size is @code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER * sizeof(void *)}.
8797@end defmac
8798
a2c4f8e0 8799@defmac DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT
27c35f4b
HPN
8800This macro need only be defined if the target might save registers in the
8801function prologue at an offset to the stack pointer that is not aligned to
8802@code{UNITS_PER_WORD}. The definition should be the negative minimum
8803alignment if @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is defined, and the positive
8804minimum alignment otherwise. @xref{SDB and DWARF}. Only applicable if
8805the target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind information.
a2c4f8e0 8806@end defmac
feca2ed3 8807
9e3be889 8808@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_TERMINATE_DW2_EH_FRAME_INFO
7606e68f
SS
8809Contains the value true if the target should add a zero word onto the
8810end of a Dwarf-2 frame info section when used for exception handling.
8811Default value is false if @code{EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME} is defined, and
8812true otherwise.
9e3be889 8813@end deftypevr
7606e68f 8814
96714395
AH
8815@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_DWARF_REGISTER_SPAN (rtx @var{reg})
8816Given a register, this hook should return a parallel of registers to
8817represent where to find the register pieces. Define this hook if the
8818register and its mode are represented in Dwarf in non-contiguous
8819locations, or if the register should be represented in more than one
8820register in Dwarf. Otherwise, this hook should return @code{NULL_RTX}.
8821If not defined, the default is to return @code{NULL_RTX}.
8822@end deftypefn
8823
ff050c66
MF
8824@deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum machine_mode} TARGET_DWARF_FRAME_REG_MODE (int @var{regno})
8825Given a register, this hook should return the mode which the
8826corresponding Dwarf frame register should have. This is normally
8827used to return a smaller mode than the raw mode to prevent call
8828clobbered parts of a register altering the frame register size
8829@end deftypefn
8830
37ea0b7e
JM
8831@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INIT_DWARF_REG_SIZES_EXTRA (tree @var{address})
8832If some registers are represented in Dwarf-2 unwind information in
8833multiple pieces, define this hook to fill in information about the
8834sizes of those pieces in the table used by the unwinder at runtime.
8835It will be called by @code{expand_builtin_init_dwarf_reg_sizes} after
8836filling in a single size corresponding to each hard register;
8837@var{address} is the address of the table.
8838@end deftypefn
8839
617a1b71
PB
8840@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_TTYPE (rtx @var{sym})
8841This hook is used to output a reference from a frame unwinding table to
8842the type_info object identified by @var{sym}. It should return @code{true}
8843if the reference was output. Returning @code{false} will cause the
8844reference to be output using the normal Dwarf2 routines.
8845@end deftypefn
8846
914d25dc
JR
8847@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ARM_EABI_UNWINDER
8848This flag should be set to @code{true} on targets that use an ARM EABI
617a1b71
PB
8849based unwinding library, and @code{false} on other targets. This effects
8850the format of unwinding tables, and how the unwinder in entered after
8851running a cleanup. The default is @code{false}.
914d25dc 8852@end deftypevr
617a1b71 8853
feca2ed3
JW
8854@node Alignment Output
8855@subsection Assembler Commands for Alignment
8856
8857@c prevent bad page break with this line
8858This describes commands for alignment.
8859
a2c4f8e0 8860@defmac JUMP_ALIGN (@var{label})
247a370b 8861The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}, which is
f710504c 8862a common destination of jumps and has no fallthru incoming edge.
25e22dc0
JH
8863
8864This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
8865to be done at such a time. Most machine descriptions do not currently
8866define the macro.
efa3896a 8867
3446405d
JH
8868Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
8869to set the variable @var{align_jumps} in the target's
74f7912a 8870@code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}. Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
247a370b 8871selection in @var{align_jumps} in a @code{JUMP_ALIGN} implementation.
a2c4f8e0 8872@end defmac
247a370b 8873
ad0c4c36
DD
8874@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ASM_JUMP_ALIGN_MAX_SKIP (rtx @var{label})
8875The maximum number of bytes to skip before @var{label} when applying
8876@code{JUMP_ALIGN}. This works only if
8877@code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN} is defined.
8878@end deftypefn
8879
a2c4f8e0 8880@defmac LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER (@var{label})
247a370b
JH
8881The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}, which follows
8882a @code{BARRIER}.
8883
8884This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
8885to be done at such a time. Most machine descriptions do not currently
8886define the macro.
a2c4f8e0 8887@end defmac
3446405d 8888
ad0c4c36
DD
8889@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ASM_LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER_MAX_SKIP (rtx @var{label})
8890The maximum number of bytes to skip before @var{label} when applying
efa3896a
GK
8891@code{LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER}. This works only if
8892@code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN} is defined.
ad0c4c36 8893@end deftypefn
efa3896a 8894
a2c4f8e0 8895@defmac LOOP_ALIGN (@var{label})
58a51369
SB
8896The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label} that heads
8897a frequently executed basic block (usually the header of a loop).
feca2ed3
JW
8898
8899This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
8900to be done at such a time. Most machine descriptions do not currently
8901define the macro.
8902
efa3896a 8903Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
aee96fe9 8904to set the variable @code{align_loops} in the target's
74f7912a 8905@code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}. Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
aee96fe9 8906selection in @code{align_loops} in a @code{LOOP_ALIGN} implementation.
a2c4f8e0 8907@end defmac
efa3896a 8908
ad0c4c36
DD
8909@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ASM_LOOP_ALIGN_MAX_SKIP (rtx @var{label})
8910The maximum number of bytes to skip when applying @code{LOOP_ALIGN} to
8911@var{label}. This works only if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN} is
8912defined.
8913@end deftypefn
efa3896a 8914
a2c4f8e0 8915@defmac LABEL_ALIGN (@var{label})
fc470718 8916The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}.
aee96fe9 8917If @code{LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER} / @code{LOOP_ALIGN} specify a different alignment,
fc470718
R
8918the maximum of the specified values is used.
8919
efa3896a 8920Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
aee96fe9 8921to set the variable @code{align_labels} in the target's
74f7912a 8922@code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}. Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
aee96fe9 8923selection in @code{align_labels} in a @code{LABEL_ALIGN} implementation.
a2c4f8e0 8924@end defmac
efa3896a 8925
ad0c4c36
DD
8926@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ASM_LABEL_ALIGN_MAX_SKIP (rtx @var{label})
8927The maximum number of bytes to skip when applying @code{LABEL_ALIGN}
8928to @var{label}. This works only if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN}
8929is defined.
8930@end deftypefn
efa3896a 8931
a2c4f8e0 8932@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP (@var{stream}, @var{nbytes})
feca2ed3
JW
8933A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
8934instruction to advance the location counter by @var{nbytes} bytes.
8935Those bytes should be zero when loaded. @var{nbytes} will be a C
606e938d 8936expression of type @code{unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT}.
a2c4f8e0 8937@end defmac
feca2ed3 8938
a2c4f8e0 8939@defmac ASM_NO_SKIP_IN_TEXT
feca2ed3 8940Define this macro if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP} should not be used in the
556e0f21 8941text section because it fails to put zeros in the bytes that are skipped.
feca2ed3
JW
8942This is true on many Unix systems, where the pseudo--op to skip bytes
8943produces no-op instructions rather than zeros when used in the text
8944section.
a2c4f8e0 8945@end defmac
feca2ed3 8946
a2c4f8e0 8947@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (@var{stream}, @var{power})
feca2ed3
JW
8948A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
8949command to advance the location counter to a multiple of 2 to the
8950@var{power} bytes. @var{power} will be a C expression of type @code{int}.
a2c4f8e0 8951@end defmac
26f63a77 8952
a2c4f8e0 8953@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN_WITH_NOP (@var{stream}, @var{power})
8e16ab99
SF
8954Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN}, except that the ``nop'' instruction is used
8955for padding, if necessary.
a2c4f8e0 8956@end defmac
8e16ab99 8957
a2c4f8e0 8958@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN (@var{stream}, @var{power}, @var{max_skip})
26f63a77
JL
8959A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
8960command to advance the location counter to a multiple of 2 to the
8961@var{power} bytes, but only if @var{max_skip} or fewer bytes are needed to
8962satisfy the alignment request. @var{power} and @var{max_skip} will be
8963a C expression of type @code{int}.
a2c4f8e0 8964@end defmac
feca2ed3
JW
8965
8966@need 3000
8967@node Debugging Info
8968@section Controlling Debugging Information Format
8969
8970@c prevent bad page break with this line
8971This describes how to specify debugging information.
8972
8973@menu
8974* All Debuggers:: Macros that affect all debugging formats uniformly.
8975* DBX Options:: Macros enabling specific options in DBX format.
8976* DBX Hooks:: Hook macros for varying DBX format.
8977* File Names and DBX:: Macros controlling output of file names in DBX format.
8978* SDB and DWARF:: Macros for SDB (COFF) and DWARF formats.
5f98259a 8979* VMS Debug:: Macros for VMS debug format.
feca2ed3
JW
8980@end menu
8981
8982@node All Debuggers
8983@subsection Macros Affecting All Debugging Formats
8984
8985@c prevent bad page break with this line
8986These macros affect all debugging formats.
8987
a2c4f8e0 8988@defmac DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (@var{regno})
feca2ed3 8989A C expression that returns the DBX register number for the compiler
4617e3b5
KG
8990register number @var{regno}. In the default macro provided, the value
8991of this expression will be @var{regno} itself. But sometimes there are
8992some registers that the compiler knows about and DBX does not, or vice
8993versa. In such cases, some register may need to have one number in the
8994compiler and another for DBX@.
feca2ed3 8995
a3a15b4d 8996If two registers have consecutive numbers inside GCC, and they can be
feca2ed3
JW
8997used as a pair to hold a multiword value, then they @emph{must} have
8998consecutive numbers after renumbering with @code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER}.
8999Otherwise, debuggers will be unable to access such a pair, because they
9000expect register pairs to be consecutive in their own numbering scheme.
9001
9002If you find yourself defining @code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER} in way that
9003does not preserve register pairs, then what you must do instead is
9004redefine the actual register numbering scheme.
a2c4f8e0 9005@end defmac
feca2ed3 9006
a2c4f8e0 9007@defmac DEBUGGER_AUTO_OFFSET (@var{x})
feca2ed3
JW
9008A C expression that returns the integer offset value for an automatic
9009variable having address @var{x} (an RTL expression). The default
9010computation assumes that @var{x} is based on the frame-pointer and
9011gives the offset from the frame-pointer. This is required for targets
9012that produce debugging output for DBX or COFF-style debugging output
9013for SDB and allow the frame-pointer to be eliminated when the
630d3d5a 9014@option{-g} options is used.
a2c4f8e0 9015@end defmac
feca2ed3 9016
a2c4f8e0 9017@defmac DEBUGGER_ARG_OFFSET (@var{offset}, @var{x})
feca2ed3
JW
9018A C expression that returns the integer offset value for an argument
9019having address @var{x} (an RTL expression). The nominal offset is
9020@var{offset}.
a2c4f8e0 9021@end defmac
feca2ed3 9022
a2c4f8e0 9023@defmac PREFERRED_DEBUGGING_TYPE
a3a15b4d 9024A C expression that returns the type of debugging output GCC should
630d3d5a 9025produce when the user specifies just @option{-g}. Define
a3a15b4d 9026this if you have arranged for GCC to support more than one format of
e5e809f4 9027debugging output. Currently, the allowable values are @code{DBX_DEBUG},
5f98259a
RK
9028@code{SDB_DEBUG}, @code{DWARF_DEBUG}, @code{DWARF2_DEBUG},
9029@code{XCOFF_DEBUG}, @code{VMS_DEBUG}, and @code{VMS_AND_DWARF2_DEBUG}.
feca2ed3 9030
630d3d5a 9031When the user specifies @option{-ggdb}, GCC normally also uses the
e5e809f4 9032value of this macro to select the debugging output format, but with two
16201823 9033exceptions. If @code{DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO} is defined, GCC uses the
e5e809f4 9034value @code{DWARF2_DEBUG}. Otherwise, if @code{DBX_DEBUGGING_INFO} is
a3a15b4d 9035defined, GCC uses @code{DBX_DEBUG}.
deabc777 9036
feca2ed3 9037The value of this macro only affects the default debugging output; the
630d3d5a 9038user can always get a specific type of output by using @option{-gstabs},
def66b10 9039@option{-gcoff}, @option{-gdwarf-2}, @option{-gxcoff}, or @option{-gvms}.
a2c4f8e0 9040@end defmac
feca2ed3
JW
9041
9042@node DBX Options
9043@subsection Specific Options for DBX Output
9044
9045@c prevent bad page break with this line
9046These are specific options for DBX output.
9047
a2c4f8e0 9048@defmac DBX_DEBUGGING_INFO
a3a15b4d 9049Define this macro if GCC should produce debugging output for DBX
630d3d5a 9050in response to the @option{-g} option.
a2c4f8e0 9051@end defmac
feca2ed3 9052
a2c4f8e0 9053@defmac XCOFF_DEBUGGING_INFO
a3a15b4d 9054Define this macro if GCC should produce XCOFF format debugging output
630d3d5a 9055in response to the @option{-g} option. This is a variant of DBX format.
a2c4f8e0 9056@end defmac
feca2ed3 9057
a2c4f8e0 9058@defmac DEFAULT_GDB_EXTENSIONS
a3a15b4d 9059Define this macro to control whether GCC should by default generate
feca2ed3
JW
9060GDB's extended version of DBX debugging information (assuming DBX-format
9061debugging information is enabled at all). If you don't define the
9062macro, the default is 1: always generate the extended information
9063if there is any occasion to.
a2c4f8e0 9064@end defmac
feca2ed3 9065
a2c4f8e0 9066@defmac DEBUG_SYMS_TEXT
feca2ed3
JW
9067Define this macro if all @code{.stabs} commands should be output while
9068in the text section.
a2c4f8e0 9069@end defmac
feca2ed3 9070
a2c4f8e0 9071@defmac ASM_STABS_OP
047c1c92
HPN
9072A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
9073use instead of @code{"\t.stabs\t"} to define an ordinary debugging symbol.
9074If you don't define this macro, @code{"\t.stabs\t"} is used. This macro
9075applies only to DBX debugging information format.
a2c4f8e0 9076@end defmac
feca2ed3 9077
a2c4f8e0 9078@defmac ASM_STABD_OP
047c1c92
HPN
9079A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
9080use instead of @code{"\t.stabd\t"} to define a debugging symbol whose
9081value is the current location. If you don't define this macro,
9082@code{"\t.stabd\t"} is used. This macro applies only to DBX debugging
9083information format.
a2c4f8e0 9084@end defmac
feca2ed3 9085
a2c4f8e0 9086@defmac ASM_STABN_OP
047c1c92
HPN
9087A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
9088use instead of @code{"\t.stabn\t"} to define a debugging symbol with no
9089name. If you don't define this macro, @code{"\t.stabn\t"} is used. This
9090macro applies only to DBX debugging information format.
a2c4f8e0 9091@end defmac
feca2ed3 9092
a2c4f8e0 9093@defmac DBX_NO_XREFS
feca2ed3
JW
9094Define this macro if DBX on your system does not support the construct
9095@samp{xs@var{tagname}}. On some systems, this construct is used to
9096describe a forward reference to a structure named @var{tagname}.
9097On other systems, this construct is not supported at all.
a2c4f8e0 9098@end defmac
feca2ed3 9099
a2c4f8e0 9100@defmac DBX_CONTIN_LENGTH
feca2ed3
JW
9101A symbol name in DBX-format debugging information is normally
9102continued (split into two separate @code{.stabs} directives) when it
9103exceeds a certain length (by default, 80 characters). On some
9104operating systems, DBX requires this splitting; on others, splitting
9105must not be done. You can inhibit splitting by defining this macro
9106with the value zero. You can override the default splitting-length by
9107defining this macro as an expression for the length you desire.
a2c4f8e0 9108@end defmac
feca2ed3 9109
a2c4f8e0 9110@defmac DBX_CONTIN_CHAR
feca2ed3
JW
9111Normally continuation is indicated by adding a @samp{\} character to
9112the end of a @code{.stabs} string when a continuation follows. To use
9113a different character instead, define this macro as a character
9114constant for the character you want to use. Do not define this macro
9115if backslash is correct for your system.
a2c4f8e0 9116@end defmac
feca2ed3 9117
a2c4f8e0 9118@defmac DBX_STATIC_STAB_DATA_SECTION
feca2ed3
JW
9119Define this macro if it is necessary to go to the data section before
9120outputting the @samp{.stabs} pseudo-op for a non-global static
9121variable.
a2c4f8e0 9122@end defmac
feca2ed3 9123
a2c4f8e0 9124@defmac DBX_TYPE_DECL_STABS_CODE
feca2ed3
JW
9125The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
9126for a typedef. The default is @code{N_LSYM}.
a2c4f8e0 9127@end defmac
feca2ed3 9128
a2c4f8e0 9129@defmac DBX_STATIC_CONST_VAR_CODE
feca2ed3
JW
9130The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
9131for a static variable located in the text section. DBX format does not
9132provide any ``right'' way to do this. The default is @code{N_FUN}.
a2c4f8e0 9133@end defmac
feca2ed3 9134
a2c4f8e0 9135@defmac DBX_REGPARM_STABS_CODE
feca2ed3
JW
9136The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
9137for a parameter passed in registers. DBX format does not provide any
9138``right'' way to do this. The default is @code{N_RSYM}.
a2c4f8e0 9139@end defmac
feca2ed3 9140
a2c4f8e0 9141@defmac DBX_REGPARM_STABS_LETTER
feca2ed3
JW
9142The letter to use in DBX symbol data to identify a symbol as a parameter
9143passed in registers. DBX format does not customarily provide any way to
9144do this. The default is @code{'P'}.
a2c4f8e0 9145@end defmac
feca2ed3 9146
a2c4f8e0 9147@defmac DBX_FUNCTION_FIRST
feca2ed3
JW
9148Define this macro if the DBX information for a function and its
9149arguments should precede the assembler code for the function. Normally,
9150in DBX format, the debugging information entirely follows the assembler
9151code.
a2c4f8e0 9152@end defmac
feca2ed3 9153
a2c4f8e0 9154@defmac DBX_BLOCKS_FUNCTION_RELATIVE
3e487b21
ZW
9155Define this macro, with value 1, if the value of a symbol describing
9156the scope of a block (@code{N_LBRAC} or @code{N_RBRAC}) should be
9157relative to the start of the enclosing function. Normally, GCC uses
9158an absolute address.
9159@end defmac
9160
9161@defmac DBX_LINES_FUNCTION_RELATIVE
9162Define this macro, with value 1, if the value of a symbol indicating
9163the current line number (@code{N_SLINE}) should be relative to the
9164start of the enclosing function. Normally, GCC uses an absolute address.
a2c4f8e0 9165@end defmac
feca2ed3 9166
a2c4f8e0 9167@defmac DBX_USE_BINCL
f0523f02 9168Define this macro if GCC should generate @code{N_BINCL} and
feca2ed3 9169@code{N_EINCL} stabs for included header files, as on Sun systems. This
f0523f02
JM
9170macro also directs GCC to output a type number as a pair of a file
9171number and a type number within the file. Normally, GCC does not
feca2ed3
JW
9172generate @code{N_BINCL} or @code{N_EINCL} stabs, and it outputs a single
9173number for a type number.
a2c4f8e0 9174@end defmac
feca2ed3
JW
9175
9176@node DBX Hooks
9177@subsection Open-Ended Hooks for DBX Format
9178
9179@c prevent bad page break with this line
9180These are hooks for DBX format.
9181
3e487b21
ZW
9182@defmac DBX_OUTPUT_SOURCE_LINE (@var{stream}, @var{line}, @var{counter})
9183A C statement to output DBX debugging information before code for line
9184number @var{line} of the current source file to the stdio stream
8a36672b 9185@var{stream}. @var{counter} is the number of time the macro was
3e487b21
ZW
9186invoked, including the current invocation; it is intended to generate
9187unique labels in the assembly output.
9188
9189This macro should not be defined if the default output is correct, or
9190if it can be made correct by defining @code{DBX_LINES_FUNCTION_RELATIVE}.
9191@end defmac
9192
a2c4f8e0 9193@defmac NO_DBX_FUNCTION_END
feca2ed3 9194Some stabs encapsulation formats (in particular ECOFF), cannot handle the
c771326b 9195@code{.stabs "",N_FUN,,0,0,Lscope-function-1} gdb dbx extension construct.
feca2ed3
JW
9196On those machines, define this macro to turn this feature off without
9197disturbing the rest of the gdb extensions.
a2c4f8e0 9198@end defmac
feca2ed3 9199
5d865dac
EB
9200@defmac NO_DBX_BNSYM_ENSYM
9201Some assemblers cannot handle the @code{.stabd BNSYM/ENSYM,0,0} gdb dbx
9202extension construct. On those machines, define this macro to turn this
9203feature off without disturbing the rest of the gdb extensions.
9204@end defmac
9205
feca2ed3
JW
9206@node File Names and DBX
9207@subsection File Names in DBX Format
9208
9209@c prevent bad page break with this line
9210This describes file names in DBX format.
9211
a2c4f8e0 9212@defmac DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILENAME (@var{stream}, @var{name})
feca2ed3 9213A C statement to output DBX debugging information to the stdio stream
93a27b7b 9214@var{stream}, which indicates that file @var{name} is the main source
feca2ed3
JW
9215file---the file specified as the input file for compilation.
9216This macro is called only once, at the beginning of compilation.
9217
9218This macro need not be defined if the standard form of output
9219for DBX debugging information is appropriate.
93a27b7b
ZW
9220
9221It may be necessary to refer to a label equal to the beginning of the
9222text section. You can use @samp{assemble_name (stream, ltext_label_name)}
9223to do so. If you do this, you must also set the variable
9224@var{used_ltext_label_name} to @code{true}.
a2c4f8e0 9225@end defmac
feca2ed3 9226
93a27b7b
ZW
9227@defmac NO_DBX_MAIN_SOURCE_DIRECTORY
9228Define this macro, with value 1, if GCC should not emit an indication
9229of the current directory for compilation and current source language at
9230the beginning of the file.
9231@end defmac
feca2ed3 9232
93a27b7b
ZW
9233@defmac NO_DBX_GCC_MARKER
9234Define this macro, with value 1, if GCC should not emit an indication
9235that this object file was compiled by GCC@. The default is to emit
9236an @code{N_OPT} stab at the beginning of every source file, with
9237@samp{gcc2_compiled.} for the string and value 0.
a2c4f8e0 9238@end defmac
feca2ed3 9239
a2c4f8e0 9240@defmac DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END (@var{stream}, @var{name})
feca2ed3 9241A C statement to output DBX debugging information at the end of
93a27b7b
ZW
9242compilation of the main source file @var{name}. Output should be
9243written to the stdio stream @var{stream}.
feca2ed3
JW
9244
9245If you don't define this macro, nothing special is output at the end
9246of compilation, which is correct for most machines.
a2c4f8e0 9247@end defmac
feca2ed3 9248
3e487b21
ZW
9249@defmac DBX_OUTPUT_NULL_N_SO_AT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END
9250Define this macro @emph{instead of} defining
9251@code{DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END}, if what needs to be output at
e4ae5e77 9252the end of compilation is an @code{N_SO} stab with an empty string,
3e487b21
ZW
9253whose value is the highest absolute text address in the file.
9254@end defmac
9255
feca2ed3
JW
9256@need 2000
9257@node SDB and DWARF
9258@subsection Macros for SDB and DWARF Output
9259
9260@c prevent bad page break with this line
9261Here are macros for SDB and DWARF output.
9262
a2c4f8e0 9263@defmac SDB_DEBUGGING_INFO
a3a15b4d 9264Define this macro if GCC should produce COFF-style debugging output
630d3d5a 9265for SDB in response to the @option{-g} option.
a2c4f8e0 9266@end defmac
feca2ed3 9267
a2c4f8e0 9268@defmac DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
a3a15b4d 9269Define this macro if GCC should produce dwarf version 2 format
630d3d5a 9270debugging output in response to the @option{-g} option.
f3ff3f4a 9271
b6fd8800 9272@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_DWARF_CALLING_CONVENTION (const_tree @var{function})
a1c496cb
EC
9273Define this to enable the dwarf attribute @code{DW_AT_calling_convention} to
9274be emitted for each function. Instead of an integer return the enum
9275value for the @code{DW_CC_} tag.
9276@end deftypefn
9277
861bb6c1
JL
9278To support optional call frame debugging information, you must also
9279define @code{INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and either set
9280@code{RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P} on the prologue insns if you use RTL for the
9281prologue, or call @code{dwarf2out_def_cfa} and @code{dwarf2out_reg_save}
08c148a8 9282as appropriate from @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} if you don't.
a2c4f8e0 9283@end defmac
861bb6c1 9284
a2c4f8e0 9285@defmac DWARF2_FRAME_INFO
a3a15b4d 9286Define this macro to a nonzero value if GCC should always output
f0a0390e
RH
9287Dwarf 2 frame information. If @code{TARGET_EXCEPT_UNWIND_INFO}
9288(@pxref{Exception Region Output}) returns @code{UI_DWARF2}, and
9289exceptions are enabled, GCC will output this information not matter
9290how you define @code{DWARF2_FRAME_INFO}.
a2c4f8e0 9291@end defmac
9ec36da5 9292
f0a0390e
RH
9293@deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum unwind_info_type} TARGET_DEBUG_UNWIND_INFO (void)
9294This hook defines the mechanism that will be used for describing frame
9295unwind information to the debugger. Normally the hook will return
9296@code{UI_DWARF2} if DWARF 2 debug information is enabled, and
9297return @code{UI_NONE} otherwise.
9298
9299A target may return @code{UI_DWARF2} even when DWARF 2 debug information
9300is disabled in order to always output DWARF 2 frame information.
9301
9302A target may return @code{UI_TARGET} if it has ABI specified unwind tables.
9303This will suppress generation of the normal debug frame unwind information.
9304@end deftypefn
9305
a2c4f8e0 9306@defmac DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO
b2244e22
JW
9307Define this macro to be a nonzero value if the assembler can generate Dwarf 2
9308line debug info sections. This will result in much more compact line number
9309tables, and hence is desirable if it works.
a2c4f8e0 9310@end defmac
b2244e22 9311
9730bc27
TT
9312@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_WANT_DEBUG_PUB_SECTIONS
9313True if the @code{.debug_pubtypes} and @code{.debug_pubnames} sections should be emitted. These sections are not used on most platforms, and in particular GDB does not use them.
9314@end deftypevr
9315
638c962f
JH
9316@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FORCE_AT_COMP_DIR
9317True if the @code{DW_AT_comp_dir} attribute should be emitted for each compilation unit. This attribute is required for the darwin linker to emit debug information.
9318@end deftypevr
9319
2ba42841
AO
9320@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_DELAY_SCHED2
9321True if sched2 is not to be run at its normal place. This usually means it will be run as part of machine-specific reorg.
9322@end deftypevr
9323
9324@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_DELAY_VARTRACK
9325True if vartrack is not to be run at its normal place. This usually means it will be run as part of machine-specific reorg.
9326@end deftypevr
9327
a2c4f8e0 9328@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_DELTA (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label1}, @var{label2})
7606e68f 9329A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a difference
192d0f89 9330@var{lab1} minus @var{lab2}, using an integer of the given @var{size}.
a2c4f8e0 9331@end defmac
7606e68f 9332
67ad2ae7
DR
9333@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_VMS_DELTA (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label1}, @var{label2})
9334A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a difference
9335between the two given labels in system defined units, e.g. instruction
9336slots on IA64 VMS, using an integer of the given size.
9337@end defmac
9338
192d0f89 9339@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_OFFSET (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label}, @var{section})
7606e68f 9340A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a
192d0f89
GK
9341section-relative reference to the given @var{label}, using an integer of the
9342given @var{size}. The label is known to be defined in the given @var{section}.
a2c4f8e0 9343@end defmac
7606e68f 9344
a2c4f8e0 9345@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_PCREL (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label})
7606e68f 9346A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a self-relative
192d0f89 9347reference to the given @var{label}, using an integer of the given @var{size}.
a2c4f8e0 9348@end defmac
7606e68f 9349
7e49a4b3
OH
9350@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_TABLE_REF (@var{label})
9351A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a reference to
9352the DWARF table identifier @var{label} from the current section. This
9353is used on some systems to avoid garbage collecting a DWARF table which
9354is referenced by a function.
9355@end defmac
9356
914d25dc 9357@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_DTPREL (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{size}, rtx @var{x})
fdbe66f2
EB
9358If defined, this target hook is a function which outputs a DTP-relative
9359reference to the given TLS symbol of the specified size.
9360@end deftypefn
9361
a2c4f8e0 9362@defmac PUT_SDB_@dots{}
feca2ed3
JW
9363Define these macros to override the assembler syntax for the special
9364SDB assembler directives. See @file{sdbout.c} for a list of these
9365macros and their arguments. If the standard syntax is used, you need
9366not define them yourself.
a2c4f8e0 9367@end defmac
feca2ed3 9368
a2c4f8e0 9369@defmac SDB_DELIM
feca2ed3
JW
9370Some assemblers do not support a semicolon as a delimiter, even between
9371SDB assembler directives. In that case, define this macro to be the
9372delimiter to use (usually @samp{\n}). It is not necessary to define
9373a new set of @code{PUT_SDB_@var{op}} macros if this is the only change
9374required.
a2c4f8e0 9375@end defmac
feca2ed3 9376
a2c4f8e0 9377@defmac SDB_ALLOW_UNKNOWN_REFERENCES
feca2ed3
JW
9378Define this macro to allow references to unknown structure,
9379union, or enumeration tags to be emitted. Standard COFF does not
9380allow handling of unknown references, MIPS ECOFF has support for
9381it.
a2c4f8e0 9382@end defmac
feca2ed3 9383
a2c4f8e0 9384@defmac SDB_ALLOW_FORWARD_REFERENCES
feca2ed3
JW
9385Define this macro to allow references to structure, union, or
9386enumeration tags that have not yet been seen to be handled. Some
9387assemblers choke if forward tags are used, while some require it.
a2c4f8e0 9388@end defmac
feca2ed3 9389
3e487b21
ZW
9390@defmac SDB_OUTPUT_SOURCE_LINE (@var{stream}, @var{line})
9391A C statement to output SDB debugging information before code for line
9392number @var{line} of the current source file to the stdio stream
9393@var{stream}. The default is to emit an @code{.ln} directive.
9394@end defmac
9395
5f98259a
RK
9396@need 2000
9397@node VMS Debug
9398@subsection Macros for VMS Debug Format
9399
9400@c prevent bad page break with this line
9401Here are macros for VMS debug format.
9402
a2c4f8e0 9403@defmac VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
5f98259a
RK
9404Define this macro if GCC should produce debugging output for VMS
9405in response to the @option{-g} option. The default behavior for VMS
9406is to generate minimal debug info for a traceback in the absence of
9407@option{-g} unless explicitly overridden with @option{-g0}. This
fac0f722 9408behavior is controlled by @code{TARGET_OPTION_OPTIMIZATION} and
74f7912a 9409@code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}.
a2c4f8e0 9410@end defmac
5f98259a 9411
b216cd4a 9412@node Floating Point
feca2ed3
JW
9413@section Cross Compilation and Floating Point
9414@cindex cross compilation and floating point
9415@cindex floating point and cross compilation
9416
b216cd4a 9417While all modern machines use twos-complement representation for integers,
feca2ed3
JW
9418there are a variety of representations for floating point numbers. This
9419means that in a cross-compiler the representation of floating point numbers
9420in the compiled program may be different from that used in the machine
9421doing the compilation.
9422
feca2ed3 9423Because different representation systems may offer different amounts of
b216cd4a
ZW
9424range and precision, all floating point constants must be represented in
9425the target machine's format. Therefore, the cross compiler cannot
9426safely use the host machine's floating point arithmetic; it must emulate
9427the target's arithmetic. To ensure consistency, GCC always uses
9428emulation to work with floating point values, even when the host and
9429target floating point formats are identical.
9430
9431The following macros are provided by @file{real.h} for the compiler to
9432use. All parts of the compiler which generate or optimize
ba31d94e
ZW
9433floating-point calculations must use these macros. They may evaluate
9434their operands more than once, so operands must not have side effects.
feca2ed3 9435
b216cd4a
ZW
9436@defmac REAL_VALUE_TYPE
9437The C data type to be used to hold a floating point value in the target
9438machine's format. Typically this is a @code{struct} containing an
9439array of @code{HOST_WIDE_INT}, but all code should treat it as an opaque
9440quantity.
9441@end defmac
9442
9443@deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUES_EQUAL (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{y})
9444Compares for equality the two values, @var{x} and @var{y}. If the target
9445floating point format supports negative zeroes and/or NaNs,
9446@samp{REAL_VALUES_EQUAL (-0.0, 0.0)} is true, and
9447@samp{REAL_VALUES_EQUAL (NaN, NaN)} is false.
9448@end deftypefn
9449
9450@deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUES_LESS (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{y})
9451Tests whether @var{x} is less than @var{y}.
9452@end deftypefn
9453
b216cd4a
ZW
9454@deftypefn Macro HOST_WIDE_INT REAL_VALUE_FIX (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9455Truncates @var{x} to a signed integer, rounding toward zero.
9456@end deftypefn
9457
9458@deftypefn Macro {unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT} REAL_VALUE_UNSIGNED_FIX (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9459Truncates @var{x} to an unsigned integer, rounding toward zero. If
9460@var{x} is negative, returns zero.
9461@end deftypefn
9462
b216cd4a
ZW
9463@deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_ATOF (const char *@var{string}, enum machine_mode @var{mode})
9464Converts @var{string} into a floating point number in the target machine's
9465representation for mode @var{mode}. This routine can handle both
9466decimal and hexadecimal floating point constants, using the syntax
9467defined by the C language for both.
9468@end deftypefn
feca2ed3 9469
15e5ad76 9470@deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUE_NEGATIVE (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
ce3649d2 9471Returns 1 if @var{x} is negative (including negative zero), 0 otherwise.
15e5ad76
ZW
9472@end deftypefn
9473
b216cd4a
ZW
9474@deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUE_ISINF (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9475Determines whether @var{x} represents infinity (positive or negative).
9476@end deftypefn
9477
9478@deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUE_ISNAN (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9479Determines whether @var{x} represents a ``NaN'' (not-a-number).
9480@end deftypefn
9481
9482@deftypefn Macro void REAL_ARITHMETIC (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{output}, enum tree_code @var{code}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{y})
9483Calculates an arithmetic operation on the two floating point values
9484@var{x} and @var{y}, storing the result in @var{output} (which must be a
9485variable).
9486
9487The operation to be performed is specified by @var{code}. Only the
9488following codes are supported: @code{PLUS_EXPR}, @code{MINUS_EXPR},
9489@code{MULT_EXPR}, @code{RDIV_EXPR}, @code{MAX_EXPR}, @code{MIN_EXPR}.
9490
9491If @code{REAL_ARITHMETIC} is asked to evaluate division by zero and the
9492target's floating point format cannot represent infinity, it will call
9493@code{abort}. Callers should check for this situation first, using
9494@code{MODE_HAS_INFINITIES}. @xref{Storage Layout}.
9495@end deftypefn
9496
9497@deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_NEGATE (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9498Returns the negative of the floating point value @var{x}.
9499@end deftypefn
9500
15e5ad76
ZW
9501@deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_ABS (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9502Returns the absolute value of @var{x}.
9503@end deftypefn
9504
9f09b1f2
R
9505@node Mode Switching
9506@section Mode Switching Instructions
9507@cindex mode switching
9508The following macros control mode switching optimizations:
9509
a2c4f8e0 9510@defmac OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING (@var{entity})
9f09b1f2
R
9511Define this macro if the port needs extra instructions inserted for mode
9512switching in an optimizing compilation.
9513
9514For an example, the SH4 can perform both single and double precision
9515floating point operations, but to perform a single precision operation,
9516the FPSCR PR bit has to be cleared, while for a double precision
9517operation, this bit has to be set. Changing the PR bit requires a general
9518purpose register as a scratch register, hence these FPSCR sets have to
e979f9e8 9519be inserted before reload, i.e.@: you can't put this into instruction emitting
18dbd950 9520or @code{TARGET_MACHINE_DEPENDENT_REORG}.
9f09b1f2
R
9521
9522You can have multiple entities that are mode-switched, and select at run time
9523which entities actually need it. @code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING} should
14976c58 9524return nonzero for any @var{entity} that needs mode-switching.
9f09b1f2 9525If you define this macro, you also have to define
06b90602
CB
9526@code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING}, @code{TARGET_MODE_NEEDED},
9527@code{TARGET_MODE_PRIORITY} and @code{TARGET_MODE_EMIT}.
9528@code{TARGET_MODE_AFTER}, @code{TARGET_MODE_ENTRY}, and @code{TARGET_MODE_EXIT}
73774972 9529are optional.
a2c4f8e0 9530@end defmac
9f09b1f2 9531
a2c4f8e0 9532@defmac NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING
9f09b1f2
R
9533If you define @code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING}, you have to define this as
9534initializer for an array of integers. Each initializer element
9535N refers to an entity that needs mode switching, and specifies the number
9536of different modes that might need to be set for this entity.
78466c0e
JM
9537The position of the initializer in the initializer---starting counting at
9538zero---determines the integer that is used to refer to the mode-switched
9f09b1f2
R
9539entity in question.
9540In macros that take mode arguments / yield a mode result, modes are
630d3d5a 9541represented as numbers 0 @dots{} N @minus{} 1. N is used to specify that no mode
9f09b1f2 9542switch is needed / supplied.
a2c4f8e0 9543@end defmac
9f09b1f2 9544
cbb1e3d9
CB
9545@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_MODE_EMIT (int @var{entity}, int @var{mode}, int @var{prev_mode}, HARD_REG_SET @var{regs_live})
9546Generate one or more insns to set @var{entity} to @var{mode}. @var{hard_reg_live} is the set of hard registers live at the point where the insn(s) are to be inserted. @var{prev_moxde} indicates the mode to switch from. Sets of a lower numbered entity will be emitted before sets of a higher numbered entity to a mode of the same or lower priority.
06b90602 9547@end deftypefn
9f09b1f2 9548
ac44248e 9549@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_MODE_NEEDED (int @var{entity}, rtx_insn *@var{insn})
cbb1e3d9 9550@var{entity} is an integer specifying a mode-switched entity. If @code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING} is defined, you must define this macro to return an integer value not larger than the corresponding element in @code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING}, to denote the mode that @var{entity} must be switched into prior to the execution of @var{insn}.
06b90602 9551@end deftypefn
73774972 9552
ac44248e 9553@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_MODE_AFTER (int @var{entity}, int @var{mode}, rtx_insn *@var{insn})
06b90602
CB
9554@var{entity} is an integer specifying a mode-switched entity. If this macro is defined, it is evaluated for every @var{insn} during mode switching. It determines the mode that an insn results in (if different from the incoming mode).
9555@end deftypefn
73774972 9556
06b90602
CB
9557@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_MODE_ENTRY (int @var{entity})
9558If this macro is defined, it is evaluated for every @var{entity} that needs mode switching. It should evaluate to an integer, which is a mode that @var{entity} is assumed to be switched to at function entry. If @code{TARGET_MODE_ENTRY} is defined then @code{TARGET_MODE_EXIT} must be defined.
9559@end deftypefn
9f09b1f2 9560
06b90602
CB
9561@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_MODE_EXIT (int @var{entity})
9562If this macro is defined, it is evaluated for every @var{entity} that needs mode switching. It should evaluate to an integer, which is a mode that @var{entity} is assumed to be switched to at function exit. If @code{TARGET_MODE_EXIT} is defined then @code{TARGET_MODE_ENTRY} must be defined.
9563@end deftypefn
9f09b1f2 9564
06b90602
CB
9565@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_MODE_PRIORITY (int @var{entity}, int @var{n})
9566This macro specifies the order in which modes for @var{entity} are processed. 0 is the highest priority, @code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING[@var{entity}] - 1} the lowest. The value of the macro should be an integer designating a mode for @var{entity}. For any fixed @var{entity}, @code{mode_priority} (@var{entity}, @var{n}) shall be a bijection in 0 @dots{} @code{num_modes_for_mode_switching[@var{entity}] - 1}.
9567@end deftypefn
9f09b1f2 9568
91d231cb
JM
9569@node Target Attributes
9570@section Defining target-specific uses of @code{__attribute__}
9571@cindex target attributes
9572@cindex machine attributes
9573@cindex attributes, target-specific
9574
9575Target-specific attributes may be defined for functions, data and types.
9576These are described using the following target hooks; they also need to
9577be documented in @file{extend.texi}.
9578
9579@deftypevr {Target Hook} {const struct attribute_spec *} TARGET_ATTRIBUTE_TABLE
9580If defined, this target hook points to an array of @samp{struct
9581attribute_spec} (defined in @file{tree.h}) specifying the machine
9582specific attributes for this target and some of the restrictions on the
9583entities to which these attributes are applied and the arguments they
9584take.
9585@end deftypevr
9586
564a129d
JM
9587@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ATTRIBUTE_TAKES_IDENTIFIER_P (const_tree @var{name})
9588If defined, this target hook is a function which returns true if the
9589machine-specific attribute named @var{name} expects an identifier
9590given as its first argument to be passed on as a plain identifier, not
9591subjected to name lookup. If this is not defined, the default is
9592false for all machine-specific attributes.
9593@end deftypefn
9594
b6fd8800 9595@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES (const_tree @var{type1}, const_tree @var{type2})
91d231cb
JM
9596If defined, this target hook is a function which returns zero if the attributes on
9597@var{type1} and @var{type2} are incompatible, one if they are compatible,
9598and two if they are nearly compatible (which causes a warning to be
9599generated). If this is not defined, machine-specific attributes are
9600supposed always to be compatible.
9601@end deftypefn
9602
9603@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SET_DEFAULT_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES (tree @var{type})
9604If defined, this target hook is a function which assigns default attributes to
914d25dc 9605the newly defined @var{type}.
91d231cb
JM
9606@end deftypefn
9607
9608@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_MERGE_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES (tree @var{type1}, tree @var{type2})
9609Define this target hook if the merging of type attributes needs special
9610handling. If defined, the result is a list of the combined
9611@code{TYPE_ATTRIBUTES} of @var{type1} and @var{type2}. It is assumed
9612that @code{comptypes} has already been called and returned 1. This
9613function may call @code{merge_attributes} to handle machine-independent
9614merging.
9615@end deftypefn
9616
9617@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_MERGE_DECL_ATTRIBUTES (tree @var{olddecl}, tree @var{newdecl})
9618Define this target hook if the merging of decl attributes needs special
9619handling. If defined, the result is a list of the combined
9620@code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES} of @var{olddecl} and @var{newdecl}.
9621@var{newdecl} is a duplicate declaration of @var{olddecl}. Examples of
9622when this is needed are when one attribute overrides another, or when an
9623attribute is nullified by a subsequent definition. This function may
9624call @code{merge_attributes} to handle machine-independent merging.
9625
9626@findex TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES
b2ca3702
MM
9627If the only target-specific handling you require is @samp{dllimport}
9628for Microsoft Windows targets, you should define the macro
9629@code{TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES} to @code{1}. The compiler
9630will then define a function called
9631@code{merge_dllimport_decl_attributes} which can then be defined as
9632the expansion of @code{TARGET_MERGE_DECL_ATTRIBUTES}. You can also
9633add @code{handle_dll_attribute} in the attribute table for your port
9634to perform initial processing of the @samp{dllimport} and
9635@samp{dllexport} attributes. This is done in @file{i386/cygwin.h} and
9636@file{i386/i386.c}, for example.
91d231cb
JM
9637@end deftypefn
9638
b6fd8800 9639@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VALID_DLLIMPORT_ATTRIBUTE_P (const_tree @var{decl})
38f8b050 9640@var{decl} is a variable or function with @code{__attribute__((dllimport))} specified. Use this hook if the target needs to add extra validation checks to @code{handle_dll_attribute}.
43d9ad1d
DS
9641@end deftypefn
9642
63c5b495 9643@defmac TARGET_DECLSPEC
1a141fe1 9644Define this macro to a nonzero value if you want to treat
63c5b495
MM
9645@code{__declspec(X)} as equivalent to @code{__attribute((X))}. By
9646default, this behavior is enabled only for targets that define
9647@code{TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES}. The current implementation
9648of @code{__declspec} is via a built-in macro, but you should not rely
9649on this implementation detail.
9650@end defmac
9651
91d231cb
JM
9652@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INSERT_ATTRIBUTES (tree @var{node}, tree *@var{attr_ptr})
9653Define this target hook if you want to be able to add attributes to a decl
9654when it is being created. This is normally useful for back ends which
9655wish to implement a pragma by using the attributes which correspond to
9656the pragma's effect. The @var{node} argument is the decl which is being
9657created. The @var{attr_ptr} argument is a pointer to the attribute list
9658for this decl. The list itself should not be modified, since it may be
9659shared with other decls, but attributes may be chained on the head of
9660the list and @code{*@var{attr_ptr}} modified to point to the new
9661attributes, or a copy of the list may be made if further changes are
9662needed.
9663@end deftypefn
9664
65a324b4 9665@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FUNCTION_ATTRIBUTE_INLINABLE_P (const_tree @var{fndecl})
91d231cb 9666@cindex inlining
5bd40ade 9667This target hook returns @code{true} if it is OK to inline @var{fndecl}
91d231cb
JM
9668into the current function, despite its having target-specific
9669attributes, @code{false} otherwise. By default, if a function has a
9670target specific attribute attached to it, it will not be inlined.
9671@end deftypefn
9672
914d25dc 9673@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_OPTION_VALID_ATTRIBUTE_P (tree @var{fndecl}, tree @var{name}, tree @var{args}, int @var{flags})
7aa7f2e3
SL
9674This hook is called to parse @code{attribute(target("..."))}, which
9675allows setting target-specific options on individual functions.
9676These function-specific options may differ
9677from the options specified on the command line. The hook should return
ab442df7
MM
9678@code{true} if the options are valid.
9679
7aa7f2e3
SL
9680The hook should set the @code{DECL_FUNCTION_SPECIFIC_TARGET} field in
9681the function declaration to hold a pointer to a target-specific
9682@code{struct cl_target_option} structure.
ab442df7
MM
9683@end deftypefn
9684
bf7b5747 9685@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_SAVE (struct cl_target_option *@var{ptr}, struct gcc_options *@var{opts})
7aa7f2e3
SL
9686This hook is called to save any additional target-specific information
9687in the @code{struct cl_target_option} structure for function-specific
bf7b5747 9688options from the @code{struct gcc_options} structure.
ab442df7
MM
9689@xref{Option file format}.
9690@end deftypefn
9691
bf7b5747 9692@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_RESTORE (struct gcc_options *@var{opts}, struct cl_target_option *@var{ptr})
7aa7f2e3
SL
9693This hook is called to restore any additional target-specific
9694information in the @code{struct cl_target_option} structure for
bf7b5747 9695function-specific options to the @code{struct gcc_options} structure.
ab442df7
MM
9696@end deftypefn
9697
d2143a2f 9698@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_PRINT (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{indent}, struct cl_target_option *@var{ptr})
7aa7f2e3
SL
9699This hook is called to print any additional target-specific
9700information in the @code{struct cl_target_option} structure for
9701function-specific options.
ab442df7
MM
9702@end deftypefn
9703
56cb42ea 9704@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_OPTION_PRAGMA_PARSE (tree @var{args}, tree @var{pop_target})
7aa7f2e3
SL
9705This target hook parses the options for @code{#pragma GCC target}, which
9706sets the target-specific options for functions that occur later in the
9707input stream. The options accepted should be the same as those handled by the
56cb42ea 9708@code{TARGET_OPTION_VALID_ATTRIBUTE_P} hook.
ab442df7
MM
9709@end deftypefn
9710
74f7912a
JR
9711@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE (void)
9712Sometimes certain combinations of command options do not make sense on
9713a particular target machine. You can override the hook
9714@code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} to take account of this. This hooks is called
9715once just after all the command options have been parsed.
9716
9717Don't use this hook to turn on various extra optimizations for
fac0f722 9718@option{-O}. That is what @code{TARGET_OPTION_OPTIMIZATION} is for.
74f7912a
JR
9719
9720If you need to do something whenever the optimization level is
9721changed via the optimize attribute or pragma, see
9722@code{TARGET_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS_AFTER_CHANGE}
9723@end deftypefn
9724
3649b9b7
ST
9725@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_OPTION_FUNCTION_VERSIONS (tree @var{decl1}, tree @var{decl2})
9726This target hook returns @code{true} if @var{DECL1} and @var{DECL2} are
9727versions of the same function. @var{DECL1} and @var{DECL2} are function
9728versions if and only if they have the same function signature and
9729different target specific attributes, that is, they are compiled for
9730different target machines.
9731@end deftypefn
9732
ab442df7
MM
9733@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CAN_INLINE_P (tree @var{caller}, tree @var{callee})
9734This target hook returns @code{false} if the @var{caller} function
9735cannot inline @var{callee}, based on target specific information. By
9736default, inlining is not allowed if the callee function has function
9737specific target options and the caller does not use the same options.
9738@end deftypefn
9739
feb60f03
NS
9740@node Emulated TLS
9741@section Emulating TLS
9742@cindex Emulated TLS
9743
9744For targets whose psABI does not provide Thread Local Storage via
9745specific relocations and instruction sequences, an emulation layer is
9746used. A set of target hooks allows this emulation layer to be
9747configured for the requirements of a particular target. For instance
a640c13b 9748the psABI may in fact specify TLS support in terms of an emulation
feb60f03
NS
9749layer.
9750
9751The emulation layer works by creating a control object for every TLS
9752object. To access the TLS object, a lookup function is provided
9753which, when given the address of the control object, will return the
9754address of the current thread's instance of the TLS object.
9755
9756@deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_GET_ADDRESS
9757Contains the name of the helper function that uses a TLS control
9758object to locate a TLS instance. The default causes libgcc's
9759emulated TLS helper function to be used.
9760@end deftypevr
9761
9762@deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_REGISTER_COMMON
9763Contains the name of the helper function that should be used at
9764program startup to register TLS objects that are implicitly
9765initialized to zero. If this is @code{NULL}, all TLS objects will
9766have explicit initializers. The default causes libgcc's emulated TLS
9767registration function to be used.
9768@end deftypevr
9769
9770@deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_SECTION
9771Contains the name of the section in which TLS control variables should
9772be placed. The default of @code{NULL} allows these to be placed in
9773any section.
9774@end deftypevr
9775
9776@deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_TMPL_SECTION
9777Contains the name of the section in which TLS initializers should be
9778placed. The default of @code{NULL} allows these to be placed in any
9779section.
9780@end deftypevr
9781
9782@deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_PREFIX
9783Contains the prefix to be prepended to TLS control variable names.
9784The default of @code{NULL} uses a target-specific prefix.
9785@end deftypevr
9786
9787@deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_TMPL_PREFIX
9788Contains the prefix to be prepended to TLS initializer objects. The
9789default of @code{NULL} uses a target-specific prefix.
9790@end deftypevr
9791
9792@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_FIELDS (tree @var{type}, tree *@var{name})
9793Specifies a function that generates the FIELD_DECLs for a TLS control
9794object type. @var{type} is the RECORD_TYPE the fields are for and
9795@var{name} should be filled with the structure tag, if the default of
9796@code{__emutls_object} is unsuitable. The default creates a type suitable
9797for libgcc's emulated TLS function.
9798@end deftypefn
9799
9800@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_INIT (tree @var{var}, tree @var{decl}, tree @var{tmpl_addr})
9801Specifies a function that generates the CONSTRUCTOR to initialize a
9802TLS control object. @var{var} is the TLS control object, @var{decl}
9803is the TLS object and @var{tmpl_addr} is the address of the
9804initializer. The default initializes libgcc's emulated TLS control object.
9805@end deftypefn
9806
b6fd8800 9807@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_ALIGN_FIXED
feb60f03
NS
9808Specifies whether the alignment of TLS control variable objects is
9809fixed and should not be increased as some backends may do to optimize
9810single objects. The default is false.
9811@end deftypevr
9812
b6fd8800 9813@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_EMUTLS_DEBUG_FORM_TLS_ADDRESS
feb60f03
NS
9814Specifies whether a DWARF @code{DW_OP_form_tls_address} location descriptor
9815may be used to describe emulated TLS control objects.
9816@end deftypevr
9817
d604bca3
MH
9818@node MIPS Coprocessors
9819@section Defining coprocessor specifics for MIPS targets.
9820@cindex MIPS coprocessor-definition macros
9821
9822The MIPS specification allows MIPS implementations to have as many as 4
2dd76960 9823coprocessors, each with as many as 32 private registers. GCC supports
d604bca3
MH
9824accessing these registers and transferring values between the registers
9825and memory using asm-ized variables. For example:
9826
9827@smallexample
9828 register unsigned int cp0count asm ("c0r1");
9829 unsigned int d;
9830
9831 d = cp0count + 3;
9832@end smallexample
9833
9834(``c0r1'' is the default name of register 1 in coprocessor 0; alternate
9835names may be added as described below, or the default names may be
9836overridden entirely in @code{SUBTARGET_CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE}.)
9837
9838Coprocessor registers are assumed to be epilogue-used; sets to them will
9839be preserved even if it does not appear that the register is used again
9840later in the function.
9841
9842Another note: according to the MIPS spec, coprocessor 1 (if present) is
8a36672b 9843the FPU@. One accesses COP1 registers through standard mips
d604bca3
MH
9844floating-point support; they are not included in this mechanism.
9845
7bb1ad93
GK
9846@node PCH Target
9847@section Parameters for Precompiled Header Validity Checking
9848@cindex parameters, precompiled headers
9849
0678ade0 9850@deftypefn {Target Hook} {void *} TARGET_GET_PCH_VALIDITY (size_t *@var{sz})
914d25dc
JR
9851This hook returns a pointer to the data needed by
9852@code{TARGET_PCH_VALID_P} and sets
0678ade0 9853@samp{*@var{sz}} to the size of the data in bytes.
7bb1ad93
GK
9854@end deftypefn
9855
b6fd8800 9856@deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_PCH_VALID_P (const void *@var{data}, size_t @var{sz})
8d932be3
RS
9857This hook checks whether the options used to create a PCH file are
9858compatible with the current settings. It returns @code{NULL}
9859if so and a suitable error message if not. Error messages will
9860be presented to the user and must be localized using @samp{_(@var{msg})}.
9861
9862@var{data} is the data that was returned by @code{TARGET_GET_PCH_VALIDITY}
9863when the PCH file was created and @var{sz} is the size of that data in bytes.
9864It's safe to assume that the data was created by the same version of the
9865compiler, so no format checking is needed.
9866
9867The default definition of @code{default_pch_valid_p} should be
9868suitable for most targets.
9869@end deftypefn
9870
b6fd8800 9871@deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_CHECK_PCH_TARGET_FLAGS (int @var{pch_flags})
8d932be3
RS
9872If this hook is nonnull, the default implementation of
9873@code{TARGET_PCH_VALID_P} will use it to check for compatible values
9874of @code{target_flags}. @var{pch_flags} specifies the value that
9875@code{target_flags} had when the PCH file was created. The return
9876value is the same as for @code{TARGET_PCH_VALID_P}.
7bb1ad93
GK
9877@end deftypefn
9878
e32ea2d1
RS
9879@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_PREPARE_PCH_SAVE (void)
9880Called before writing out a PCH file. If the target has some
9881garbage-collected data that needs to be in a particular state on PCH loads,
9882it can use this hook to enforce that state. Very few targets need
9883to do anything here.
9884@end deftypefn
9885
4185ae53
PB
9886@node C++ ABI
9887@section C++ ABI parameters
9888@cindex parameters, c++ abi
9889
9890@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CXX_GUARD_TYPE (void)
9891Define this hook to override the integer type used for guard variables.
9892These are used to implement one-time construction of static objects. The
9893default is long_long_integer_type_node.
9894@end deftypefn
9895
9896@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_GUARD_MASK_BIT (void)
f676971a 9897This hook determines how guard variables are used. It should return
914d25dc
JR
9898@code{false} (the default) if the first byte should be used. A return value of
9899@code{true} indicates that only the least significant bit should be used.
4185ae53
PB
9900@end deftypefn
9901
46e995e0
PB
9902@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CXX_GET_COOKIE_SIZE (tree @var{type})
9903This hook returns the size of the cookie to use when allocating an array
9904whose elements have the indicated @var{type}. Assumes that it is already
9905known that a cookie is needed. The default is
9906@code{max(sizeof (size_t), alignof(type))}, as defined in section 2.7 of the
8a36672b 9907IA64/Generic C++ ABI@.
46e995e0
PB
9908@end deftypefn
9909
9910@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_COOKIE_HAS_SIZE (void)
9911This hook should return @code{true} if the element size should be stored in
9912array cookies. The default is to return @code{false}.
9913@end deftypefn
9914
38f8b050 9915@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_CXX_IMPORT_EXPORT_CLASS (tree @var{type}, int @var{import_export})
d59c7b4b
NC
9916If defined by a backend this hook allows the decision made to export
9917class @var{type} to be overruled. Upon entry @var{import_export}
78466c0e 9918will contain 1 if the class is going to be exported, @minus{}1 if it is going
d59c7b4b
NC
9919to be imported and 0 otherwise. This function should return the
9920modified value and perform any other actions necessary to support the
9921backend's targeted operating system.
9922@end deftypefn
9923
44d10c10
PB
9924@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_CDTOR_RETURNS_THIS (void)
9925This hook should return @code{true} if constructors and destructors return
9926the address of the object created/destroyed. The default is to return
9927@code{false}.
9928@end deftypefn
9929
af287697
MM
9930@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_KEY_METHOD_MAY_BE_INLINE (void)
9931This hook returns true if the key method for a class (i.e., the method
9932which, if defined in the current translation unit, causes the virtual
9933table to be emitted) may be an inline function. Under the standard
9934Itanium C++ ABI the key method may be an inline function so long as
9935the function is not declared inline in the class definition. Under
9936some variants of the ABI, an inline function can never be the key
9937method. The default is to return @code{true}.
9938@end deftypefn
9939
1e731102 9940@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_CXX_DETERMINE_CLASS_DATA_VISIBILITY (tree @var{decl})
38f8b050 9941@var{decl} is a virtual table, virtual table table, typeinfo object, or other similar implicit class data object that will be emitted with external linkage in this translation unit. No ELF visibility has been explicitly specified. If the target needs to specify a visibility other than that of the containing class, use this hook to set @code{DECL_VISIBILITY} and @code{DECL_VISIBILITY_SPECIFIED}.
1e731102
MM
9942@end deftypefn
9943
9944@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_CLASS_DATA_ALWAYS_COMDAT (void)
9945This hook returns true (the default) if virtual tables and other
9946similar implicit class data objects are always COMDAT if they have
9947external linkage. If this hook returns false, then class data for
9948classes whose virtual table will be emitted in only one translation
9949unit will not be COMDAT.
505970fc
MM
9950@end deftypefn
9951
157600d0
GK
9952@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_LIBRARY_RTTI_COMDAT (void)
9953This hook returns true (the default) if the RTTI information for
9954the basic types which is defined in the C++ runtime should always
9955be COMDAT, false if it should not be COMDAT.
9956@end deftypefn
9957
9f62c3e3
PB
9958@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_USE_AEABI_ATEXIT (void)
9959This hook returns true if @code{__aeabi_atexit} (as defined by the ARM EABI)
9960should be used to register static destructors when @option{-fuse-cxa-atexit}
9961is in effect. The default is to return false to use @code{__cxa_atexit}.
9962@end deftypefn
9963
97388150
DS
9964@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_USE_ATEXIT_FOR_CXA_ATEXIT (void)
9965This hook returns true if the target @code{atexit} function can be used
9966in the same manner as @code{__cxa_atexit} to register C++ static
9967destructors. This requires that @code{atexit}-registered functions in
9968shared libraries are run in the correct order when the libraries are
9969unloaded. The default is to return false.
9970@end deftypefn
9971
43d9ad1d 9972@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_CXX_ADJUST_CLASS_AT_DEFINITION (tree @var{type})
38f8b050 9973@var{type} is a C++ class (i.e., RECORD_TYPE or UNION_TYPE) that has just been defined. Use this hook to make adjustments to the class (eg, tweak visibility or perform any other required target modifications).
43d9ad1d
DS
9974@end deftypefn
9975
5b880ea6
RO
9976@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CXX_DECL_MANGLING_CONTEXT (const_tree @var{decl})
9977Return target-specific mangling context of @var{decl} or @code{NULL_TREE}.
9978@end deftypefn
9979
09e881c9
BE
9980@node Named Address Spaces
9981@section Adding support for named address spaces
9982@cindex named address spaces
9983
9984The draft technical report of the ISO/IEC JTC1 S22 WG14 N1275
9985standards committee, @cite{Programming Languages - C - Extensions to
9986support embedded processors}, specifies a syntax for embedded
9987processors to specify alternate address spaces. You can configure a
9988GCC port to support section 5.1 of the draft report to add support for
9989address spaces other than the default address space. These address
9990spaces are new keywords that are similar to the @code{volatile} and
9991@code{const} type attributes.
9992
02a9370c 9993Pointers to named address spaces can have a different size than
09e881c9
BE
9994pointers to the generic address space.
9995
9996For example, the SPU port uses the @code{__ea} address space to refer
9997to memory in the host processor, rather than memory local to the SPU
9998processor. Access to memory in the @code{__ea} address space involves
9999issuing DMA operations to move data between the host processor and the
10000local processor memory address space. Pointers in the @code{__ea}
10001address space are either 32 bits or 64 bits based on the
10002@option{-mea32} or @option{-mea64} switches (native SPU pointers are
10003always 32 bits).
10004
10005Internally, address spaces are represented as a small integer in the
10006range 0 to 15 with address space 0 being reserved for the generic
10007address space.
10008
3ef0694c
UW
10009To register a named address space qualifier keyword with the C front end,
10010the target may call the @code{c_register_addr_space} routine. For example,
10011the SPU port uses the following to declare @code{__ea} as the keyword for
10012named address space #1:
36c5e70a
BE
10013@smallexample
10014#define ADDR_SPACE_EA 1
3ef0694c 10015c_register_addr_space ("__ea", ADDR_SPACE_EA);
36c5e70a 10016@end smallexample
36c5e70a 10017
d4ebfa65
BE
10018@deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum machine_mode} TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_POINTER_MODE (addr_space_t @var{address_space})
10019Define this to return the machine mode to use for pointers to
10020@var{address_space} if the target supports named address spaces.
10021The default version of this hook returns @code{ptr_mode} for the
10022generic address space only.
10023@end deftypefn
10024
10025@deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum machine_mode} TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_ADDRESS_MODE (addr_space_t @var{address_space})
10026Define this to return the machine mode to use for addresses in
10027@var{address_space} if the target supports named address spaces.
10028The default version of this hook returns @code{Pmode} for the
10029generic address space only.
10030@end deftypefn
10031
10032@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_VALID_POINTER_MODE (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, addr_space_t @var{as})
10033Define this to return nonzero if the port can handle pointers
10034with machine mode @var{mode} to address space @var{as}. This target
10035hook is the same as the @code{TARGET_VALID_POINTER_MODE} target hook,
10036except that it includes explicit named address space support. The default
10037version of this hook returns true for the modes returned by either the
10038@code{TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_POINTER_MODE} or @code{TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_ADDRESS_MODE}
10039target hooks for the given address space.
10040@end deftypefn
10041
b6fd8800 10042@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{exp}, bool @var{strict}, addr_space_t @var{as})
09e881c9
BE
10043Define this to return true if @var{exp} is a valid address for mode
10044@var{mode} in the named address space @var{as}. The @var{strict}
10045parameter says whether strict addressing is in effect after reload has
10046finished. This target hook is the same as the
10047@code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P} target hook, except that it includes
10048explicit named address space support.
10049@end deftypefn
10050
b6fd8800 10051@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS (rtx @var{x}, rtx @var{oldx}, enum machine_mode @var{mode}, addr_space_t @var{as})
09e881c9
BE
10052Define this to modify an invalid address @var{x} to be a valid address
10053with mode @var{mode} in the named address space @var{as}. This target
10054hook is the same as the @code{TARGET_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS} target hook,
10055except that it includes explicit named address space support.
10056@end deftypefn
10057
b5bcaa4a 10058@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_SUBSET_P (addr_space_t @var{subset}, addr_space_t @var{superset})
09e881c9
BE
10059Define this to return whether the @var{subset} named address space is
10060contained within the @var{superset} named address space. Pointers to
10061a named address space that is a subset of another named address space
10062will be converted automatically without a cast if used together in
10063arithmetic operations. Pointers to a superset address space can be
a4ce9883 10064converted to pointers to a subset address space via explicit casts.
09e881c9
BE
10065@end deftypefn
10066
b6fd8800 10067@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_CONVERT (rtx @var{op}, tree @var{from_type}, tree @var{to_type})
09e881c9
BE
10068Define this to convert the pointer expression represented by the RTL
10069@var{op} with type @var{from_type} that points to a named address
10070space to a new pointer expression with type @var{to_type} that points
10071to a different named address space. When this hook it called, it is
10072guaranteed that one of the two address spaces is a subset of the other,
10073as determined by the @code{TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_SUBSET_P} target hook.
10074@end deftypefn
10075
feca2ed3
JW
10076@node Misc
10077@section Miscellaneous Parameters
10078@cindex parameters, miscellaneous
10079
10080@c prevent bad page break with this line
10081Here are several miscellaneous parameters.
10082
e543e219
ZW
10083@defmac HAS_LONG_COND_BRANCH
10084Define this boolean macro to indicate whether or not your architecture
10085has conditional branches that can span all of memory. It is used in
10086conjunction with an optimization that partitions hot and cold basic
10087blocks into separate sections of the executable. If this macro is
10088set to false, gcc will convert any conditional branches that attempt
10089to cross between sections into unconditional branches or indirect jumps.
10090@end defmac
10091
10092@defmac HAS_LONG_UNCOND_BRANCH
10093Define this boolean macro to indicate whether or not your architecture
10094has unconditional branches that can span all of memory. It is used in
10095conjunction with an optimization that partitions hot and cold basic
10096blocks into separate sections of the executable. If this macro is
10097set to false, gcc will convert any unconditional branches that attempt
10098to cross between sections into indirect jumps.
a2c4f8e0 10099@end defmac
8fe0ca0c 10100
a2c4f8e0 10101@defmac CASE_VECTOR_MODE
feca2ed3
JW
10102An alias for a machine mode name. This is the machine mode that
10103elements of a jump-table should have.
a2c4f8e0 10104@end defmac
feca2ed3 10105
a2c4f8e0 10106@defmac CASE_VECTOR_SHORTEN_MODE (@var{min_offset}, @var{max_offset}, @var{body})
33f7f353
JR
10107Optional: return the preferred mode for an @code{addr_diff_vec}
10108when the minimum and maximum offset are known. If you define this,
10109it enables extra code in branch shortening to deal with @code{addr_diff_vec}.
4226378a 10110To make this work, you also have to define @code{INSN_ALIGN} and
33f7f353 10111make the alignment for @code{addr_diff_vec} explicit.
391aaa6b 10112The @var{body} argument is provided so that the offset_unsigned and scale
33f7f353 10113flags can be updated.
a2c4f8e0 10114@end defmac
33f7f353 10115
a2c4f8e0 10116@defmac CASE_VECTOR_PC_RELATIVE
18543a22 10117Define this macro to be a C expression to indicate when jump-tables
9c49953c
KH
10118should contain relative addresses. You need not define this macro if
10119jump-tables never contain relative addresses, or jump-tables should
10120contain relative addresses only when @option{-fPIC} or @option{-fPIC}
10121is in effect.
a2c4f8e0 10122@end defmac
feca2ed3 10123
b6fd8800 10124@deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_CASE_VALUES_THRESHOLD (void)
e6ff3083 10125This function return the smallest number of different values for which it
feca2ed3
JW
10126is best to use a jump-table instead of a tree of conditional branches.
10127The default is four for machines with a @code{casesi} instruction and
10128five otherwise. This is best for most machines.
e6ff3083 10129@end deftypefn
feca2ed3 10130
a2c4f8e0 10131@defmac WORD_REGISTER_OPERATIONS
feca2ed3
JW
10132Define this macro if operations between registers with integral mode
10133smaller than a word are always performed on the entire register.
10134Most RISC machines have this property and most CISC machines do not.
a2c4f8e0 10135@end defmac
feca2ed3 10136
7be4d808 10137@defmac LOAD_EXTEND_OP (@var{mem_mode})
feca2ed3 10138Define this macro to be a C expression indicating when insns that read
7be4d808
R
10139memory in @var{mem_mode}, an integral mode narrower than a word, set the
10140bits outside of @var{mem_mode} to be either the sign-extension or the
feca2ed3 10141zero-extension of the data read. Return @code{SIGN_EXTEND} for values
7be4d808 10142of @var{mem_mode} for which the
feca2ed3 10143insn sign-extends, @code{ZERO_EXTEND} for which it zero-extends, and
f822d252 10144@code{UNKNOWN} for other modes.
feca2ed3 10145
7be4d808 10146This macro is not called with @var{mem_mode} non-integral or with a width
feca2ed3
JW
10147greater than or equal to @code{BITS_PER_WORD}, so you may return any
10148value in this case. Do not define this macro if it would always return
f822d252 10149@code{UNKNOWN}. On machines where this macro is defined, you will normally
feca2ed3 10150define it as the constant @code{SIGN_EXTEND} or @code{ZERO_EXTEND}.
7be4d808 10151
f822d252 10152You may return a non-@code{UNKNOWN} value even if for some hard registers
7be4d808
R
10153the sign extension is not performed, if for the @code{REGNO_REG_CLASS}
10154of these hard registers @code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} returns nonzero
10155when the @var{from} mode is @var{mem_mode} and the @var{to} mode is any
10156integral mode larger than this but not larger than @code{word_mode}.
10157
f822d252 10158You must return @code{UNKNOWN} if for some hard registers that allow this
7be4d808
R
10159mode, @code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} says that they cannot change to
10160@code{word_mode}, but that they can change to another integral mode that
10161is larger then @var{mem_mode} but still smaller than @code{word_mode}.
a2c4f8e0 10162@end defmac
feca2ed3 10163
a2c4f8e0 10164@defmac SHORT_IMMEDIATES_SIGN_EXTEND
77643ab8
MM
10165Define this macro if loading short immediate values into registers sign
10166extends.
a2c4f8e0 10167@end defmac
77643ab8 10168
728d406c 10169@deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_MIN_DIVISIONS_FOR_RECIP_MUL (enum machine_mode @var{mode})
bc23502b
PB
10170When @option{-ffast-math} is in effect, GCC tries to optimize
10171divisions by the same divisor, by turning them into multiplications by
10172the reciprocal. This target hook specifies the minimum number of divisions
10173that should be there for GCC to perform the optimization for a variable
10174of mode @var{mode}. The default implementation returns 3 if the machine
10175has an instruction for the division, and 2 if it does not.
10176@end deftypefn
10177
a2c4f8e0 10178@defmac MOVE_MAX
feca2ed3
JW
10179The maximum number of bytes that a single instruction can move quickly
10180between memory and registers or between two memory locations.
a2c4f8e0 10181@end defmac
feca2ed3 10182
a2c4f8e0 10183@defmac MAX_MOVE_MAX
feca2ed3
JW
10184The maximum number of bytes that a single instruction can move quickly
10185between memory and registers or between two memory locations. If this
10186is undefined, the default is @code{MOVE_MAX}. Otherwise, it is the
10187constant value that is the largest value that @code{MOVE_MAX} can have
10188at run-time.
a2c4f8e0 10189@end defmac
feca2ed3 10190
a2c4f8e0 10191@defmac SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED
feca2ed3
JW
10192A C expression that is nonzero if on this machine the number of bits
10193actually used for the count of a shift operation is equal to the number
10194of bits needed to represent the size of the object being shifted. When
df2a54e9 10195this macro is nonzero, the compiler will assume that it is safe to omit
feca2ed3
JW
10196a sign-extend, zero-extend, and certain bitwise `and' instructions that
10197truncates the count of a shift operation. On machines that have
c771326b 10198instructions that act on bit-fields at variable positions, which may
feca2ed3
JW
10199include `bit test' instructions, a nonzero @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED}
10200also enables deletion of truncations of the values that serve as
c771326b 10201arguments to bit-field instructions.
feca2ed3
JW
10202
10203If both types of instructions truncate the count (for shifts) and
c771326b 10204position (for bit-field operations), or if no variable-position bit-field
feca2ed3
JW
10205instructions exist, you should define this macro.
10206
10207However, on some machines, such as the 80386 and the 680x0, truncation
10208only applies to shift operations and not the (real or pretended)
c771326b 10209bit-field operations. Define @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED} to be zero on
feca2ed3
JW
10210such machines. Instead, add patterns to the @file{md} file that include
10211the implied truncation of the shift instructions.
10212
10213You need not define this macro if it would always have the value of zero.
a2c4f8e0 10214@end defmac
feca2ed3 10215
273a2526 10216@anchor{TARGET_SHIFT_TRUNCATION_MASK}
914d25dc 10217@deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT} TARGET_SHIFT_TRUNCATION_MASK (enum machine_mode @var{mode})
273a2526
RS
10218This function describes how the standard shift patterns for @var{mode}
10219deal with shifts by negative amounts or by more than the width of the mode.
10220@xref{shift patterns}.
10221
10222On many machines, the shift patterns will apply a mask @var{m} to the
10223shift count, meaning that a fixed-width shift of @var{x} by @var{y} is
10224equivalent to an arbitrary-width shift of @var{x} by @var{y & m}. If
10225this is true for mode @var{mode}, the function should return @var{m},
10226otherwise it should return 0. A return value of 0 indicates that no
10227particular behavior is guaranteed.
10228
10229Note that, unlike @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED}, this function does
10230@emph{not} apply to general shift rtxes; it applies only to instructions
10231that are generated by the named shift patterns.
10232
10233The default implementation of this function returns
10234@code{GET_MODE_BITSIZE (@var{mode}) - 1} if @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED}
10235and 0 otherwise. This definition is always safe, but if
10236@code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED} is false, and some shift patterns
10237nevertheless truncate the shift count, you may get better code
10238by overriding it.
10239@end deftypefn
10240
a2c4f8e0 10241@defmac TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION (@var{outprec}, @var{inprec})
feca2ed3
JW
10242A C expression which is nonzero if on this machine it is safe to
10243``convert'' an integer of @var{inprec} bits to one of @var{outprec}
10244bits (where @var{outprec} is smaller than @var{inprec}) by merely
10245operating on it as if it had only @var{outprec} bits.
10246
10247On many machines, this expression can be 1.
10248
10249@c rearranged this, removed the phrase "it is reported that". this was
10250@c to fix an overfull hbox. --mew 10feb93
10251When @code{TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION} returns 1 for a pair of sizes for
10252modes for which @code{MODES_TIEABLE_P} is 0, suboptimal code can result.
10253If this is the case, making @code{TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION} return 0 in
10254such cases may improve things.
a2c4f8e0 10255@end defmac
feca2ed3 10256
b12cbf2c 10257@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, enum machine_mode @var{rep_mode})
66a4ad37 10258The representation of an integral mode can be such that the values
b12cbf2c
AN
10259are always extended to a wider integral mode. Return
10260@code{SIGN_EXTEND} if values of @var{mode} are represented in
10261sign-extended form to @var{rep_mode}. Return @code{UNKNOWN}
10262otherwise. (Currently, none of the targets use zero-extended
10263representation this way so unlike @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP},
10264@code{TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED} is expected to return either
10265@code{SIGN_EXTEND} or @code{UNKNOWN}. Also no target extends
914d25dc 10266@var{mode} to @var{rep_mode} so that @var{rep_mode} is not the next
b12cbf2c
AN
10267widest integral mode and currently we take advantage of this fact.)
10268
10269Similarly to @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP} you may return a non-@code{UNKNOWN}
10270value even if the extension is not performed on certain hard registers
10271as long as for the @code{REGNO_REG_CLASS} of these hard registers
10272@code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} returns nonzero.
10273
10274Note that @code{TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED} and @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP}
10275describe two related properties. If you define
10276@code{TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED (mode, word_mode)} you probably also want
10277to define @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP (mode)} to return the same type of
10278extension.
10279
10280In order to enforce the representation of @code{mode},
10281@code{TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION} should return false when truncating to
10282@code{mode}.
10283@end deftypefn
10284
a2c4f8e0 10285@defmac STORE_FLAG_VALUE
feca2ed3
JW
10286A C expression describing the value returned by a comparison operator
10287with an integral mode and stored by a store-flag instruction
ac5eda13
PB
10288(@samp{cstore@var{mode}4}) when the condition is true. This description must
10289apply to @emph{all} the @samp{cstore@var{mode}4} patterns and all the
feca2ed3
JW
10290comparison operators whose results have a @code{MODE_INT} mode.
10291
630d3d5a
JM
10292A value of 1 or @minus{}1 means that the instruction implementing the
10293comparison operator returns exactly 1 or @minus{}1 when the comparison is true
feca2ed3
JW
10294and 0 when the comparison is false. Otherwise, the value indicates
10295which bits of the result are guaranteed to be 1 when the comparison is
10296true. This value is interpreted in the mode of the comparison
10297operation, which is given by the mode of the first operand in the
ac5eda13 10298@samp{cstore@var{mode}4} pattern. Either the low bit or the sign bit of
feca2ed3
JW
10299@code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} be on. Presently, only those bits are used by
10300the compiler.
10301
630d3d5a 10302If @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} is neither 1 or @minus{}1, the compiler will
feca2ed3
JW
10303generate code that depends only on the specified bits. It can also
10304replace comparison operators with equivalent operations if they cause
10305the required bits to be set, even if the remaining bits are undefined.
10306For example, on a machine whose comparison operators return an
10307@code{SImode} value and where @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} is defined as
10308@samp{0x80000000}, saying that just the sign bit is relevant, the
10309expression
10310
10311@smallexample
10312(ne:SI (and:SI @var{x} (const_int @var{power-of-2})) (const_int 0))
10313@end smallexample
10314
10315@noindent
10316can be converted to
10317
10318@smallexample
10319(ashift:SI @var{x} (const_int @var{n}))
10320@end smallexample
10321
10322@noindent
10323where @var{n} is the appropriate shift count to move the bit being
10324tested into the sign bit.
10325
10326There is no way to describe a machine that always sets the low-order bit
10327for a true value, but does not guarantee the value of any other bits,
10328but we do not know of any machine that has such an instruction. If you
a3a15b4d 10329are trying to port GCC to such a machine, include an instruction to
feca2ed3 10330perform a logical-and of the result with 1 in the pattern for the
b11cc610 10331comparison operators and let us know at @email{gcc@@gcc.gnu.org}.
feca2ed3
JW
10332
10333Often, a machine will have multiple instructions that obtain a value
10334from a comparison (or the condition codes). Here are rules to guide the
10335choice of value for @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE}, and hence the instructions
10336to be used:
10337
10338@itemize @bullet
10339@item
10340Use the shortest sequence that yields a valid definition for
10341@code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE}. It is more efficient for the compiler to
10342``normalize'' the value (convert it to, e.g., 1 or 0) than for the
10343comparison operators to do so because there may be opportunities to
10344combine the normalization with other operations.
10345
10346@item
630d3d5a 10347For equal-length sequences, use a value of 1 or @minus{}1, with @minus{}1 being
feca2ed3
JW
10348slightly preferred on machines with expensive jumps and 1 preferred on
10349other machines.
10350
10351@item
10352As a second choice, choose a value of @samp{0x80000001} if instructions
10353exist that set both the sign and low-order bits but do not define the
10354others.
10355
10356@item
10357Otherwise, use a value of @samp{0x80000000}.
10358@end itemize
10359
10360Many machines can produce both the value chosen for
10361@code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} and its negation in the same number of
10362instructions. On those machines, you should also define a pattern for
10363those cases, e.g., one matching
10364
10365@smallexample
10366(set @var{A} (neg:@var{m} (ne:@var{m} @var{B} @var{C})))
10367@end smallexample
10368
10369Some machines can also perform @code{and} or @code{plus} operations on
10370condition code values with less instructions than the corresponding
ac5eda13 10371@samp{cstore@var{mode}4} insn followed by @code{and} or @code{plus}. On those
feca2ed3
JW
10372machines, define the appropriate patterns. Use the names @code{incscc}
10373and @code{decscc}, respectively, for the patterns which perform
10374@code{plus} or @code{minus} operations on condition code values. See
2b0d3573 10375@file{rs6000.md} for some examples. The GNU Superoptimizer can be used to
feca2ed3
JW
10376find such instruction sequences on other machines.
10377
06f31100
RS
10378If this macro is not defined, the default value, 1, is used. You need
10379not define @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} if the machine has no store-flag
10380instructions, or if the value generated by these instructions is 1.
a2c4f8e0 10381@end defmac
feca2ed3 10382
a2c4f8e0 10383@defmac FLOAT_STORE_FLAG_VALUE (@var{mode})
df2a54e9 10384A C expression that gives a nonzero @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE} value that is
feca2ed3 10385returned when comparison operators with floating-point results are true.
fc7ca5fd 10386Define this macro on machines that have comparison operations that return
feca2ed3
JW
10387floating-point values. If there are no such operations, do not define
10388this macro.
a2c4f8e0 10389@end defmac
feca2ed3 10390
fc7ca5fd 10391@defmac VECTOR_STORE_FLAG_VALUE (@var{mode})
a4d05547 10392A C expression that gives a rtx representing the nonzero true element
fc7ca5fd
RS
10393for vector comparisons. The returned rtx should be valid for the inner
10394mode of @var{mode} which is guaranteed to be a vector mode. Define
10395this macro on machines that have vector comparison operations that
10396return a vector result. If there are no such operations, do not define
10397this macro. Typically, this macro is defined as @code{const1_rtx} or
10398@code{constm1_rtx}. This macro may return @code{NULL_RTX} to prevent
10399the compiler optimizing such vector comparison operations for the
10400given mode.
10401@end defmac
10402
a2c4f8e0
ZW
10403@defmac CLZ_DEFINED_VALUE_AT_ZERO (@var{mode}, @var{value})
10404@defmacx CTZ_DEFINED_VALUE_AT_ZERO (@var{mode}, @var{value})
14670a74 10405A C expression that indicates whether the architecture defines a value
ff2ce160 10406for @code{clz} or @code{ctz} with a zero operand.
14670a74
SL
10407A result of @code{0} indicates the value is undefined.
10408If the value is defined for only the RTL expression, the macro should
10409evaluate to @code{1}; if the value applies also to the corresponding optab
10410entry (which is normally the case if it expands directly into
ff2ce160 10411the corresponding RTL), then the macro should evaluate to @code{2}.
14670a74 10412In the cases where the value is defined, @var{value} should be set to
ff2ce160 10413this value.
14670a74
SL
10414
10415If this macro is not defined, the value of @code{clz} or
10416@code{ctz} at zero is assumed to be undefined.
7dba8395
RH
10417
10418This macro must be defined if the target's expansion for @code{ffs}
10419relies on a particular value to get correct results. Otherwise it
14670a74
SL
10420is not necessary, though it may be used to optimize some corner cases, and
10421to provide a default expansion for the @code{ffs} optab.
7dba8395
RH
10422
10423Note that regardless of this macro the ``definedness'' of @code{clz}
10424and @code{ctz} at zero do @emph{not} extend to the builtin functions
10425visible to the user. Thus one may be free to adjust the value at will
10426to match the target expansion of these operations without fear of
8a36672b 10427breaking the API@.
a2c4f8e0 10428@end defmac
7dba8395 10429
a2c4f8e0 10430@defmac Pmode
feca2ed3
JW
10431An alias for the machine mode for pointers. On most machines, define
10432this to be the integer mode corresponding to the width of a hardware
10433pointer; @code{SImode} on 32-bit machine or @code{DImode} on 64-bit machines.
10434On some machines you must define this to be one of the partial integer
10435modes, such as @code{PSImode}.
10436
10437The width of @code{Pmode} must be at least as large as the value of
10438@code{POINTER_SIZE}. If it is not equal, you must define the macro
10439@code{POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED} to specify how pointers are extended
10440to @code{Pmode}.
a2c4f8e0 10441@end defmac
feca2ed3 10442
a2c4f8e0 10443@defmac FUNCTION_MODE
feca2ed3 10444An alias for the machine mode used for memory references to functions
f71e957e 10445being called, in @code{call} RTL expressions. On most CISC machines,
ff2ce160 10446where an instruction can begin at any byte address, this should be
f71e957e
DK
10447@code{QImode}. On most RISC machines, where all instructions have fixed
10448size and alignment, this should be a mode with the same size and alignment
10449as the machine instruction words - typically @code{SImode} or @code{HImode}.
a2c4f8e0 10450@end defmac
feca2ed3 10451
a2c4f8e0 10452@defmac STDC_0_IN_SYSTEM_HEADERS
ee773fcc
NB
10453In normal operation, the preprocessor expands @code{__STDC__} to the
10454constant 1, to signify that GCC conforms to ISO Standard C@. On some
10455hosts, like Solaris, the system compiler uses a different convention,
10456where @code{__STDC__} is normally 0, but is 1 if the user specifies
10457strict conformance to the C Standard.
10458
10459Defining @code{STDC_0_IN_SYSTEM_HEADERS} makes GNU CPP follows the host
10460convention when processing system header files, but when processing user
10461files @code{__STDC__} will always expand to 1.
a2c4f8e0 10462@end defmac
ee773fcc 10463
1efcb8c6
JM
10464@deftypefn {C Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_C_PREINCLUDE (void)
10465Define this hook to return the name of a header file to be included at the start of all compilations, as if it had been included with @code{#include <@var{file}>}. If this hook returns @code{NULL}, or is not defined, or the header is not found, or if the user specifies @option{-ffreestanding} or @option{-nostdinc}, no header is included.
10466
10467 This hook can be used together with a header provided by the system C library to implement ISO C requirements for certain macros to be predefined that describe properties of the whole implementation rather than just the compiler.
10468@end deftypefn
10469
88b0e79e
JC
10470@deftypefn {C Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_IMPLICIT_EXTERN_C (const char*@var{})
10471Define this hook to add target-specific C++ implicit extern C functions. If this function returns true for the name of a file-scope function, that function implicitly gets extern "C" linkage rather than whatever language linkage the declaration would normally have. An example of such function is WinMain on Win32 targets.
10472@end deftypefn
10473
a2c4f8e0 10474@defmac NO_IMPLICIT_EXTERN_C
161d7b59 10475Define this macro if the system header files support C++ as well as C@.
feca2ed3
JW
10476This macro inhibits the usual method of using system header files in
10477C++, which is to pretend that the file's contents are enclosed in
10478@samp{extern "C" @{@dots{}@}}.
a2c4f8e0 10479@end defmac
feca2ed3 10480
feca2ed3
JW
10481@findex #pragma
10482@findex pragma
a2c4f8e0 10483@defmac REGISTER_TARGET_PRAGMAS ()
8b97c5f8 10484Define this macro if you want to implement any target-specific pragmas.
a5da89c6 10485If defined, it is a C expression which makes a series of calls to
b5b3e36a
DJ
10486@code{c_register_pragma} or @code{c_register_pragma_with_expansion}
10487for each pragma. The macro may also do any
a5da89c6 10488setup required for the pragmas.
8b97c5f8
ZW
10489
10490The primary reason to define this macro is to provide compatibility with
10491other compilers for the same target. In general, we discourage
161d7b59 10492definition of target-specific pragmas for GCC@.
feca2ed3 10493
c237e94a 10494If the pragma can be implemented by attributes then you should consider
91d231cb 10495defining the target hook @samp{TARGET_INSERT_ATTRIBUTES} as well.
f09db6e0 10496
8b97c5f8
ZW
10497Preprocessor macros that appear on pragma lines are not expanded. All
10498@samp{#pragma} directives that do not match any registered pragma are
630d3d5a 10499silently ignored, unless the user specifies @option{-Wunknown-pragmas}.
a2c4f8e0 10500@end defmac
8b97c5f8 10501
c58b209a 10502@deftypefun void c_register_pragma (const char *@var{space}, const char *@var{name}, void (*@var{callback}) (struct cpp_reader *))
b5b3e36a 10503@deftypefunx void c_register_pragma_with_expansion (const char *@var{space}, const char *@var{name}, void (*@var{callback}) (struct cpp_reader *))
8b97c5f8 10504
b5b3e36a
DJ
10505Each call to @code{c_register_pragma} or
10506@code{c_register_pragma_with_expansion} establishes one pragma. The
8b97c5f8
ZW
10507@var{callback} routine will be called when the preprocessor encounters a
10508pragma of the form
10509
10510@smallexample
10511#pragma [@var{space}] @var{name} @dots{}
10512@end smallexample
10513
a5da89c6
NB
10514@var{space} is the case-sensitive namespace of the pragma, or
10515@code{NULL} to put the pragma in the global namespace. The callback
10516routine receives @var{pfile} as its first argument, which can be passed
51fabca5 10517on to cpplib's functions if necessary. You can lex tokens after the
75ce3d48 10518@var{name} by calling @code{pragma_lex}. Tokens that are not read by the
51fabca5 10519callback will be silently ignored. The end of the line is indicated by
b5b3e36a
DJ
10520a token of type @code{CPP_EOF}. Macro expansion occurs on the
10521arguments of pragmas registered with
10522@code{c_register_pragma_with_expansion} but not on the arguments of
10523pragmas registered with @code{c_register_pragma}.
8b97c5f8 10524
75ce3d48 10525Note that the use of @code{pragma_lex} is specific to the C and C++
aac69a49 10526compilers. It will not work in the Java or Fortran compilers, or any
75ce3d48 10527other language compilers for that matter. Thus if @code{pragma_lex} is going
aac69a49 10528to be called from target-specific code, it must only be done so when
c771326b 10529building the C and C++ compilers. This can be done by defining the
aac69a49 10530variables @code{c_target_objs} and @code{cxx_target_objs} in the
aee96fe9 10531target entry in the @file{config.gcc} file. These variables should name
aac69a49 10532the target-specific, language-specific object file which contains the
75ce3d48 10533code that uses @code{pragma_lex}. Note it will also be necessary to add a
aac69a49
NC
10534rule to the makefile fragment pointed to by @code{tmake_file} that shows
10535how to build this object file.
8b97c5f8
ZW
10536@end deftypefun
10537
b5b3e36a 10538@defmac HANDLE_PRAGMA_PACK_WITH_EXPANSION
24a57808 10539Define this macro if macros should be expanded in the
b5b3e36a
DJ
10540arguments of @samp{#pragma pack}.
10541@end defmac
10542
467cecf3
JB
10543@defmac TARGET_DEFAULT_PACK_STRUCT
10544If your target requires a structure packing default other than 0 (meaning
0bdcd332 10545the machine default), define this macro to the necessary value (in bytes).
8b7d4300 10546This must be a value that would also be valid to use with
467cecf3
JB
10547@samp{#pragma pack()} (that is, a small power of two).
10548@end defmac
10549
a2c4f8e0 10550@defmac DOLLARS_IN_IDENTIFIERS
b1822ccc 10551Define this macro to control use of the character @samp{$} in
170ea7b9 10552identifier names for the C family of languages. 0 means @samp{$} is
b1822ccc
NB
10553not allowed by default; 1 means it is allowed. 1 is the default;
10554there is no need to define this macro in that case.
a2c4f8e0 10555@end defmac
feca2ed3 10556
a2c4f8e0 10557@defmac INSN_SETS_ARE_DELAYED (@var{insn})
feca2ed3
JW
10558Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if it is safe for the
10559delay slot scheduler to place instructions in the delay slot of @var{insn},
10560even if they appear to use a resource set or clobbered in @var{insn}.
a3a15b4d 10561@var{insn} is always a @code{jump_insn} or an @code{insn}; GCC knows that
feca2ed3
JW
10562every @code{call_insn} has this behavior. On machines where some @code{insn}
10563or @code{jump_insn} is really a function call and hence has this behavior,
10564you should define this macro.
10565
10566You need not define this macro if it would always return zero.
a2c4f8e0 10567@end defmac
feca2ed3 10568
a2c4f8e0 10569@defmac INSN_REFERENCES_ARE_DELAYED (@var{insn})
feca2ed3
JW
10570Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if it is safe for the
10571delay slot scheduler to place instructions in the delay slot of @var{insn},
10572even if they appear to set or clobber a resource referenced in @var{insn}.
10573@var{insn} is always a @code{jump_insn} or an @code{insn}. On machines where
10574some @code{insn} or @code{jump_insn} is really a function call and its operands
10575are registers whose use is actually in the subroutine it calls, you should
10576define this macro. Doing so allows the delay slot scheduler to move
10577instructions which copy arguments into the argument registers into the delay
10578slot of @var{insn}.
10579
10580You need not define this macro if it would always return zero.
a2c4f8e0 10581@end defmac
feca2ed3 10582
a2c4f8e0 10583@defmac MULTIPLE_SYMBOL_SPACES
15072eb1
ZW
10584Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if, in some cases,
10585global symbols from one translation unit may not be bound to undefined
10586symbols in another translation unit without user intervention. For
10587instance, under Microsoft Windows symbols must be explicitly imported
10588from shared libraries (DLLs).
10589
10590You need not define this macro if it would always evaluate to zero.
a2c4f8e0 10591@end defmac
861bb6c1 10592
61158923 10593@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_MD_ASM_CLOBBERS (tree @var{outputs}, tree @var{inputs}, tree @var{clobbers})
67dfe110 10594This target hook should add to @var{clobbers} @code{STRING_CST} trees for
61158923 10595any hard regs the port wishes to automatically clobber for an asm.
67dfe110 10596It should return the result of the last @code{tree_cons} used to add a
61158923
HPN
10597clobber. The @var{outputs}, @var{inputs} and @var{clobber} lists are the
10598corresponding parameters to the asm and may be inspected to avoid
10599clobbering a register that is an input or output of the asm. You can use
91b4415a 10600@code{tree_overlaps_hard_reg_set}, declared in @file{tree.h}, to test
61158923 10601for overlap with regards to asm-declared registers.
67dfe110 10602@end deftypefn
57bcb97a 10603
a2c4f8e0 10604@defmac MATH_LIBRARY
71d718e0 10605Define this macro as a C string constant for the linker argument to link
d9d16a19
JM
10606in the system math library, minus the initial @samp{"-l"}, or
10607@samp{""} if the target does not have a
71d718e0
JM
10608separate math library.
10609
d9d16a19 10610You need only define this macro if the default of @samp{"m"} is wrong.
a2c4f8e0 10611@end defmac
512b62fb 10612
a2c4f8e0 10613@defmac LIBRARY_PATH_ENV
512b62fb
JM
10614Define this macro as a C string constant for the environment variable that
10615specifies where the linker should look for libraries.
10616
10617You need only define this macro if the default of @samp{"LIBRARY_PATH"}
10618is wrong.
a2c4f8e0 10619@end defmac
e09d24ff 10620
4969c0d8
L
10621@defmac TARGET_POSIX_IO
10622Define this macro if the target supports the following POSIX@ file
10623functions, access, mkdir and file locking with fcntl / F_SETLKW@.
10624Defining @code{TARGET_POSIX_IO} will enable the test coverage code
e09d24ff 10625to use file locking when exiting a program, which avoids race conditions
4969c0d8 10626if the program has forked. It will also create directories at run-time
709a840a 10627for cross-profiling.
a2c4f8e0 10628@end defmac
0c99ec5c 10629
a2c4f8e0 10630@defmac MAX_CONDITIONAL_EXECUTE
0c99ec5c
RH
10631
10632A C expression for the maximum number of instructions to execute via
10633conditional execution instructions instead of a branch. A value of
10634@code{BRANCH_COST}+1 is the default if the machine does not use cc0, and
106351 if it does use cc0.
a2c4f8e0 10636@end defmac
90280148 10637
a2c4f8e0 10638@defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_TESTS (@var{ce_info}, @var{true_expr}, @var{false_expr})
c05ffc49
BS
10639Used if the target needs to perform machine-dependent modifications on the
10640conditionals used for turning basic blocks into conditionally executed code.
10641@var{ce_info} points to a data structure, @code{struct ce_if_block}, which
10642contains information about the currently processed blocks. @var{true_expr}
10643and @var{false_expr} are the tests that are used for converting the
10644then-block and the else-block, respectively. Set either @var{true_expr} or
10645@var{false_expr} to a null pointer if the tests cannot be converted.
a2c4f8e0 10646@end defmac
c05ffc49 10647
a2c4f8e0 10648@defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_MULTIPLE_TESTS (@var{ce_info}, @var{bb}, @var{true_expr}, @var{false_expr})
c05ffc49
BS
10649Like @code{IFCVT_MODIFY_TESTS}, but used when converting more complicated
10650if-statements into conditions combined by @code{and} and @code{or} operations.
10651@var{bb} contains the basic block that contains the test that is currently
10652being processed and about to be turned into a condition.
a2c4f8e0 10653@end defmac
90280148 10654
a2c4f8e0 10655@defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_INSN (@var{ce_info}, @var{pattern}, @var{insn})
c05ffc49
BS
10656A C expression to modify the @var{PATTERN} of an @var{INSN} that is to
10657be converted to conditional execution format. @var{ce_info} points to
10658a data structure, @code{struct ce_if_block}, which contains information
10659about the currently processed blocks.
a2c4f8e0 10660@end defmac
90280148 10661
a2c4f8e0 10662@defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_FINAL (@var{ce_info})
90280148 10663A C expression to perform any final machine dependent modifications in
c05ffc49
BS
10664converting code to conditional execution. The involved basic blocks
10665can be found in the @code{struct ce_if_block} structure that is pointed
10666to by @var{ce_info}.
a2c4f8e0 10667@end defmac
90280148 10668
a2c4f8e0 10669@defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_CANCEL (@var{ce_info})
90280148 10670A C expression to cancel any machine dependent modifications in
c05ffc49
BS
10671converting code to conditional execution. The involved basic blocks
10672can be found in the @code{struct ce_if_block} structure that is pointed
10673to by @var{ce_info}.
a2c4f8e0 10674@end defmac
c05ffc49 10675
67a0732f
SB
10676@defmac IFCVT_MACHDEP_INIT (@var{ce_info})
10677A C expression to initialize any machine specific data for if-conversion
10678of the if-block in the @code{struct ce_if_block} structure that is pointed
10679to by @var{ce_info}.
a2c4f8e0 10680@end defmac
c05ffc49 10681
b6fd8800 10682@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_MACHINE_DEPENDENT_REORG (void)
18dbd950
RS
10683If non-null, this hook performs a target-specific pass over the
10684instruction stream. The compiler will run it at all optimization levels,
10685just before the point at which it normally does delayed-branch scheduling.
10686
10687The exact purpose of the hook varies from target to target. Some use
10688it to do transformations that are necessary for correctness, such as
10689laying out in-function constant pools or avoiding hardware hazards.
10690Others use it as an opportunity to do some machine-dependent optimizations.
10691
10692You need not implement the hook if it has nothing to do. The default
10693definition is null.
10694@end deftypefn
10695
b6fd8800 10696@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS (void)
f6155fda
SS
10697Define this hook if you have any machine-specific built-in functions
10698that need to be defined. It should be a function that performs the
4a1d48f6
BS
10699necessary setup.
10700
c771326b 10701Machine specific built-in functions can be useful to expand special machine
4a1d48f6
BS
10702instructions that would otherwise not normally be generated because
10703they have no equivalent in the source language (for example, SIMD vector
10704instructions or prefetch instructions).
10705
6e34d3a3
JM
10706To create a built-in function, call the function
10707@code{lang_hooks.builtin_function}
c771326b 10708which is defined by the language front end. You can use any type nodes set
1a072294 10709up by @code{build_common_tree_nodes};
c237e94a 10710only language front ends that use those two functions will call
f6155fda 10711@samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}.
acdcefcc 10712@end deftypefn
4a1d48f6 10713
914d25dc 10714@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_BUILTIN_DECL (unsigned @var{code}, bool @var{initialize_p})
e9e4b3a8
RG
10715Define this hook if you have any machine-specific built-in functions
10716that need to be defined. It should be a function that returns the
10717builtin function declaration for the builtin function code @var{code}.
10718If there is no such builtin and it cannot be initialized at this time
10719if @var{initialize_p} is true the function should return @code{NULL_TREE}.
10720If @var{code} is out of range the function should return
10721@code{error_mark_node}.
10722@end deftypefn
10723
f6155fda 10724@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN (tree @var{exp}, rtx @var{target}, rtx @var{subtarget}, enum machine_mode @var{mode}, int @var{ignore})
4a1d48f6 10725
c771326b 10726Expand a call to a machine specific built-in function that was set up by
f6155fda
SS
10727@samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}. @var{exp} is the expression for the
10728function call; the result should go to @var{target} if that is
10729convenient, and have mode @var{mode} if that is convenient.
10730@var{subtarget} may be used as the target for computing one of
10731@var{exp}'s operands. @var{ignore} is nonzero if the value is to be
10732ignored. This function should return the result of the call to the
10733built-in function.
acdcefcc 10734@end deftypefn
4a1d48f6 10735
7a241624 10736@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_RESOLVE_OVERLOADED_BUILTIN (unsigned int @var{loc}, tree @var{fndecl}, void *@var{arglist})
4268e4cf
PB
10737Select a replacement for a machine specific built-in function that
10738was set up by @samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}. This is done
10739@emph{before} regular type checking, and so allows the target to
10740implement a crude form of function overloading. @var{fndecl} is the
10741declaration of the built-in function. @var{arglist} is the list of
10742arguments passed to the built-in function. The result is a
10743complete expression that implements the operation, usually
10744another @code{CALL_EXPR}.
7a241624 10745@var{arglist} really has type @samp{VEC(tree,gc)*}
4268e4cf
PB
10746@end deftypefn
10747
f311c3b4 10748@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_FOLD_BUILTIN (tree @var{fndecl}, int @var{n_args}, tree *@var{argp}, bool @var{ignore})
a05a80fc
KH
10749Fold a call to a machine specific built-in function that was set up by
10750@samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}. @var{fndecl} is the declaration of the
f311c3b4
NF
10751built-in function. @var{n_args} is the number of arguments passed to
10752the function; the arguments themselves are pointed to by @var{argp}.
ea679d55
JG
10753The result is another tree, valid for both GIMPLE and GENERIC,
10754containing a simplified expression for the call's result. If
10755@var{ignore} is true the value will be ignored.
10756@end deftypefn
10757
10758@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_GIMPLE_FOLD_BUILTIN (gimple_stmt_iterator *@var{gsi})
10759Fold a call to a machine specific built-in function that was set up
10760by @samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}. @var{gsi} points to the gimple
10761statement holding the function call. Returns true if any change
10762was made to the GIMPLE stream.
d6c2b67d
PB
10763@end deftypefn
10764
3649b9b7
ST
10765@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_COMPARE_VERSION_PRIORITY (tree @var{decl1}, tree @var{decl2})
10766This hook is used to compare the target attributes in two functions to
10767determine which function's features get higher priority. This is used
10768during function multi-versioning to figure out the order in which two
10769versions must be dispatched. A function version with a higher priority
10770is checked for dispatching earlier. @var{decl1} and @var{decl2} are
10771 the two function decls that will be compared.
10772@end deftypefn
10773
10774@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_GET_FUNCTION_VERSIONS_DISPATCHER (void *@var{decl})
10775This hook is used to get the dispatcher function for a set of function
10776versions. The dispatcher function is called to invoke the right function
10777version at run-time. @var{decl} is one version from a set of semantically
10778identical versions.
10779@end deftypefn
10780
10781@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_GENERATE_VERSION_DISPATCHER_BODY (void *@var{arg})
10782This hook is used to generate the dispatcher logic to invoke the right
10783function version at run-time for a given set of function versions.
10784@var{arg} points to the callgraph node of the dispatcher function whose
10785body must be generated.
10786@end deftypefn
10787
807e902e 10788@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CAN_USE_DOLOOP_P (const widest_int @var{&iterations}, const widest_int @var{&iterations_max}, unsigned int @var{loop_depth}, bool @var{entered_at_top})
1d0216c8
RS
10789Return true if it is possible to use low-overhead loops (@code{doloop_end}
10790and @code{doloop_begin}) for a particular loop. @var{iterations} gives the
10791exact number of iterations, or 0 if not known. @var{iterations_max} gives
10792the maximum number of iterations, or 0 if not known. @var{loop_depth} is
10793the nesting depth of the loop, with 1 for innermost loops, 2 for loops that
10794contain innermost loops, and so on. @var{entered_at_top} is true if the
10795loop is only entered from the top.
10796
10797This hook is only used if @code{doloop_end} is available. The default
10798implementation returns true. You can use @code{can_use_doloop_if_innermost}
10799if the loop must be the innermost, and if there are no other restrictions.
10800@end deftypefn
10801
ac44248e 10802@deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_WITHIN_DOLOOP (const rtx_insn *@var{insn})
a71a498d 10803
e7e64a25 10804Take an instruction in @var{insn} and return NULL if it is valid within a
72392b81
JR
10805low-overhead loop, otherwise return a string explaining why doloop
10806could not be applied.
a71a498d 10807
e7e64a25
AS
10808Many targets use special registers for low-overhead looping. For any
10809instruction that clobbers these this function should return a string indicating
083cad55 10810the reason why the doloop could not be applied.
a71a498d 10811By default, the RTL loop optimizer does not use a present doloop pattern for
083cad55 10812loops containing function calls or branch on table instructions.
a71a498d
AS
10813@end deftypefn
10814
ac44248e 10815@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LEGITIMATE_COMBINED_INSN (rtx_insn *@var{insn})
78e4f1ad
UB
10816Take an instruction in @var{insn} and return @code{false} if the instruction is not appropriate as a combination of two or more instructions. The default is to accept all instructions.
10817@end deftypefn
10818
a2c4f8e0 10819@defmac MD_CAN_REDIRECT_BRANCH (@var{branch1}, @var{branch2})
6e7b03e1 10820
4fe9b91c 10821Take a branch insn in @var{branch1} and another in @var{branch2}.
6e7b03e1
AH
10822Return true if redirecting @var{branch1} to the destination of
10823@var{branch2} is possible.
10824
10825On some targets, branches may have a limited range. Optimizing the
10826filling of delay slots can result in branches being redirected, and this
10827may in turn cause a branch offset to overflow.
a2c4f8e0 10828@end defmac
6e7b03e1 10829
4b4de898
JR
10830@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CAN_FOLLOW_JUMP (const_rtx @var{follower}, const_rtx @var{followee})
10831FOLLOWER and FOLLOWEE are JUMP_INSN instructions; return true if FOLLOWER may be modified to follow FOLLOWEE; false, if it can't. For example, on some targets, certain kinds of branches can't be made to follow through a hot/cold partitioning.
10832@end deftypefn
10833
914d25dc 10834@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_COMMUTATIVE_P (const_rtx @var{x}, int @var{outer_code})
8ddf681a
R
10835This target hook returns @code{true} if @var{x} is considered to be commutative.
10836Usually, this is just COMMUTATIVE_P (@var{x}), but the HP PA doesn't consider
0ee2ea09 10837PLUS to be commutative inside a MEM@. @var{outer_code} is the rtx code
8ddf681a
R
10838of the enclosing rtl, if known, otherwise it is UNKNOWN.
10839@end deftypefn
10840
b48f503c 10841@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_ALLOCATE_INITIAL_VALUE (rtx @var{hard_reg})
385b6e2d
R
10842
10843When the initial value of a hard register has been copied in a pseudo
4fe9b91c 10844register, it is often not necessary to actually allocate another register
385b6e2d 10845to this pseudo register, because the original hard register or a stack slot
b48f503c
KK
10846it has been saved into can be used. @code{TARGET_ALLOCATE_INITIAL_VALUE}
10847is called at the start of register allocation once for each hard register
10848that had its initial value copied by using
385b6e2d
R
10849@code{get_func_hard_reg_initial_val} or @code{get_hard_reg_initial_val}.
10850Possible values are @code{NULL_RTX}, if you don't want
10851to do any special allocation, a @code{REG} rtx---that would typically be
10852the hard register itself, if it is known not to be clobbered---or a
10853@code{MEM}.
10854If you are returning a @code{MEM}, this is only a hint for the allocator;
10855it might decide to use another register anyways.
29454ff5
SL
10856You may use @code{current_function_is_leaf} or
10857@code{REG_N_SETS} in the hook to determine if the hard
385b6e2d 10858register in question will not be clobbered.
b48f503c
KK
10859The default value of this hook is @code{NULL}, which disables any special
10860allocation.
10861@end deftypefn
385b6e2d 10862
215b063c
PB
10863@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_UNSPEC_MAY_TRAP_P (const_rtx @var{x}, unsigned @var{flags})
10864This target hook returns nonzero if @var{x}, an @code{unspec} or
10865@code{unspec_volatile} operation, might cause a trap. Targets can use
10866this hook to enhance precision of analysis for @code{unspec} and
10867@code{unspec_volatile} operations. You may call @code{may_trap_p_1}
10868to analyze inner elements of @var{x} in which case @var{flags} should be
10869passed along.
10870@end deftypefn
10871
db2960f4 10872@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SET_CURRENT_FUNCTION (tree @var{decl})
ff2ce160 10873The compiler invokes this hook whenever it changes its current function
db2960f4
SL
10874context (@code{cfun}). You can define this function if
10875the back end needs to perform any initialization or reset actions on a
10876per-function basis. For example, it may be used to implement function
10877attributes that affect register usage or code generation patterns.
10878The argument @var{decl} is the declaration for the new function context,
10879and may be null to indicate that the compiler has left a function context
10880and is returning to processing at the top level.
10881The default hook function does nothing.
10882
10883GCC sets @code{cfun} to a dummy function context during initialization of
10884some parts of the back end. The hook function is not invoked in this
10885situation; you need not worry about the hook being invoked recursively,
10886or when the back end is in a partially-initialized state.
914d25dc
JR
10887@code{cfun} might be @code{NULL} to indicate processing at top level,
10888outside of any function scope.
db2960f4
SL
10889@end deftypefn
10890
a2c4f8e0 10891@defmac TARGET_OBJECT_SUFFIX
807633e5
ZW
10892Define this macro to be a C string representing the suffix for object
10893files on your target machine. If you do not define this macro, GCC will
10894use @samp{.o} as the suffix for object files.
a2c4f8e0 10895@end defmac
807633e5 10896
a2c4f8e0 10897@defmac TARGET_EXECUTABLE_SUFFIX
807633e5
ZW
10898Define this macro to be a C string representing the suffix to be
10899automatically added to executable files on your target machine. If you
10900do not define this macro, GCC will use the null string as the suffix for
10901executable files.
a2c4f8e0 10902@end defmac
807633e5 10903
a2c4f8e0 10904@defmac COLLECT_EXPORT_LIST
807633e5
ZW
10905If defined, @code{collect2} will scan the individual object files
10906specified on its command line and create an export list for the linker.
10907Define this macro for systems like AIX, where the linker discards
10908object files that are not referenced from @code{main} and uses export
10909lists.
a2c4f8e0 10910@end defmac
807633e5 10911
a2c4f8e0 10912@defmac MODIFY_JNI_METHOD_CALL (@var{mdecl})
55ae46b1
RM
10913Define this macro to a C expression representing a variant of the
10914method call @var{mdecl}, if Java Native Interface (JNI) methods
10915must be invoked differently from other methods on your target.
95fef11f 10916For example, on 32-bit Microsoft Windows, JNI methods must be invoked using
55ae46b1
RM
10917the @code{stdcall} calling convention and this macro is then
10918defined as this expression:
10919
10920@smallexample
10921build_type_attribute_variant (@var{mdecl},
10922 build_tree_list
10923 (get_identifier ("stdcall"),
10924 NULL))
10925@end smallexample
a2c4f8e0 10926@end defmac
e4ec2cac
AO
10927
10928@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CANNOT_MODIFY_JUMPS_P (void)
10929This target hook returns @code{true} past the point in which new jump
10930instructions could be created. On machines that require a register for
10931every jump such as the SHmedia ISA of SH5, this point would typically be
10932reload, so this target hook should be defined to a function such as:
10933
10934@smallexample
10935static bool
10936cannot_modify_jumps_past_reload_p ()
10937@{
10938 return (reload_completed || reload_in_progress);
10939@}
10940@end smallexample
10941@end deftypefn
fe3ad572 10942
a87cf97e 10943@deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_BRANCH_TARGET_REGISTER_CLASS (void)
fe3ad572
SC
10944This target hook returns a register class for which branch target register
10945optimizations should be applied. All registers in this class should be
c0cbdbd9 10946usable interchangeably. After reload, registers in this class will be
fe3ad572
SC
10947re-allocated and loads will be hoisted out of loops and be subjected
10948to inter-block scheduling.
10949@end deftypefn
10950
10951@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_BRANCH_TARGET_REGISTER_CALLEE_SAVED (bool @var{after_prologue_epilogue_gen})
10952Branch target register optimization will by default exclude callee-saved
10953registers
10954that are not already live during the current function; if this target hook
10955returns true, they will be included. The target code must than make sure
10956that all target registers in the class returned by
10957@samp{TARGET_BRANCH_TARGET_REGISTER_CLASS} that might need saving are
10958saved. @var{after_prologue_epilogue_gen} indicates if prologues and
10959epilogues have already been generated. Note, even if you only return
10960true when @var{after_prologue_epilogue_gen} is false, you still are likely
10961to have to make special provisions in @code{INITIAL_ELIMINATION_OFFSET}
10962to reserve space for caller-saved target registers.
10963@end deftypefn
2082e02f 10964
2929029c
WG
10965@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_CONDITIONAL_EXECUTION (void)
10966This target hook returns true if the target supports conditional execution.
10967This target hook is required only when the target has several different
10968modes and they have different conditional execution capability, such as ARM.
10969@end deftypefn
10970
40ac4f73
CB
10971@deftypefn {Target Hook} unsigned TARGET_LOOP_UNROLL_ADJUST (unsigned @var{nunroll}, struct loop *@var{loop})
10972This target hook returns a new value for the number of times @var{loop}
10973should be unrolled. The parameter @var{nunroll} is the number of times
10974the loop is to be unrolled. The parameter @var{loop} is a pointer to
10975the loop, which is going to be checked for unrolling. This target hook
10976is required only when the target has special constraints like maximum
10977number of memory accesses.
10978@end deftypefn
10979
2082e02f 10980@defmac POWI_MAX_MULTS
73774972 10981If defined, this macro is interpreted as a signed integer C expression
2082e02f
RS
10982that specifies the maximum number of floating point multiplications
10983that should be emitted when expanding exponentiation by an integer
10984constant inline. When this value is defined, exponentiation requiring
10985more than this number of multiplications is implemented by calling the
10986system library's @code{pow}, @code{powf} or @code{powl} routines.
10987The default value places no upper bound on the multiplication count.
10988@end defmac
94d1613b 10989
3dd53121 10990@deftypefn Macro void TARGET_EXTRA_INCLUDES (const char *@var{sysroot}, const char *@var{iprefix}, int @var{stdinc})
94d1613b
MS
10991This target hook should register any extra include files for the
10992target. The parameter @var{stdinc} indicates if normal include files
3dd53121
AP
10993are present. The parameter @var{sysroot} is the system root directory.
10994The parameter @var{iprefix} is the prefix for the gcc directory.
10995@end deftypefn
10996
10997@deftypefn Macro void TARGET_EXTRA_PRE_INCLUDES (const char *@var{sysroot}, const char *@var{iprefix}, int @var{stdinc})
10998This target hook should register any extra include files for the
10999target before any standard headers. The parameter @var{stdinc}
11000indicates if normal include files are present. The parameter
11001@var{sysroot} is the system root directory. The parameter
11002@var{iprefix} is the prefix for the gcc directory.
94d1613b
MS
11003@end deftypefn
11004
11005@deftypefn Macro void TARGET_OPTF (char *@var{path})
11006This target hook should register special include paths for the target.
11007The parameter @var{path} is the include to register. On Darwin
11008systems, this is used for Framework includes, which have semantics
11009that are different from @option{-I}.
11010@end deftypefn
4a77e08c 11011
914d25dc
JR
11012@defmac bool TARGET_USE_LOCAL_THUNK_ALIAS_P (tree @var{fndecl})
11013This target macro returns @code{true} if it is safe to use a local alias
4a77e08c 11014for a virtual function @var{fndecl} when constructing thunks,
914d25dc 11015@code{false} otherwise. By default, the macro returns @code{true} for all
431ae0bf 11016functions, if a target supports aliases (i.e.@: defines
4a77e08c 11017@code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF}), @code{false} otherwise,
914d25dc 11018@end defmac
a2bec818
DJ
11019
11020@defmac TARGET_FORMAT_TYPES
11021If defined, this macro is the name of a global variable containing
11022target-specific format checking information for the @option{-Wformat}
11023option. The default is to have no target-specific format checks.
11024@end defmac
11025
11026@defmac TARGET_N_FORMAT_TYPES
11027If defined, this macro is the number of entries in
11028@code{TARGET_FORMAT_TYPES}.
11029@end defmac
e50e6b88 11030
6590fc9f
KT
11031@defmac TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_ATTRIBUTES
11032If defined, this macro is the name of a global variable containing
11033target-specific format overrides for the @option{-Wformat} option. The
11034default is to have no target-specific format overrides. If defined,
11035@code{TARGET_FORMAT_TYPES} must be defined, too.
11036@end defmac
11037
11038@defmac TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_ATTRIBUTES_COUNT
11039If defined, this macro specifies the number of entries in
11040@code{TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_ATTRIBUTES}.
11041@end defmac
11042
94564826
KT
11043@defmac TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_INIT
11044If defined, this macro specifies the optional initialization
11045routine for target specific customizations of the system printf
11046and scanf formatter settings.
11047@end defmac
11048
914d25dc 11049@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_RELAXED_ORDERING
445cf5eb
JM
11050If set to @code{true}, means that the target's memory model does not
11051guarantee that loads which do not depend on one another will access
11052main memory in the order of the instruction stream; if ordering is
11053important, an explicit memory barrier must be used. This is true of
11054many recent processors which implement a policy of ``relaxed,''
11055``weak,'' or ``release'' memory consistency, such as Alpha, PowerPC,
11056and ia64. The default is @code{false}.
914d25dc 11057@end deftypevr
445cf5eb 11058
b6fd8800 11059@deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_ARG_FOR_UNPROTOTYPED_FN (const_tree @var{typelist}, const_tree @var{funcdecl}, const_tree @var{val})
083cad55
EC
11060If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11061illegal to pass argument @var{val} to function @var{funcdecl}
4d3e6fae
FJ
11062with prototype @var{typelist}.
11063@end deftypefn
11064
b6fd8800 11065@deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_CONVERSION (const_tree @var{fromtype}, const_tree @var{totype})
4de67c26
JM
11066If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11067invalid to convert from @var{fromtype} to @var{totype}, or @code{NULL}
11068if validity should be determined by the front end.
11069@end deftypefn
11070
b6fd8800 11071@deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_UNARY_OP (int @var{op}, const_tree @var{type})
4de67c26
JM
11072If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11073invalid to apply operation @var{op} (where unary plus is denoted by
11074@code{CONVERT_EXPR}) to an operand of type @var{type}, or @code{NULL}
11075if validity should be determined by the front end.
11076@end deftypefn
11077
b6fd8800 11078@deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_BINARY_OP (int @var{op}, const_tree @var{type1}, const_tree @var{type2})
4de67c26
JM
11079If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11080invalid to apply operation @var{op} to operands of types @var{type1}
11081and @var{type2}, or @code{NULL} if validity should be determined by
11082the front end.
11083@end deftypefn
11084
b6fd8800 11085@deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_PARAMETER_TYPE (const_tree @var{type})
40449a90 11086If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
ff2ce160 11087invalid for functions to include parameters of type @var{type},
40449a90
SL
11088or @code{NULL} if validity should be determined by
11089the front end. This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
11090@end deftypefn
11091
b6fd8800 11092@deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_RETURN_TYPE (const_tree @var{type})
40449a90 11093If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
ff2ce160 11094invalid for functions to have return type @var{type},
40449a90
SL
11095or @code{NULL} if validity should be determined by
11096the front end. This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
11097@end deftypefn
11098
b6fd8800 11099@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_PROMOTED_TYPE (const_tree @var{type})
ff2ce160
MS
11100If defined, this target hook returns the type to which values of
11101@var{type} should be promoted when they appear in expressions,
40449a90
SL
11102analogous to the integer promotions, or @code{NULL_TREE} to use the
11103front end's normal promotion rules. This hook is useful when there are
11104target-specific types with special promotion rules.
11105This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
11106@end deftypefn
11107
b6fd8800 11108@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CONVERT_TO_TYPE (tree @var{type}, tree @var{expr})
ff2ce160
MS
11109If defined, this hook returns the result of converting @var{expr} to
11110@var{type}. It should return the converted expression,
40449a90 11111or @code{NULL_TREE} to apply the front end's normal conversion rules.
ff2ce160 11112This hook is useful when there are target-specific types with special
40449a90
SL
11113conversion rules.
11114This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
11115@end deftypefn
11116
e50e6b88
DS
11117@defmac TARGET_USE_JCR_SECTION
11118This macro determines whether to use the JCR section to register Java
11119classes. By default, TARGET_USE_JCR_SECTION is defined to 1 if both
11120SUPPORTS_WEAK and TARGET_HAVE_NAMED_SECTIONS are true, else 0.
11121@end defmac
64ee9490
EC
11122
11123@defmac OBJC_JBLEN
11124This macro determines the size of the objective C jump buffer for the
11125NeXT runtime. By default, OBJC_JBLEN is defined to an innocuous value.
11126@end defmac
56e449d3
SL
11127
11128@defmac LIBGCC2_UNWIND_ATTRIBUTE
11129Define this macro if any target-specific attributes need to be attached
ff2ce160 11130to the functions in @file{libgcc} that provide low-level support for
56e449d3
SL
11131call stack unwinding. It is used in declarations in @file{unwind-generic.h}
11132and the associated definitions of those functions.
11133@end defmac
007e61c2 11134
2e3f842f
L
11135@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_UPDATE_STACK_BOUNDARY (void)
11136Define this macro to update the current function stack boundary if
11137necessary.
11138@end deftypefn
11139
11140@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_GET_DRAP_RTX (void)
914d25dc 11141This hook should return an rtx for Dynamic Realign Argument Pointer (DRAP) if a
2e3f842f 11142different argument pointer register is needed to access the function's
914d25dc
JR
11143argument list due to stack realignment. Return @code{NULL} if no DRAP
11144is needed.
2e3f842f
L
11145@end deftypefn
11146
b6fd8800 11147@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ALLOCATE_STACK_SLOTS_FOR_ARGS (void)
007e61c2
PB
11148When optimization is disabled, this hook indicates whether or not
11149arguments should be allocated to stack slots. Normally, GCC allocates
11150stacks slots for arguments when not optimizing in order to make
11151debugging easier. However, when a function is declared with
11152@code{__attribute__((naked))}, there is no stack frame, and the compiler
11153cannot safely move arguments from the registers in which they are passed
11154to the stack. Therefore, this hook should return true in general, but
11155false for naked functions. The default implementation always returns true.
11156@end deftypefn
2c5bfdf7 11157
2c5bfdf7
AN
11158@deftypevr {Target Hook} {unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT} TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR
11159On some architectures it can take multiple instructions to synthesize
11160a constant. If there is another constant already in a register that
11161is close enough in value then it is preferable that the new constant
11162is computed from this register using immediate addition or
a4ce9883 11163subtraction. We accomplish this through CSE. Besides the value of
2c5bfdf7
AN
11164the constant we also add a lower and an upper constant anchor to the
11165available expressions. These are then queried when encountering new
11166constants. The anchors are computed by rounding the constant up and
11167down to a multiple of the value of @code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR}.
11168@code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR} should be the maximum positive value
11169accepted by immediate-add plus one. We currently assume that the
11170value of @code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR} is a power of 2. For example, on
11171MIPS, where add-immediate takes a 16-bit signed value,
11172@code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR} is set to @samp{0x8000}. The default value
0d8aa4b1
AS
11173is zero, which disables this optimization.
11174@end deftypevr
57c5ab1b 11175
dfe06d3e
JJ
11176@deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT} TARGET_ASAN_SHADOW_OFFSET (void)
11177Return the offset bitwise ored into shifted address to get corresponding
11178Address Sanitizer shadow memory address. NULL if Address Sanitizer is not
11179supported by the target.
11180@end deftypefn
11181
5dcfdccd
KY
11182@deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT} TARGET_MEMMODEL_CHECK (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT @var{val})
11183Validate target specific memory model mask bits. When NULL no target specific
11184memory model bits are allowed.
11185@end deftypefn
11186
57c5ab1b
RH
11187@deftypevr {Target Hook} {unsigned char} TARGET_ATOMIC_TEST_AND_SET_TRUEVAL
11188This value should be set if the result written by @code{atomic_test_and_set} is not exactly 1, i.e. the @code{bool} @code{true}.
11189@end deftypevr
2f251a05
AI
11190
11191@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAS_IFUNC_P (void)
11192It returns true if the target supports GNU indirect functions.
11193The support includes the assembler, linker and dynamic linker.
11194The default value of this hook is based on target's libc.
11195@end deftypefn
267bac10 11196
fceec4d3
AM
11197@deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_ATOMIC_ALIGN_FOR_MODE (enum machine_mode @var{mode})
11198If defined, this function returns an appropriate alignment in bits for an atomic object of machine_mode @var{mode}. If 0 is returned then the default alignment for the specified mode is used.
11199@end deftypefn
11200
267bac10
JM
11201@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ATOMIC_ASSIGN_EXPAND_FENV (tree *@var{hold}, tree *@var{clear}, tree *@var{update})
11202ISO C11 requires atomic compound assignments that may raise floating-point exceptions to raise exceptions corresponding to the arithmetic operation whose result was successfully stored in a compare-and-exchange sequence. This requires code equivalent to calls to @code{feholdexcept}, @code{feclearexcept} and @code{feupdateenv} to be generated at appropriate points in the compare-and-exchange sequence. This hook should set @code{*@var{hold}} to an expression equivalent to the call to @code{feholdexcept}, @code{*@var{clear}} to an expression equivalent to the call to @code{feclearexcept} and @code{*@var{update}} to an expression equivalent to the call to @code{feupdateenv}. The three expressions are @code{NULL_TREE} on entry to the hook and may be left as @code{NULL_TREE} if no code is required in a particular place. The default implementation leaves all three expressions as @code{NULL_TREE}. The @code{__atomic_feraiseexcept} function from @code{libatomic} may be of use as part of the code generated in @code{*@var{update}}.
11203@end deftypefn
807e902e
KZ
11204
11205@defmac TARGET_SUPPORTS_WIDE_INT
11206
11207On older ports, large integers are stored in @code{CONST_DOUBLE} rtl
11208objects. Newer ports define @code{TARGET_SUPPORTS_WIDE_INT} to be nonzero
11209to indicate that large integers are stored in
11210@code{CONST_WIDE_INT} rtl objects. The @code{CONST_WIDE_INT} allows
11211very large integer constants to be represented. @code{CONST_DOUBLE}
11212is limited to twice the size of the host's @code{HOST_WIDE_INT}
11213representation.
11214
11215Converting a port mostly requires looking for the places where
11216@code{CONST_DOUBLE}s are used with @code{VOIDmode} and replacing that
11217code with code that accesses @code{CONST_WIDE_INT}s. @samp{"grep -i
11218const_double"} at the port level gets you to 95% of the changes that
11219need to be made. There are a few places that require a deeper look.
11220
11221@itemize @bullet
11222@item
11223There is no equivalent to @code{hval} and @code{lval} for
11224@code{CONST_WIDE_INT}s. This would be difficult to express in the md
11225language since there are a variable number of elements.
11226
11227Most ports only check that @code{hval} is either 0 or -1 to see if the
11228value is small. As mentioned above, this will no longer be necessary
11229since small constants are always @code{CONST_INT}. Of course there
11230are still a few exceptions, the alpha's constraint used by the zap
11231instruction certainly requires careful examination by C code.
11232However, all the current code does is pass the hval and lval to C
11233code, so evolving the c code to look at the @code{CONST_WIDE_INT} is
11234not really a large change.
11235
11236@item
11237Because there is no standard template that ports use to materialize
11238constants, there is likely to be some futzing that is unique to each
11239port in this code.
11240
11241@item
11242The rtx costs may have to be adjusted to properly account for larger
11243constants that are represented as @code{CONST_WIDE_INT}.
11244@end itemize
11245
11246All and all it does not take long to convert ports that the
11247maintainer is familiar with.
11248
11249@end defmac